Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 19, 2017

Registration No. 333-            


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

FORM S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

STERLING BANCORP, INC.
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

Michigan   6035   38-3163775
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  (I.R.S. Employer Identification Number)

One Towne Square, Suite 1900
Southfield, Michigan 48076
248-355-2400
(Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Registrant's Principal Executive Offices)

Gary Judd
Chairman, Chief Executive Officer
One Towne Square, Suite 1900
Southfield, Michigan 48076
248-355-2400
(Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Agent for Service)

Copies to:

Phillip D. Torrence, Esq.
Jeffrey H. Kuras, Esq.
Jessica M. Herron, Esq.
Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP
660 Woodward Avenue
2290 First National Building
Detroit, Michigan 48226
(313) 465-7000
  Colleen L. Kimmel, Esq.
Vice President & General Counsel
Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
One Towne Square, Suite 1900
Southfield, Michigan 48076
248-355-2400
  Craig D. Miller, Esq.
Manatt, Phelps & Phillips, LLP
One Embarcadero Center, 30th Floor
San Francisco, California 94111
(415) 291-7400

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this registration statement becomes effective.

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box: o

If this Form is filed to register additional shares for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering: o

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering: o

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering: o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer," "smaller reporting company" and "emerging growth company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer o   Accelerated filer o   Non-accelerated filer ý
(Do not check if a smaller
reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company o

Emerging growth company ý

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided to Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act. ý

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

       
 
Title of each class of
securities to be registered

  Proposed
maximum
aggregate
offering
price(1)(2)

  Amount of
registration fee

 

Common Stock, no par value per share

  $230,000,000   $28,635

 

(1)
Includes                additional shares that the underwriter has the option to purchase.

(2)
Estimated solely for purposes of calculating the amount of the registration fee in accordance with Rule 457(o) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this registration statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

   


Table of Contents

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We and the selling shareholders may not sell these securities until the Registration Statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED OCTOBER 19, 2017

PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS

                Shares

LOGO

COMMON STOCK

        This is the initial public offering of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., the holding company for Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B., a federal savings bank.

        We are offering                shares of common stock and the selling shareholders are offering                shares of our common stock. We will not receive any proceeds from the sales of shares by the selling shareholders.

        Prior to this offering, there has been no established public market for our common stock. We have applied to list our common stock on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol "             ."

        We anticipate that the public offering price of our common stock will be between $            and $            per share.

        We are an "emerging growth company" as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 and, as such, have elected to comply with certain reduced public company disclosure standards.

        We are a "controlled company" under the corporate governance rules for Nasdaq-listed companies, and as such, our board of directors could determine not to have a majority of independent directors, a nominating committee or a compensation committee comprised solely of independent directors.

        Investing in our common stock involves risk. See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 16 of this prospectus to read about factors you should consider before investing in our common stock.

 
  Per Share   Total  

Public offering price

             

Underwriting discounts(1)

             

Proceeds to us, before expenses

             

Proceeds to the selling shareholders, before expenses

             

(1)
The offering of our common stock will be conducted on a firm commitment basis. See "Underwriting" for a description of all underwriting compensation payable and expense reimbursement in connection with this offering.

        The underwriter has an option to purchase up to an additional            shares from us and up to an additional            shares from the selling shareholders at the public offering price, less the underwriting discount, within 30 days from the date of this prospectus.

        Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

        The shares of our common stock in this offering are not savings accounts, deposits or other obligations of any bank and are not insured or guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any other governmental agency.

        The underwriter expects to deliver the shares of our common stock against payment on or about                , 2017.

LOGO

   

The date of this prospectus is                , 2017.


Table of Contents

GRAPHIC


Table of Contents


TABLE OF CONTENTS

SUMMARY

    1  

RISK FACTORS

    16  

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

    42  

USE OF PROCEEDS

    44  

CAPITALIZATION

    45  

DILUTION

    46  

DIVIDEND POLICY

    48  

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA

    50  

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

    54  

BUSINESS

    79  

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

    92  

MANAGEMENT

    102  

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

    109  

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

    114  

PRINCIPAL AND SELLING SHAREHOLDERS

    116  

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

    118  

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

    122  

CERTAIN MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF COMMON STOCK

    124  

UNDERWRITING

    128  

LEGAL MATTERS

    132  

EXPERTS

    132  

WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

    132  

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

    F-1  

i


Table of Contents


About This Prospectus

        You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus that we authorize to be delivered to you. We, the selling shareholders and the underwriter have not authorized anyone to provide you with different or additional information. We, the selling shareholders and the underwriter are not making an offer of these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer is not permitted. You should not assume that the information contained in this prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date on the front of this prospectus. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since that date.

        Unless we state otherwise or the context otherwise requires, references in this prospectus to "we," "our," "us" or "the Company" refer to Sterling Bancorp, Inc., a Michigan corporation, and its subsidiaries, including Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B., which we sometimes refer to as "Sterling Bank," "the Bank" or "our Bank."


Market and Industry Data

        Within this prospectus, we reference certain market, industry and demographic data and other statistical information. We have obtained this data and information from various independent, third party industry sources and publications. Nothing in the data or information used or derived from third party sources should be construed as advice. Some data and other information are also based on our good faith estimates, which are derived from our review of internal surveys and independent sources. We believe that these external sources and estimates are reliable, but have not independently verified them. Statements as to our market position are based on market data currently available to us. Although we are not aware of any misstatements regarding the economic, demographic and market data presented herein, these estimates involve inherent risks and uncertainties and are based on assumptions that are subject to change.


Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company

        As a company with less than $1.07 billion in revenue during our last fiscal year, we qualify as an "emerging growth company" under the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act (the "JOBS Act"). An emerging growth company may take advantage of reduced reporting requirements and is relieved of certain other significant requirements that are otherwise generally applicable to public companies. As an emerging growth company:

        In addition to the relief described above, the JOBS Act permits us an extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards affecting public companies. We have irrevocably determined not to take advantage of this extended transition period, which means that the financial statements included in this prospectus, as well as any financial statements that we file in the

ii


Table of Contents

future, will be subject to all new or revised accounting standards generally applicable to public companies.

        In this prospectus we have elected to take advantage of the reduced disclosure requirements relating to executive compensation, and in the future we may take advantage of any or all of these exemptions for so long as we remain an emerging growth company. We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest of (i) the end of the fiscal year during which we have total annual gross revenues of $1.07 billion or more, (ii) the end of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of the completion of this offering, (iii) the date on which we have, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt and (iv) the date on which we are deemed to be a "large accelerated filer" under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

iii


Table of Contents



SUMMARY

        This summary highlights selected information contained in greater detail elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary may not contain all of the information that you should consider before investing in our securities. You should carefully read this entire prospectus, including the sections entitled "Risk Factors" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and the notes related thereto before making an investment decision. Some of the statements in this prospectus constitute forward-looking statements. See "Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements."

Our Company

        We are a unitary thrift holding company headquartered in Southfield, Michigan with our primary branch operations in San Francisco and Los Angeles, California. Through our wholly owned bank subsidiary, Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B., we offer a broad range of loan products to the residential and commercial markets, as well as retail banking services. Since 2013, we have grown organically at a compound annual growth rate of 29% while maintaining stable margins and solid asset quality. Since 2013, we have grown our branch network from 16 branches to our current total of 26 branches, including 20 in the San Francisco area, 4 in greater Los Angeles, our recently opened branch in New York City and our headquarters' branch in Michigan. We also expect to open a branch near Seattle, Washington, where we currently have a loan production office, by the end of 2017 and two additional branches in Los Angeles in early 2018.

        We have a large and growing portfolio of adjustable rate residential mortgage loans. We manage residential credit risks through a financial documentation process and programs with low loan to value ratios, which averaged 63% across our residential portfolio as of June 30, 2017. Our risk management includes disciplined documentation of ability to repay, liquidity analysis and face-to-face customer interaction.

        We also operate substantial and growing commercial and construction lending businesses, utilizing a traditional community banking relationship-focused culture to identify strong borrowers with projects and operations in our branch network areas. We manage credit risks in our commercial and construction business through financial and relationship diligence with our customers and by financing projects within our branch footprint almost exclusively backed by personal guarantees.

        We believe our significant growth has not come at the expense of asset quality. We have historically been able to focus on long-term returns and remain committed to responsible growth. We also believe our strong sales team, disciplined underwriting and culture of cost management have driven consistent earnings and exemplary net interest margins, efficiency metrics and shareholder

1


Table of Contents

returns. The consistency of our success in these key areas since January 1, 2013 is demonstrated by the following tables:

GRAPHIC

        An important contributor to our growth since 2015 has been our successful entry into the greater Los Angeles market, where we started with a loan production office in 2015 and have grown to 4 full service branches, constituting 20.4% and 21.7% of our total loans and retail deposits as of June 30, 2017, with two new branches expected to open in the market in early 2018. While other institutions frequently enter new geographies through acquisitions, we have grown our geographic footprint through de novo branches while remaining true to our business model, offering the same products and services that proved successful in our San Francisco operations. We intend to continue our organic growth while further diversifying our geographical concentration with the recent expansion in New York City and Seattle, where we are targeting similar markets with products we fully understand.

Our History

        Sterling Bank was founded as a federally chartered thrift institution in 1984 in Southfield, Michigan by members of the Seligman family, and we have remained closely held. By 2004 we had 10 branches in the Detroit metropolitan area. However, in the early 1990s, our owners and management recognized an opportunity to shift the Bank's focus to a rapidly growing market less dependent, as Detroit was, on a single industry. In 1994, the Bank established its first branch in San Francisco, California. In 2004, we made the strategic decision to sell all but one of our Detroit-area branches and focus nearly exclusively on the California market. In 2004, we divested 10 Michigan branches and by 2006, substantially reduced new lending in Michigan.

        Our NPA/Total Assets ratio peaked at 5.7% in 2008, as we worked our way through credit issues related primarily to our legacy Michigan portfolios, which now represent a de minimis 1.3% of our loan portfolio. Since such time, our credit quality has improved significantly, with NPA/Total Assets as of June 30, 2017 of 0.16%. Between 2004 and 2008, we expanded our San Francisco presence by opening an additional 7 branches.

2


Table of Contents

        Our residential mortgage portfolio consists of homeowners with strong credit and ability to repay. We work directly with our borrowers and third parties to confirm their credit status and ability to repay and offer our borrowers the opportunity to expand their credit history through what is often a first-time mortgage for the customer, while requiring a minimum down payment of 35% on our key residential loan programs. We believe the resulting low loan to value ratios, which averaged 60%, in our core residential product portfolio, protects our position while enabling the customer to manage smaller overall monthly payments than would otherwise be available with a low down payment, traditional qualified mortgage. In addition, we offer TIC, or tenant-in-common, loans, which operate similarly to co-op loans. In our TIC program, each co-owner of multi-unit dwellings (which typically have between 4 and 6 units) has their own mortgage based on the purchase price of their unit and includes similar low loan to value ratios, averaging 69% as of June 30, 2017. We expect continuing demand for this program in our San Francisco and Los Angeles markets, particularly in communities that restrict conversion to condominium projects.

        We believe that our strong growth and consistent profitability is the result of management's efforts to focus on growth in San Francisco while managing legacy credit quality issues primarily in Michigan. In addition, we avoid purchasing loan participations where we do not have a relationship with the borrower and do not service the underlying credit. We have established a culture that places credit responsibility with individual loan officers and management and does not rely solely on a loan committee and institutional experience to remain disciplined in our underwriting. Furthermore, we believe our growing commercial and construction lending businesses have diversified our product offerings and allow us to identify strong borrowers with well-supported projects and operations in our branch network area. We manage credit risks in our commercial and construction lending businesses through financial and relationship diligence with our customers and by financing projects within our branch footprint through mostly recourse loans.

Our Competitive Strengths

        We attribute our success to the following competitive strengths:

        Responsiveness and Deep Customer Relationships.    We emphasize the values of personal relationships and quality customer service. Our extensive knowledge of our customers enables us to tailor products and solutions that fit their needs. In fact, approximately 86% of our borrowers also have a deposit relationship with the Bank, providing us with visibility into their liquidity profile and contributing to our ability to manage our asset quality. Further, we believe our responsiveness to our customers has enabled us to build a strong reputation for execution in our markets. With most loans closed in less than 30 days from a complete application to closing in our residential real estate lending, our reputation has facilitated our expansion into Seattle, Washington and New York City in 2017. Our efficient organizational structure further contributes to our ability to make quick decisions and timely respond to our customers. We believe this responsiveness allows us to remain competitive even when other financial institutions may offer lower rates.

        Product Expertise and Disciplined Credit Culture.    We believe the success of our products is the result of our focus on the markets we serve, our understanding of customer needs, our management of product criteria, and our disciplined underwriting of the type of loans we make. We believe our willingness to focus on nontraditional loan products allows us to face less price competition for our non-TIC residential portfolio, in particular, than we do when competing for traditional conforming, fixed-rate mortgages. We have developed consistent underwriting and credit management processes tailored to each of the products we offer, allowing us to build high quality asset portfolios. We believe our relationships with, and knowledge of, our customers further enhances our credit quality, as we do not provide our key loan products to any customer unless the applicable relationship manager has met them and documented the interaction. We also subject our portfolios to annual stress testing and ongoing monitoring. Because we service our portfolio and retain servicing rights on loans that we sell,

3


Table of Contents

we maintain access to key information that enhances our ability to manage the entire customer relationship. We believe that our continuity and consistency in underwriting is reflected by our 0.12% rate of delinquency as of June 30, 2017.

        Leveraged Back Office Operations.    We believe our strong profitability, net interest margins and efficiency metrics have been bolstered by our lower-cost back office operations in the Midwest, relative to the expenses incurred by our competitors who perform these functions in the more dynamic labor and real estate markets in which we operate. The majority of our leadership team and back office operations (currently consisting of 90 full-time employees) remain in the lower-cost Detroit area, while 96% of our revenue is derived from our branches and loan production offices in the higher-cost areas of California, Seattle and New York. The significantly lower operating expenses where we are headquartered have contributed to our competitively low efficiency ratio of 36% and 37% in the periods ended June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively, and have been a key driver of our consistent profitability since shifting our growth strategy to San Francisco, Los Angeles, and now other metropolitan areas. In addition, we have been able to maintain continuity of executive management and talent retention at a rate we believe to be higher than many of our peers. This low rate of turnover and high retention rate of management has contributed to our low efficiency ratio. We also believe that conducting certain back room functions, such as responding to regulatory exams and audits, through our back office operations and separating such functions from the business production at our branches, lessens distractions to our production teams.

        Experienced Management Team.    We believe that we are well positioned to quickly and efficiently deploy new capital to continue our outstanding growth metrics. The management team that successfully led us through the crisis is driving the Company's performance today and continues to apply the lessons learned over their lengthy community banking careers. Our leadership team consists of senior managers who, on average, have been immersed in our cost-conscious culture for at least 16 years. We believe this continuity and institutional knowledge has significantly contributed to our growth and strong asset quality. Our key leadership team includes:

    Gary Judd, our Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, who has over 40 years of experience in the banking industry and has led our Company since August 2008. His prior experience includes service as a Director, President and Chief Executive Officer for WestStar Bank and its parent company, Vail Banks, Inc. as well as Vectra Bank and its parent company Vectra Banking Corporation. Prior to those positions, he served in numerous positions with Citibank. We believe Mr. Judd's extensive expertise over many credit cycles has provided an experienced hand at the top throughout his tenure with the Company.

    Thomas Lopp, our President, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer, who has been with us for 20 years, first joined our Company as a Divisional Controller in 1997. Mr. Lopp was appointed President in December 2016, has served as our Chief Operating Officer since September 2009, as our Chief Financial Officer since 2002, and led our expansion into Southern California in 2015. We believe Mr. Lopp's deep understanding of the Company, his long experience with our financial reporting responsibilities and the risks inherent in the banking business, has enhanced our credibility with regulators and helped us effectively manage the risks attendant to growth.

    Michael Montemayor, our President of Retail and Commercial Banking and Chief Lending Officer, who has been with us for 25 years, having first joined our Company as a Residential Lender in 1992. Mr. Montemayor worked his way through the Company as a Regional Branch Manager, Commercial Loan Officer, Construction Loan Officer, Construction Lending Manager and then Managing Director of Commercial Lending, followed by his appointment as Chief Lending Officer in 2006, and has led retail banking since 2013. We believe his broad experience in all aspects of our lending business and his long-term service as our Chief Lender has helped to provide continuity and consistency in our business model and lending practices.

4


Table of Contents

 

We believe this stability and institutional knowledge allows us to promote our culture of solid underwriting and growth across all levels of our organization. Notwithstanding inevitable turnover in a competitive industry, we pride ourselves on our ability to attract and maintain talent within our Company. We strive to foster an environment where we are able to promote key employees who perform and understand our culture and values.

Our Business Strategy

        Our goal is to maintain our strong performance while continuing to efficiently provide the highest level of customer service while limiting our exposure to credit risk. The additional capital from this offering will allow us to continue our organic growth, further diversify our geographical concentration, and allow us to opportunistically consider strategic initiatives.

        Focused Growth and Diversification Initiatives in Core Products.    In 2015, we extended our operations to the Los Angeles market, focusing on the same products that had been successful for us in San Francisco. As of June 30, 2017, our 4 Los Angeles branches have grown to an aggregate of $385.4 million in deposits, all organically. We are focused on continued growth in our core residential products while maintaining our strong asset quality. We expect to continue to grow our portfolio in the Los Angeles market, as we expect two additional branches to open in 2018. We are also laying the groundwork to replicate this successful strategy in certain communities in Seattle, Washington and New York City that we believe have similar demographics to our existing markets. Consistent with our culture of building long-term value and maintaining profitability, our strategy in entering new markets is conservative, as we limit initial expenses to a temporary loan production office until we are confident that we can hire lenders and other employees that fit our culture and understand our products and strategy. We have not bought books of business by hiring full lending teams from other institutions. Entry into these new markets will help diversify our loan portfolio to mitigate the impact of potential geographically-localized economic downturns. In addition, we intend to further diversify our revenues by building a fee-based income stream from wealth management and financial advisory services.

        Deposit Growth.    We believe our policy of meeting each portfolio loan customer in person has enabled us to leverage our significant loan growth to increase our deposits from $953.2 million as of December 31, 2014 to nearly $1.8 billion as of June 30, 2017. During 2016 and in the six months ended June 30, 2017, 98.2% and 98.3%, respectively, of our Advantage Loan mortgage customers chose to open deposit accounts at our branches, in part to take advantage of rate incentives and our ACH payment program. Our residential borrower related checking deposit accounts average $15,756 per account as of June 30, 2017. Our flagship deposit strategy consists primarily of our popular money market accounts, which constitute 68.7% of our deposit portfolio at June 30, 2017. We believe that significant cross-selling of our deposit products to our residential mortgage customers and enrollment in our automated payment program contribute to our solid asset quality. In addition, the combination of our high net interest margin and low expense ratio leaves us room to pay competitively attractive rates to our depositors and increase our market share.

        Continued Focus on Growing Commercial and Construction Loans.    We are committed to continuing to grow our successful commercial and construction loan portfolios at a ratio of approximately 20-25% of our assets. Our commercial and construction loan portfolio has grown from $255 million to $450 million since 2012. Our commercial and construction lending portfolio consists primarily of mixed use developments, offices, multifamily, construction and renovation projects. We also finance SROs, or single room occupancy projects, the majority of which are in our San Francisco market. We expect to maintain our strategy of developing a commercial and construction loan profile in our expanding branch footprint, where we can continue to leverage our ability to develop customer relationships and leverage our high quality service model into new opportunities. We attribute the growth in our commercial and construction portfolio to our increased hiring of quality commercial lenders, ability to

5


Table of Contents

execute on our pipeline, and high demand for the projects we underwrite. We also endeavor to manage the inherent risks attendant to increased commercial and construction loan activity, including their generally larger average size as compared to residential loans and the less readily-marketable collateral underlying commercial and construction loans. While we remain committed to minimizing these risks, losses incurred on a small number of commercial loans could have a disproportionately adverse impact on our results of operations.

        Bulk Loan Sales.    In order to open additional avenues of ongoing liquidity, in 2015 we began selling pools of our portfolio loans from time to time in the secondary markets. From May 2015 to May 2017 we sold approximately $422 million of our originated loans, recognizing approximately $13.1 million in gains on sale. In that time, some of the loans we sold have been used as collateral in securitizations and, as part of that process, we have been rated by DBRS and Fitch Ratings, each an independent ratings agency, as a servicer. We believe that the market for our loans and servicer ratings is a testament to the quality of our underwriting standards. While we prefer to keep the majority of our originations on our balance sheet, we will continue to consider additional sales in order to maintain visibility into market perception of our pricing, as well as to keep liquidity options open.

        Leverage Public Company Status.    In addition to raising capital to support our growth as further discussed under "Use of Proceeds," we believe becoming a public company, while increasing our operating costs, will provide us with additional options and better pricing to manage our cost of capital that were previously unavailable to us as a closely-held private company. While we have not historically engaged in significant merger and acquisition activity, the ability to issue publicly-traded stock as consideration may enable us to opportunistically approach potential transactions. In addition, we believe the ability to add a public stock equity component to our compensation programs in a responsible manner will enable us to better incentivize and retain key employees in the competitive markets in which we operate.

Our Market Area

        We currently have 20 branches in greater San Francisco, 4 branches in Los Angeles, one branch in New York City, one operational-focused branch and our corporate headquarters in Southfield, Michigan, and one loan production office near Seattle, Washington. We believe the comparatively high household incomes, population density, and projected population growth in our current markets will enhance our ability to continue our organic growth. The graphs below illustrate the expected

6


Table of Contents

population growth, median household incomes, population density and populations of our markets as they compare to national averages:

GRAPHIC


Source:
SNL Financial and Nielsen. Data as of September 30, 2017.

        California Markets.    We operate primarily in the San Francisco-Oakland-Hayward, California Metropolitan Statistical Area ("MSA") with substantial operations in the Los Angeles-Long Beach-Anaheim, California MSA, with Northern California responsible for 78.3% and Southern California responsible for 20.4% of our loan portfolio as of June 30, 2017.

        With a population of approximately 5 million, the San Francisco-Oakland-Hayward MSA represents the second most populous area in California and the twelfth largest in the United States. In addition to its current size, the market also demonstrates key characteristics we believe provide the opportunity for additional growth, including projected population growth of 5.1% through 2023 versus the national average of 3.5%, a median household income of $98.0 thousand versus a national average of $50.9 thousand, and the third highest population density in the nation.

        The Los Angeles-Long Beach-Anaheim, California MSA maintains a population of approximately 13.5 million, the most populous area in California and the second largest in the United States. We believe the market's projected population growth of 3.4% through 2023, its median household income of $69,330, and its highest population density in the nation position the area as an attractive market in which to expand operations, which we intend to accomplish through the opening of two additional branches in 2018.

        Newest Markets.    We recently established a branch in New York City and a loan production office near Seattle, Washington, which we expect to convert to a branch by the end of 2017.

7


Table of Contents

        The New York-Newark-Jersey City MSA is the largest in the United States by both deposits and population. The MSA has a median household income of $74,446 and the second highest population density in the nation. It also has a projected population growth of 1.9% by 2023.

        While smaller in size than our New York market, the Seattle-Tacoma-Bellevue, Washington MSA is the fourth largest on the west coast of the United States and supports a population of approximately 4 million. The Seattle-Tacoma-Bellevue, Washington MSA has an expected population growth of 6.7% by 2023.

        Operational Center.    We maintain a single, operationally focused branch in Southfield, Michigan in the Detroit-Warren-Dearborn, Michigan MSA. This branch serves as our headquarters and central operations center where we are able to leverage our operations to drive efficiencies and profitability

GRAPHIC

and maintain a presence where the Company was founded. We believe that maintaining our headquarters and key back-office staff in a market with a lower cost of doing business than many of our competitors in our primary market areas contributes to our quality efficiency metrics. The graph to the left indicates the cost of doing business in each of our market areas, and reflects the significantly lower cost of business in the Detroit-Warren-Dearborn MSA in comparison to our other MSAs.

        We believe that the favorable demographics of each of our primary MSAs will provide us with the opportunity to continue to grow our businesses organically in a focused and strategic manner.


Source: KPMG Competitive Alternatives 2016. Business cost data as of December 31, 2016.

Note: Business costs are expressed as an index. An index below 100 indicates lower costs than the U.S. baseline. An index over 100 indicates higher costs than the U.S. baseline (e.g., an index of 95.0 represents costs 5.0% below the U.S. baseline). U.S. baseline is the average of the four largest U.S. metro areas.

Risks Relating to Our Company and an Investment in Our Common Stock

        An investment in our common stock involves substantial risks and uncertainties. Investors should carefully consider all of the information in this prospectus, including the detailed discussion of these and other risks under "Risk Factors" beginning on page 16, prior to investing in our common stock. Some of the more significant risks include the following:

    Our concentration in residential mortgage loans exposes us to risks from regional and economic conditions in our market;

    Strong competition within our market areas with respect to our products and pricing may limit our growth and profitability;

    A lack of liquidity could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations and result in regulatory limits being placed on the Company;

    The value of our mortgage servicing rights can be volatile;

    Operational risks resulting from a high volume of financial transactions and increased reliance on technology, including risk of economic loss and reputational damage related to cyber-security breaches;

8


Table of Contents

    Our reliance on external financing to fund our operations and the failure to obtain such financing on favorable terms, or at all, in the future could materially and adversely impact our growth strategy and prospects;

    Our ability to originate loans could be restricted by regulations;

    Changes in the state of the general economy and the financial markets, and a slowdown or downturn in the general economy or the financial markets could adversely affect our results of operations;

    Our credit risk may increase in our commercial, construction and residential loan portfolios;

    Interest rate shifts may reduce net interest income, our profits and asset values, and otherwise negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations;

    We and our borrowers in our California communities may be adversely affected by earthquakes or other natural disasters;

    If the allowance for loan losses is not sufficient to cover actual loan losses, earnings could decrease;

    Difficulties in managing our growth, including retention and recruitment of qualified management and personnel to support growth;

    Our reliance on key executives;

    Customer fraud or misrepresentations from counter-parties;

    Our subordinated debt and the ability to maintain current or future debt service payments;

    If the secondary market for our mortgage loans were to contract significantly, our earnings profile would be negatively affected and our ability to manage our balance sheet could be materially and adversely affected;

    The highly regulated environment of the financial services industry and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in any of them; and

    An active, liquid trading market for our common stock may not develop, and you may not be able to sell your common stock at or above the public offering price, or at all.

Seligman Family Trustee Voting Rights and Our Status as a Controlled Company

        The trustee of certain entities and trusts affiliated with the Bank's founder and the Company's Vice President, Scott Seligman, and members of the Seligman family, will, after our initial public offering, control approximately        % of the voting power of our outstanding capital stock, and will have the ability to control the outcome of matters submitted to our shareholders for approval, including the election of our directors, as well as the overall management and direction of our Company. In the event of the family trustee's death or replacement, the shares of our capital stock that are held in these trusts will be transferred to other persons or entities that the Seligman family designates.

        Because the Seligman family trustee controls a majority of our outstanding voting power, we are a "controlled company" under the corporate governance rules for NASDAQ-listed companies. Therefore, we are not required to have a majority of our board of directors be independent, nor are we required to have a compensation committee or an independent nominating function. Accordingly, our board of directors may rely on the "controlled company" exception relating to the board of directors and committee independence requirements under the NASDAQ rules.

9


Table of Contents

Corporate Information

        Our principal executive offices are located at One Towne Square, Suite 1900, Southfield, Michigan 48076, and our telephone number at that address is (248) 355-2400. Our website address is www.sterlingbank.com. The information contained on our website is not a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this prospectus.

10


Table of Contents

 


The Offering

Common stock offered by us

              shares

Common stock offered by the selling shareholders

 

            shares

Underwriter's purchase option

 

            shares from us and            shares from certain selling shareholders

Common stock outstanding after completion of this offering

 

            shares (or            shares if the underwriter exercises its purchase option in full).

Use of proceeds

 

We estimate that the net proceeds to us from this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, will be approximately $            million (or approximately $            million if the underwriter exercises its option to purchase additional shares in full), based on an assumed public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover of this prospectus. We intend to use the net proceeds that we receive from this offering to support the Bank's current growth and for general corporate purposes, which could include additional contributions to the Bank to support growth initiatives or selective acquisition activity. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares of our common stock by the selling shareholders. See "Use of Proceeds."

Dividend policy

 

It has been our policy to pay dividends to holders of our common stock, and we intend to consider conservative and appropriate dividend levels. Our dividend policy and practice may change in the future, however, and our board of directors may change or eliminate the payment of future dividends at its discretion, without notice to our shareholders. Any future determination to pay dividends to holders of our common stock will depend on our results of operations, growth capital needs, financial condition, capital requirements, banking regulations, contractual restrictions and any other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant. See "Dividend Policy."

Listing and trading symbol

 

We have applied to list our common stock on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol "            ."

Risk factors

 

See "Risk Factors" for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in our common stock.

        References in this section to the number of shares of our common stock outstanding after this offering are based on 45,271,000 shares of our common stock issued and outstanding as of June 30, 2017. Unless otherwise indicated, these references:

    give retroactive effect to our recent 1,000-for-1 split of our common stock;

11


Table of Contents

    assume the 5,072,000 outstanding shares of our non-voting common stock will convert on an one-for-one basis into voting common stock prior to the completion of this offering;

    assume no exercise of the underwriter's option to purchase up to            additional shares of common stock from us; and

    exclude            shares of our common stock reserved and available for future awards under the equity incentive plan we plan to adopt prior to the completion of this offering.

12


Table of Contents



Summary Historical Consolidated Financial and Operating Data

        The following table sets forth summary historical consolidated financial and operating data as of the dates and for the periods indicated. The summary financial data as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, except for selected ratios, were derived from our audited consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary financial data as of and for the year ended December 31, 2014, except for selected ratios, were derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes that are not included in this prospectus. The summary financial data as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, except for selected ratios, were derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. In the opinion of management, the unaudited consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as our audited consolidated financial statements and include all adjustments, consisting of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of our consolidated financial position and consolidated results of operations as of such dates and for such periods. Results for the interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full year. The historical consolidated financial data, set forth below, have been retrospectively adjusted for a merger of an entity that occurred in April 2017 that was under common control for all the periods presented. Also, all share and per share amounts have been retroactively adjusted, where applicable, to reflect the stock split that occurred on September 11, 2017.

        These historical results are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for any future period. The summary historical consolidated financial and operating data set forth below should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
  Year Ended December 31,  
(dollars in thousands, except per share data)
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Statements of Income Data:

                               

Interest income

                               

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 54,881   $ 40,663   $ 89,566   $ 65,111   $ 51,302  

Interest and dividends on investment securities

    849     566     1,211     806     677  

Other interest

        16     26     33     33  

Total interest income

    55,730     41,245     90,803     65,950     52,012  

Interest expense

                               

Interest on deposits

    7,311     5,112     11,428     6,526     4,983  

Interest on Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    1,700     1,032     2,439     1,539     928  

Interest on subordinated notes and other

    1,816     426     1,978     43      

Total interest expense

    10,827     6,570     15,845     8,108     5,911  

Net interest income

    44,903     34,675     74,958     57,842     46,101  

Provision for loan losses

    1,200     (917 )   1,280     525     (1,400 )

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    43,703     35,592     73,678     57,317     47,501  

Total non-interest income

    8,399     9,288     16,006     8,617     6,472  

Total non-interest expense

    19,265     15,986     33,235     28,136     24,475  

Income before income taxes

    32,837     28,894     56,449     37,798     29,498  

Income tax expense

    13,483     11,728     23,215     15,287     11,775  

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166   $ 33,234   $ 22,511   $ 17,723  

Income per share, basic and diluted

  $ 0.43   $ 0.38   $ 0.73   $ 0.49   $ 0.36  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    45,271,000     45,271,000     45,271,000     46,148,000     48,829,000  

Cash dividends per share

  $ 0.10   $ 0.10   $ 0.19   $ 0.15   $  

13


Table of Contents


 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of
June 30,
2017
 
 
  2016   2015   2014  

Period End Balance Sheet Data:

                         

Investment securities available for sale

  $ 102,501   $ 75,606   $ 46,678   $ 32,559  

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses

    2,205,530     1,982,439     1,575,802     1,136,078  

Allowance for loan losses

    16,246     14,822     10,984     10,015  

Total assets

    2,416,171     2,163,601     1,712,008     1,241,963  

Noninterest-bearing deposits

    66,455     59,231     44,298     29,626  

Interest-bearing deposits

    1,729,869     1,555,914     1,185,462     923,608  

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    359,312     308,198     326,437     148,085  

Subordinated notes

    49,404     49,338          

Total liabilities

    2,241,888     2,001,329     1,575,730     1,115,076  

Total shareholders' equity

    174,283     162,272     136,278     126,887  


 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Performance Ratios:

                               

Return on average assets

    1.72 %   1.93 %   1.73 %   1.59 %   1.60 %

Return on average shareholders' equity

    22.70     23.80     22.06     17.09     15.04  

Return on average tangible common equity(1)

    22.86     24.08     22.29     17.35     15.36  

Yield on earning assets

    5.10     4.77     4.86     4.80     4.88  

Cost of average interest-bearing liabilities

    1.10     0.85     0.94     0.66     0.62  

Net interest spread

    4.00     3.92     3.92     4.14     4.26  

Net interest margin

    4.11     4.01     4.01     4.21     4.33  

Efficiency ratio(2)

    36     36     37     42     47  

Dividend payout ratio(3)

    24     27     26     31     0  

Core deposits / total deposits(4)

    95     90     91     89     94  

Net non-core funding dependence ratio(5)

    16     22     19     26     15  

Capital Ratios

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Regulatory and Other Capital Ratios—Consolidated:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Tangible common equity to tangible assets(1)        

    7.17 %   7.56 %   7.44 %   7.86 %   10.05 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    11.69     12.37     12.22     12.90     15.53 (6)

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    7.62     8.01     7.74     8.42     9.77 (6)

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    11.69     12.37     12.22     12.90     15.53 (6)

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    16.11     15.81     17.07     13.94     16.74 (6)

Regulatory and Other Capital Ratios—Bank:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    13.79     14.51     14.61     12.76     14.61  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    8.99     9.40     9.26     8.33     9.19  

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    13.79     14.51     14.61     12.76     14.61  

Total capital to risk-weighted assets

    14.89     15.57     15.73     13.80     15.82  

Credit Quality Data:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Nonperforming loans(7)

  $ 665   $ 642   $ 565   $ 1,167   $ 1,643  

Nonperforming loans to total loans(7)

    0.03 %   0.04 %   0.03 %   0.07 %   0.14 %

Nonperforming assets(8)

  $ 3,793   $ 3,772   $ 3,699   $ 7,229   $ 6,508  

Nonperforming assets to total assets(8)

    0.16 %   0.20 %   0.17 %   0.42 %   0.52 %

Allowance for loan losses to total loans

    0.73 %   0.67 %   0.74 %   0.69 %   0.87 %

Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans(7)                 

    2443 %   1893 %   2623 %   941 %   610 %

Net charge offs to average loans

    (0.01 )%   (0.13 )%   (0.14 )%   (0.03 )%   (0.12 )%

(1)
Return on average tangible common equity and tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio are Non-GAAP financial measures. See "Non-GAAP Financial Measures" for a reconciliation of these measures to their most comparable U.S. GAAP measure.

(2)
Efficiency ratio represents the ratio of non-interest expense divided by the sum of net interest income and non-interest income.

(3)
Dividend payout ratio represents the ratio of total dividends paid to our shareholders divided by our net income.

14


Table of Contents

(4)
Core deposit ratio represents the ratio of all demand, savings, NOW and money market accounts and those time deposits with balances less than or equal to $250,000 divided by total deposits.

(5)
Net non-core funding dependence ratio represents the degree to which the bank is funding longer term assets with non-core funds. We calculate this ratio as the sum of all time deposits greater than $250,000 and FHLB borrowings less short-term investments divided by the sum of all long-term assets.

(6)
Sterling Bancorp was not required to comply with regulatory and other capital ratios for periods ending prior to January 1, 2015 but has included such ratios for informational purposes.

(7)
Nonperforming loans include nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest.

(8)
Nonperforming assets include nonperforming loans and loans modified under trouble debt restructurings and other repossessed assets.

15


Table of Contents


RISK FACTORS

        Investing in our common stock involves a high degree of risk. Before you decide to invest in our common stock, you should carefully consider the risks described below, together with all other information included in this prospectus, including our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. We believe the events described below are the risks that are material to us as of the date of this prospectus. If any of the following risks actually occurs, our business, prospects, financial condition, results of operations and cash flow could be materially and adversely affected. In such an event, the value of our common stock could decline and you could lose all or part of your investment. This prospectus also contains forward-looking statements, estimates and projections that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in the forward-looking statements, estimates and projections as a result of specific factors, including the risk factors described below. See also "Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements" beginning on page 42.

Risks Related to Our Business

Our concentration in residential mortgage loans exposes us to risks.

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, one-to-four family residential real estate loans amounted to $1.78 billion and $1.62 billion, or 80% and 81%, respectively, of our total loan portfolio, and we intend to continue this type of lending in the foreseeable future. Residential mortgage lending is generally sensitive to regional and local economic conditions that significantly impact the ability of borrowers to meet their loan payment obligations, making loss levels difficult to predict. If borrowers are unable to meet their loan repayment obligations, our results of operations would be materially and adversely affected. In addition, a decline in residential real estate values as a result of a downturn in the markets we serve would reduce the value of the real estate collateral securing these types of loans. Declines in real estate values could cause some of our residential mortgages to be inadequately collateralized, which would expose us to a great risk of loss if we seek to recover on defaulted loans by selling the real estate collateral.

Strong competition within our market areas or with respect to our products may limit our growth and profitability.

        Competition in the banking and financial services industry is intense. In our market area, we compete with commercial banks, savings institutions, mortgage brokerage firms, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms and unregulated or less regulated non-banking entities, operating locally and elsewhere. Many of these competitors have substantially greater resources and higher lending limits than we have and offer certain services that we do not or cannot provide. In addition, some of our competitors offer loans with lower interest rates on more attractive terms than loans we offer. Competition also makes it increasingly difficult and costly to attract and retain qualified employees. Our profitability depends upon our continued ability to successfully compete in our market areas. If we must raise interest rates paid on deposits or lower interest rates charged on our loans, our net interest margin and profitability could be adversely affected. As we expand into new market areas, we expect that competition for customers and relationships will be intense. As a result, our ability to successfully deploy our business strategy in these market areas may be difficult.

        In addition, we believe that we have historically faced less competition for customers of our Advantage Loan program as compared to the competition we face in the market for qualified mortgages. To the extent that our competitors begin to offer similar products and compete in this area more frequently or intensely, we may face significant pricing pressure. Many of our competitors are much larger and may be able to achieve economies of scale and, as a result, may offer better pricing for the type of products and services we provide. Should competition over the type of loans we

16


Table of Contents

underwrite increase, our profitability could be materially and adversely affected. See "Business—Market Area" and "—Competition."

A lack of liquidity could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations and result in regulatory limits being placed on the Company.

        Liquidity is essential to our business. We rely on our ability to generate deposits and effectively manage the repayment and maturity schedules of our loans to ensure that we have adequate liquidity to fund our operations. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of loans and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. Our most important source of funds is deposits. Deposit balances can decrease when customers perceive alternative investments as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. If customers move money out of deposits such as money market funds, we would lose a relatively low-cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and reducing our net interest income and net income. While we strive to appropriately balance our loan to deposit ratio, the growth in our loan portfolio challenges our ability to achieve the optimal ratio.

        Other primary sources of funds consist of cash flows from operations and sales of investment securities, and proceeds from the issuance and sale of our equity securities. Additional liquidity is provided by the ability to borrow from the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis (the "FHLB") or our ability to sell portions of our loan portfolio. We also may borrow funds from third-party lenders, such as other financial institutions. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities, or on terms that are acceptable to us, could be impaired by factors that affect us directly or the financial services industry or economy in general, such as disruptions in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry. Our access to funding sources could also be affected by a decrease in the ability to sell mortgage portfolios as a result of a downturn in our markets or by one or more adverse regulatory actions against us. A lack of liquidity could also attract increased regulatory scrutiny and potential restraints imposed on us by regulators.

        Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses, or to fulfill obligations such as repaying our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, business, financial condition and results of operations.

We face significant operational risks because the financial services business involves a high volume of transactions and increased reliance on technology, including risk of loss related to cyber-security breaches.

        We operate in diverse markets and rely on the ability of our employees and systems to process a high number of transactions and to collect, process, transmit and store significant amounts of confidential information regarding our customers, employees and others, as well as our own business, operations, plans and strategies. Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from our operations, including but not limited to, the risk of fraud by employees or persons outside our company, the execution of unauthorized transactions, errors relating to transaction processing and technology, systems failures or interruptions, breaches of our internal control systems and compliance requirements, and business continuation and disaster recovery. We face an increasing number of regulations and regulatory scrutiny related to our information technology systems, and security or privacy breaches with respect to our data could result in regulatory fines, reputational harm and customer losses, any of which would significantly impact our financial condition. Insurance coverage may not be available for such losses, or where available, such losses may exceed insurance limits. In addition, because we perform our own core processing and other technological functions, we cannot rely on indemnification or another source of third-party recovery in the event of a breach of such functions.

17


Table of Contents

        This risk of loss also includes the potential legal actions that could arise as a result of operational deficiencies or as a result of non-compliance with applicable regulatory standards or customer attrition due to potential negative publicity. In addition, we outsource some of our data processing to certain third-party providers. If these third-party providers encounter difficulties, including as a result of cyber-attacks or information security breaches, or if we have difficulty communicating with them, our ability to adequately process and account for transactions could be affected, and our business operations could be materially and adversely affected.

        In the event of a breakdown in our internal control systems, improper operation of systems or improper employee actions, or a breach of our security systems, including if confidential or proprietary information were to be mishandled, misused or lost, we could suffer financial loss, face regulatory action, fines, civil litigation and/or suffer damage to our reputation.

We rely on external financing to fund our operations and the failure to obtain such financing on favorable terms, or at all, in the future could materially and adversely impact our growth strategy and prospects.

        We rely in part on advances from the FHLB to fund our operations. Although we consider such sources of funds adequate for our current needs, we may need to seek additional debt or equity capital in the future to implement our growth strategy in the event that our borrowing availability with the FHLB is decreased. The sale of equity or equity-related securities in the future may be dilutive to our shareholders, and debt financing arrangements may require us to pledge some of our assets and enter into various affirmative and negative covenants, including limitations on operational activities and financing alternatives. Future financing sources, if sought, might be unavailable to us or, if available, could be on terms unfavorable to us and may require regulatory approval. If financing sources are unavailable or are not available on favorable terms or we are unable to obtain regulatory approval, our growth strategy and future prospects could be materially and adversely impacted.

Our ability to originate loans could be restricted by federal regulations and we could be subject to statutory claims for violations of the ability to repay standard.

        The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau has issued a rule intended to clarify how lenders can avoid legal liability under the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act ("Dodd-Frank Act"), which holds lenders accountable for ensuring a borrower's ability to repay a mortgage loan. Under the rule, loans that meet the "qualified mortgage" definition will be presumed to have complied with the new ability-to-repay standard. Under the rule, a "qualified mortgage" loan must not contain certain specified features, including:

Also, to qualify as a "qualified mortgage," a loan must be made to a borrower whose total monthly debt-to-income ratio does not exceed 43%. Lenders must also verify and document the income and financial resources relied upon to qualify a borrower for the loan and underwrite the loan based on a fully amortizing payment schedule and maximum interest rate during the first five years, taking into account all applicable taxes, insurance and assessments. Lenders of mortgages that meet the "qualified mortgage" standards have a safe harbor or a presumption of compliance with these requirements. A majority of our residential mortgage loans are not "qualified mortgages," as our underwriting process does not strictly follow applicable regulatory guidance required for such qualification and the rates offered exceed qualifying guidelines. In the event that these mortgages begin to experience a significant

18


Table of Contents

rate of default, we could be subject to statutory claims for violations of the ability to repay standard. Any such claims could materially and adversely affect our ability to underwrite these loans, our business, results of operations or financial condition.

As a business operating in the financial services industry, our business and operations may be adversely affected in numerous and complex ways by weak economic conditions.

        Our business and operations, which primarily consist of lending money to customers in the form of loans, borrowing money from customers in the form of deposits and investing in securities, are sensitive to general business and economic conditions in the United States. If the U.S. economy weakens, our growth and profitability from our lending, deposit and investment operations could be constrained. Uncertainty about the federal fiscal policymaking process, the medium and long-term fiscal outlook of the federal government, and future tax rates is a concern for businesses, consumers and investors in the United States. In addition, economic conditions in foreign countries, including uncertainty over the stability of the euro currency, could affect the stability of global financial markets, which could hinder U.S. economic growth. Weak economic conditions are characterized by deflation, fluctuations in debt and equity capital markets, a lack of liquidity and/or depressed prices in the secondary market for mortgage loans, increased delinquencies on mortgage, consumer and commercial loans, residential and commercial real estate price declines and lower home sales and commercial activity. The current economic environment is also characterized by interest rates at historically low levels, which impacts our ability to attract deposits and to generate attractive earnings through our investment portfolio. All of these factors are detrimental to our business, and the interplay between these factors can be complex and unpredictable. Our business is also significantly affected by monetary and related policies of the U.S. federal government and its agencies. Changes in any of these policies are influenced by macroeconomic conditions and other factors that are beyond our control. Adverse economic conditions and government policy responses to such conditions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

Our business is affected by changes in the state of the general economy and the financial markets, and a slowdown or downturn in the general economy or the financial markets could adversely affect our results of operations.

        Our customer activity is intrinsically linked to the health of the economy generally and of the financial markets specifically. In addition to the economic factors discussed above, a downturn in the real estate or commercial markets generally could cause our customers and potential customers to exit the market for real estate or commercial loans. As a result, we believe that fluctuations, disruptions, instability or downturns in the general economy and the financial markets could disproportionately affect demand for our residential and commercial loan services. If such conditions occur and persist, our business and financial results, including our liquidity and our ability to fulfill our debt obligations, could be materially adversely affected.

If the allowance for loan losses is not sufficient to cover actual loan losses, earnings could decrease.

        Loan customers may not repay their loans according to the terms of their loans, and the collateral securing the payment of their loans may be insufficient to assure repayment. We may experience significant credit losses, which could have a material adverse effect on our operating results. Various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of the loan portfolio are made, including the creditworthiness of borrowers and the value of the real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the repayment of many loans. In determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses, management reviews the loans and the loss and delinquency experience and evaluates economic conditions.

        At June 30, 2017, our allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans, net of unearned income, was 0.73%. The determination of the appropriate level of allowance is subject to judgment and

19


Table of Contents

requires us to make significant estimates of current credit risks and future trends, all of which are subject to material changes. If assumptions prove to be incorrect, the allowance for loan losses may not cover probable incurred losses in the loan portfolio at the date of the financial statements. Significant additions to the allowance would materially decrease net income. Nonperforming loans may increase and nonperforming or delinquent loans may adversely affect future performance. In addition, federal regulators periodically review the allowance for loan losses and may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses or the recognition of further loan charge offs. Any significant increase in our allowance for loan losses or loan charge offs as required by these regulatory agencies could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

Changes in economic conditions could cause an increase in delinquencies and nonperforming assets, including loan charge offs, which could depress our net income and growth.

        Our loan portfolio includes primarily real estate secured loans, demand for which may decrease during economic downturns as a result of, among other things, an increase in unemployment, a decrease in real estate values and a slowdown in housing. If we see negative economic conditions develop in the United States as a whole or in the markets that we serve, we could experience higher delinquencies and loan charge offs, which would reduce our net income and adversely affect our financial condition. Furthermore, to the extent that real estate collateral is obtained through foreclosure, the costs of holding and marketing the real estate collateral, as well as the ultimate values obtained from disposition, could reduce our earnings and adversely affect our financial condition.

Because we intend to continue to increase our commercial loans, our credit risk may increase in our commercial loan portfolios.

        At June 30, 2017, our commercial loans net of unearned income totaled $449.9 million, or 20.2% of our total loans. We intend to increase our originations of commercial loans, within permissible limits for a federal savings bank, which primarily consists of commercial real estate, construction and development, and commercial lines of credit. These loans generally have more risk than residential mortgage loans.

        Because we plan to continue to increase our originations of these loans, commercial loans generally have a larger average size as compared with other loans such as residential loans. The collateral for commercial loans is generally less readily-marketable and losses incurred on a small number of commercial loans could have a disproportionate and material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

Interest rate shifts may reduce net interest income and otherwise negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

        The majority of our banking assets are monetary in nature and subject to risk from changes in interest rates. Like most financial institutions, our earnings and cash flows depend to a great extent upon the level of our net interest income, or the difference between the interest income we earn on loans, investments and other interest earning assets, and the interest we pay on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Changes in interest rates can increase or decrease our net interest income, because different types of assets and liabilities may react differently, and at different times, to market interest rate changes.

        When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest earning assets in a period, an increase in interest rates could reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest earning assets mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could reduce net interest income. Additionally, an increase in interest rates may, among other things, reduce the demand for loans and our ability to

20


Table of Contents

originate loans and decrease loan repayment rates. A decrease in the general level of interest rates may affect us through, among other things, increased prepayments on our loan portfolio and increased competition for deposits. Accordingly, changes in the level of market interest rates affect our net yield on interest earning assets, loan origination volume and our overall results. Although our asset-liability management strategy is designed to control and mitigate exposure to the risks related to changes in market interest rates, those rates are affected by many factors outside of our control, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, recession, changes in unemployment, the money supply, international disorder and instability in domestic and foreign financial markets.

Future changes in interest rates could reduce our profits and asset values.

        Net interest income makes up a majority of our income and is based on the difference between:

        The rates we earn on our assets and the rates we pay on our liabilities are generally fixed for a contractual period of time. Like many savings institutions, our liabilities generally have shorter contractual maturities than our assets. This imbalance can create significant earnings volatility because market interest rates change over time. In a period of rising interest rates, the demand for our residential lending products may decline and the interest income we earn on our assets may not increase as rapidly as the interest we pay on our liabilities. In a period of declining interest rates, the interest income we earn on our assets may decrease more rapidly than the interest we pay on our liabilities, as borrowers prepay mortgage loans, and mortgage-backed securities and callable investment securities are called, requiring us to reinvest those cash flows at lower interest rates. Such changes in interest rates could materially and adversely affect our results of operations and overall profitability.

        In addition, changes in interest rates can affect the average life of loans and mortgage-backed and related securities. A decline in interest rates results in increased prepayments of loans and mortgage-backed and related securities as borrowers refinance their debt to reduce their borrowing costs. This creates reinvestment risk, which is the risk that we may not be able to reinvest prepayments at rates that are comparable to the rates we earned on the prepaid loans or securities. Furthermore, an inverted interest rate yield curve, where short-term interest rates (which are usually the rates at which financial institutions borrow funds) are higher than long-term interest rates (which are usually the rates at which financial institutions lend funds for fixed-rate loans) can reduce our net interest margin and create financial risk for financial institutions like ours.

A continuation of the historically low interest rate environment and the possibility that we may access higher-cost funds to support our loan growth and operations may adversely affect our net interest income and profitability.

        In recent years the Federal Reserve Board's policy has been to maintain interest rates at historically low levels through its targeted federal funds rate and the purchase of mortgage-backed securities. Recently, the Federal Reserve Board has indicated that it believes a gradual increase in the targeted federal funds rate is appropriate. To this end, the Federal Reserve Board raised the targeted federal funds rate in December 2016 and March and June 2017. We cannot make any representation as to whether, or how many times, the Federal Reserve will increase the targeted federal funds rate in the future. Notwithstanding the Federal Reserve Board's expressed intentions, our ability to reduce our interest expense may be limited at current interest rate levels while the average yield on our interest-earning assets may continue to decrease, and our interest expense may increase as we access non-core funding sources or increase deposit rates to fund our operations. A continuation of a low, or relatively low, interest rate environment or increasing our cost of funds may adversely affect our net interest income, which would have a material adverse effect on our profitability.

21


Table of Contents

A substantial majority of our loans and operations are in San Francisco, and therefore our business is particularly vulnerable to a downturn in the San Francisco economy.

        Unlike larger financial institutions that are more geographically diversified, a large portion of our business is concentrated primarily in the state of California, specifically in the San Francisco Bay Area. As of June 30, 2017, 98.7% of our loan portfolio was based in California and our loan portfolio had concentrations of 78.3% in the San Francisco Bay Area. While there is not a single employer or industry in our market area on which a significant number of our customers are dependent, if the local economy, and particularly the real estate market, declines, the rates of delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, bankruptcies and losses in our loan portfolio would likely increase. Similarly, catastrophic natural events such as earthquakes could have a disproportionate effect on our financial condition. As a result of this lack of diversification in our loan portfolio, a downturn in the local economy generally and real estate market specifically could significantly reduce our profitability and growth and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition.

We may not be able to grow, and, if we do grow, we may have difficulty managing that growth.

        Our business strategy is to continue to grow our assets and expand our operations, including through geographic expansion. Our ability to grow depends, in part, upon our ability to expand our market share, successfully attract core deposits, and to identify loan and investment opportunities as well as opportunities to generate fee-based income. We can provide no assurance that we will be successful in increasing the volume of our loans and deposits at acceptable levels and upon terms acceptable to us. We also can provide no assurance that we will be successful in expanding our operations organically or geographically while managing the costs and implementation risks associated with this growth strategy.

We face strong competition in the banking industry, and we may not be able to successfully grow or retain market share in our existing markets.

        We face intense competition in the banking industry from many competitors who compete with us on an international, regional or local level. Our strategy for future growth relies in part on growth in the communities we serve and our ability to develop relationships in particular locations, and we expect to continue to face strong competition from competitors in all of our markets. If we fail to compete effectively against our competitors, we may be unable to expand our market share in our existing markets, and we may be unable to retain our existing market share in key growth markets or in those markets in which we have traditionally had a strong presence. Failure to protect our market share on a regional level or to grow our market share in key growth markets and product categories could have a material adverse effect on our overall market share and on our profitability.

Our business strategy includes growth, and our financial condition and results of operations could be negatively affected if we fail to grow or fail to manage our growth effectively. Growing our operations could also cause our expenses to increase faster than our revenues.

        Our business strategy includes growth in assets, deposits, the scale of our operations and entry into new markets. Achieving such growth will require us to attract customers that currently bank at other financial institutions in our market area and obtain new customers in new market areas where we will have to establish brand recognition and operations. Our ability to successfully grow will depend on a variety of factors, including our ability to attract and retain experienced bankers and loan officers, the continued availability of desirable business opportunities, competition from other financial institutions in our market areas and our ability to manage our growth. Growth opportunities may not be available, may be prohibitively expensive, or we may not be able to manage our growth successfully. If we do not manage our growth effectively, our financial condition and operating results could be negatively affected. Furthermore, there can be considerable costs involved in expanding deposit and lending

22


Table of Contents

capacity that generally require a period of time to generate the necessary revenues to offset their costs, especially in areas in which we do not have an established presence and require alternative delivery methods. Accordingly, any such business expansion can be expected to negatively impact our earnings for some period of time until certain economies of scale are reached. Our expenses could be further increased if we encounter delays in opening new branches.

We may have difficulty identifying additional regional and local markets for expansion of our business, and we may misjudge the potential of new markets.

        In order to successfully expand our business, we must identify new regional and local markets in which we will be successful. To execute this strategy, we must devote substantial financial resources and managerial time to the analysis of demographics, results of competing banks, potential operating costs, real estate costs and availability, construction costs and discretionary spending patterns in different regions of the United States and specific local areas within those selected regions. We may be unfamiliar with many of these areas, and, despite our research, we may choose markets that may prove to be less accepting of our banking concepts than customers in our existing markets. As a result, we may invest substantial time, energy and money in new markets that may not generate satisfactory returns. In addition, new branches, including those located in new markets, will take at least several months to reach planned operating levels due to inefficiencies typically associated with opening a new location, and the financial results of new branches over at least the first year of operation are expected to be below our historical results.

The value of our mortgage servicing rights can be volatile.

        We sell in the secondary market residential mortgage loans that we originate, which provides a meaningful portion of our non-interest income in the form of gains on the sale of mortgage loans. We also earn revenue from fees we receive for servicing mortgage loans. As a result of our mortgage servicing business, we have a growing portfolio of mortgage servicing rights. A mortgage servicing right is the right to service a mortgage loan—collect principal, interest, and escrow amounts—for a fee. We acquire mortgage servicing rights when we keep the servicing rights in connection with the sale of loans we have originated.

        Changes in interest rates may impact our mortgage servicing revenues, which could negatively impact our non-interest income. When rates rise, net revenue from our mortgage servicing activities can increase due to slower prepayments, which reduces our amortization expense for mortgage servicing rights. When rates fall, the value of our mortgage servicing rights usually tends to decline as a result of a higher volume of prepayments, resulting in a decline in our net revenue. It is possible that, because of economic conditions and/or a weak or deteriorating housing market, even if interest rates were to fall or remain low, mortgage originations may also fall or any increase in mortgage originations may not be enough to offset the decrease in the mortgage servicing rights value caused by the lower rates. Because the value of our mortgage servicing rights is capitalized on our balance sheet and evaluated on a quarterly basis, any significant decline in value could adversely affect our income, our capital ratios or require us to raise additional capital, which may not be available on favorable terms.

One of our historical markets, minority and immigrant individuals, may be threatened by gentrification or adverse political developments, which could decrease our growth and profitability.

        We believe that a significant part of our historical strength has been our focus on the minority and immigrant markets. The continuing displacement of minorities due to gentrification of our communities may adversely affect us unless we are able to adapt and increase the acceptance of our products and services by non-minority customers. We may also be unfavorably impacted by political developments adverse to the United States and specifically adverse to markets that are dependent on immigrant populations.

23


Table of Contents

We rely heavily on our management team and our business could be adversely affected by the unexpected loss of one or more of our officers or directors.

        We are led by a management team with substantial experience in the markets that we serve and the financial products that we offer. Our operating strategy focuses on providing products and services through long-term relationship managers. Accordingly, our success depends in large part on the performance of our key officers and directors, as well as on our ability to attract, motivate and retain highly qualified senior and middle management. Competition for employees is intense, and the process of identifying key personnel with the combination of skills and attributes required to execute our business plan may be lengthy. We may not be successful in retaining our key employees or directors and the unexpected loss of services of one or more of our officers or directors could have a material adverse effect on our business because of their skills, knowledge of our market and financial products, years of industry experience, long-term business and customer relationships and the difficulty of finding qualified replacement personnel. If the services of any of our key personnel should become unavailable for any reason, we may not be able to identify and hire qualified persons on terms acceptable to us, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may be at risk for future restrictions on compensation paid to our executives.

        As a private closely held company, we have historically not been subject to compensation restrictions. Under certain circumstances, our primary regulators could impose restrictions on compensation to our management team. In addition, as a public company, we will be required to disclose the compensation of our named executive officers and may face pressure from investors to the extent such compensation is deemed excessive. If we experience future limitations in our executive compensation program, these limitations may make it more difficult to attract and retain executive officers.

Our future success depends on our ability to retain key executives and to identify, attract, retain and motivate qualified personnel.

        We are highly dependent on the experience and strong relationships we have developed in the communities that we serve. We also recognize that the banking industry is competitive and should we lose several of our front office personnel, it would take time for new employees to develop the experience and cultural values that we believe our long-term employees have developed. Additionally, our hiring processes are unique to us, meaning that we prefer to hire employees with experience in our industry and who have an interest in working with the Bank for many years. Furthermore, replacing executive officers and key employees may be difficult and may take an extended period of time because of the limited number of individuals in our industry with the breadth of skills and experience required to successfully manage, develop and grow in the banking industry. If we fail to identify and develop or recruit successors, we are at risk of being harmed by the departures of key employees.

The success of our growth strategy depends on our ability to identify and retain individuals with experience and relationships in the markets in which we intend to expand.

        We may expand our banking network over the next several years, not just in our existing and planned market areas, but also in other communities. To expand into new markets successfully, we must identify and retain experienced key management members with local expertise and relationships in these markets. We expect that competition for qualified management in the markets in which we may expand will be intense and that there will be a limited number of qualified persons with knowledge of and experience in the community banking industry in these markets. Even if we identify individuals that we believe could assist us in establishing a presence in a new market, we may be unable to recruit these individuals away from competitors or more established banks. In addition, the process of identifying

24


Table of Contents

and recruiting individuals with the combination of skills and attributes required to carry out our strategy is often lengthy. Our inability to identify, recruit, and retain talented personnel to manage new banking offices effectively would limit our growth and could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer, third party, or employee fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

        Employee errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence and increased regulatory scrutiny.

        We maintain a system of internal controls and insurance coverage to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud. If our internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, or if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information provided by customers and counterparties.

        In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with customers and counterparties, we may rely on information furnished to us by, or on behalf of, customers and counterparties, including financial statements and other financial information. We also may rely on representations of customers and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that information. In deciding whether to extend credit, we may rely upon our customers' representations that their financial statements are accurate. We also may rely on customer representations and certifications, or other audit or accountants' reports, with respect to the business and financial condition of our commercial clients. Our financial condition, results of operations, financial reporting and reputation could be materially adversely affected if we rely on materially misleading, false, inaccurate or fraudulent information.

We may incur future losses in connection with certain representations and warranties we've made with respect to mortgages that we have sold into the secondary market.

        From time to time, we package residential mortgages for sale into the secondary market. In connection with such sales, we make representations and warranties, which, if breached, may require us to repurchase such loans, substitute other loans or indemnify the purchasers of such loans for actual losses incurred in respect of such loans. A substantial decline in residential real estate values in the markets in which we originated such loans could increase the risk of such consequences. While we have not to date received any repurchase requests and we currently believe our repurchase risk remains low based upon our careful loan underwriting and documentation standards, it is possible that requests to repurchase loans could occur in the future and such requests may have a negative financial impact on us.

We are a community bank and our ability to maintain our reputation is critical to the success of our business and the failure to do so may materially adversely affect our performance.

        We are a community bank, and our reputation is one of the most valuable components of our business. A key component of our business strategy is to rely on our reputation for customer service

25


Table of Contents

and knowledge of local markets to expand our presence by capturing new business opportunities from existing and prospective customers in our market area and new market areas. As such, we strive to conduct our business in a manner that enhances our reputation. This is done, in part, by recruiting, hiring and retaining employees who share our core values of being an integral part of the communities we serve, delivering superior service to our customers and caring about our customers and associates. If our reputation is negatively affected by the actions of our employees, by our inability to conduct our operations in a manner that is appealing to current or prospective customers, or otherwise, our business and, therefore, our operating results may be materially adversely affected.

If our enterprise risk management framework is not effective at mitigating risk and loss to us, we could suffer unexpected losses and our results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

        Our enterprise risk management framework seeks to achieve an appropriate balance between risk and return, which is critical to optimizing shareholder value. We have established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, report and analyze the types of risk to which we are subject, including credit, liquidity, operational, regulatory compliance and reputational. However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated or identified. If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses and our business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

Our modest size makes it more difficult for us to compete.

        Our modest size makes it more difficult to compete with other financial institutions which are generally larger and can more easily afford to invest in the marketing and technologies needed to attract and retain customers. Because our principal source of income is the net interest income we earn on our loans and investments after deducting interest paid on deposits and other sources of funds, our ability to generate the revenues needed to cover our expenses and finance such investments is limited by the size of our loan and investment portfolios. Accordingly, we are not always able to offer new products and services as quickly as our competitors. As a smaller institution, we are also disproportionately affected by the continually increasing costs of compliance with new banking and other regulations.

We face risks related to our operational, technological and organizational infrastructure.

        Our ability to grow and compete is dependent on our ability to build or acquire the necessary operational and technological infrastructure and to manage the cost of that infrastructure as we expand. Similar to other corporations, operational risk can manifest itself in many ways, such as errors related to failed or inadequate processes, faulty or disabled computer systems, fraud by employees or outside persons and exposure to external events. As discussed below, we are dependent on our operational infrastructure to help manage these risks. In addition, we are heavily dependent on the strength and capability of our technology systems which we use both to interface with our customers and to manage our internal financial records and other systems. Our ability to develop and deliver new products that meet the needs of our existing customers and attract new ones depends on the functionality of our technology systems. Additionally, our ability to run our business in compliance with applicable laws and regulations is dependent on these infrastructures.

        We monitor our operational and technological capabilities and make modifications and improvements when we believe it will be cost effective to do so. In some instances, we may build and maintain these capabilities ourselves. Specifically, we provide our own core systems processing and essential web hosting. We also outsource some of these functions to third parties. If we experience difficulties, fail to comply with banking regulations or keep up with increasingly sophisticated technologies, our operations could be interrupted. If an interruption were to continue for a significant

26


Table of Contents

period of time, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected, perhaps materially. Even if we are able to replace them, it may be at a higher cost to us, which could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Adherence to our internal policies and procedures by our employees is critical to our performance and how we are perceived by our regulators.

        Our internal policies and procedures are a critical component of our corporate governance and, in some cases, compliance with applicable regulations. We adopt internal policies and procedures to guide management and employees regarding the operation and conduct of our business. Any deviation or non-adherence to these internal policies and procedures, whether intentional or unintentional, could have a detrimental effect on our management, operations or financial condition.

We must keep pace with technological change to remain competitive and introduce new products and services.

        Financial products and services have become increasingly technologically driven. Our ability to meet the needs of our customers competitively and introduce new products in a cost-efficient manner is dependent on the ability to keep pace with technological advances, to invest in new technology as it becomes available, and to obtain and maintain related essential personnel. Many of our competitors have already implemented critical technologies and have greater resources to invest in technology than we do and may be better equipped to market new technologically driven products and services. In addition, we may not have the same ability to rapidly respond to technological innovations as our competitors do. Furthermore, the introduction of new technologies and products by financial technology companies and "fintech" platforms may adversely affect our ability to obtain new customers and successfully grow our business. The ability to keep pace with technological change is important, and the failure to do so, due to cost, proficiency or otherwise, could have a material adverse impact on our business and therefore on our financial condition and results of operations.

Changes in accounting standards could materially impact our financial statements.

        From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board or the SEC may change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements. Such changes may result in us being subject to new or changing accounting and reporting standards. In addition, the bodies that interpret the accounting standards (such as banking regulators, outside auditors or management) may change their interpretations or positions on how these standards should be applied. These changes may be beyond our control, can be hard to predict, and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retrospectively, or apply an existing standard differently, also retrospectively, in each case resulting in our needing to revise or restate prior period financial statements.

Adverse conditions internationally could adversely affect our business.

        Many of our customers are recent immigrants or foreign nationals. U.S. and global economic policies, military tensions, and unfavorable global economic conditions may adversely impact the economies in which our customers have family or business ties. A significant deterioration of economic conditions internationally, and in Asia in particular, could expose us to, among other things, economic and transfer risk, and we could experience an outflow of deposits by those of our customers with connections to Asia. In addition, foreign currency restrictions, particularly on the movement of cash from abroad, could adversely affect many of our customers, including with respect to their ability to make down payments or repay loans. Adverse economic conditions abroad, and in China or Taiwan in particular, may also negatively impact asset values and the profitability and liquidity of our customers with ties to these regions.

27


Table of Contents

Changes in the valuation of our securities portfolio could hurt our profits and reduce our shareholders' equity.

        Our securities portfolio may be impacted by fluctuations in market value, potentially reducing accumulated other comprehensive income and/or earnings. Fluctuations in market value may be caused by changes in market interest rates, lower market prices for securities and limited investor demand. Management evaluates securities for other-than-temporary impairment on a quarterly basis, with more frequent evaluation for selected issues. In analyzing a debt issuer's financial condition, management may consider whether the securities are issued by the federal government or its agencies, whether downgrades by bond rating agencies have occurred and industry analysts' reports. In analyzing an equity issuer's financial condition, management may consider industry analysts' reports, financial performance and projected target prices of investment analysts. If this evaluation shows impairment to the actual or projected cash flows associated with one or more securities, a potential loss to earnings may occur. Changes in interest rates can also have an adverse effect on our financial condition, as our available-for-sale securities are reported at their estimated fair value, and therefore are impacted by fluctuations in interest rates. We increase or decrease our shareholders' equity by the amount of change in the estimated fair value of the available-for-sale securities, net of taxes. Declines in market value could result in other-than-temporary impairments of these assets, which would lead to accounting charges that could have a material adverse effect on our net income and capital levels. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Securities Portfolio."

Legal and regulatory proceedings and related matters could adversely affect us.

        We have been, and may in the future become, involved in legal and regulatory proceedings. We consider most of the proceedings to be in the normal course of our business or typical for the industry; however, it is inherently difficult to assess the outcome of these matters, and we may not prevail in any proceedings or litigation. There could be substantial cost and management diversion in such litigation and proceedings, and any adverse determination could have a material adverse effect on our business, brand or image, or our financial condition and results of our operations.

As part of our asset/liability management strategy, we sell portions of our residential loan portfolio from time to time, while retaining servicing rights. If the market for our mortgage loans to the secondary market were to significantly contract, our earnings profile would be negatively affected and our ability to manage our balance sheet would be materially and adversely affected.

        From time to time, we manage our liquidity and balance sheet risk by selling loans in our mortgage portfolio into the secondary market. If the market for our mortgages were to contract or our counterparties were to lose confidence in our asset quality, we would lose a key piece of our liquidity strategy and would need to find alternative means to manage our liquidity that may be less effective. If the market for our residential portfolio were to contract, our liquidity, capital ratios and financial condition would be materially and adversely affected.

Any debt service obligations will reduce the funds available for other business purposes, and the terms and covenants relating to our current and future indebtedness could adversely impact our financial performance and liquidity.

        We have sold $65 million in aggregate principal amount of our 7.0% Fixed to Floating Subordinated Notes due April 15, 2026. As a result, we are currently, and to the extent we incur significant debt in the future, we will be, subject to risks typically associated with debt financing, such as insufficient cash flow to meet required debt service payment obligations and the inability to refinance existing indebtedness. In addition, our subordinated notes and the related subordinated note purchase agreements contain customary covenants, which under certain circumstances place restrictions on our ability to pay dividends or make other distributions and enter into certain transactions, including

28


Table of Contents

acquisition activity. If we fail to satisfy one or more of the covenants under our subordinated notes, we would be in default under such notes, and may be required to repay such debt with capital from other sources. Under such circumstances, other sources of capital may not be available to us on reasonable terms or at all.

We and our borrowers in our California communities may be adversely affected by earthquakes or other natural disasters and our business continuity and disaster recovery plans may not adequately protect us from a serious disaster.

        The majority of our branches are located in the San Francisco and Los Angeles, California areas, which in the past have experienced both severe earthquakes and wildfires. We do not carry earthquake insurance on our properties. Earthquakes, wildfires or other natural disasters could severely disrupt our operations, and have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects. In addition, our customers and loan collateral may be severely impacted by such events, resulting in losses.

        If a natural disaster, power outage or other event occurred that prevented us from using all or a significant portion of our branches, that damaged critical infrastructure or that otherwise disrupted operations, it may be difficult or, in certain cases, impossible, for us to continue our business for a substantial period of time in the San Francisco and/or Los Angeles, California areas. The disaster recovery and business continuity plans we have in place currently are limited and are unlikely to prove adequate in the event of a serious disaster or similar event. We may incur substantial expenses as a result of the limited nature of our disaster recovery and business continuity plans, which, particularly when taken together with our lack of earthquake insurance, could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Risks Related to Our Industry and Regulation

Our business, financial condition, results of operations and future prospects could be adversely affected by the highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in any of them.

        As a unitary thrift holding company, we are subject to extensive examination, supervision and comprehensive regulation by various federal agencies that govern almost all aspects of our operations. These laws and regulations are not intended to protect our shareholders. Rather, these laws and regulations are intended to protect customers, depositors, the Deposit Insurance Fund (the "DIF") and the overall financial stability of the United States. These laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage, limit the dividend or distributions that Sterling Bank can pay to us, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our debt, and impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than generally accepted accounting principles would require. Compliance with these laws and regulations is difficult and costly, and changes to these laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations, even if the failure follows good faith effort or reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could materially adversely affect our results of operations, capital base and the price of our securities. Further, any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more difficult or expensive.

        Likewise, the Company operates in an environment that imposes income taxes on its operations at both the federal and state levels to varying degrees. Changes in tax laws could significantly affect our financial position and results of operations. In addition, we are subject to regular review and audit by U.S. federal and certain state authorities. Tax authorities may disagree with certain positions we have

29


Table of Contents

taken and any adverse outcome of such a review or audit could have a negative effect on our financial position and results of operations.

Legislative and regulatory actions taken now or in the future may increase our costs and impact our business, governance structure, financial condition or results of operations.

        The Dodd-Frank Act, among other things, imposed new capital requirements on thrift holding companies; changed the base for FDIC insurance assessments to a bank's average consolidated total assets minus average tangible equity, rather than upon its deposit base; permanently raised the current standard deposit insurance limit to $250,000; and expanded the FDIC's authority to raise insurance premiums. The Dodd-Frank Act also established the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau as an independent entity within the FRB, which has broad rulemaking, supervisory and enforcement authority over consumer financial products and services, including deposit products, residential mortgages, home-equity loans and credit cards and contains provisions on mortgage-related matters, such as steering incentives, determinations as to a borrower's ability to repay and prepayment penalties. Although the applicability of certain elements of the Dodd-Frank Act is limited to institutions with more than $10 billion in assets, there can be no guarantee that such applicability will not be extended in the future or that regulators or other third parties will not seek to impose such requirements on institutions with less than $10 billion in assets, such as the Company. The Dodd-Frank Act has had and may continue to have a material impact on our operations, particularly through increased regulatory burden and compliance costs. Because the FRB has only been a primary regulator for thrift holding companies since 2012, it is unclear whether we will be exposed to additional regulatory burdens. Any future legislative changes could have a material impact on our profitability, the value of assets held for investment or the value of collateral for loans. Future legislative changes could also require changes to business practices and potentially expose us to additional costs, liabilities, enforcement action and reputational risk.

        Compliance with the Dodd-Frank Act and its implementing regulations has and will continue to result in additional operating and compliance costs that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.

        In addition, new proposals for legislation continue to be introduced in the U.S. Congress that could further substantially increase regulation of the bank and non-bank financial services industries and impose restrictions on the operations and general ability of firms within the industry to conduct business consistent with historical practices. Federal regulatory agencies also frequently adopt changes to their regulations or change the manner in which existing regulations are applied. Certain aspects of current or proposed regulatory or legislative changes to laws applicable to the financial industry, if enacted or adopted, may impact the profitability of our business activities, require more oversight or change certain of our business practices, including the ability to offer products, obtain financing, attract deposits, make loans and achieve satisfactory interest spreads and could expose us to additional costs, including increased compliance costs. These changes also may require us to invest significant management attention and resources to make any necessary changes to operations to comply and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.

        The Bank Secrecy Act, the USA Patriot Act and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain an effective anti-money laundering program and to file timely reports such as suspicious activity reports and currency transaction reports. We are required to comply with these and other anti-money laundering requirements. The federal banking agencies and Financial Crimes Enforcement Network are authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations of those requirements and have recently engaged in coordinated enforcement

30


Table of Contents

efforts against banks and other financial services providers with the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration and Internal Revenue Service. We are also subject to increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets Control. Because a significant portion of our customer base consists of foreign nationals and recent immigrants, these laws and regulations pose disproportionate challenges to us relative to our peers. If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient, we would be subject to liability, including fines and regulatory actions, which may include restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain aspects of our business plan.

        Failure to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us. Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.

We are subject to the Community Reinvestment Act and fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to material penalties.

        The Community Reinvestment Act ("CRA"), the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions. The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, the United States Department of Justice and other federal agencies are responsible for enforcing these laws and regulations. A successful challenge to an institution's performance under the CRA or fair lending laws and regulations could result in a wide variety of sanctions, including the required payment of damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, imposition of restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity and restrictions on expansion activity. Private parties may also have the ability to challenge an institution's performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation.

Federal regulators periodically examine our business, and we may be required to remediate adverse examination findings.

        The Federal Reserve Board ("FRB") and the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency ("OCC") periodically examine our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a federal banking agency were to determine that our financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, interest rate risk and liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that we were in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin "unsafe or unsound" practices, to require affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate our deposit insurance and place us into receivership or conservatorship. If we become subject to any regulatory actions, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and growth prospects.

As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act and recent rulemaking, we are subject to more stringent capital requirements.

        In July 2013, the U.S. federal banking authorities approved new regulatory capital rules implementing the Basel III regulatory capital reforms effecting certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act. The new regulatory capital requirements are generally applicable to all U.S. banks as well as to unitary thrift holding companies with assets over $1 billion, such as the Company. The new regulatory capital rules not only increase most of the required minimum regulatory capital ratios, but also introduce a new common equity Tier 1 capital ratio and the concept of a capital conservation

31


Table of Contents

buffer. The new regulatory capital rules also expand the current definition of capital by establishing additional criteria that capital instruments must meet to be considered additional Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital. In order to be a "well-capitalized" depository institution under the new regime, an institution must maintain a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.5% or more; a Tier 1 capital ratio of 8% or more; a total capital ratio of 10% or more; and a leverage ratio of 5% or more. Institutions must also maintain a capital conservation buffer consisting of common equity Tier 1 capital. The new regulatory capital rules became effective as applied to Sterling Bank on January 1, 2015 with a phase-in period that generally extends through January 1, 2019 for many of the changes. The mechanisms the FRB will utilize to enforce, and the manner in which the FRB will interpret, these standards with respect to unitary thrifts such as the Company remain uncertain.

        The failure to meet applicable regulatory capital requirements could result in one or more of our regulators placing limitations or conditions on our activities, including our growth initiatives, or restricting the commencement of new activities, and could materially adversely affect customer and investor confidence, our costs of funds and FDIC insurance costs, our ability to pay dividends on our common stock, our ability to make acquisitions, and our business, results of operations and financial conditions, generally.

The FRB or OCC may require us to commit capital resources to support Sterling Bank.

        As a matter of policy, the FRB expects a unitary thrift holding company to act as a source of financial and managerial strength for a subsidiary bank and to commit resources to support such subsidiary bank. The Dodd-Frank Act codified the FRB's policy on serving as a source of financial strength. Under the "source of strength" doctrine, the FRB may require a unitary thrift holding company to make capital injections into a troubled subsidiary bank and may charge the unitary thrift holding company with engaging in unsafe and unsound practices for failure to commit resources to a subsidiary bank. A capital injection may be required at times when the holding company may not have the resources to provide it and therefore may be required to borrow the funds or raise capital. Any loans by a holding company to its subsidiary bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of the subsidiary bank. In the event of a unitary thrift's bankruptcy, the bankruptcy trustee will assume any commitment by the holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank. Moreover, bankruptcy law provides that claims based on any such commitment will be entitled to a priority of payment over the claims of the institution's general unsecured creditors, including the holders of its note obligations. Thus, any borrowing that must be done by the Company to make a required capital injection becomes more difficult and expensive and could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. The requirement that we serve as a source of strength to our Bank may be exacerbated by OCC requirements to maintain certain capital requirements at the bank level and we may not be able to access the necessary funds to do so, which would further materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The FASB has recently issued an accounting standard update that will result in a significant change in how we provide for credit losses and may have a material impact on our financial condition or results of operations.

        In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued an accounting standard update, "Financial Instruments-Credit Losses (Topic 326), Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments," which replaces the current "incurred loss" model for recognizing credit losses with an "expected loss" model referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss ("CECL") model. Under the CECL model, we will be required to present certain financial assets carried at amortized cost, such as loans held for investment and held-to-maturity debt securities, at the net amount expected to be collected. The measurement of expected credit losses is to be based on information about past events,

32


Table of Contents

including historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts that affect the collectability of the reported amount. This measurement will take place at the time the financial asset is first added to the balance sheet and periodically thereafter. This differs significantly from the "incurred loss" model required under GAAP, which delays recognition until it is probable a loss has been incurred. Accordingly, we expect that the adoption of the CECL model will materially affect how we determine our allowance for loan losses and could require us to significantly increase our allowance. Moreover, the CECL model may create more volatility in the level of our allowance for loan losses. If we are required to materially increase our level of allowance for loan losses for any reason, such increase could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        The new CECL standard will become effective for us for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019 and for interim periods within those fiscal years. We are currently evaluating the impact the CECL model will have on our accounting, but we expect to recognize a one-time cumulative-effect adjustment to our allowance for loan losses as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which the new standard is effective, consistent with regulatory expectations set forth in interagency guidance issued at the end of 2016. We cannot yet determine the magnitude of any such one-time cumulative adjustment or of the overall impact of the new standard on our financial condition or results of operations.

FDIC deposit insurance assessments may materially increase in the future, which would have an adverse effect on earnings.

        As a member institution of the FDIC, our subsidiary, Sterling Bank, is assessed a quarterly deposit insurance premium. Failed banks nationwide significantly depleted the insurance fund and reduced the ratio of reserves to insured deposits. The FDIC has adopted a Deposit Insurance Fund Restoration Plan, which requires the FDIC's DIF to attain a 1.35% reserve ratio by September 30, 2020. As a result of this requirement, Sterling Bank could be required to pay significantly higher premiums or additional special assessments that would adversely affect its earnings, thereby reducing the availability of funds to pay dividends to us.

Monetary policies and regulations of the FRB could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the FRB. An important function of the FRB is to regulate the money supply and credit conditions. Among the instruments used by the FRB to implement these objectives are open market purchases and sales of U.S. government securities, adjustments of the discount rate and changes in banks' reserve requirements against bank deposits. These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits. Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

        The monetary policies and regulations of the FRB have had a significant effect on the operating results of banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. The effects of such policies upon our business, financial condition and results of operations cannot be predicted.

Our accounting estimates and risk management processes and controls rely on analytical and forecasting techniques and models and assumptions, which may not accurately predict future events.

        Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. Our management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with GAAP and reflect management's judgment of the most appropriate manner in which to report our financial condition and results. In some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more

33


Table of Contents

alternatives, any of which may be reasonable under the circumstances, yet which may result in our reporting materially different results than would have been reported under a different alternative.

        Certain accounting policies are critical to presenting our financial condition and results of operations. They require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain. Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions or estimates. These critical accounting policies include the allowance for loan losses and the fair value of securities. Because of the uncertainty of estimates involved in these matters, we may be required to significantly increase the allowance for loan losses or sustain loan losses that are significantly higher than the reserve provided or reduce the carrying value of an asset measured at fair value. Any of these could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."

        Our internal controls, disclosure controls, processes and procedures, and corporate governance policies and procedures are based in part on certain assumptions and can provide only reasonable (not absolute) assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of our controls, processes and procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls, processes and procedures could necessitate changes in those controls, processes and procedures, which may increase our compliance costs, divert management attention from our business or subject us to regulatory actions and increased regulatory scrutiny. Any of these could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We could be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions and other third parties we rely on.

        Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including banks, brokers and dealers, investment banks and other institutional entities. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacerbated when our collateral cannot be foreclosed upon or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the credit or derivative exposure due.

Risks Related to the Offering and an Investment in Our Common Stock

An active, liquid trading market for our common stock may not develop, and you may not be able to sell your common stock at or above the public offering price, or at all.

        Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common stock. An active trading market for shares of our common stock may never develop or be sustained following this offering. If an active trading market does not develop, you may have difficulty selling your shares of common stock at an attractive price, or at all. The public offering price for our common stock will be determined by negotiations between us and the underwriter and may not be indicative of prices that will prevail in the open market following this offering. Consequently, you may not be able to sell your common stock at or above the public offering price or at any other price or at the time that you would like to sell. An inactive market may also impair our ability to raise capital by selling our common stock and may impair our ability to expand our business by using our common stock as consideration in an acquisition.

34


Table of Contents

The price of our common stock could be volatile following this offering.

        The market price of our common stock following this offering may be volatile and could be subject to wide fluctuations in price in response to various factors, some of which are beyond our control. These factors include, among other things:

        The realization of any of the risks described in this "Risk Factors" section could have a material adverse effect on the market price of our common stock and cause the value of your investment to decline. In addition, the stock market experiences extreme volatility that has often been unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies. These types of broad market fluctuations may adversely affect investor confidence and could affect the trading price of our common stock over the short, medium or long term, regardless of our actual performance. If the market price of our common stock reaches an elevated level following this offering, it may materially and rapidly decline. In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company's securities, shareholders have often instituted securities class action litigation. If we were to be involved in a class action lawsuit, we could incur substantial costs and it could divert the attention of senior management and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If equity research analysts do not publish research or reports about our business, or if they do publish such reports but issue unfavorable commentary or downgrade our common stock, the price and/or trading volume of our common stock could decline.

        The trading market for our common stock could be affected by whether equity research analysts publish research or reports about us and our business. We cannot predict at this time whether any research analysts will publish research and reports on us and our common stock. If one or more equity analysts do cover us and our common stock and publish research reports about us, if one or more

35


Table of Contents

securities analysts downgrade our stock, or if those analysts issue other unfavorable commentary or cease publishing reports about us or our business, the price of our stock could decline.

        If any of the analysts who elect to cover us downgrades our stock, our stock price could decline rapidly. If any of these analysts ceases coverage of us, we could lose visibility in the market, which in turn could cause our common stock price or trading volume to decline and our common stock to be less liquid.

Our management will have broad discretion as to the use of proceeds from this offering, and we may not use the proceeds effectively.

        We are not required to apply any portion of the net proceeds of this offering for any particular purpose. Accordingly, our management will have broad discretion as to the application of the net proceeds of this offering and could use them for purposes other than those contemplated at the time of this offering. Our shareholders may not agree with the manner in which our management chooses to allocate and invest the net proceeds. We may not be successful in using the net proceeds from this offering to increase our profitability or market value and we cannot predict whether the proceeds will be invested to yield a favorable return.

We are a "controlled company" under the corporate governance rules for NASDAQ-listed companies, and we may eventually elect to take advantage of the "controlled company" exception, which would make our common stock less attractive to some investors or otherwise harm our stock price.

        Because we qualify as a "controlled company" under the corporate governance rules for NASDAQ-listed companies, we are not required to have a majority of our board of directors be independent, nor are we required to have a compensation committee or an independent monitoring function. In light of our status as a controlled company, our board of directors could determine not to have an independent nominating function and may choose to have the full board of directors be directly responsible for nominating members of our board, and in the future we could elect not to have a majority of our board of directors be independent or not to have a compensation committee. Accordingly, should the interests of our controlling shareholder differ from those of other shareholders, the other shareholders may not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the corporate governance rules for NASDAQ-listed companies. We may take advantage of some or all the "controlled company" exceptions and to the extent we do not, this determination could change in the future. Our status as a controlled company could make our common stock less attractive to some investors or otherwise harm our stock price.

You will incur immediate dilution as a result of this offering.

        If you purchase our common stock in this offering, you will pay more for your shares than the net tangible book value per share immediately following consummation of this offering. As a result, you will incur immediate dilution of $            per share representing the difference between the offering price of $            , the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and our net tangible book value per share as of June 30, 2017 of $3.81 per share of common stock. This represents        % dilution from the midpoint of the initial public offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. Accordingly, if we were to be liquidated at our book value immediately following this offering, you would not receive the full amount of your investment.

36


Table of Contents

The obligations associated with being a public company will require significant resources and management attention, which may divert from our business operations.

        As a result of this offering, we will become subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or Exchange Act, and the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, or the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. The Exchange Act requires that we file annual, quarterly and current reports with respect to our business and financial condition with the SEC. The Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires, among other things, that we establish and maintain effective internal controls and procedures for financial reporting. As a result, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not previously incur. We anticipate that these costs will materially increase our general and administrative expenses. Furthermore, the need to establish the corporate infrastructure demanded of a public company may divert management's attention from implementing our strategic plan, which could prevent us from successfully implementing our growth initiatives and improving our business, results of operations and financial condition.

        As an "emerging growth company" as defined in the JOBS Act, we intend to take advantage of certain temporary exemptions from various reporting requirements, including reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports and proxy statements and an exemption from the requirement to obtain an attestation from our auditors on management's assessment of our internal control over financial reporting. When these exemptions cease to apply, we expect to incur additional expenses and devote increased management effort toward ensuring compliance with them. We cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur as a result of becoming a public company or the timing of such costs.

The reduced disclosures and relief from certain other significant disclosure requirements that are available to emerging growth companies may make our common stock less attractive to investors.

        We are an "emerging growth company," as defined in the JOBS Act, and we intend to take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that apply to other public companies that are not "emerging growth companies." These exemptions include the following:

        In addition, even if we comply with the greater obligations of public companies that are not emerging growth companies immediately after this offering, we may avail ourselves of the reduced requirements applicable to emerging growth companies from time to time in the future, so long as we are an emerging growth company.

        We will remain an emerging growth company for up to five years, though we may cease to be an emerging growth company earlier under certain circumstances, including if, before the end of such five years, we are deemed to be a large accelerated filer under the rules of the SEC (which depends on, among other things, having a market value of common stock held by non-affiliates in excess of $700 million). Investors and securities analysts may find it more difficult to evaluate our common stock because we will rely on one or more of these exemptions. If, as a result, some investors find our common stock less attractive, there may be a less active trading market for our common stock, which could result in a reduction and greater volatility in the prices of our common stock.

37


Table of Contents

As a closely held private company, our historical dividend policy has varied. We have only recently paid consistent dividends and we may not pay dividends on our common stock in the near term or over a broader time frame. Consequently, your only opportunity to achieve a return on your investment may be if the price of our common stock appreciates.

        The holders of our common stock will receive dividends if and when declared by our board of directors out of legally available funds. We have only recently paid dividends to our shareholders and while we intend to consider conservative and appropriate dividend levels post-offering, we may not pay any dividends in the future. Any future determination relating to our dividend policy will be made at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on a number of factors, including our future earnings, capital requirements, restrictions imposed by our subordinated debt, funds needed to pay the interest cost on any debt, financial condition, future prospects, regulatory restrictions, and other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant.

        Our principal business operations are conducted through our subsidiary, Sterling Bank. Cash available to pay dividends to our shareholders is derived primarily, if not entirely, from dividends paid by Sterling Bank to us. The ability of Sterling Bank to pay dividends to us, as well as our ability to pay dividends to our shareholders, will continue to be subject to, and limited by, certain legal and regulatory restrictions. Further, any lenders making loans to us may impose financial covenants that may be more restrictive with respect to dividend payments than the regulatory requirements.

A future issuance of stock could dilute the value of our common stock.

        We may sell additional shares of common stock, or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such shares, in subsequent public or private offerings. Upon completion of this offering, there will be                shares of our common stock issued and outstanding, or                shares if the underwriter exercises in full its option to purchase additional shares. Future issuance of any new shares could cause further dilution in the value of our outstanding shares of common stock. We cannot predict the size of future issuances of our common stock, or securities convertible into or exchangeable for such shares, or the effect, if any, that future issuances and sales of shares of our common stock will have on the market price of our common stock. Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock (including shares issued in connection with an acquisition), or the perception that such sales could occur, may adversely affect prevailing market prices of our common stock.

If a substantial number of shares become available for sale and are sold in a short period of time, the market price of our common stock could decline.

        If our existing shareholders sell substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market following this offering, the market price of our common stock could decrease significantly. The perception in the public market that our existing shareholders might sell shares of common stock could also depress our market price. Upon completion of this offering, we will have                shares of our common stock outstanding, or                shares if the underwriter exercises in full its option to purchase additional shares. The selling shareholders (and certain other shareholders) collectively representing        % of our common shares outstanding upon completion of this offering, or        % if the underwriter exercises in full its option to purchase additional shares, will be subject to the lock-up agreements described in "Underwriting" and the Rule 144 holding period requirements described in "Shares Eligible for Future Sale." After all of the lock-up periods have expired and the holding periods have elapsed, 45,271,000 additional shares of our outstanding common stock will be eligible for sale in the public market. In addition, the underwriter may, at any time and without notice, release all or a portion of the shares subject to lock-up agreements. The market price of shares of our common stock may drop significantly when the restrictions on resale by our existing shareholders lapse. A decline in the price of shares of our common stock might impede our ability to raise capital through the issuance

38


Table of Contents

of additional shares of our common stock or other equity securities and could result in a decline in the value of the shares of our common stock purchased in this offering.

The Seligman family, through the family's trustee and the Bank's founder and the Company's Vice President, Scott Seligman, will have the ability to influence Company operations and control the outcome of matters submitted for shareholder approval and may have interests that differ from those of our other shareholders.

        After the completion of this offering, assuming the underwriter does not exercise its option to purchase additional shares, certain trusts for the benefit of members of the Seligman family and administered by their trustee will beneficially own approximately        % of our common stock. In addition, Scott Seligman, the founder of the Bank, Vice President of the Company and consultant to the Bank's board of directors, represents the interests of the family and continues to serve in an advisory capacity to the Company and the Bank, including through attendance at board meetings and frequent consultation with senior management. Therefore, Mr. Seligman will continue to have access and influence with respect to Company operations and the Seligman family trustee will continue to have effective control over the outcome of votes on all matters requiring approval by shareholders after the offering, including the election of directors, the adoption of amendments to our articles of incorporation and bylaws and approval of a sale of the Company and other significant corporate transactions, regardless of how other shareholders vote on these matters. Furthermore, the interests of the Seligman family may be different than the interests of other shareholders. This concentration of voting power could also have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a change in control or other business combination that might otherwise be beneficial to our shareholders.

Our common stock is subordinate to our existing and future indebtedness and preferred stock.

        Shares of our common stock are equity interests and do not constitute indebtedness. As such, our common stock ranks junior to all our customer deposits and indebtedness, whether now existing or hereafter incurred, and other non-equity claims on us, with respect to assets available to satisfy claims. Additionally, holders of common stock are subject to the prior liquidation rights of the holders of our subordinated debt and may be subject to the prior dividend and liquidation rights of any series of preferred stock we may issue in the future.

Certain provisions of our corporate governance documents and Michigan law could discourage, delay or prevent a merger or acquisition at a premium price.

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws that we will adopt prior to completion of this offering will contain provisions that may make the acquisition of our Company more difficult without the approval of our board of directors. These include provisions that, among other things:

39


Table of Contents

        These provisions may frustrate or prevent any attempts by our shareholders to replace or remove our current management by making it more difficult for shareholders to replace members of the board of directors, which is responsible for appointing members of our management. Any matters requiring the approval of our shareholders will effectively require the approval of the Seligman family and their trustee, which may have interests that differ from those of our other shareholders. See "—The Seligman family, through the family trustee and the Bank's founder and the Company's Vice President, Scott Seligman, will have the ability to control the outcome of matters submitted for shareholder approval and may have interests that differ from those of our other shareholders."

        In addition, the 2017 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan will permit the board of directors or a committee thereof to accelerate, vest or cause the restrictions to lapse with respect to outstanding equity awards, in the event of, or immediately prior to, a change in control. Such vesting or acceleration could discourage the acquisition of our Company.

        We could also become subject to certain anti-takeover provisions under Michigan law which may discourage, delay or prevent someone from acquiring us or merging with us, whether or not an acquisition or merger is desired by or beneficial to our shareholders. If a corporation's board of directors chooses to "opt-in" to certain provisions of Michigan Law, such corporation may not, in general, engage in a business combination with any beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of 10% of the corporation's outstanding voting shares unless the holder has held the shares for five years or more or, among other things, the board of directors has approved the business combination. Our board of directors has not elected to be subject to this provision, but could do so in the future. Any provision of our second amended and restated articles of incorporation or amended and restated bylaws or Michigan law that has the effect of delaying or deterring a change in control could limit the opportunity for our shareholders to receive a premium for their shares, and could also affect the price that some investors are willing to pay for our common stock otherwise.

Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation designates the courts of the State of Michigan located in Oakland County and the United States District for the Eastern District of Michigan as the sole and exclusive forum for certain types of actions and proceedings that may be initiated by our shareholders, which could limit our shareholders' ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for disputes with us or our directors, officers or other employees.

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation provides that the courts of the State of Michigan located in Oakland County and the United States District for the Eastern District of Michigan shall be the sole and exclusive forum for (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf, (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors,

40


Table of Contents

officers, or employees to us or our shareholders, (iii) any action asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Michigan Business Corporation Act (as it may be amended from time to time, the "MBCA"), or (iv) any action asserting a claim against us governed by the State of Michigan's internal affairs doctrine. Any person or entity purchasing or otherwise acquiring any interest in shares of our common stock shall be deemed to have notice of and consented to the provisions of our second amended and restated articles of incorporation described above. This choice of forum provision may limit a shareholder's ability to bring a claim in a judicial forum that it finds favorable for disputes with us or our directors, officers or other employees, which may discourage such lawsuits against us and our directors, officers and other employees. Alternatively, if a court were to find these provisions of our second amended and restated articles of incorporation inapplicable to, or unenforceable in respect of, one or more of the specified types of actions or proceedings, we may incur additional costs associated with resolving such matters in other jurisdictions, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Our ability to pay dividends is restricted by applicable law and the terms of our subordinated notes.

        Our ability to pay cash dividends is restricted by the terms of our subordinated notes as well as applicable provisions of Michigan law and the rules and regulations of the OCC and the FRB. Any future determination to pay dividends to holders of our common stock will depend on our results of operations, financial condition, capital requirements, banking regulations, contractual restrictions and any other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant, and we can provide no assurance that we will pay any dividends to our shareholders following completion of this offering. See "Dividend Policy."

An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is not guaranteed by the FDIC, so you could lose some or all of your investment.

        An investment in our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss or guaranteed by the FDIC, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. An investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described herein. As a result, if you acquire our common stock, you could lose some or all of your investment.

41


Table of Contents


CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

        This prospectus contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the federal securities laws. These forward-looking statements reflect our current views with respect to, among other things, future events and our financial performance. These statements are often, but not always, made through the use of words or phrases such as "may," "might," "should," "could," "predict," "potential," "believe," "expect," "attribute," "continue," "will," "anticipate," "seek," "estimate," "intend," "plan," "projection," "goal," "target," "outlook," "aim," "would," "annualized" and "outlook," or the negative version of those words or other comparable words or phrases of a future or forward-looking nature. These forward-looking statements are not historical facts, and are based on current expectations, estimates and projections about our industry, management's beliefs and certain assumptions made by management, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and beyond our control. Accordingly, we caution you that any such forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and are subject to risks, assumptions, estimates and uncertainties that are difficult to predict. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in these forward-looking statements are reasonable as of the date made, actual results may prove to be materially different from the results expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements.

        The following factors, among others, could cause actual results to differ materially from the anticipated results or other expectations expressed in the forward-looking statements:

42


Table of Contents

        The foregoing factors should not be construed as exhaustive and should be read in conjunction with other cautionary statements that are included in this prospectus as well as the items set forth under the heading "Risk Factors". If one or more events related to these or other risks or uncertainties materialize, or if our underlying assumptions prove to be incorrect, actual results may differ materially from what we anticipate. Accordingly, you should not place undue reliance on any such forward-looking statements. Any forward-looking statement speaks only as of the date on which it is made, and we do not undertake any obligation to publicly update or review any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise except as required by law. New risks and uncertainties arise from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict those events or how they may affect us. In addition, we cannot assess the impact of each factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements.

43


Table of Contents


USE OF PROCEEDS

        Assuming an initial public offering price of $            per share, the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, we estimate that the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us will be approximately $             million (or approximately $             million if the underwriter exercises in full its option to purchase additional shares of common stock from us), after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. Each $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price would increase (decrease) the net proceeds to us of this offering by approximately $             million (or approximately $             million if the underwriter elects to exercise its purchase option in full), after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

        We intend to contribute $            million of the net proceeds of the offering to the Bank as needed to support its current growth while remaining well-capitalized and to use the remainder for general corporate purposes, which could include future contributions to the Bank to support growth initiatives or selective acquisition activity, though no specific opportunities are currently under consideration.

        Our management will retain broad discretion to allocate the net proceeds of this offering, and the precise amounts and timing of our use of the net proceeds of this offering will depend upon market conditions, as well as other factors. Until we deploy the proceeds of this offering for the uses described above, we expect to hold such proceeds in short-term investments.

        We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares of our common stock by the selling shareholders.

44


Table of Contents


CAPITALIZATION

        The following table sets forth our capitalization as of June 30, 2017:

        You should read this table in conjunction with "Use of Proceeds," "Selected Historical Consolidated Financial and Operating Data," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  At June 30, 2017  
 
  Actual   As Adjusted  
 
  (dollars in thousands)
 

Long-term debt (including current portion):

             

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings(1)

  $ 205,000        

Subordinated notes(2)

    49,404        

Total long-term debt

    254,404        

Shareholders' equity:

             

Preferred stock, authorized 1,000,000 shares, none issued and outstanding; actual and as adjusted

           

Common stock, voting, no par value, authorized 490,000,000 shares, 40,199,000 shares issued and outstanding;        issued and outstanding; as adjusted

    22,863        

Common stock, non-voting, no par value, authorized 10,000,000 shares, 5,072,000 shares issued and outstanding; none issued and outstanding; as adjusted

    2,885        

Additional paid-in capital

    12,290        

Retained earnings

    136,371        

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (126 )      

Total shareholders' equity

    174,283        

Total capitalization

  $ 428,687        

(1)
Consists of long-term Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings that bear interest at rates of 0.98% to 3.84% per annum.

(2)
Consists of 7% fixed to floating rate subordinated notes ("Notes") issued in 2016 to accredited investors with proceeds raised of $50 million. Subsequent to June 30, 2017, the Company sold an additional $15 million of Notes to accredited investors.

        A $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $            per share, the midpoint of the estimated price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase (decrease), on an as adjusted basis, total shareholders' equity and total capitalization by approximately $             million, assuming the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses. The pro forma information discussed above is illustrative only and will be adjusted based on the actual public offering price and other terms of this offering determined at pricing.

45


Table of Contents


DILUTION

        If you invest in our common stock in this offering, your ownership interest will be immediately diluted to the extent that the initial public offering price per share of our common stock exceeds the pro forma net tangible book value per share of our common stock immediately after this offering.

        Our historical net tangible book value as of June 30, 2017 was approximately $173 million, or $3.82 per share of common stock. Our historical net tangible book value is the amount of our total tangible assets less our total liabilities. Historical net tangible book value per share is our historical net tangible book value divided by the number of shares of common stock outstanding as of June 30, 2017.

        Our pro forma net tangible book value as of June 30, 2017 was $     million, or $    per share of common stock. Pro forma net tangible book value gives effect to (i) the conversion of our 5,072,000 outstanding shares of our non-voting shares into 5,072,000 shares of voting common stock prior to the completion of this offering and (ii) the sale of            shares of our common stock by us (assuming the underwriter does not exercise its option to purchase any additional shares from us to cover over-allotments, if any) at the initial public offering price of $            per share, the midpoint of the estimated price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of            per share to existing common shareholders, and an immediate dilution of $            per share to new investors in this offering. If the initial public offering price is higher or lower, the dilution to new shareholders will be greater or less, respectively.

        The following table illustrates this dilution on a per share basis:

Assumed initial public offering price per share

               $           

Net tangible book value per share at June 30, 2017

  $ 3.82               

Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to new investors

             

Pro forma net tangible book value per share after giving effect to this offering

             

Dilution per share to new investors in this offering

               $           

        A $1.00 increase (or decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price per share of common stock, would increase (or decrease) the pro forma net tangible book value after this offering by approximately $        , and dilution in net tangible book value to new investors in this offering by approximately $        per share, assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

        If the underwriter exercises in full its option to purchase additional shares of our common stock in this offering and up to  from the selling shareholders the pro forma net tangible book value after this offering would be $        per share and the dilution in pro forma net tangible book value to new investors would be $        per share.

        The following table summarizes, on a pro forma basis as of June 30, 2017 and after giving effect to the offering, the differences between our existing shareholders, including the selling shareholders, and new investors with respect to the number of shares of our common stock purchased from us, the total consideration paid to us and the average price per share paid. The calculations with respect to shares purchased by new investors in this offering reflect an assumed offering price of $        per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, before

46


Table of Contents

deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us:

 
  Shares Purchased   Total Consideration    
 
 
  Average
Price
Per Share
 
 
  Number   Percentage   Amount   Percentage  

Existing shareholders

  45,271,000       % $                  % $             

New investors

                   %                    %               

Total

                 100.0 % $                100.0 % $             

        In addition, if the underwriter's option to purchase additional shares is exercised in full, the number of shares of common stock held by existing shareholders as of June 30, 2017 would be shares or      % of the total number of shares of common stock to be outstanding upon the completion of this offering, and the number of shares of common stock held by investors participating in this offering would be            shares or      % of the total number of shares of common stock to be outstanding upon the completion of this offering.

        The table above excludes                shares of our common stock reserved and available for future awards under the equity incentive plan we plan to adopt prior to the completion of this offering. When equity awards are issued under such equity incentive plan, investors purchasing in this offering will experience further dilution.

47


Table of Contents


DIVIDEND POLICY

        We have only recently paid dividends to our shareholders and while we intend to consider conservative and appropriate dividend levels post-offering, we may not pay dividends in the future. Our dividend policy and practice may change at any time, and our board of directors may change or eliminate the payment of future dividends at its discretion, without notice to our shareholders. Any future determination to pay dividends to holders of our common stock will depend on our future earnings, capital requirements, restrictions imposed by our subordinated debt, funds needed to pay the interest cost on any debt, financial condition, future prospects, regulatory restrictions and any other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant.

        The following table shows recent dividends that have been paid on our common stock during the periods indicated giving retroactive effect to our recent 1,000-for-1 stock split. The annual and year to date aggregate amounts set forth below were paid on a quarterly basis during the period indicated.

Year
  Amount Per
Share
 

2017 (through June 30)

  $ .10  

2016

  $ .19  

2015

  $ .15  

Dividend Restrictions

        Under the terms of our 7.0% Fixed to Floating Subordinated Notes due April 15, 2026 and the related subordinated note purchase agreements, we are not permitted to declare or pay any dividends on our capital stock if an event of default occurs under the terms of the subordinated notes. Additionally, under the terms of such notes, we are not permitted to declare or pay any dividends on our capital stock if we are not "well capitalized" for regulatory purposes immediately prior to the payment of such dividend, except for dividends payable solely in shares of our common stock.

        As a Michigan corporation, we are subject to certain restrictions on dividends under the Michigan Business Corporation Act. Generally, Michigan law limits cash dividends if the corporation would not be able to pay its debts as they become due in the usual course of business after giving effect to the cash dividend or if the corporation's total assets would be less than the sum of its total liabilities plus the amount needed to satisfy the preferential rights upon dissolution of shareholders whose preferential rights on dissolution are superior to those receiving the distribution.

        As a unitary thrift holding company, our ability to pay dividends is affected by the policies and enforcement powers of the Federal Reserve. See "Supervision and Regulation—The Company—Dividend Payments." Because we are a holding company, we are dependent upon the payment of dividends by Sterling Bank to us as our principal source of funds to pay dividends in the future, if any, and to make other payments. Sterling Bank is also subject to various legal, regulatory and other restrictions on its ability to pay dividends and make other distributions and payments to us. See "Supervision and Regulation—The Bank—Dividend Payments."

        A federal savings bank may generally declare a cash dividend, without approval from the OCC, in an amount equal to its year-to-date net income plus the prior two years' net income that is still available for dividends. The OCC has the authority to prohibit a federal savings bank from paying cash dividends if such payment is deemed to be an unsafe or unsound practice. In addition, as a depository institution the deposits of which are insured by the FDIC, Sterling Bank may not pay cash dividends or distribute any of its capital assets while it remains in default on any assessment due to the FDIC. Sterling Bank currently is not (and never has been) in default under any of its obligations to the FDIC. See "Supervision and Regulation—Sterling Bank—Dividends" and "—Safety and Soundness Standards."

48


Table of Contents

        The FRB has issued a policy statement regarding the payment of cash dividends by bank holding companies. In general, the FRB's policy provides that cash dividends should be paid only out of current earnings and only if the prospective rate of earnings retention by the bank holding company appears consistent with the organization's capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition. The FRB has the authority to prohibit a bank holding company from paying cash dividends if such payment is deemed to be an unsafe or unsound practice.

49


Table of Contents

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA

        The following table sets forth selected historical consolidated financial and operating data as of the dates and for the periods indicated. The selected financial data as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, except for selected ratios, were derived from our audited consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected financial data as of and for the year ended December 31, 2014, except for selected ratios, were derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes that are not included in this prospectus. The selected financial data as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, except for selected ratios, were derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus. In the opinion of management, the unaudited consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as our audited consolidated financial statements and include all adjustments, consisting of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of our consolidated financial position and consolidated results of operations as of such dates and for such periods. Results for the interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the full year. The historical consolidated financial data set forth below, have been retrospectively adjusted for a merger of an entity that occurred in April 2017 that was under common control for all the periods presented. Also, all share and per share amounts have been retroactively adjusted, where applicable, to reflect the stock split that occurred on September 11, 2017.

        These historical results are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for any future period. The selected historical consolidated financial and operating data set forth below should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
  Year Ended December 31,  
(dollars in thousands, except per share data)
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Statements of Income Data:

                               

Interest income

                               

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 54,881   $ 40,663   $ 89,566   $ 65,111   $ 51,302  

Interest and dividends on investment securities           

    849     566     1,211     806     677  

Other interest

        16     26     33     33  

Total interest income

    55,730     41,245     90,803     65,950     52,012  

Interest expense

                               

Interest on deposits

    7,311     5,112     11,428     6,526     4,983  

Interest on Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    1,700     1,032     2,439     1,539     928  

Interest on subordinated notes and other

    1,816     426     1,978     43      

Total interest expense

    10,827     6,570     15,845     8,108     5,911  

Net interest income

    44,903     34,675     74,958     57,842     46,101  

Provision for loan losses

    1,200     (917 )   1,280     525     (1,400 )

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    43,703     35,592     73,678     57,317     47,501  

Total non-interest income

    8,399     9,288     16,006     8,617     6,472  

Total non-interest expense

    19,265     15,986     33,235     28,136     24,475  

Income before income taxes

    32,837     28,894     56,449     37,798     29,498  

Income tax expense

    13,483     11,728     23,215     15,287     11,775  

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166   $ 33,234   $ 22,511   $ 17,723  

Income per share, basic and diluted

  $ 0.43   $ 0.38   $ 0.73   $ 0.49   $ 0.36  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    45,271,000     45,271,000     45,271,000     46,148,000     48,829,000  

Cash dividends per share

  $ 0.10   $ 0.10   $ 0.19   $ 0.15   $  

50


Table of Contents


 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of
June 30,
2017
 
 
  2016   2015   2014  

Period End Balance Sheet Data:

                         

Investment securities, available for sale

  $ 102,501   $ 75,606   $ 46,678   $ 32,559  

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses

    2,205,530     1,982,439     1,575,802     1,136,078  

Allowance for loan losses

    16,246     14,822     10,984     10,015  

Total assets

    2,416,171     2,163,601     1,712,008     1,241,963  

Non-interest bearing deposits

    66,455     59,231     44,298     29,626  

Interest-bearing deposits

    1,729,869     1,555,914     1,185,462     923,608  

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    359,312     308,198     326,437     148,085  

Subordinated notes

    49,404     49,338          

Total liabilities

    2,241,888     2,001,329     1,575,730     1,115,076  

Total shareholders' equity

    174,283     162,272     136,278     126,887  

 

 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Performance Ratios:

                               

Return on average assets

    1.72 %   1.93 %   1.73 %   1.59 %   1.60 %

Return on average shareholders' equity

    22.70     23.80     22.06     17.09     15.04  

Return on average tangible common equity(1)

    22.86     24.08     22.29     17.35     15.36  

Yield on earning assets

    5.10     4.77     4.86     4.80     4.88  

Cost of average interest-bearing liabilities

    1.10     0.85     0.94     0.66     0.62  

Net interest spread

    4.00     3.92     3.92     4.14     4.26  

Net interest margin

    4.11     4.01     4.01     4.21     4.33  

Efficiency ratio(2)

    36     36     37     42     47  

Dividend payout ratio(3)

    24     27     26     31     0  

Core deposits / total deposits(4)

    95     90     91     89     94  

Net non-core funding dependence ratio(5)

    16     22     19     26     15  

Capital Ratios

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Regulatory and Other Capital Ratios—Consolidated:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Tangible common equity to tangible assets(1)

    7.17 %   7.56 %   7.44 %   7.86 %   10.05 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    11.69     12.37     12.22     12.90     15.53 (6)

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    7.62     8.01     7.74     8.42     9.77 (6)

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    11.69     12.37     12.22     12.90     15.53 (6)

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    16.11     15.81     17.07     13.94     16.74 (6)

Regulatory and Other Capital Ratios—Bank:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    13.79     14.51     14.61     12.76     14.61  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    8.99     9.40     9.26     8.33     9.19  

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    13.79     14.51     14.61     12.76     14.61  

Total capital to risk-weighted assets

    14.89     15.57     15.73     13.80     15.82  

Credit Quality Data:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Nonperforming loans(7)

  $ 665   $ 642   $ 565   $ 1,167   $ 1,643  

Nonperforming loans to total loans(7)

    0.03 %   0.04 %   0.03 %   0.07 %   0.14 %

Nonperforming assets(8)

  $ 3,793   $ 3,772   $ 3,699   $ 7,229   $ 6,508  

Nonperforming assets to total assets(8)           

    0.16 %   0.20 %   0.17 %   0.42 %   0.52 %

Allowance for loan losses to total loans           

    0.73 %   0.67 %   0.74 %   0.69 %   0.87 %

Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans(7)

    2443 %   1893 %   2623 %   941 %   610 %

Net charge offs to average loans

    (0.01 )%   (0.13 )%   (0.14 )%   (0.03 )%   (0.12 )%

(1)
Return on average tangible common equity and tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio are Non-GAAP financial measures. See "Non-GAAP Financial Measures" for a reconciliation of these measures to their most comparable U.S. GAAP measure.

(2)
Efficiency ratio represents the ratio of non-interest expense divided by the sum of net interest income and non-interest income.

(3)
Dividend payout ratio represents the ratio of total dividends paid to our shareholders divided by our net income.

(4)
Core deposit ratio represents the ratio of all demand, savings, NOW and money market accounts and those time deposits with balances less than or equal to $250,000 divided by total deposits.

51


Table of Contents

(5)
Net non-core funding dependence ratio represents the degree to which the bank is funding longer term assets with non-core funds. We calculate this ratio as the sum of all time deposits greater than $250,000 and FHLB borrowings less short-term investments divided by the sum of all long-term assets.

(6)
Sterling Bancorp was not required to comply with regulatory and other capital ratios for periods ending prior to January 1, 2015 but has included such ratios for informational purposes.

(7)
Nonperforming loans include nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest.

(8)
Nonperforming assets include nonperforming loans and loans modified under trouble debt restructurings and other repossessed assets.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

        Some of the financial measures included in this prospectus are not measures of financial performance recognized by U.S. GAAP. These non-GAAP financial measures include return on average tangible common equity and tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio. Our management uses these non-GAAP financial measures in its analysis of our performance.

Return on Average Tangible Common Equity

        Management measures return on average tangible common equity to assess the Company's capital strength and business performance. Average tangible equity excludes the effect of intangible assets. This non-GAAP financial measure should not be considered a substitute for those comparable measures that are similarly titled that are determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP that may be used by other companies. The following table reconciles return on average tangible common equity to its most comparable U.S. GAAP measure:

 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the
Year Ended December 31,
 
(Dollars in thousands)
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166   $ 33,234   $ 22,511   $ 17,723  

Average shareholders' equity

    170,544     144,272     150,664     131,738     117,876  

Adjustments

                               

Customer-related intangible

    (1,238 )   (1,688 )   (1,575 )   (2,025 )   (2,475 )

Average tangible common equity

  $ 169,306   $ 142,585   $ 149,089   $ 129,713   $ 115,401  

Return on average tangible common equity

    22.86 %   24.08 %   22.29 %   17.35 %   15.36 %

Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets Ratio

        The tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio is a non-GAAP measure that is generally used by financial analysts and investment bankers to evaluate capital adequacy. We calculate (i) tangible common equity as total shareholders' equity less intangible assets and (ii) tangible assets as total assets less intangible assets. This non-GAAP financial measure should not be considered a substitute for those comparable measures that are similarly titled that are determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP that may be used by other companies. The following table reconciles shareholders' equity on a U.S. GAAP

52


Table of Contents

basis to tangible common equity and total assets on a U.S. GAAP basis to tangible assets to arrive at our tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio:

 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the
Year Ended December 31,
 
(Dollars in thousands)
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014  

Tangible common equity:

                               

Total shareholders' equity

  $ 174,283   $ 149,049   $ 162,272   $ 136,278   $ 126,887  

Adjustments

                               

Customer-related intangible

    (1,125 )   (1,575 )   (1,350 )   (1,800 )   (2,250 )

Tangible common equity

  $ 173,158   $ 147,474   $ 160,922   $ 134,478   $ 124,637  

Tangible assets:

                               

Total assets

  $ 2,416,171   $ 1,952,696   $ 2,163,601   $ 1,712,008   $ 1,241,963  

Adjustments

                               

Customer-related intangible

    (1,125 )   (1,575 )   (1,350 )   (1,800 )   (2,250 )

Tangible assets

  $ 2,415,046   $ 1,951,121   $ 2,162,251   $ 1,710,208   $ 1,239,713  

Tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio

    7 .17 %   7.56 %   7.44 %   7.86 %   10.05 %

53


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

        The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 and for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 should be read in conjunction with "Selected Historical Consolidated Financial and Operating Data" and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that are subject to certain risks and uncertainties and are based on certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable but may prove to be inaccurate. Certain risks, uncertainties and other factors, including those set forth under "Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements," "Risk Factors" and elsewhere in this prospectus, may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected results discussed in the forward-looking statements appearing in this discussion and analysis. We assume no obligation to update any of these forward-looking statements except as required by law.

Overview

        We are a unitary thrift holding company headquartered in Southfield, Michigan with our primary branch operations in San Francisco and Los Angeles, California. Through our wholly owned bank subsidiary, Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B., a qualified thrift lender, we offer a broad range of loan products to the residential and commercial markets, as well as retail and business banking services.

        Since 2013, we have grown organically at a compound annual growth rate of 29% while maintaining stable margins and solid asset quality. We have made significant investments over the last several years in staffing and upgrading technology and system security. In 2017, we opened a loan production office in Seattle, Washington and a branch in New York City. We plan to open additional branches in Los Angeles and Seattle in 2018. As of June 30, 2017, the Company had total consolidated assets of $2.4 billion, total consolidated deposits of $1.8 billion and total consolidated shareholders' equity of $174.3 million.

        Total assets increased $253 million, or 12%, to $2.42 billion at June 30, 2017 from $2.16 billion at December 31, 2016, primarily as a result of loan growth. We continue to focus on the residential mortgage market, construction, and commercial real estate lending. Net loans increased $223 million, or 11%, to $2.21 billion at June 30, 2017 from $1.98 billion at December 31, 2016, reflecting increases in all major loan categories.

        Our net income increased $2.2 million, or 13%, to $19.4 million at the six month period ended June 30, 2017 from $17.2 million at the six month period ended June 30, 2016, primarily as a result of income from loan growth outpacing corresponding increases in expenses.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

        Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and with general practices within the financial services industry. Application of these principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under current circumstances. These assumptions form the basis for our judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily available from independent, objective sources. We evaluate our estimates on an ongoing basis. Use of alternative assumptions may have resulted in significantly different estimates. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

        We have identified the following accounting policies and estimates that, due to the difficult, subjective or complex judgments and assumptions inherent in those policies and estimates, and the

54


Table of Contents

potential sensitivity of our financial statements to those judgments and assumptions, are critical to an understanding of our financial condition and results of operations. We believe that the judgments, estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of our financial statements are appropriate.

Allowance for Loan Losses

        The allowance for loan losses is a valuation allowance for probable incurred credit losses, increased or decreased by the provision (benefit) for loan losses and decreased by charge offs less recoveries. Loan losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of a loan balance is confirmed. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. Management estimates the allowance balance required using past loan loss experience, the nature and volume of the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, economic conditions, and other factors. Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for any loan that, in management's judgment, should be charged-off.

        The allowance consists of specific and general components. The specific component relates to loans that are individually classified as impaired. The general component covers all other loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for general economic conditions and other qualitative factors by loan segment.

        Commercial lines of credit, construction loans, and commercial real estate loans are individually evaluated for impairment based upon a quarterly systematic review utilizing among other components our internal risk rating system, similar to those employed by banking regulators. If a loan is impaired, a portion of the allowance is allocated so that the loan is reported, net, at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan's existing rate or at the fair value of collateral if repayment is expected solely from the collateral or operations of collateral. Large groups of smaller balance homogeneous loans, such as consumer and residential real estate loans, are collectively evaluated for impairment, and accordingly, are not separately identified for impairment disclosures.

        Loans which have been modified resulting in a concession, and which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, are considered troubled debt restructurings. Troubled debt restructurings are separately identified for impairment disclosures and are measured at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan's effective rate at inception. If a troubled debt restructuring is considered to be a collateral dependent loan, the loan is reported, net, at the fair value of the collateral. For troubled debt restructurings that subsequently default, the Company determines the amount of reserve in accordance with the accounting policy for the allowance for loan losses on loans individually identified as impaired.

        The general reserve component covers all non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. The historical loss experience is determined by portfolio segment and is based on the actual loss history experienced by the Company over the most recent three years. This actual loss experience is supplemented with economic and other factors based on the risks present for each portfolio segment. These economic and other risk factors include consideration of the following: levels of and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge offs and recoveries; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards; other changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; seasoning of loans where the borrower had limited credit history at origination; national and local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations.

        The degree of risk in residential real estate lending depends primarily on the loan amount in relation to collateral value, the interest rate and the borrower's ability to repay in an orderly fashion. Economic trends determined by unemployment rates and other key economic indicators are closely

55


Table of Contents

correlated to the credit quality of these loans. Weak economic trends indicate that the borrowers' capacity to repay their obligations may be deteriorating. The classes identified by the Company in the residential real estate portfolio segment consist of residential first mortgages and residential second mortgages. Our residential first mortgages are further stratified by product and borrower characteristics.

        Adverse economic developments or an overbuilt market impact commercial real estate projects and may result in troubled loans. Trends in vacancy rates of commercial properties impact the credit quality of these loans. High vacancy rates reduce operating revenues and the ability for the properties to produce sufficient cash flow to service debt obligations. The classes identified by the Company in the commercial real estate portfolio segment consist of retail, multifamily, offices, hotels, industrial, gas stations, and other.

        The commercial lines of credit portfolio is comprised of loans to businesses such as sole proprietorships, partnerships, limited liability companies and corporations for the daily operating needs of the business. The risk characteristics of these loans vary based on the borrowers' business and industry as repayment is typically dependent on cash flows generated from the underlying business. These loans may be secured or unsecured. The classes identified by the Company in the commercial lines of credit portfolio segment consist of private banking loans and commercial & industrial ("C&I") lending.

        The construction loan portfolio is comprised of loans to builders and developers primarily for residential, commercial and mixed-use development. In addition to general commercial real estate risks, construction loans have additional risk of cost overruns, market deterioration during construction, lack of permanent financing and no operating history.

        The consumer loan portfolio is usually comprised of a large number of small loans, including automobile, marine, personal loans, credit cards, etc. Most loans are made directly for consumer purchases. Economic trends determined by unemployment rates and other key economic indicators are closely correlated to the credit quality of these loans. Weak economic trends indicate the borrowers' capacity to repay their obligations may be deteriorating. The Company has not identified any classes within the consumer portfolio segment.

Securities

        Securities generally must be classified as held to maturity, available for sale or trading. Held-to-maturity securities are principally debt securities that we have both the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity. Other securities, such as required investments in Federal Home Loan Bank stock are carried at cost. Trading securities are held primarily for sale in the near term to generate income. Securities that do not meet the definition of trading or held to maturity are classified as available for sale.

        The classification of investment securities is significant since it directly impacts the accounting for unrealized gains and losses on these securities. Unrealized gains and losses on trading securities flow directly through earnings during the periods in which they arise. Trading and available-for-sale securities are measured at fair value each reporting period. Unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities are recorded as a separate component of shareholders' equity (accumulated other comprehensive income or loss) and do not affect earnings until realized or deemed to be other-than-temporary impairment, or OTTI. Investment securities that are classified as held to maturity are recorded at amortized cost, unless deemed to be OTTI.

        The fair value of securities is a critical accounting estimate. Changes in the fair value estimates that are likely to occur from period to period, or the use of different estimates that we could have reasonably used in the current period, could have a material impact on our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

56


Table of Contents

Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition

        The following sets forth a discussion and analysis of our financial condition as of the dates presented below.

        Loan Portfolio Composition.    The following table sets forth the composition of our loan portfolio by type of loan at the dates indicated.

 
  At June 30,   At December 31,  
 
  2017   2016   2015  
 
  Amount   %   Amount   %   Amount   %  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Real Estate:

                                     

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 1,776,353     80 % $ 1,617,087     81 % $ 1,282,321     81 %

Commercial real estate

    220,779     10 %   201,394     10 %   193,637     12 %

Construction

    188,751     8 %   146,600     7 %   74,573     5 %

Total real estate

    2,185,883     98 %   1,965,081     98 %   1,550,531     98 %

Commercial

    40,359     2 %   36,793     2 %   38,377     2 %

Consumer

    62     0 %   63     0 %   90     0 %

Total loans

    2,226,304     100 %   2,001,937     100 %   1,588,998     100 %

Allowance for loan losses

    (16,246 )         (14,822 )         (10,984 )      

Deferred loan costs, net

    (4,528 )         (4,676 )         (2,212 )      

Loans, net

  $ 2,205,530         $ 1,982,439         $ 1,575,802        

 

 
  At December 31,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  
 
  Amount   %   Amount   %   Amount   %  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Real Estate:

                                     

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 886,393     77 % $ 659,123     73 % $ 512,185     67 %

Commercial real estate

    185,267     16 %   180,736     20 %   204,960     27 %

Construction

    44,695     4 %   45,066     5 %   39,006     5 %

Total real estate

    1,116,355     97 %   884,925     98 %   756,151     99 %

Commercial

    32,354     3 %   15,786     2 %   10,783     1 %

Consumer

    146     0 %   213     0 %   271     0 %

Total loans

    1,148,855     100 %   900,924     100 %   767,205     100 %

Allowance for loan losses

    (10,015 )         (10,151 )         (9,875 )      

Deferred loan costs, net

    (2,762 )         (2,407 )         (2,234 )      

Loans, net

  $ 1,136,078         $ 888,366         $ 755,096        

        Loan Maturity.    The following table sets forth certain information at December 31, 2016 regarding the contractual maturity of our loan portfolio. Demand loans, loans having no stated repayment schedule or maturity, and overdraft loans are reported as being due in one year or less. The table does

57


Table of Contents

not include any estimate of prepayments that could significantly shorten the average life of all loans and may cause our actual repayment experience to differ from that shown below.

December 31, 2016
  1 - 4
Family
Residential
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Construction   Commercial   Consumer   Total  
 
  (in thousands)
 

Amounts due in:

                                     

One year or less

  $ 7,650   $ 22,497   $ 124,707   $ 29,968   $ 47   $ 184,869  

More than one to five years

    12,637     31,986     21,893     5,400     16     71,932  

More than five to ten years

    5,699     146,911         1,271         153,881  

More than ten years

    1,591,101             154         1,591,255  

Total

  $ 1,617,087   $ 201,394   $ 146,600   $ 36,793   $ 63   $ 2,001,937  

        The following table sets forth fixed and adjustable-rate loans at December 31, 2016 that are contractually due after December 31, 2017.

 
  Due After December 31, 2017  
 
  Fixed   Adjustable   Total  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Real Estate:

                   

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 9,086   $ 1,600,351   $ 1,609,437  

Commercial Real Estate

    11,454     167,443     178,897  

Construction

        21,893     21,893  

Commercial

    1,920     4,905     6,825  

Consumer

    16         16  

Total

  $ 22,476   $ 1,794,592   $ 1,817,068  

        The loan maturity dates set forth above include primarily adjustable rate loans. The table set forth below contains certain information with respect to the repricing dates included within our loan portfolio as of June 30, 2017:

June 30, 2017
  1 - 4
Family
Residential
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Construction   Commercial   Consumer   Total  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Amounts to adjust in:

                                     

Six months or less

  $ 253,976   $ 25,871   $ 188,751   $ 39,176   $   $ 507,774  

More than 6 months thru 12 months

    357,573     7,260                 364,833  

More than 12 months thru 24 months

    303,325     22,713                 326,038  

More than 24 months thru 36 months

    305,179     33,353                 338,532  

More than 36 months thru 60 months

    423,836     99,371                 523,207  

More than 60 months

    117,413     3,550                 120,963  

Fixed to Maturity

    15,051     28,661         1,183     62     44,957  

Total

  $ 1,776,353   $ 220,779   $ 188,751   $ 40,359   $ 62   $ 2,226,304  

58


Table of Contents

        At June 30, 2017, $157 million, or 7.2%, of our adjustable interest rate loans were at their interest rate floor.

        Delinquent Loans.    The following tables set forth our loan delinquencies, including nonaccrual loans, by type and amount at the dates indicated.

 
  June 30, 2017   December 31, 2016   December 31, 2015  
 
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
 
 
  (In thousands)
 

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 492   $ 6   $ 568   $ 416   $ 398   $ 427   $ 163   $   $ 648  

Commercial Real Estate

            97             138             501  

Construction

    1,524                                 18  

Commercial

                    227                  

Consumer

                                     

Total delinquent loans

  $ 2,016   $ 6   $ 665   $ 416   $ 625   $ 565   $ 163   $   $ 1,167  

 

 
  December 31, 2014   December 31, 2013   December 31, 2012  
 
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  90 Days
or More
Past Due
 
 
  (In thousands)
 

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 280   $ 41   $ 476   $ 383   $ 130   $ 631   $ 381   $ 319   $ 1,204  

Commercial Real Estate

            1,035     789         1,242         1,232     3,274  

Construction

            132             155     4,866         2,119  

Commercial

                            151          

Consumer

                75             81     2     33  

Total delinquent loans

  $ 280   $ 41   $ 1,643   $ 1,247   $ 130   $ 2,028   $ 5,479   $ 1,553   $ 6,630  

Nonperforming Assets.

        Nonperforming assets include loans that are 90 or more days past due or on nonaccrual status, including troubled debt restructurings and real estate and other loan collateral acquired through foreclosure and repossession. Troubled debt restructurings include loans for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower's financial difficulties, for which we grant a concession to the borrower that we would not consider otherwise. Loans 90 days or greater past due may remain on an accrual basis if adequately collateralized and in the process of collection. At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, we had $105 thousand and $155 thousand, respectively of accruing loans past due 90 days, which consisted primarily of government guaranteed and one troubled debt restructuring in nonaccrual with a balance of $89 thousand and $99 thousand, respectively. For nonaccrual loans, interest previously accrued but not collected is reversed and charged against income at the time a loan is placed on nonaccrual status. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

        Real estate that we acquire as a result of foreclosure or by deed-in-lieu of foreclosure is classified as other real estate owned until it is sold. When property is acquired, it is initially recorded at the fair value less costs to sell at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis. Holding costs and declines in fair value after acquisition of the property result in charges against income.

59


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth information regarding our nonperforming assets at the dates indicated.

 
  At June 30,   At December 31,  
 
  2017   2016   2015   2014   2013   2012  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Nonaccrual loans:

                                     

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 463   $ 272   $ 512   $ 153   $ 260   $ 652  

Commercial Real Estate

    97     138     501     1,035     1,242     3,274  

Construction

                132     155     2,119  

Commercial

            18              

Consumer

                        33  

Total nonaccrual loans

  $ 560   $ 410   $ 1,031   $ 1,320   $ 1,657   $ 6,078  

Other real estate owned

            1,280     6     226     2,977  

Loans past due 90 days and still accruing

    105     155     136     323     371     552  

Troubled debt restructurings

    3,128     3,134     4,782     4,859     7,043     6,065  

Total nonperforming assets

  $ 3,793   $ 3,699   $ 7,229   $ 6,508   $ 9,297   $ 15,672  

Total loans

  $ 2,226,304   $ 2,001,937   $ 1,588,998   $ 1,148,855   $ 900,924   $ 767,205  

Total assets

  $ 2,416,171   $ 2,163,601   $ 1,712,008   $ 1,241,963   $ 983,982   $ 862,997  

Total nonaccrual loans to total loans

    0.03 %   0.02 %   0.06 %   0.11 %   0.18 %   0.79 %

Total nonperforming assets to total assets

    0.16 %   0.17 %   0.42 %   0.52 %   0.95 %   1.82 %

(1)
Loans are presented before the allowance for loan losses and exclude deferred fees/costs.

Allowance for Loan Losses.

        Please see "—Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates—Allowance for Loan Losses" for additional discussion of our allowance policy.

        The allowance for loan losses is maintained at levels considered adequate by management to provide for probable loan losses inherent in the loan portfolio as of the consolidated balance sheet reporting dates. The allowance for loan losses is based on management's assessment of various factors affecting the loan portfolio, including portfolio composition, delinquent and nonaccrual loans, national and local business conditions and loss experience and an overall evaluation of the quality of the underlying collateral.

60


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth activity in our allowance for loan losses for the periods indicated.

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2017   2016   2016   2015   2014   2013   2012  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Allowance at beginning of period

  $ 14,822   $ 10,984   $ 10,984   $ 10,015   $ 10,151   $ 9,875   $ 11,966  

Provision for loan losses

    1,200     (917 )   1,280     525     (1,400 )   (700 )   7,170  

Charge offs:

                                           

1-4 family residential

  $   $ (19 ) $ (24 ) $ (90 ) $ (184 ) $ (274 ) $ (1,054 )

Commercial Real Estate

                (86 )       (107 )   (8,089 )

Construction

                        (50 )   (1,400 )

Commercial

                             

Consumer

                        (2 )   (11 )

Total charge offs

        (19 )   (24 )   (176 )   (184 )   (433 )   (10,554 )

Recoveries:

                                           

1-4 family residential

  $ 39   $ 14   $ 117   $ 61   $ 61   $ 122   $ 110  

Commercial Real Estate

    80     1,839     2,153     423     1,049     407     888  

Construction

    104     253     310     84     198     800     69  

Commercial

                50     100     53     182  

Consumer

    1         2     2     40     27     44  

Total recoveries

    224     2,106     2,582     620     1,448     1,409     1,293  

Allowance at end of period

  $ 16,246   $ 12,154   $ 14,822   $ 10,984   $ 10,015   $ 10,151   $ 9,875  

Nonperforming loans and TDRs at end of period

  $ 3,793   $ 3,772   $ 3,699   $ 5,949   $ 6,502   $ 9,071   $ 12,603  

Total loans outstanding at end of period

  $ 2,226,304   $ 1,816,180   $ 2,001,937   $ 1,588,998   $ 1,148,855   $ 900,924   $ 767,205  

Average loans outstanding during period

  $ 2,073,748   $ 1,654,708   $ 1,783,234   $ 1,316,608   $ 1,021,080   $ 833,303   $ 693,936  

Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans and TDRs

    428 %   322 %   401 %   185 %   154 %   112 %   78 %

Allowance for loan losses to total loans at end of period

    0.73 %   0.67 %   0.74 %   0.69 %   0.87 %   1.13 %   1.29 %

Net charge offs to average loans outstanding during the period

    (0.01 )%   (0.13 )%   (0.14 )%   (0.03 )%   (0.12 )%   (0.12 )%   1.33 %

        Allocation of Allowance for Loan Losses.    The following tables set forth the allowance for loan losses allocated by loan category. The allowance for loan losses allocated to each category is not

61


Table of Contents

necessarily indicative of future losses in any particular category and does not restrict the use of the allowance to absorb losses in other categories.

 
   
   
  At December 31,  
 
  At June 30, 2017   2016   2015  
 
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 12,472     79.8 % $ 11,863     80.8 % $ 8,192     80.7 %

Commercial Real Estate

    1,247     9.9 %   915     10.1 %   1,530     12.2 %

Construction

    1,168     8.5 %   679     7.3 %   317     4.7 %

Commercial

    385     1.8 %   373     1.8 %   392     2.4 %

Consumer

    2     0.00 %   2     0.0 %   2     0.0 %

Unallocated

    972         990         551      

Total

  $ 16,246     100.00 % $ 14,822     100.0 % $ 10,984     100.0 %

 

 
  At December 31,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  
 
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
  Allowance
for Loan
Losses
  Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category to
Total Loans
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

1 - 4 family residential

  $ 4,350     77.2 % $ 3,502     73.2 % $ 2,743     66.8 %

Commercial Real Estate

    4,682     16.1 %   5,019     20.0 %   5,081     26.7 %

Construction

    203     3.9 %   453     5.0 %   756     5.1 %

Commercial

    235     2.8 %   599     1.8 %   296     1.4 %

Consumer

    4     0.0 %   5     0.0 %   7     0.0 %

Unallocated

    541         573         992      

Total

  $ 10,015     100.0 % $ 10,151     100.00 % $ 9,875     100.00 %

        The allowance for loan losses as a percentage of loans was 0.73%, 0.74% and 0.69% as of June 30, 2017, December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The decrease in the allowance percentage from December 31, 2016 to June 30, 2017 was primarily due to change in risk profile associated with the seasoning of loans originated in the greater Los Angeles market.

        The allowance consists of general and allocated components. The general component relates to pools of non-impaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. The allocated component relates to loans that are classified as impaired, whereby an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows, collateral value or observable market price of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan.

        A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that we will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Factors considered by us in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. We determine the significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower's prior payment record, and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed. The measurement of an impaired loan is based on (i) the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan's effective interest rate, (ii) the loan's observable market price or (iii) the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.

62


Table of Contents

        At June 30, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, we had impaired loans of $3.3 million, $3.4 million and $7.5 million, respectively.

        Commercial real estate, and construction loans, and commercial lines of credit are individually evaluated for impairment. Larger groups of smaller balance homogeneous loans, such as residential real estate and consumer, are collectively evaluated for impairment.

        Troubled debt restructurings are included in the impairment disclosures and are measured at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan's effective rate at inception. If a troubled debt restructuring is considered to be a collateral dependent loan, the loan is reported, net, at the fair value of the collateral. For troubled debt restructurings that subsequently default, we determine the amount of reserve in accordance with the accounting policy for the allowance for loan losses.

        Interest income on mortgage and commercial loans is discontinued at the time the loan is 90 days delinquent unless the loan is well-secured and in process of collection. Consumer loans are typically charged off no later than 120 days past due. Past due status is based on the contractual terms of the loan. In all cases, loans are placed on nonaccrual or charged-off at an earlier date if collection of principal or interest is considered doubtful. Nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days still on accrual include both smaller balance homogeneous loans that are collectively evaluated for impairment and individually classified impaired loans. A loan is moved to nonaccrual status in accordance with our loan policy, typically after 90 days of non-payment.

        All interest accrued but not received for loans placed on nonaccrual is reversed against interest income. Interest received on such loans is accounted for on the cash-basis or cost-recovery method, until qualifying for return to accrual. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

        Although we believe that we use the best information available to establish the allowance for loan losses, future adjustments to the allowance for loan losses may be necessary and our results of operations could be adversely affected if circumstances differ substantially from the assumptions used in making the determinations. Furthermore, while we believe we have established our allowance for loan losses in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America, there can be no assurance that regulators, in reviewing our loan portfolio, will not require us to increase our allowance for loan losses. In addition, because future events affecting borrowers and collateral cannot be predicted with certainty, there can be no assurance that the existing allowance for loan losses is adequate or that increases will not be necessary should the quality of any loans deteriorate as a result of the factors discussed above. Any material increase in the allowance for loan losses may adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

63


Table of Contents

Securities Portfolio

        The following table sets forth the amortized cost and estimated fair value of our available-for-sale securities portfolio at the dates indicated. Our securities portfolio has increased in recent years in conjunction with overall asset growth.

 
   
   
  At December 31,  
 
  At June 30, 2017   2016   2015   2014  
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

U.S. Treasuries

  $ 82,111   $ 82,021   $ 70,072   $ 70,040   $ 40,039   $ 40,014   $ 25,057   $ 25,048  

Agency mortgage-backed securities

    14,300     14,211                          

Non-Agency collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,099     2,152     2,411     2,462     2,970     3,048     3,758     3,927  

Collateralized debt obligations

    608     589     610     585     2,104     1,064     2,104     1,029  

Equity securities

    528     528     529     529     530     530     521     521  

Other securities

    3,045     3,000     2,045     1,990     2,045     2,022     2,045     2,034  

Total

  $ 102,691   $ 102,501   $ 75,667   $ 75,606   $ 47,688   $ 46,678   $ 33,485   $ 32,559  

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, we had no investments in a single company or entity, other than government and government agency securities, that had an aggregate book value in excess of 10% of our equity.

        We review the investment portfolio on a quarterly basis to determine the cause, magnitude and duration of declines in the fair value of each security. In estimating other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI), we consider many factors including: (1) the length of time and extent that fair value has been less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near term prospects of the issuer, (3) whether the market decline was affected by macroeconomic conditions, and (4) whether we have the intent to sell the security or more likely than not will be required to sell the security before its anticipated recovery. If either of the criteria regarding intent or requirement to sell is met, the entire difference between amortized cost and fair value is recognized as impairment through earnings. For debt securities that do not meet the aforementioned criteria, the amount of impairment is split into two components as follows: (1) OTTI related to credit loss, which must be recognized in the income statement and (2) OTTI related to other factors, which is recognized in other comprehensive income. The credit loss is defined as the difference between the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected and the amortized cost basis. The assessment of whether any other than temporary decline exists may involve a high degree of subjectivity and judgment and is based on the information available to management at a point in time. We evaluate securities for OTTI at least on a quarterly basis, and more frequently when economic or market conditions warrant such an evaluation.

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, securities in unrealized loss positions included in 2017, issuances from government sponsored entities, and, during both periods, U.S. Treasury securities, a Trust Preferred CDO, and a mutual fund. Due to the decline in fair value attributable to changes in interest rates and illiquidity, not credit quality, and because we do not have the intent to sell the securities and it is likely that we will not be required to sell the securities before their anticipated recovery, we do not consider the securities to be other-than-temporarily impaired at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016.

        No securities related impairment charges were recorded for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 or for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

64


Table of Contents

        Portfolio Maturities and Yields.    The composition and maturities of the investment securities portfolio at June 30, 2017, are summarized in the following table.

 
  At June 30, 2017(1)  
 
  One Year or
Less
  More Than
One Year
Through
Five Years
  More Than
Five Years
Through
Ten Years
  More Than Ten
Years
  Total  
 
  Book
Value
  WTD
AVG
Yield
  Book
Value
  WTD
AVG
Yield
  Book
Value
  WTD
AVG
Yield
  Book
Value
  WTD
AVG
Yield
  Book
Value
  WTD
AVG
Yield
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

U.S. Treasuries

  $ 82,111     0.95 % $       $       $       $ 82,111     0.95 %

Agency mortgage-backed securities

                            14,300     3.60 %   14,300     3.60 %

Non-Agency collateralized mortgage obligations

                            2,099     4.92 %   2,099     4.92 %

Collateralized debt obligations

                            608     3.45 %   608     3.45 %

Total investment securities available for sale

  $ 82,111     0.95 % $       $       $ 17,007     3.76 % $ 99,118     1.43 %

(1)
This table does not include other securities and equity securities due to lack of stated maturity.

Deposits

        Total deposits increased $181 million, or 11.2%, to $1.80 billion at June 30, 2017 from $1.61 billion at December 31, 2016, primarily as a result of strong growth in our money market deposit product in the greater Los Angeles area. We continue to focus on the acquisition and expansion of core deposit relationships, which we define as all deposits except for certificates of deposits greater than $250,000. Core deposits totaled $1.70 billion at June 30, 2017, or 94.8% of total deposits at that date.

        Total deposits increased $385.4 million, or 31.3%, to $1.61 billion at December 31, 2016 from $1.23 billion at December 31, 2015, primarily as the result of the growth in the Los Angeles market and the competitive money market rates. We continue to focus on the acquisition and expansion of core deposit relationships. Core deposits totaled $1.46 billion at December 31, 2016, or 90.6% of total deposits at that date.

        The following tables set forth the distribution of average deposits by account type at the dates indicated.

 
  For the Six Months Ended
June 30,
  For the Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2017   2016   2015  
 
  Avg
Balance
  Percent   Avg
Rate
  Avg
Balance
  Percent   Avg
Rate
  Avg
Balance
  Percent   Avg
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Demand

  $ 60,442     3.5 %   0.00 % $ 54,026     3.8 %   0.00 % $ 35,262     3.3 %   0.00 %

Savings, NOW and Money Market

    1,252,327     73.0 %   0.84 %   946,528     66.6 %   0.78 %   688,294     64.7 %   0.55 %

Time

    403,332     23.5 %   1.04 %   421,228     29.6 %   0.95 %   340,614     32.0 %   0.80 %

Total deposits

  $ 1,716,101     100.0 %   0.86 % $ 1,421,782     100.0 %   0.80 % $ 1,064,170     100.0 %   0.61 %

65


Table of Contents

        As of June 30, 2017, the aggregate amount of all our certificates of deposit in amounts greater than or equal to $100,000 was approximately $223.8 million. The following table sets forth the maturity of these certificates as of June 30, 2017:

 
  June 30, 2017  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Maturing Period:

       

Three months or less

  $ 67,561  

Over three months through six months

    36,990  

Over six months through twelve months

    58,545  

Over twelve months

    60,697  

Total certificates of deposit

  $ 223,793  

Borrowings

        At June 30, 2017, we had the ability to borrow a total of $642 million from Federal Home Loan Bank, including an available line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank of $50 million. At June 30, 2017, we also had available credit lines with three additional banks for $35 million. Outstanding borrowings on June 30, 2017 with the FHLB totaled $359 million, and there were no amounts outstanding with the aforementioned additional bank lines. In addition, between April and September 2016, we sold $50 million in aggregate principal amount of our Fixed to Floating Subordinated Notes due April 15, 2016 (the "Subordinated Notes"), and an additional $15 million in August 2017, of which $50 million and $65 million remained outstanding as of June 30, 2017 and August 31, 2017, respectively.

        At December 31, 2016, we had the ability to borrow a total of $626 million from Federal Home Loan Bank including an available line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank of $50 million. At December 31, 2016, we also had available credit lines with three additional banks for $35 million. Outstanding borrowings on December 31, 2016 with the FHLB totaled $308 million, and there were no amounts outstanding with the aforementioned additional bank lines. At December 31, 2016, $50 million in principal amount remained outstanding under the Subordinated Notes.

        At December 31, 2015, we had the ability to borrow a total of $567 million from Federal Home Loan Bank including an available line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank of $50 million. At December 31, 2015, we also had available credit lines with three additional banks for $35 million. Outstanding borrowings on December 31, 2015 with the FHLB totaled $326 million, and there were no amounts outstanding with the aforementioned additional bank lines.

        In addition to deposits, we use short-term borrowings, such as FHLB advances and a FHLB overdraft credit line, as a source of funds to meet the daily liquidity needs of our customers and fund growth in earning assets. Our short-term FHLB advances consists primarily of advances of funds for

66


Table of Contents

one-to-two-week period. The following table sets forth information on our short-term FHLB borrowings during the periods presented:

 
  As of and
for the Six
Months
Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2017   2016   2015   2014  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Outstanding at period-end

  $ 154,312   $ 103,198   $ 261,437   $ 48,085  

Average amount outstanding

    65,431     190,502     141,471     53,110  

Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end

    154,312     257,343     261,437     104,892  

Weighted average interest rate:

                         

During period

    0.98%     0.52%     0.40%     0.37%  

End of period

    1.23%     0.78%     0.53%     0.39%  

Shareholders' Equity

        Total shareholders' equity increased $12.0 million, or 7.4% to $174.3 million at June 30, 2017, from $162.3 million at December 31, 2016. The increase for the six months ended June 30, 2017 was primarily due to an increase in retained earnings.

        Total shareholders' equity increased approximately $26.0 million, or 19.1%, to $162.3 million at December 31, 2016, from $136.3 million at December 31, 2015. The increase for the year ended December 31, 2016 was also primarily a result of an increase in retained earnings.

Average Balance Sheet and Related Yields and Rates

        The following tables present average balance sheet information, interest income, interest expense and the corresponding average yields earned and rates paid for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 and for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. The average balances are daily averages and, for loans, include both performing and nonperforming balances. Interest income on loans

67


Table of Contents

includes the effects of discount accretion and net deferred loan origination costs accounted for as yield adjustments.

 
  Six Months Ended June 30,  
 
  2017   2016  
 
  Average
Balance
  Interest   Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Balance
  Interest   Average
Yield/
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Interest Earning Assets

                                     

Loans

  $ 2,073,748   $ 54,881     5.29 % $ 1,654,708   $ 40,663     4.91 %

Securities, includes restricted stock

    103,914     804     1.55 %   70,691     566     1.60 %

Other interest earning assets

    9,597     45     0.94 %   3,679     16     0.87 %

Total interest earning assets

    2,187,259   $ 55,730     5.10 %   1,729,078   $ 41,245     4.77 %

Noninterest earning assets

                                     

Cash and due from banks

    8,918                 7,570              

Other assets

    45,669                 42,063              

Total average assets

  $ 2,241,846               $ 1,778,711              

Interest-bearing liabilities

                                     

Savings, NOW, Money Markets

  $ 1,252,327   $ 5,223     0.84 % $ 864,142   $ 3,272     0.76 %

Time deposits

    403,332     2,088     1.04 %   399,928     1,840     0.93 %

Total deposits

    1,655,659     7,311     0.89 %   1,264,070     5,112     0.81 %

FHLB borrowings

    270,431     1,700     1.26 %   281,667     1,032     0.74 %

Subordinated notes

    49,366     1,816     7.36 %   11,997     426     7.10 %

Total borrowings

    319,797     3,516     2.17 %   293,664     1,458     0.99 %

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    1,975,457   $ 10,827     1.10 %   1,557,734   $ 6,570     0.85 %

Noninterest-bearing liabilities

                                     

Demand deposits

    60,442                 51,566              

Other liabiliites

    35,404                 25,138              

Total noninterest-bearing liabilities

    95,846                 76,704              

Shareholders' equity

    170,543                 144,273              

Total average liabilities and equity

  $ 2,241,846               $ 1,778,711              

Net interest income and spread

        $ 44,903     4.00 %       $ 34,675     3.92 %

Net interest margin

                4.11 %               4.01 %

(1)
Nonaccrual loans are included in the respective average loan balances. Income, if any, on such loans is recognized on a cash basis.

(2)
Interest income does not include taxable equivalent adjustments.

68


Table of Contents

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2016   2015   2014  
 
  Average
Balance
  Interest   Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Balance
  Interest   Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Balance
  Interest   Average
Yield/
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
   
   
   
 

Interest Earning Assets

                                                       

Loans

  $ 1,783,234   $ 89,566     5.02 % $ 1,316,608   $ 65,111     4.95 % $ 1,021,080   $ 51,302     5.02 %

Securities, includes restricted stock

    78,043     1,215     1.56 %   53,596     839     1.57 %   38,941     706     1.81 %

Other interest earning assets

    5,802     22     0.38 %   3,622     (2 )   0.00 %   5,191     4     0.08 %

Total interest earning assets

    1,867,079   $ 90,803     4.86 %   1,373,826   $ 65,950     4.80 %   1,065,212   $ 52,012     4.88 %

Noninterest earning assets

                                                       

Cash and due from banks

    7,822                 6,454                 5,137              

Other assets

    42,749                 39,902                 38,859              

Total average assets

  $ 1,917,650               $ 1,420,182               $ 1,109,208              

Interest-bearing liabilities

                                                       

Savings, NOW, Money Markets

  $ 946,528   $ 7,417     0.78 % $ 688,294   $ 3,800     0.55 % $ 654,044   $ 3,353     0.51 %

Time deposits

    421,228     4,011     0.95 %   340,614     2,726     0.80 %   207,000     1,630     0.79 %

Total deposits

    1,367,756     11,428     0.84 %   1,028,908     6,526     0.63 %   861,044     4,983     0.58 %

FHLB borrowings

    290,096     2,439     0.84 %   205,914     1,539     0.75 %   91,786     928     1.01 %

Subordinated notes

    27,185     1,978     7.28 %   863     43     5.00 %              

Total borrowings

    317,281     4,417     1.39 %   206,777     1,582     0.77 %   91,786     928     1.01 %

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    1,685,037   $ 15,845     0.94 %   1,235,685   $ 8,108     0.66 %   952,830   $ 5,911     0.62 %

Noninterest-bearing liabilities

                                                       

Demand deposits

    54,026                 35,262                 24,364              

Other liabiliites

    27,921                 17,496                 14,139              

Total noninterest-bearing liabilities

    81,947                 52,758                 38,503              

Shareholders' equity

    150,666                 131,739                 117,875              

Total average liabilities and equity

  $ 1,917,650               $ 1,420,182               $ 1,109,208              

Net interest income and spread

        $ 74,958     3.92 %       $ 57,842     4.14 %       $ 46,101     4.26 %

Net interest margin

                4.01 %               4.21 %               4.33 %

(1)
Nonaccrual loans are included in the respective average loan balances. Income, if any, on such loans is recognized on a cash basis.

(2)
Interest income does not include taxable equivalent adjustments.

        The following table presents the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for major components of interest earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities for the periods indicated. The table distinguishes between: (1) changes attributable to volume (changes in volume multiplied by the prior period's rate), (2) changes attributable to rate (change in rate multiplied by the prior year's

69


Table of Contents

volume) and (3) total increase (decrease) (the sum of the previous columns). Changes attributable to both volume and rate are allocated ratably between the volume and rate categories.

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30, 2017 vs 2016
  Year Ended
December 31, 2016 vs 2015
  Year Ended
December 31, 2015 vs 2014
 
 
  Increase
(Decrease)
due to
   
  Increase
(Decrease)
due to
   
  Increase
(Decrease)
due to
   
 
 
  Total
Increase
(Decrease)
  Total
Increase
(Decrease)
  Total
Increase
(Decrease)
 
 
  Volume   Rate   Volume   Rate   Volume   Rate  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Interest earned on:

                                                       

Loans

  $ 10,905   $ 3,313   $ 14,218   $ 23,422   $ 1,033   $ 24,455   $ 14,602   $ (793 ) $ 13,809  

Securities, includes restricted stock

    254     (33 )   221     380     (6 )   374     210     (75 )   135  

Interest earning cash

    (1 )   47     46     (1 )   25     24     (1 )   (5 )   (6 )

Total interest income

    11,158     3,327     14,485     23,801     1,052     24,853     14,811     (873 )   13,938  

Interest paid on:

                                                       

Saving/Now/Money Markets

    1,584     367     1,951     1,708     1,909     3,617     181     266     447  

Time deposits

    15     233     248     713     572     1,285     1,069     27     1,096  

Total deposits

    1,599     600     2,199     2,421     2,481     4,902     1,250     293     1,543  

FHLB borrowings and subordinated notes

    141     1,917     2,058     1,119     1,716     2,835     816     (162 )   654  

Total interest expense

    1,740     2,517     4,257     3,540     4,197     7,737     2,066     131     2,197  

Change in net interest income

  $ 9,418   $ 810   $ 10,228   $ 20,261   $ (3,145 ) $ 17,116   $ 12,745   $ (1,004 ) $ 11,741  

Results of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2017 and 2016

        General.    Net income increased $2.2 million, or 12.7%, to $19.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $17.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016. The increase resulted primarily from increased net interest income with average earning assets increasing $458 million, or 26.5% to 2.19 billion at June 30, 2017 from $1.73 billion at June 30, 2016. This increase was offset in part by increased operating expenses to support the balance sheet growth.

        Interest Income.    Interest income increased $14.5 million, or 35%, to $55.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $41.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016 primarily due to loans. The increase in interest income on loans was due to average outstanding loans increasing $419 million, or 25.3% to $2.07 billion for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $1.66 billion for the six months ended June 30, 2016. The average rate collected on loans increased 38 basis points, or 7.7%, to 5.29% for the six months ending June 30, 2017 from 4.91% for the six months ended June 30, 2016.

        Interest Expense.    Interest expense increased $4.3 million, or 64.8%, to $10.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $6.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016, primarily as a result of deposit growth and borrowings. The average rate we paid on interest-bearing deposits increased 8 basis points to 0.89% for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from 0.81% for the six months ended June 30, 2016. Our average balance of interest-bearing deposits increased $392 million, or 31.0%, to $1.66 billion for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $1.26 billion for the six months ended June 30, 2016. The average rate paid on borrowings increased 119 basis points to 2.17% for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from 0.98% for the six months ended June 30, 2016 primarily due to the addition of subordinated debt. Our average balance of borrowings increased $26 million, or 8.9%, to $320 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $294 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016.

        Net Interest Income.    Net interest income increased $10.2 million, or 29%, to $44.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from $34.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016. Our net

70


Table of Contents

interest rate spread increased 8 basis points to 4.00% for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from 3.92% for the six months ended June 30, 2016, while our net interest margin increased 10 basis points to 4.11% for the six months ended June 30, 2017 from 4.01% for the six months ended June 30, 2016. The average yield we earned on interest earning assets increased 33 basis points to 5.10% and the average rate we paid on interest-bearing liabilities increased by 25 basis points to 1.10%.

        Provision for Loan Losses.    Our provision for loan losses was $1.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 compared to $(0.9) million benefit for the six months ended June 30, 2016. The provisions recorded resulted in an allowance for loan losses of $16.2 million, or 0.73% of total loans at June 30, 2017, compared to $12.2 million, or 0.67% of total loans at June 30, 2016.

        Non-interest Income.    Non-interest income information is as follows:

 
  Six Months
Ended June 30,
  Change  
 
  2017   2016   Amount   Percent  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-interest income

                         

Service charges and fees

  $ 1,901   $ 967   $ 934     96.6 %

Gain on sale of other real estate owned, net

        32     (32 )   (100.0 )%

Gain on sale of investment securities

    73         73      

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    17     568     (551 )   (97.0 )%

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    4,419     5,096     (677 )   (13.3 )%

Income on cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    583     583         0.0 %

Investment management and advisory fees

    1,141     1,813     (672 )   (37.1 )%

Other income

    265     229     36     15.7 %

Total non-interest income

  $ 8,399   $ 9,288   $ (889 )   (9.6 )%

        Service charges and fees have increased primarily due to growth in loan originations as well as an increase in the mortgage loan servicing portfolio. Gain on portfolio loan sales declined as $120 million of portfolio loans were sold during the six months ended June 30, 2017, compared to $184 million for the six months ended June 30, 2016. Investment advisory fees declined due to the loss of a portion of the investment assets of a large institutional client of our investment management subsidiary. Gain on sale of mortgage loans declined due primarily to purchase and subsequent sale of CRA-qualifying loans at a loss during the six months ended June 30, 2017.

        Non-interest Expense.    Non-interest expense information is as follows:

 
  For the six months
ended June 30,
  Change  
 
  2017   2016   Amount   Percent  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-interest Expense

                         

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 10,687   $ 8,390   $ 2,297     27.4 %

Occupancy and equipment

    2,805     2,511     294     11.7 %

Advertising and marketing

    422     638     (216 )   (33.9 )%

Professional fees

    664     637     27     4.2 %

FDIC assessments

    506     440     66     15.0 %

Data processing

    486     489     (3 )   (0.6 )%

Other

    3,695     2,881     814     28.3 %

Total non-interest expense

  $ 19,265   $ 15,986   $ 3,279     20.5 %

71


Table of Contents

        Salaries and employee benefits increased primarily as a result of the addition of 66 full-time equivalent employees to support balance sheet and overall growth, which employee count increased to 268 at June 30, 2017 from 202 at June 30, 2016. The significant increase in employees may cause a corresponding increase in our efficiency ratio in the near term.

        Income Tax Expense.    We recorded an income tax expense of $13.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017, reflecting an effective tax rate of 41.1%, compared to $11.7 million, or 40.6%, for the six months ended June 30, 2016.

Results of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2016 and 2015

        General.    Net income increased $10.7 million or 47.6%, to $33.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $22.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2015. The increase resulted from a $17.1 million increase in net interest income and a $7.4 million increase in non-interest income, which were partially offset by a $5.1 million increase in non-interest expense.

        Interest and Dividend Income.    Interest and dividend income increased $24.9 million, or 37.7%, to $90.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $66.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2015. The increase was driven by an increase in interest and fees on loans, which increased $24.5 million, or 37.6%, to $89.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $65.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.

        The increase in interest income on loans was due to an increase in average balance of loans of $467 million, or 35.4%, to $1.78 billion for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $1.32 billion for the year ended December 31, 2015. This increase was due to our continued focus on growing residential loans, construction loans and commercial real estate loans.

        Interest Expense.    Interest expense increased $7.7 million, or 95.4%, to $15.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $8.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2015, caused by both rate and volume increases. The average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities also increased 28 basis points to 0.94% for the year ended December 31, 2016 from 0.66% for the year ended December 31, 2015. Our average balance of interest-bearing liabilities increased $449 million or 36.3% to $1.69 billion for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $1.24 billion for the year ended December 31, 2015.

        Net Interest Income.    Net interest income increased $17.1 million, or 29.6%, to $75.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 from $57.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2015. Our net interest rate spread decreased 22 basis points to 3.92% for the year ended December 31, 2016 from 4.14% for the year ended December 31, 2015, while our net interest margin decreased 20 basis points to 4.01% for the year ended December 31, 2016 from 4.21% for the year ended December 31, 2015. Although the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities increased by 28 basis point to 0.94%, the interest earned on interest earning assets also increased 6 basis points to 4.86%.

        Provision for Loan Losses.    Our provision for loan losses was $1.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to $0.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2015. Higher provision expense was warranted during 2016 in order to adequately provide for the loan growth. The provisions recorded resulted in an allowance for loan losses of $14.8 million, or 0.74% of total loans at December 31, 2016, compared to $11.0 million, or 0.69% of total loans at December 31, 2015.

72


Table of Contents

        Non-interest Income.    Non-interest income information is as follows:

 
  For the Year Ended
December 31,
  Change  
 
  2016   2015   Amount   Percent  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-interest income

                         

Service charges and fees

  $ 2,456   $ 1,336   $ 1,120     83.8 %

Gain on sale of other real estate owned, net

    31     102     (71 )   (69.6 )%

Investment securities losses, net

    (898 )       (898 )    

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    1,541     1,551     (10 )   (0.6 )%

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    8,016     658     7,358     1118.2 %

Income on cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    1,166     1,159     7     0.6 %

Investment management and advisory fees

    3,209     3,378     (169 )   (5.0 )%

Other income

    485     433     52     12.0 %

Total non-interest income

  $ 16,006   $ 8,617   $ 7,389     85.7 %

        Service charges and fees have increased due to growth in loan originations as well as growth in our mortgage servicing portfolio. Gain on sale of portfolio loans grew with the sale of $279 million of our Advantage loans during the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to sales of $23 million in the year ended December 31, 2015. The disposition of a nonperforming trust preferred security during 2016 resulted in a $0.9 million loss.

        Non-interest Expense.    Non-interest expense information is as follows:

 
  For the Year Ended
December 31,
  Change  
 
  2016   2015   Amount   Percent  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-interest Expense

                         

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 17,812   $ 15,772   $ 2,040     12.9 %

Occupancy and equipment

    4,891     4,430     461     10.4 %

Advertising and marketing

    1,449     773     676     87.5 %

Professional fees

    1,466     1,219     247     20.3 %

FDIC assessments

    990     725     265     36.6 %

Data processing

    986     876     110     12.6 %

Other

    5,641     4,341     1,300     29.9 %

Total non-interest expense

  $ 33,235   $ 28,136   $ 5,099     18.1 %

        Salaries and employee benefits increased for the year ended December 31, 2016 from the year ended December 31, 2015 primarily due to additional staffing to support balance sheet and income growth.

        Income Tax Expense.    We recorded income tax expense of $23.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, reflecting an effective tax rate of 41.1%, compared to $15.3 million, or 40.4%, for the year ended December 31, 2015.

Management of Market Risk

        General.    The principal objective of our asset and liability management function is to evaluate the interest rate risk within the balance sheet and pursue a controlled assumption of interest rate risk while maximizing net income and preserving adequate levels of liquidity and capital. The Asset Liability Committee of our board of directors has oversight of our asset and liability management function,

73


Table of Contents

which is implemented and managed by our Management Asset Liability Committee. Our Management Asset Liability Committee meets regularly to review, among other things, the sensitivity of our assets and liabilities to product offering rate changes, local and national market conditions and market interest rates. That group also reviews our liquidity, capital, deposit mix, loan mix and investment positions.

        We manage our exposure to interest rates primarily by structuring our balance sheet in the ordinary course of business. We do not typically enter into derivative contracts for the purpose of managing interest rate risk, but we may do so in the future. Based upon the nature of our operations, we are not subject to foreign exchange or commodity price risk. We do not own any trading assets.

        Net Interest Income Simulation.    We use an interest rate risk simulation model to test the interest rate sensitivity of net interest income and the balance sheet. Instantaneous parallel rate shift scenarios are modeled and utilized to evaluate risk and establish exposure limits for acceptable changes in net interest income. These scenarios, known as rate shocks, simulate an instantaneous change in interest rates and use various assumptions, including, but not limited to, prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment and replacement of asset and liability cash flows.

        The following table presents the estimated changes in net interest income of Sterling Bank, calculated on a bank-only basis, which would result from changes in market interest rates over twelve-month periods beginning December 31, 2016 and 2015. The tables below demonstrate that for the initial twelve-month period after an immediate and parallel rate shock we are liability sensitive in a rising interest rate environment.

 
  At December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  
Change in
Interest Rates
(Basis Points)
  Estimated
12-Months
Net Interest Income
  Change   Estimated
12-Months
Net Interest Income
  Change  
(Dollars in thousands)
 
  400     61,090     (30.8 )%   39,102     (40.7 )%
  300     69,258     (21.6 )%   46,687     (29.3 )%
  200     76,488     (13.4 )%   53,926     (18.5 )%
  100     82,975     (6.0 )%   60,483     (8.8 )%
  0     88,288           66,426        
  –100     89,470     1.3 %   66,626     0.3 %

        Our net interest income interest rate sensitivity is affected by the time periods in which our adjustable rate loans reprice. Our adjustable loans reprice in an average of two years with 94% repricing within the next five years.

        Economic Value of Equity Simulation.    We also analyze our sensitivity to changes in interest rates through an economic value of equity ("EVE") model. EVE represents the present value of the expected cash flows from our assets less the present value of the expected cash flows arising from our liabilities adjusted for the value of off-balance sheet contracts. EVE attempts to quantify our economic value using a discounted cash flow methodology. We estimate what our EVE would be as of a specific date. We then calculate what EVE would be as of the same date throughout a series of interest rate scenarios representing immediate and permanent, parallel shifts in the yield curve. We currently calculate EVE under the assumptions that interest rates increase 100, 200, 300 and 400 basis points from current market rates, and under the assumption that interest rates decrease 100 basis points from current market rates.

74


Table of Contents

        The following table presents the estimated changes in EVE of Sterling Bank, calculated on a bank-only basis, that would result from changes in market interest rates as of December 31, 2016 and 2015.

 
  At December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  
Change in
Interest Rates
(Basis Points)
  Economic
Value of Equity
  Change   Economic
Value of Equity
  Change  
(Dollars in thousands)
 
  400     244,257     (23.0 )%   103,541     (48.4 )%
  300     275,902     (13.0 )%   134,685     (32.9 )%
  200     298,374     (5.9 )%   161,210     (19.7 )%
  100     312,805     (1.3 )%   182,752     (8.9 )%
  0     317,078           200,660        
  –100     290,471     (8.4 )%   189,924     (5.4 )%

        Many assumptions are used to calculate the impact of interest rate fluctuations. Actual results may be significantly different than our projections due to several factors, including the timing and frequency of rate changes, market conditions and the shape of the yield curve. The computations of interest rate risk shown above do not include actions that our management may undertake to manage the risks in response to anticipated changes in interest rates, and actual results may also differ due to any actions taken in response to the changing rates.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

        Liquidity is the ability to meet current and future financial obligations when they come due. Our primary sources of funds consist of deposit inflows, loan repayments and FHLB borrowings. While maturities and scheduled amortization of loans and securities are predictable sources of funds, deposit flows and mortgage prepayments are greatly influenced by general interest rates, economic conditions and competition.

        We regularly review the need to adjust our investments in liquid assets based upon our assessment of: (1) expected loan demand, (2) expected deposit flows, (3) yields available on interest earning deposits and securities, and (4) the objectives of our asset/liability management program. Excess liquid assets are invested generally in interest earning deposits and short-term securities.

        Our most liquid assets are cash and due from banks and U.S. Treasury and Agency securities classified as available for sale. The levels of these assets are dependent on our operating, financing, lending and investing activities during any given period. At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, cash and due from banks totaled $26.0 million and $22.1 million, respectively. Securities classified as available-for-sale, which provide additional sources of liquidity, totaled $102.5 million at June 30, 2017 and $75.6 million at December 31, 2016.

        At June 30, 2017, we had the ability to borrow a total of $642 million from Federal Home Loan Bank including an available line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank of $50 million. At June 30, 2017, we also had available credit lines with three additional banks for $35 million. Outstanding borrowings on June 30, 2017 with the FHLB totaled $359 million, and there were no amounts outstanding with the aforementioned additional bank lines.

        At December 31, 2016, we had the ability to borrow a total of $626 million from Federal Home Loan Bank including an available line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank of $50 million. At December 31, 2016, we also had available credit lines with three additional banks for $35 million. Outstanding borrowings on December 31, 2016 with the FHLB totaled $308 million, and there were no amounts outstanding with the aforementioned additional bank lines.

75


Table of Contents

        We have no material commitments or demands that are likely to affect our liquidity other than as set forth below. In the event loan demand were to increase faster than expected, or any unforeseen demand or commitment were to occur, we could access our borrowing capacity with the Federal Home Loan Bank, our bank lines of credit, or obtain additional funds through brokered certificates of deposit.

        At June 30, 2017, we had $385 million in loan commitments outstanding. We also had $70 thousand in standby letters of credit at June 30, 2017. At December 31, 2016, we had $242 million in loan commitments outstanding. We also had $72 thousand in standby letters of credit at December 31, 2016.

        Certificates of deposit due within one year of June 30, 2017 totaled $276 million, or 15% of total deposits. Total certificates of deposit were $372 million, or 21%, of total deposits. Certificates of deposit due within one year of December 31, 2016 totaled $361 million, or 22% of total deposits. Total certificates of deposit were $436 million, or 27% of total deposits.

        Our primary investing activities are the origination of loans and to a lesser extent, the purchase of securities. During the six months ended June 30, 2017, we originated $607 million of loans and purchased $85.2 million of securities. During the six months ended June 30, 2016, we originated $518 million of loans and purchased $47.5 million of securities. During the year ended December 31, 2016, we originated $1.21 billion of loans and purchased $93.9 million of securities. During the year ended December 31, 2015, we originated $909 million of loans and we purchased $63.8 million of securities.

        Financing activities consist primarily of activity in deposit accounts. We experienced increases in total deposits of $181 million and $219 million for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. We experienced net increases in total deposits of $385.4 million and $276.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. We generate deposits from local businesses and individuals through customer referrals and other relationships and through our retail presence. We believe we have a very stable core deposit base evidenced by the average life of our accounts, which we attribute to a high level of customer service and our consistently competitive rates. The high level of liquid accounts is expected to be maintained. We utilize borrowings and bulk sales of whole loans to supplement deposit needs and manage overall growth. In addition, we issued $50 million in subordinated notes in the year ended December 31, 2016, and an additional $15 million of subordinated notes in August of 2017.

        The Company and Sterling Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve and the OCC, respectively. At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, each of the Company and Sterling Bank exceeded all applicable regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank was considered "well capitalized" under regulatory guidelines. See Note 16 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information.

        We manage our capital to comply with our internal planning targets and regulatory capital standards administered by the Federal Reserve and the OCC. We review capital levels on a monthly basis including our needs for additional capital and ability to pay cash dividends. At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, Sterling Bank was classified as well-capitalized for regulatory purposes and the Company exceeded applicable capital requirements.

        The net proceeds from this offering will significantly increase our liquidity and capital resources. Over time, the initial level of liquidity will be reduced as net proceeds from this offering are used for general corporate purposes, including the funding of loans. We believe our financial condition and results of operations will be enhanced by the net proceeds from this offering, resulting in increased net interest earning assets and net interest income. However, due to the increase in equity resulting from the net proceeds raised in this offering, as well as other factors associated with this offering including

76


Table of Contents

additional expenses associated with public company status, we expect our return on equity will be adversely affected following this offering.

        The following tables present our capital ratios as of the indicated dates for the Company and Sterling Bank.

 
  Well
Capitalized
  Company Actual at
December 31, 2016
  Company Actual at
December 31, 2015
 

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    N/A     17.07 %   13.94 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    N/A     12.22 %   12.90 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    N/A     7.74 %   8.42 %

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    N/A     12.22 %   12.90 %

 

 
  Well
Capitalized
  Sterling Bank Actual at
December 31, 2016
  Sterling Bank Actual at
December 31, 2015
 

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    10.00 %   15.73 %   13.80 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    8.00 %   14.61 %   12.76 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    5.00 %   9.26 %   8.33 %

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    6.50 %   14.61 %   12.76 %

 

 
  Well
Capitalized
  Adequately
Capitalized
  Under
Capitalized
  Company Actual at
June 30, 2017
 

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    N/A     8.00 %   6.00 %   16.11 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    N/A     6.00 %   4.00 %   11.69 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    N/A     4.00 %   3.00 %   7.62 %

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    N/A     4.50 %   3.00 %   11.69 %

 

 
  Well
Capitalized
  Adequately
Capitalized
  Under
Capitalized
  Bank Actual at
June 30, 2017
 

Total adjusted capital to risk-weighted assets

    10.00 %   8.00 %   6.00 %   14.89 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk-weighted assets

    8.00 %   6.00 %   4.00 %   13.79 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

    5.00 %   4.00 %   3.00 %   8.99 %

Common Tier 1 (CET 1)

    6.50 %   4.50 %   3.00 %   13.79 %

        Basel III revised the capital adequacy requirements and the Prompt Corrective Action Framework effective January 1, 2015 for the Company. When fully phased in on January 1, 2019, the Basel Rules will require the Company to maintain a 2.5% "capital conservation buffer" on top of the minimum risk-weighted asset ratios. The capital conservation buffer is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. Banking institutions with a (i) CET1 to risk-weighted assets, (ii) Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets or (iii) total capital to risk-weighted assets above the respective minimum but below the capital conservation buffer will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers based on the amount of the shortfall. The implementation of the capital conservation buffer began on January 1, 2016 at the 0.625% level and will increase by 0.625% on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019.

77


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

        Contractual Obligations.    In the ordinary course of our operations, we enter into certain contractual obligations. The following table presents our contractual obligations as of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016.

Contractual Maturities as of December 31, 2016  
 
  Less Than
One Year
  More Than
One Year
Through
Three Years
  More Than
Three Years
Through
Five Years
  Over
Five Years
  Total  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Short-term FHLB advances and other

  $ 103,198                     $ 103,198  

Long-term FHLB advances

    15,000     11,000     22,000     157,000     205,000  

Subordinated notes

                      49,338     49,338  

Operating lease obligations

    2,924     5,703     4,688     6,710     20,025  

Time deposits

    361,400     38,399     36,196         435,995  

Total

  $ 482,522   $ 55,102   $ 62,884   $ 213,048   $ 813,556  

Note: Subordinated notes above are shown net of unamortized debt issuance costs of $662.

Contractual Maturities as of June 30, 2017  
 
  Less Than
One Year
  More Than
One Year
Through
Three Years
  More Than
Three Years
Through
Five Years
  Over
Five Years
  Total  
 
  (In thousands)
 

Short-term FHLB advances and other

  $ 154,312                     $ 154,312  

Long-term FHLB advances

    15,000     11,000     22,000     157,000     205,000  

Subordinated notes

                      49,404     49,404  

Operating lease obligations

    1,815     7,404     8,020     7,460     24,699  

Time deposits

    276,120     62,283     33,660         372,063  

Total

  $ 447,247   $ 80,687   $ 63,680   $ 213,864   $ 805,478  

Note: Subordinated notes above are shown net of unamortized debt issuance costs of $596.

        Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements.    We are a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of our customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit, which involve elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheets. Our exposure to credit loss is represented by the contractual amount of the instruments. We use the same credit policies in making commitments as we do for on-balance sheet instruments.

        For further information, see Note 15 to the audited consolidated financial statements.

Effect of Inflation and Changing Prices

        The consolidated financial statements and related financial data included in this prospectus have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars without considering the change in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation. The primary impact of inflation on our operations is reflected in increased operating costs. Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all the assets and liabilities of a financial institution are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates generally have a more significant impact on a financial institution's performance than do general levels of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction or to the same extent as the prices of goods and services.

78


Table of Contents


BUSINESS

Our Company

        We are a unitary thrift holding company headquartered in Southfield, Michigan with our primary branch operations in San Francisco and Los Angeles, California. Through our wholly owned bank subsidiary, Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B., we offer a broad range of loan products to the residential and commercial markets, as well as retail banking services. Since 2013, we have grown organically at a compound annual growth rate of 29% while maintaining stable margins and solid asset quality. Since 2013, we have grown our branch network from 16 branches to our current total of 26 branches, including 20 in the San Francisco area, 4 in greater Los Angeles, our recently opened branch in New York City and our headquarters' branch in Michigan. We also expect to open a branch near Seattle, Washington, where we currently have a loan production office, by the end of 2017 and two additional branches in Los Angeles in early 2018.

        We have a large and growing portfolio of adjustable rate residential mortgage loans. We manage residential credit risks through a financial documentation process and programs with low loan to value ratios, which averaged 63% across our residential portfolio as of June 30, 2017. Our risk management includes disciplined documentation of ability to repay, liquidity analysis and face-to-face customer interaction.

        We also operate substantial and growing commercial and construction lending businesses, utilizing a traditional community banking relationship-focused culture to identify strong borrowers with projects and operations in our branch network areas. We manage credit risks in our commercial and construction business through financial and relationship diligence with our customers and by financing projects within our branch footprint almost exclusively backed by personal guarantees.

        We believe our significant growth has not come at the expense of asset quality. We have historically been able to focus on long-term returns and remain committed to responsible growth. We also believe our strong sales team, disciplined underwriting and culture of cost management have driven consistent earnings and exemplary net interest margins, efficiency metrics and shareholder

79


Table of Contents

returns. The consistency of our success in these key areas since January 1, 2013 is demonstrated by the following tables:

GRAPHIC

        An important contributor to our growth since 2015 has been our successful entry into the greater Los Angeles market, where we started with a loan production office in 2015 and have grown to 4 full service branches, constituting 20.4% and 21.7% of our total loans and retail deposits as of June 30, 2017, with two new branches expected to open in the market in early 2018. While other institutions frequently enter new geographies through acquisitions, we have grown our geographic footprint through de novo branches while remaining true to our business model, offering the same products and services that proved successful in our San Francisco operations. We intend to continue our organic growth while further diversifying our geographical concentration with the recent expansion in New York City and Seattle, where we are targeting similar markets with products we fully understand.

Our History

        Sterling Bank was founded as a federally chartered thrift institution in 1984 in Southfield, Michigan by members of the Seligman family, and we have remained closely held. By 2004 we had 10 branches in the Detroit metropolitan area. However, in the early 1990s, our owners and management recognized an opportunity to shift the Bank's focus to a rapidly growing market less dependent, as Detroit was, on a single industry. In 1994, the Bank established its first branch in San Francisco, California. In 2004, we made the strategic decision to sell all but one of our Detroit-area branches and focus nearly exclusively on the California market. In 2004, we divested 10 Michigan branches and by 2006, substantially reduced new lending in Michigan.

        Our NPA/Total Assets ratio peaked at 5.7% in 2008, as we worked our way through credit issues related primarily to our legacy Michigan portfolios, which now represent a de minimis 1.3% of our loan portfolio. Since such time, our credit quality has improved significantly, with NPA/Total Assets as of June 30, 2017 of 0.16%. Between 2004 and 2008, we expanded our San Francisco presence by opening an additional 7 branches.

80


Table of Contents

        Our residential mortgage portfolio consists of homeowners with strong credit and ability to repay. We work directly with our borrowers and third parties to confirm their credit status and ability to repay and offer our borrowers the opportunity to expand their credit history through what is often a first-time mortgage for the customer, while requiring a minimum down payment of 35% on our key residential loan programs. We believe the resulting low loan to value ratios, which averaged 60%, in our core residential products portfolio, protects our position while enabling the customer to manage smaller overall monthly payments than would otherwise be available with a low down payment, traditional qualified mortgage. In addition, we offer TIC, or tenant-in-common, loans, which operate similarly to co-op loans. In our TIC program, each co-owner of multi-unit dwellings (which typically have between 4 and 6 units) has their own mortgage based on the purchase price of their unit and includes similar low loan to value ratios, averaging 69% as of June 30, 2017. We expect continuing demand for this program in our San Francisco and Los Angeles markets, particularly in communities that restrict conversion to condominium projects.

        We believe that our strong growth and consistent profitability is the result of management's efforts to focus on growth in San Francisco while managing legacy credit quality issues primarily in Michigan. In addition, we avoid purchasing loan participations where we do not have a relationship with the borrower and do not service the underlying credit. We have established a culture that places credit responsibility with individual loan officers and management and does not rely solely on a loan committee and institutional experience to remain disciplined in our underwriting. Furthermore, we believe our growing commercial and construction lending businesses have diversified our product offerings and allow us to identify strong borrowers with well-supported projects and operations in our branch network area. We manage credit risks in our commercial and construction lending businesses through financial and relationship diligence with our customers and by financing projects within our branch footprint through mostly recourse loans.

Our Competitive Strengths

        We attribute our success to the following competitive strengths:

        Responsiveness and Deep Customer Relationships.    We emphasize the values of personal relationships and quality customer service. Our extensive knowledge of our customers enables us to tailor products and solutions that fit their needs. In fact, approximately 86% of our borrowers also have a deposit relationship with the Bank, providing us with visibility into their liquidity profile and contributing to our ability to manage our asset quality. Further, we believe our responsiveness to our customers has enabled us to build a strong reputation for execution in our markets. With most loans closed in less than 30 days from a complete application to closing in our residential real estate lending, our reputation has facilitated our expansion into Seattle, Washington and New York City in 2017. Our efficient organizational structure further contributes to our ability to make quick decisions and timely respond to our customers. We believe this responsiveness allows us to remain competitive even when other financial institutions may offer lower rates.

        Product Expertise and Disciplined Credit Culture.    We believe the success of our products is the result of our focus on the markets we serve, our understanding of customer needs, our management of product criteria, and our disciplined underwriting of the type of loans we make. We believe our willingness to focus on nontraditional loan products allows us to face less price competition for our non-TIC residential portfolio, in particular, than we do when competing for traditional conforming, fixed-rate mortgages. We have developed consistent underwriting and credit management processes tailored to each of the products we offer, allowing us to build high quality asset portfolios. We believe our relationships with, and knowledge of, our customers further enhances our credit quality, as we do not provide our key loan products to any customer unless the applicable relationship manager has met them and documented the interaction. We also subject our portfolios to annual stress testing and ongoing monitoring. Because we service our portfolio and retain servicing rights on loans that we sell,

81


Table of Contents

we maintain access to key information that enhances our ability to manage the entire customer relationship. We believe that our continuity and consistency in underwriting is reflected by our 0.12% rate of delinquency as of June 30, 2017.

        Leveraged Back Office Operations.    We believe our strong profitability, net interest margins and efficiency metrics have been bolstered by our lower-cost back office operations in the Midwest, relative to the expenses incurred by our competitors who perform these functions in the more dynamic labor and real estate markets in which we operate. The majority of our leadership team and back office operations (currently consisting of 89 full-time employees) remain in the lower-cost Detroit area, while 96% of our revenue is derived from our branches and loan production offices in the higher-cost areas of California, Seattle and New York. The significantly lower operating expenses where we are headquartered have contributed to our competitively low efficiency ratio of 36% and 37% in the periods ended June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively, and have been a key driver of our consistent profitability since shifting our growth strategy to San Francisco, Los Angeles, and now other metropolitan areas. In addition, we have been able to maintain continuity of executive management and talent retention at a rate we believe to be higher than many of our peers. This low rate of turnover and high retention rate of management has contributed to our low efficiency ratio. We also believe that conducting certain back room functions, such as responding to regulatory exams and audits, through our back office operations and separating such functions from the business production at our branches, lessens distractions to our production teams.

        Experienced Management Team.    We believe that we are well positioned to quickly and efficiently deploy new capital to continue our outstanding growth metrics. The management team that successfully led us through the crisis is driving the Company's performance today and continues to apply the lessons learned over their lengthy community banking careers. Our leadership team consists of senior managers who, on average, have been immersed in our cost-conscious culture for at least 16 years. We believe this continuity and institutional knowledge has significantly contributed to our growth and strong asset quality. Our key leadership team includes:

82


Table of Contents

We believe this stability and institutional knowledge allows us to promote our culture of solid underwriting and growth across all levels of our organization. Notwithstanding inevitable turnover in a competitive industry, we pride ourselves on our ability to attract and maintain talent within our Company. We strive to foster an environment where we are able to promote key employees who perform and understand our culture and values.

Our Business Strategy

        Our goal is to maintain our strong performance while continuing to efficiently provide the highest level of customer service while limiting our exposure to credit risk. The additional capital from this offering will allow us to continue our organic growth, further diversify our geographical concentration, and allow us to opportunistically consider strategic initiatives.

        Focused Growth and Diversification Initiative in Core Products.    In 2015, we extended our operations to the Los Angeles market, focusing on the same products that had been successful for us in San Francisco. As of June 30, 2017, our 4 Los Angeles branches have grown to an aggregate of $385.4 million in deposits, all organically. We are focused on continued growth in our core residential products while maintaining our strong asset quality. We expect to continue to grow our portfolio in the Los Angeles market, as two additional branches to open in 2018. We are also laying the groundwork to replicate this successful strategy in certain communities in Seattle, Washington and New York City that we believe have similar demographics to our existing markets. Consistent with our culture of building long-term value and maintaining profitability, our strategy in entering new markets is conservative, as we limit initial expenses to a temporary loan production office until we are confident that we can hire lenders and other employees that fit our culture and understand our products and strategy. We have not bought books of business by hiring full lending teams from other institutions. Entry into these new markets will help diversify our loan portfolio to mitigate the impact of potential geographically-localized economic downturns. In addition, we intend to further diversify our revenues by building a fee-based income stream from wealth management and financial advisory services.

        Deposit Growth.    We believe our policy of meeting each portfolio loan customer in person has enabled us to leverage our significant loan growth to increase our deposits from $953.2 million as of December 31, 2014 to nearly $1.8 billion as of June 30, 2017. During 2016 and in the six months ended June 30, 2017, 98.2% and 98.3%, respectively, of our Advantage Loan mortgage customers chose to open deposit accounts at our branches, in part to take advantage of rate incentives and our ACH payment program. Our residential borrower related checking deposit accounts average $15,756 per account as of June 30, 2017. Our flagship deposit strategy consists primarily of our popular money market accounts, which constitute 68.7% of our retail deposit portfolio at June 30, 2017. We believe that significant cross-selling of our deposit products to our residential mortgage customers and enrollment in our automated payment program contribute to our solid asset quality. In addition, the combination of our high net interest margin and low expense ratio leaves us room to pay competitively attractive rates to our depositors and increase our market share.

        Continued Focus on Growing Commercial and Construction Loans.    We are committed to continuing to grow our successful commercial and construction loan portfolios at a ratio of approximately 20-25% of our assets. Our commercial and construction loan portfolio has grown from $255 million to $450 million since 2012. Our commercial and construction lending portfolio consists primarily of mixed use developments, offices, multifamily, construction and renovation projects. We also finance SROs, or single room occupancy projects, the majority of which are in our San Francisco market. We expect to maintain our strategy of developing a commercial and construction loan profile in our expanding branch footprint, where we can continue to leverage our ability to develop customer relationships and

83


Table of Contents

leverage our high quality service model into new opportunities. We attribute the growth in our commercial and construction portfolio to our increased hiring of quality commercial lenders, ability to execute on our pipeline, and high demand for the projects we underwrite. We also endeavor to manage the inherent risks attendant to increased commercial and construction loan activity, including their generally larger average size as compared to residential loans and the less readily-marketable collateral underlying commercial and construction loans. While we remain committed to minimizing these risks, losses incurred on a small number of commercial loans could have a disproportionately adverse impact on our results of operations.

        Bulk Loan Sales.    In order to open additional avenues of ongoing liquidity, in 2015 we began selling pools of our residential portfolio loans from time to time in the secondary markets. From May 2015 to May 2017 we sold approximately $422 million of our originated loans, recognizing approximately $13.1 million in gains on sale. In that time, some of the loans we sold have been used as collateral in securitizations and, as part of that process, we have been rated by DBRS and Fitch Ratings, each an independent ratings agency, as a servicer. We believe that the market for our loans and servicer ratings is a testament to the quality of our underwriting standards. While we prefer to keep the majority of our originations on our balance sheet, we will continue to consider additional sales in order to maintain visibility into market perception of our pricing, as well as to keep liquidity options open.

        Leverage Public Company Status.    In addition to raising capital to support our growth as further discussed under "Use of Proceeds, " we believe becoming a public company, while increasing our operating costs, will provide us with additional options and better pricing to manage our cost of capital that were previously unavailable to us as a closely-held private company. While we have not historically engaged in significant merger and acquisition activity, the ability to issue publicly-traded stock as consideration may enable us to opportunistically approach potential transactions. In addition, we believe the ability to add a public stock equity component to our compensation programs in a responsible manner will enable us to better incentivize and retain key employees in the competitive markets in which we operate.

Our Market Area

        We currently have 20 branches in greater San Francisco, 4 branches in Los Angeles, one branch in New York City, one operational-focused branch and our corporate headquarters in Southfield, Michigan, and one loan production office near Seattle, Washington. We believe the comparatively high household incomes, population density, and projected population growth in our current markets will enhance our ability to continue our organic growth. The graphs below illustrate the expected

84


Table of Contents

population growth, median household incomes, population density and populations of our markets as they compare to national averages:

GRAPHIC


Source: SNL Financial and Nielsen. Data as of September 30, 2017.

        California Markets.    We operate primarily in the San Francisco-Oakland-Hayward, California Metropolitan Statistical Area ("MSA") with substantial operations in the Los Angeles-Long Beach-Anaheim, California MSA, with Northern California responsible for 78.3% and Southern California responsible for 20.4% of our loan portfolio as of June 30, 2017.

        With a population of approximately 5 million, the San Francisco-Oakland-Hayward MSA represents the second most populous area in California and the twelfth largest in the United States. In addition to its current size, the market also demonstrates key characteristics we believe provide the opportunity for additional growth, including projected population growth of 5.1% through 2023 versus the national average of 3.5%, a median household income of $98.0 thousand versus a national average of $50.9 thousand, and the third highest population density in the nation.

        The Los Angeles-Long Beach-Anaheim, California MSA maintains a population of approximately 13.5 million, the most populous area in California and the second largest in the United States. We believe the market's projected population growth of 3.4% through 2023, its median household income of $69,330, and its highest population density in the nation position the area as an attractive market in which to expand operations, which we intend to accomplish through the opening of two additional branches in 2018.

85


Table of Contents

        Newest Markets.    We recently established a branch in New York City and a loan production office near Seattle, Washington, which we expect to convert to a branch by the end of 2017.

        The New York-Newark-Jersey City MSA is the largest in the United States by both deposits and population. The MSA has a median household income of $74,446 and the second highest population density in the nation. It also has a projected population growth of 1.9% by 2023.

        While smaller in size than our New York market, the Seattle-Tacoma-Bellevue, Washington MSA is the fourth largest on the west coast of the United States and supports a population of approximately 4 million. The Seattle-Tacoma-Bellevue, Washington MSA has an expected population growth of 6.7% by 2023.

        Operational Center.    We maintain a single, operationally focused branch in Southfield, Michigan in the Detroit-Warren-Dearborn, Michigan MSA. This branch serves as our headquarters and central operations center where we are able to leverage our operations to drive efficiencies and profitability

GRAPHIC

and maintain a presence where the Company was founded. We believe that maintaining our headquarters and key back-office staff in a market with a lower cost of doing business than many of our competitors in our primary market areas contributes to our quality efficiency metrics. The graph to the left indicates the cost of doing business in each of our market areas, and reflects the significantly lower cost of business in the Detroit-Warren-Dearborn MSA in comparison to our other MSAs.

        We believe that the favorable demographics of each of our primary MSAs will provide us with the opportunity to continue to grow our businesses organically in a focused and strategic manner.


Source: KPMG Competitive Alternatives 2016. Business cost data as of December 31, 2016.

Note: Business costs are expressed as an index. An index below 100 indicates lower costs than the U.S. baseline. An index over 100 indicates higher costs than the U.S. baseline (e.g., an index of 95.0 represents costs 5.0% below the U.S. baseline). U.S. baseline is the average of the four largest U.S. metro areas.

Lending Activities

        General.    Our lending strategy is to offer a broad range of loan products to the residential and commercial markets, tailored to our customers' needs. The majority of our loan portfolio consists of residential real estate mortgages, which accounted for 80% of our loan portfolio as of June 30, 2017. The balance of our loan portfolio consists of commercial real estate, construction, multifamily residential and commercial lines of credit.

        One- to Four-Family Residential Loans.    The origination of mortgage loans to enable borrowers to purchase or refinance existing homes comprises the largest portion of our loan portfolio. We offer fixed-rate and adjustable-rate mortgage loans with terms of up to 30 years. Among our significant products is our Advantage Loan program, which consists of one, three, five, or seven year adjustable rate mortgages with a minimum 35% down payment requirement. We offer this product to underserved home buyers who have good credit, but may have limited credit history. We offer lower rates in cases where borrowers have the ability to make more than the minimum down payment. Our Advantage Loan program constituted 73% of our residential loan portfolio as of June 30, 2017. Another significant product is our tenant-in-common, or TIC, loan program, which is similar to traditional co-op loans. Our primary market areas of San Francisco and Los Angeles contain a substantial number of two to six

86


Table of Contents

unit residential buildings and a large amount of condominium conversions. Through our TIC program, we lend to owners of individual units within the building based on their relative ownership share. Because we understand the intricacies of home ownership in buildings with multiple units, we believe our experience enables us to often close TIC loans faster than other banks. Our TIC loans generally consist of three, five and seven year adjustable rate mortgages, with an average balance of $451,000, and total outstanding loans of $421 million as of June 30, 2017. We also offer conventional conforming fixed-rate loans with terms of either 15, 20, or 30 years for mortgages of less than $636,150. The bulk of our conforming mortgage portfolio is held for sale, after which we typically retain servicing rights. In addition, we have a jumbo loan program for residential loans of between $636,150 and $2.5 million, for which we offer both fixed and adjustable rates. Across our portfolio, our adjustable-rate mortgage loans are based on a 30-year amortization schedule and interest rates and payments adjust annually after a one, three, five, or seven-year initial fixed period. Interest rates on our adjustable-rate loans generally are adjusted to a rate typically equal to 350 to 395 basis points above the one year LIBOR. Across our residential portfolio, our loan-to-value ratio was 63% as of June 30, 2017.

        We have a loan approval process through which we require not only financial and other information from our borrowers, but our loan officers are required to meet face-to-face with each of our borrowers in our Advantage and TIC programs and produce a narrative documentation recommending the loan.

        Our single-family residential real estate portfolio is secured by real estate. Adverse developments affecting real estate values in our market areas could therefore increase the credit risk associated with these loans, impair the value of property pledged as collateral on loans, and affect our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure without a loss or additional losses. Loans held for sale consist primarily of first trust deed mortgages on single-family residential properties.

        Commercial Loans.    We offer a variety of commercial loan products, consisting primarily of commercial real estate loans, construction loans, business loans and business lines of credit. Our commercial loans are almost exclusively recourse loans, as we endeavor to secure personal guaranties on each loan we underwrite.

        Commercial Real Estate.    Our commercial real estate portfolio includes single room occupancy, hotels, office, industrial, retail, multifamily and mixed-use properties. We focus almost exclusively on projects within or contiguous to our branch footprint, focusing on what we believe to be high quality credits with income-producing properties, strong cash flow characteristics and strong collateral profiles. At June 30, 2017, approximately 13% of the commercial real estate loan portfolio consisted of fixed rate loans. Our loan-to-value policy limits are 75% for commercial real estate loans and 80% for multifamily.

        The total commercial real estate portfolio totaled $220.8 million at June 30, 2017 and $201.4 million at December 31, 2016, of which $11.5 million and $11.9 million, respectively, were secured by owner occupied properties. Our nonaccrual commercial real estate loans as of June 30, 2017 were $97 thousand, which has not changed materially from December 31, 2016 levels of $138 thousand.

        A primary repayment risk for commercial real estate loans is the interruption or discontinuance of operating cash flows from the properties or businesses involved, which may be influenced by economic events, changes in governmental regulations or other events not under the control of the borrower. Additionally, adverse developments affecting commercial real estate values in our market areas could increase the credit risk associated with these loans, impair the value of property pledged as collateral for these loans, and affect our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure without a loss or additional losses.

        Construction loans.    Our construction loans are comprised primarily of residential construction, commercial construction and mixed-use development. We focus primarily on renovation projects, as

87


Table of Contents

opposed to ground-up developments. We believe that opportunities for construction lending will continue to increase, particularly in our San Francisco market, where historic preservation ordinances and other regulations limit the number of ground-up projects. Interest reserves are generally established on real estate construction loans. These loans are typically Prime based and typically have maturities of less than 18 months. Our loan-to-value policy limits are 80% for construction and 65% for land loans. The total construction portfolio totaled $188.8 million at June 30, 2017 and $146.6 million at December 31, 2016.

        The risks inherent in construction lending may affect adversely our results of operations. Such risks include, among other things, the possibility that contractors may fail to complete, or complete on a timely basis, construction of the relevant properties, substantial cost overruns in excess of original estimates and financing, market deterioration during construction, and lack of permanent take-out financing. Loans secured by such properties also involve additional risk because they have no operating history. In these loans, loan funds are advanced upon the security of the project under construction (which is of uncertain value prior to completion of construction) and the estimated operating cash flow to be generated by the completed project.

        Commercial Lines of Credit and Consumer Loans.    We also offer commercial lines of credit to businesses and individuals for business purposes. We seek to streamline the application process and provide quick decision-making to allow our customers to access credit quickly. These lines of credit are typically secured by real estate, inventory, equipment, accounts receivable and all assets. The total commercial line of credit and consumer loan portfolio totaled $40.4 million at June 30, 2017 and $36.8 million at December 31, 2016.

Investment Portfolio

        As of June 30, 2017 the fair value of our investment portfolio totaled $102.5 million, with an average effective yield of 1.43%. The estimated duration on the fixed income portion of our investment portfolio (fair value of $99.0 million) is 2.4 years. The primary objectives of the investment portfolio are to provide liquidity in accordance with the liquidity regulations, generate economic value, and to be responsive to cash needs and assist in managing interest rate risk. The majority of our investment portfolio, or 80%, consists of treasuries, with 20% in other collateralized debt obligations, equity or other securities. We regularly evaluate the composition of our investment portfolio as the interest rate yield curve changes and may sell investment securities from time to time to adjust our exposure to interest rates or to provide liquidity to meet loan demand.

        Our investment policy is reviewed at least annually by our board of directors. Overall investment goals are established by our board, CEO, CFO and members of our Asset and Liability Committee ("ALCO"). Our board of directors has delegated the responsibility of monitoring our investment activities to our management ALCO. Day-to-day activities pertaining to the securities portfolio are conducted under the supervision of our COO and CFO. We actively monitor our investments on an ongoing basis to identify any material changes in the securities. We also review our securities for potential other-than-temporary impairment at least quarterly.

Deposits

        The quality of our deposit franchise and access to stable funding are key components to our success. We offer traditional depository products, including checking, savings, money market, IRAs and certificates of deposits, to individuals and businesses through our branch network throughout our market areas. Deposits at the Bank are insured by the FDIC up to statutory limits. We offer customers traditional retail deposit products through our branch network and the ability to access their accounts through online and mobile banking platforms. We seek to grow our deposits through cross-selling to our loan customers, use of competitive rates, a focused marketing campaign, and multi-product clubs in

88


Table of Contents

which we offer varying benefits depending on the overall relationship with the customer. We consider our core deposits, defined as all deposits except for time deposits exceeding $250,000, to be our primary and most valuable funding source, and as of June 30, 2017, core deposits represented 94.8% of our total deposits. We strive to retain an attractive deposit mix from both large and small customers as well as a broad market reach, which has resulted in our top 50 customers accounting for only 9.17% of retail deposits, as of June 30, 2017. Our bankers are incentivized to acquire and maintain quality, core deposits as we depend on deposits to fund the majority of our loans. We believe that our long-standing and high quality relationships with our depositors who provide us with long-term funding are due to the convenience, rates and dedicated service we offer. We leverage our branch locations and deep network of customer relationships in our market areas to provide low-cost funding sources for our lending business. We had $1.774 billion of retail deposits, and our cost of deposits was 0.857% for the six months ended June 30, 2017.

Distribution Channels

        The primary markets in which we operate are San Francisco and greater Los Angeles, and our 24 branch network in these areas is our core distribution channel. Sterling Bank is the only bank with less than $30 billion in assets with a significant branch network in San Francisco. We strive to take advantage of our focused footprint and deep-rooted relationships to target local customers with a diversified product offering.

        Our expansive local branch network enables us to gather low cost deposits, promote the Sterling brand and customer loyalty, originate loans and other products and maintain relationships with our customers through regular community involvement. Our branch network is fundamental to our ability to achieve successful customer outreach in line with our culture, which promotes high-touch engagement with our customers and proactive solutions.

Risk Management

        We believe that effective risk management is of primary importance to our organization. Risk management refers generally to the activities by which we identify, measure, monitor, evaluate and manage the risks we face in the course of our banking activities. These include liquidity, interest rate, credit, operational, cyber/technological, legal, compliance, regulatory, strategic, financial and reputational risk exposures. Our board of directors and management team have created a risk-conscious culture that is focused on quality growth, which includes infrastructure capable of addressing the evolving risks we face, as well as the changing regulatory and compliance landscape. Our risk management approach employs comprehensive policies and processes to establish robust governance and emphasizes personal ownership and accountability for risk with our employees. We believe a disciplined and conservative underwriting approach has been the key to our strong asset quality.

        Our board of directors sets the tone at the top of our organization, adopting and overseeing the implementation of our company-wide risk management framework, which establishes our overall risk appetite and risk management strategy. Our Enterprise Risk Committee meets every other month and provides a written report to our board on a quarterly basis regarding our enterprise risk management function, which includes risk policies, procedures, limits, targets and reporting structured to guide decisions regarding the appropriate balance between risk and return considerations in our business. We also perform an annual capital stress test through which we simulate the worst case scenario published by the FRB and evaluate the effect on the capital position of the Company. We seek to build a risk management culture through educational seminars for our employees, management analysis of risk scenarios, risk performance studies and the formulation of contingency plans.

89


Table of Contents

        Our lenders are our first line of defense for assuring credit quality and the integrity of our risk rating process. Our lenders must have an understanding of the nature of the borrower's ability to repay and the nature and value of the underlying collateral. We currently outsource the internal loan review to a major independent firm. The firm conducts a minimum of one onsite review each year covering approximately 35% of our Commercial loan portfolio and approximately 2% of our Residential portfolio. The Commercial loan review procedures include a credit quality assessment (including independent risk rating) along with a standard documentation review. The Residential loan review examines compliance with Bank policy and loan documentation testing.

        Our management of interest rate risk is overseen by our Board ALCO, and implemented by our Management ALCO based on a risk management infrastructure approved by our board of directors that outlines reporting and measurement requirements. In particular, this infrastructure sets limits, calculated quarterly, for various interest rate-related metrics, our economic value of equity and net interest income simulations involving parallel shifts in interest rate curves. Steepening and flattening yield curves and various prepayment and deposit duration assumptions are prepared at least annually. Our interest rate management policies also require periodic review and documentation of all key assumptions used, such as identifying appropriate interest rate scenarios, setting loan prepayment rates and deposit durations based on historical analysis.

Competition

        The financial services industry is highly competitive as we compete for loans, deposits and customer relationships in our market. Competition involves efforts to retain current clients, make new loans and obtain new deposits, increase the scope and sophistication of services offered and offer competitive interest rates paid on deposits and charged on loans. Within our branch footprint, we primarily face competition from national, regional and other local financial institutions that have established branch networks throughout the San Francisco and Los Angeles areas as well as new markets, giving them visible retail presence to customers.

        In mortgage banking, we face competition from a wide range of national financial institutions, regional and local community banks, as well as credit unions and national mortgage underwriters. In commercial banking, we face competition to underwrite loans to sound, stable businesses and real estate projects at competitive price levels that make sense for our business and risk profile. Our major commercial bank competitors include larger national, regional and local financial institutions that may have the ability to make loans on larger projects than we can or provide a larger mix of product offerings. We also compete with smaller local financial institutions that may have aggressive pricing and unique terms on various types of loans and, increasingly, financial technology platforms that offer their products exclusively through web-based portals.

        In retail banking, we primarily compete with national and local banks that have visible retail presence and personnel in our market areas. The primary factors driving competition in consumer banking are customer service, interest rates, fees charged, branch location and hours of operation and the range of products offered. We compete for deposits by advertising, offering competitive interest rates and seeking to provide a higher level of personal service. We also face competition from non-traditional alternatives to banks such as credit unions, money centers, money market mutual funds and cash management accounts.

        We believe our ability to provide a flexible, sophisticated product offering and an efficient process to our customers allows us to stay competitive in the financial services environment. Our local presence and hands-on approach enables us to provide a high level of service that our customers value.

90


Table of Contents

Other Subsidiaries

        Quantum Capital Management.    In April 2017 we acquired Quantum, an investment management platform that historically focused on hedged equity and mid-cap, small-cap and micro-cap portfolio strategies. As of June 30, 2017, Quantum had $428 million in assets under management. We expect Quantum to provide an investment service platform to help diversify our fee-based income.

        Sterling Wealth Management.    Sterling Wealth Management, a subsidiary of the Bank, provides wealth management services to certain of our customers. To date, Sterling Wealth Management has not been a significant contributor to our non-interest income. We have a customer service representative training program to establish a traditional fee-based, wealth management platform that will deliver a sustainable revenue stream for the Bank while providing clients with an enhanced level of investment advisory services. We believe that our recent acquisition of Quantum will produce synergies to provide professional research, market analysis, lead generation, and referrals from the two subsidiaries.

Information Technology Systems

        We devote significant resources to maintain stable, reliable, efficient and scalable information technology systems. We utilize our own single, highly integrated core processing system that improves cost efficiency and protects us against escalating rates and termination fees from third party providers and positions us to be in control of new practice development and time to market. We work with our third party vendors to monitor and maximize the efficiency of our use of their applications. We use integrated systems to originate and process loans and deposit accounts, which reduces processing time, improves customer experience and reduces costs.

        We have an Information Security Officer who reports to the General Counsel, whom we charge with the review and implementation of strategies, policies, managed services, technology, and any other resource that could aid in the effort against cybercrime. Our Information Systems ("IS") Department proactively identifies and monitors systems to analyze risk to the organization and implement mitigating controls where appropriate. Formal business continuity and disaster recovery exercises are conducted annually. Additionally, we involve independent firms to perform an audit and internal and external penetration tests on our IS systems on at least an annual basis.

Employees

        As of June 30, 2017, we had 268 full-time equivalent employees. None of our employees are represented by any collective bargaining unit or are parties to a collective bargaining agreement. We believe that our relations with our employees are good.

Properties

        Our corporate headquarters is located at One Towne Square, Suite 1900, Southfield, Michigan 48076. In addition to our corporate headquarters, we operate 20 branch offices located in the San Francisco metropolitan area, 4 branch offices in the Los Angeles metropolitan area, one branch located in New York City and one loan production office near Seattle, Washington as of August 31, 2017. We lease our corporate headquarters and all of our retail branch offices at what we believe to be market rates.

Legal and Regulatory Proceedings

        We operate in a highly regulated environment. From time to time we are a party to various litigation matters incidental to the conduct of our business. We are not presently party to any legal proceedings the resolution of which we believe would have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, financial condition, liquidity, results of operation, cash flows or capital levels.

91


Table of Contents


SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

General

        As a federal savings bank, Sterling Bank is subject to primary examination and regulation by the OCC and, as an insured depository institution, the FDIC. The federal system of regulation and supervision establishes a comprehensive framework of activities in which Sterling Bank may engage and is intended primarily for the protection of depositors and the FDIC's Deposit Insurance Fund rather than our shareholders. Sterling Bank also is a member of, and owns stock in, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis, which is one of the 11 regional banks in the Federal Home Loan Bank System.

        As a unitary thrift holding company, Sterling Bancorp is required to comply with the rules and regulations of the Federal Reserve Board. It is required to file certain reports with the Federal Reserve Board and is subject to examination by and the enforcement authority of the Federal Reserve Board. Sterling Bancorp will also be subject to the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission under the federal securities laws.

        Under this system of regulation, the regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory, enforcement, rulemaking and examination activities and policies, including rules or policies that: establish minimum capital levels; restrict the timing and amount of dividend payments; govern the classification of assets; determine the adequacy of loan loss reserves for regulatory purposes; and establish the timing and amounts of assessments and fees. Moreover, as part of their examination authority, the banking regulators assign numerical ratings to banks and savings institutions relating to capital, asset quality, management, liquidity, earnings and other factors. These ratings are inherently subjective and the receipt of a less than satisfactory rating in one or more category may result in enforcement action by the banking regulators against a financial institution. A less than satisfactory rating may also prevent a financial institution, such as Sterling Bank or Sterling Bancorp, from obtaining necessary regulatory approvals to access the capital markets, pay dividends, acquire other financial institutions or establish new branches.

        In addition, we must comply with anti-money laundering and anti-terrorism laws and regulations, Community Reinvestment Act laws and regulations, and fair lending laws and regulations. Government agencies have the authority to impose monetary penalties and other sanctions on institutions that fail to comply with these laws and regulations, which could significantly affect our business activities, including our ability to expand our branch network or acquire other financial institutions.

        Any change in applicable laws or regulations, whether by the OCC, the FDIC, the Federal Reserve Board or Congress, could have a material adverse impact on the operations and financial performance of Sterling Bancorp and Sterling Bank.

        Set forth below is a brief description of material regulatory requirements that are or will be applicable to Sterling Bank and Sterling Bancorp. The description is limited to certain material aspects of the statutes and regulations addressed, and is not intended to be a complete description of such statutes and regulations and their effects on Sterling Bank and Sterling Bancorp.

Federal Banking Regulation

        Business Activities.    A federal savings bank derives its lending and investment powers from the Home Owners' Loan Act, as amended, and applicable federal regulations. Under these laws and regulations, Sterling Bank may invest in mortgage loans secured by residential and commercial real estate, commercial business and consumer loans, certain types of debt securities and certain other assets, subject to applicable limits. Sterling Bank may also establish subsidiaries that may engage in certain activities not otherwise permissible for Sterling Bank, including wealth and investment management.

92


Table of Contents

        Capital Requirements.    Federal regulations require Sterling Bancorp and Sterling Bank to meet several minimum capital standards. In the case of Sterling Bank, minimum capital standards include a common equity Tier 1 capital to risk-based assets ratio of 4.5%, a Tier 1 capital to risk-based assets ratio of 6.0%, a total capital to risk-based assets ratio of 8.0%, and a 4.0% Tier 1 capital to total assets leverage ratio. These capital requirements were effective January 1, 2015 and are the result of a final rule implementing recommendations of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision and certain requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act.

        In determining the amount of risk-weighted assets for purposes of calculating risk-based capital ratios, all assets, including certain off-balance sheet assets (e.g., recourse obligations, direct credit substitutes, residual interests) are multiplied by a risk weight factor assigned by the regulations based on the risks believed inherent in the type of asset. Higher levels of capital are required for asset categories believed to present greater risk. Common equity Tier 1 capital is generally defined as common shareholders' equity and retained earnings. Tier 1 capital is generally defined as common equity Tier 1 and additional Tier 1 capital. Additional Tier 1 capital includes certain noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus and minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries. Total capital includes Tier 1 capital (common equity Tier 1 capital plus additional Tier 1 capital) and Tier 2 capital. Tier 2 capital is comprised of capital instruments and related surplus, meeting specified requirements, and may include cumulative preferred stock and long-term perpetual preferred stock, mandatory convertible securities, intermediate preferred stock and subordinated debt. Also included in Tier 2 capital is the allowance for loan and lease losses limited to a maximum of 1.25% of risk-weighted assets and, for institutions that have exercised an opt-out election regarding the treatment of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income, up to 45% of net unrealized gains on available-for-sale equity securities with readily determinable fair market values. Calculation of all types of regulatory capital is subject to deductions and adjustments specified in the regulations. In assessing an institution's capital adequacy, the OCC takes into consideration not only these numeric factors, but qualitative factors as well, and has the authority to establish higher capital requirements for individual institutions where deemed necessary.

        In addition to establishing the minimum regulatory capital requirements, the regulations limit capital distributions and certain discretionary bonus payments to management if the institution does not hold a "capital conservation buffer" consisting of 2.5% of common equity Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets above the amount necessary to meet its minimum risk-based capital requirements. The capital conservation buffer requirement is being phased in, a process which began January 1, 2016 at 0.625% of risk-weighted assets and increases by such amount each year until fully implemented at 2.5% of risk-weighted assets on January 1, 2019.

        At June 30, 2017, the Company and the Bank met all regulatory capital requirements to which they are subject.

        Loans-to-One Borrower.    Generally, a federal savings bank may not make a loan or extend credit to a single or related group of borrowers in excess of 15% of unimpaired capital and surplus. An additional amount may be loaned, equal to 10% of unimpaired capital and surplus, if the loan is secured by readily marketable collateral, which generally does not include real estate. As of June 30, 2017, Sterling Bank was in compliance with the loans-to-one borrower limitations.

        Qualified Thrift Lender Test.    As a federal savings bank, Sterling Bank must satisfy the qualified thrift lender, or "QTL," test. Under the QTL test, Sterling Bank must maintain at least 65% of its "portfolio assets" in "qualified thrift investments" (primarily residential mortgages and related investments, including mortgage-backed securities) in at least nine months of the most recent 12-month period. "Portfolio assets" generally means total assets of a savings bank, less the sum of specified liquid assets up to 20% of total assets, goodwill and other intangible assets, and the value of property used in the conduct of the savings bank's business.

93


Table of Contents

        Sterling Bank also may satisfy the QTL test by qualifying as a "domestic building and loan association" as defined in the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. This test generally requires a savings bank to have at least 75% of its deposits held by the public and earn at least 25% of its income from loans and U.S. government obligations. Alternatively, a savings bank can satisfy this test by maintaining at least 60% of its assets in cash, real estate loans and U.S. Government or state obligations.

        A savings bank that fails the qualified thrift lender test must operate under specified restrictions set forth in the Home Owners' Loan Act. The Dodd-Frank Act made noncompliance with the QTL test subject to agency enforcement action. At June 30, 2017, Sterling Bank satisfied the QTL test.

        Capital Distributions.    Federal regulations govern capital distributions by a federal savings bank, which include cash dividends, stock repurchases and other transactions charged to the savings bank's capital account. A federal savings bank must file an application with the OCC for approval of a capital distribution if:

        Even if an application is not otherwise required, every savings bank that is a subsidiary of a unitary thrift holding company, such as Sterling Bank, must still file a notice with the Federal Reserve Board at least 30 days before the board of directors declares a dividend or approves a capital distribution.

        A notice or application related to a capital distribution may be disapproved if:

        In addition, the Federal Deposit Insurance Act provides that an insured depository institution may not make any capital distribution if, after making such distribution, the institution would fail to meet any applicable regulatory capital requirement.

        Community Reinvestment Act and Fair Lending Laws.    All federal savings banks have a responsibility under the Community Reinvestment Act and related regulations to help meet the credit needs of their communities, including low and moderate-income borrowers. In connection with its examination of a federal savings bank, the OCC is required to assess the federal savings bank's record of compliance with the Community Reinvestment Act. A savings bank's failure to comply with the provisions of the Community Reinvestment Act could, at a minimum, result in denial of certain corporate applications such as branch expansion or mergers, or in restrictions on its activities. In addition, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act prohibit lenders from discriminating in their lending practices on the basis of characteristics specified in those statutes. The failure to comply with the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act could result in enforcement actions by the OCC, as well as other federal regulatory agencies and the Department of Justice.

94


Table of Contents

        The Community Reinvestment Act requires all institutions insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation to publicly disclose their rating. Sterling Bank received a "satisfactory" Community Reinvestment Act rating in its most recent federal examination.

        Transactions with Related Parties.    A federal savings bank's authority to engage in transactions with its affiliates is limited by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and federal regulation. An affiliate is generally a company that controls, or is under common control with, an insured depository institution such as Sterling Bank. Sterling Bancorp is an affiliate of Sterling Bank because of its control of Sterling Bank. A subsidiary of a bank that is not also a depository institution or a "financial subsidiary" under federal law is not treated as an affiliate of the bank for the purposes of Sections 23A and 23B; however, the OCC has the discretion to treat subsidiaries of a bank as affiliates on a case-by-case basis. Section 23A limits the extent to which a bank or its subsidiaries may engage in "covered transactions" with any one affiliate to 10% of the bank's capital stock and surplus. There is an aggregate limit of 20% of the bank's capital stock and surplus for such transactions with all affiliates. The term "covered transaction" includes, among other things, the making of a loan to an affiliate, a purchase of assets from an affiliate, the issuance of a guarantee on behalf of an affiliate and the acceptance of securities of an affiliate as collateral for a loan. All such transactions are required to be on terms and conditions that are consistent with safe and sound banking practices and no transaction may involve the acquisition of any "low quality asset" from an affiliate. Certain covered transactions, such as loans to or guarantees on behalf of an affiliate, must be secured by collateral in amounts ranging from 100 to 130 percent of the loan amount, depending upon the type of collateral. In addition, Section 23B requires that any covered transaction (and specified other transactions) between a bank and an affiliate must be on terms and conditions that are substantially the same, or at least as favorable, to the bank, as those that would be provided to a non-affiliate.

        A bank's loans to its executive officers, directors, any owner of more than 10% of its stock (each, an "insider") and certain entities affiliated with any such person (an insider's "related interest") are subject to the conditions and limitations imposed by Section 22(h) of the Federal Reserve Act and the FRB's Regulation O. The aggregate amount of a bank's loans to any insider and the insider's related interests may not exceed the loans-to-one-borrower limit applicable to national banks. Aggregate loans by a bank to its insiders and insiders' related interests may not exceed the bank's unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus. With certain exceptions, such as education loans and certain residential mortgages, a bank's loans to its executive officers, may not exceed the greater of $25,000 or 2.5% of the bank's unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus, but in no event more than $100,000. Regulation O also requires that any loan to an insider or a related interest of an insider be approved in advance by a majority of the board of directors of the bank, with any interested director not participating in the voting, if the loan, when aggregated with any existing loans to that insider or the insider's related interests, would exceed the lesser or $500,000 or 5% of the bank's unimpaired capital and surplus. Generally, such loans must be made on substantially the same terms as, and follow credit underwriting procedures that are no less stringent than, those that are prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other persons and must not present more than a normal risk of collectability. An exception is made for extensions of credit made pursuant to a benefit or compensation plan of a bank that is widely available to employees of the bank and that does not give any preference to insiders of the bank over other employees of the bank. As of June 30, 2017, none of our insiders had any outstanding loans with the Bank.

        Enforcement.    The OCC has primary enforcement responsibility over federal savings banks and has authority to bring enforcement action against all "institution-affiliated parties," including directors, officers, shareholders, attorneys, appraisers and accountants who knowingly or recklessly participate in wrongful action likely to have an adverse effect on a federal savings bank. Formal enforcement action by the OCC may range from the issuance of a capital directive, formal agreement or cease and desist order to removal of officers and/or directors of the institution and the appointment of a receiver or

95


Table of Contents

conservator. Civil penalties cover a wide range of violations and actions, and range up to $25,000 per day, unless a finding of reckless disregard is made, in which case penalties may be as high as $1 million per day. The FDIC also has the authority to terminate deposit insurance or recommend to the OCC that enforcement action be taken with respect to a particular savings bank. If such action is not taken, the FDIC has authority to take the action under specified circumstances.

        Standards for Safety and Soundness.    Federal law requires each federal banking agency to prescribe certain standards for all insured depository institutions. These standards relate to, among other things, internal controls, information systems and audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate risk exposure, asset growth, compensation and other operational and managerial standards as the agency deems appropriate. Interagency guidelines set forth the safety and soundness standards that the federal banking agencies use to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions before capital becomes impaired. If the appropriate federal banking agency determines that an institution fails to meet any standard prescribed by the guidelines, the agency may require the institution to submit to the agency an acceptable plan to achieve compliance with the standard. If an institution fails to meet these standards, the appropriate federal banking agency may require the institution to implement an acceptable compliance plan. Failure to implement such a plan can result in further enforcement action, including the issuance of a cease and desist order or the imposition of civil money penalties.

        Interstate Banking and Branching.    Federal law permits well capitalized and well managed holding companies to acquire banks in any state, subject to Federal Reserve Board approval, certain concentration limits and other specified conditions. Interstate mergers of banks are also authorized, subject to regulatory approval and other specified conditions. In addition, among other things, certain amendments made by the Dodd-Frank Act permit banks to establish de novo branches on an interstate basis provided that branching is authorized by the law of the host state for the banks chartered by that state.

        Prompt Corrective Action.    Federal law requires, among other things, that federal bank regulators take "prompt corrective action" with respect to institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. For this purpose, the law establishes five capital categories: well capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized. The applicable OCC regulations were amended to incorporate the previously mentioned increased regulatory capital standards that were effective January 1, 2015. Under the amended regulations, an institution is deemed to be "well capitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a leverage ratio of 5.0% or greater and a common equity Tier 1 ratio of 6.5% or greater. An institution is "adequately capitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater, a leverage ratio of 4.0% or greater and a common equity Tier 1 ratio of 4.5% or greater. An institution is "undercapitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 8.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a leverage ratio of less than 4.0% or a common equity Tier 1 ratio of less than 4.5%. An institution is deemed to be "significantly undercapitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.0%, a leverage ratio of less than 3.0% or a common equity Tier 1 ratio of less than 3.0%. An institution is considered to be "critically undercapitalized" if it has a ratio of tangible equity (as defined in the regulations) to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%.

        At each successive lower capital category, an insured depository institution is subject to more restrictions and prohibitions, including restrictions on growth, restrictions on interest rates paid on deposits, restrictions or prohibitions on payment of dividends, and restrictions on the acceptance of brokered deposits. Furthermore, if an insured depository institution is classified in one of the undercapitalized categories, it is required to submit a capital restoration plan to the appropriate federal

96


Table of Contents

banking agency, and the holding company must guarantee the performance of that plan. Based upon its capital levels, a bank that is classified as well-capitalized, adequately capitalized, or undercapitalized may be treated as though it were in the next lower capital category if the appropriate federal banking agency, after notice and opportunity for hearing, determines that an unsafe or unsound condition, or an unsafe or unsound practice, warrants such treatment. An undercapitalized bank's compliance with a capital restoration plan is required to be guaranteed by any company that controls the undercapitalized institution in an amount equal to the lesser of 5.0% of the institution's total assets when deemed undercapitalized or the amount necessary to achieve the status of adequately capitalized. If an "undercapitalized" bank fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is "significantly undercapitalized." "Significantly undercapitalized" banks must comply with one or more of a number of additional restrictions, including but not limited to an order by the Federal Reserve Board to sell sufficient voting stock to become adequately capitalized, requirements to reduce total assets, cease receipt of deposits from correspondent banks or dismiss directors or officers, and restrictions on interest rates paid on deposits, compensation of executive officers and capital distributions by the parent holding company. "Critically undercapitalized" institutions are subject to additional measures including, subject to a narrow exception, the appointment of a receiver or conservator within 270 days after it obtains such status.

        At June 30, 2017, Sterling Bank met the criteria for being considered "well capitalized."

        Insurance of Deposit Accounts.    The Deposit Insurance Fund of the FDIC insures deposits at FDIC-insured financial institutions such as Sterling Bank. Deposit accounts in Sterling Bank are insured by the FDIC generally up to a maximum of $250,000 per separately insured depositor. The FDIC charges insured depository institutions premiums to maintain the Deposit Insurance Fund.

        Under the FDIC's risk-based assessment system, insured institutions are assigned to one of four risk categories based on supervisory evaluations, regulatory capital levels and certain other risk factors. Rates are based on each institution's risk category and certain specified risk adjustments. Institutions deemed to be less risky pay lower rates while institutions deemed riskier pay higher rates. Assessment rates (inclusive of possible adjustments) currently range from 21/2 to 45 basis points of each institution's total assets less tangible capital. The FDIC may increase or decrease the scale uniformly, except that no adjustment can deviate more than two basis points from the base scale without notice and comment rulemaking. The FDIC's current system represents a change, required by the Dodd-Frank Act, from its prior practice of basing the assessment on an institution's deposits.

        The Dodd-Frank Act increased the minimum target Deposit Insurance Fund ratio from 1.15% of estimated insured deposits to 1.35% of estimated insured deposits. The FDIC must seek to achieve the 1.35% ratio by September 30, 2020. Insured institutions with assets of $10 billion or more are supposed to fund the increase. The Dodd-Frank Act eliminated the 1.5% maximum fund ratio, instead leaving it to the discretion of the FDIC, which has exercised that discretion by establishing a long range fund ratio of 2%.

        The FDIC has authority to increase insurance assessments. Any significant increases could have an adverse effect on the operating expenses and results of operations of Sterling Bank. We cannot predict what assessment rates will be in the future.

        Insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that an institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC. We do not know of any practice, condition or violation that may lead to termination of our deposit insurance.

        In addition to the FDIC assessments, the Financing Corporation ("FICO") is authorized to impose and collect, with the approval of the FDIC, assessments for anticipated payments, issuance costs and custodial fees on bonds issued by the FICO in the 1980s to recapitalize the former Federal Savings and

97


Table of Contents

Loan Insurance Corporation. The bonds issued by the FICO are due to mature in 2017 through 2019. For the 1st quarter expense paid in the quarter ended June 30, 2017, the annualized FDIC assessment was equal to 5.28 basis points of total assets less tangible capital.

        Supervisory Assessments.    OCC-chartered banks are required to pay supervisory assessments to the OCC to fund its operations. The amount of the assessment paid by a federally-chartered bank to the OCC is calculated on the basis of the institution's total assets, including consolidated subsidiaries, as reported to the OCC. During the year ended December 31, 2016, the Bank paid supervisory assessments to the OCC totaling $390 thousand.

        Privacy Regulations.    Federal regulations generally require that Sterling Bank disclose its privacy policy, including identifying with whom it shares a customer's "non-public personal information," to customers at the time of establishing the customer relationship and annually thereafter. In addition, Sterling Bank is required to provide its customers with the ability to "opt-out" of having their personal information shared with unaffiliated third parties and not to disclose account numbers or access codes to non-affiliated third parties for marketing purposes. Sterling Bank currently has a privacy protection policy in place and believes that such policy is in compliance with the regulations.

        USA Patriot Act.    Sterling Bank is subject to the USA PATRIOT Act, which gives federal agencies additional powers to address terrorist threats through enhanced domestic security measures, expanded surveillance powers, increased information sharing, and broadened anti-money laundering requirements. The USA PATRIOT Act contains provisions intended to encourage information sharing among bank regulatory agencies and law enforcement bodies and imposes affirmative obligations on financial institutions, such as enhanced recordkeeping and customer identification requirements.

        Prohibitions Against Tying Arrangements.    Federal savings banks are prohibited, subject to some exceptions, from extending credit to or offering any other service, or fixing or varying the consideration for such extension of credit or service, on the condition that the customer obtain some additional service from the institution or its affiliates or not obtain services of a competitor of the institution.

Other Regulations

        Interest and other charges collected or contracted for by Sterling Bank are subject to state usury laws and federal laws concerning interest rates. Loan operations are also subject to state and federal laws applicable to credit transactions, such as the:

98


Table of Contents

        The deposit operations of Sterling Bank also are subject to, among others, the:

Federal Reserve System

        Under FRB regulations, Sterling Bank is required to maintain reserves at the Federal Reserve Bank against its transaction accounts, including checking and NOW accounts. The regulations currently require that reserves of 3% be maintained against aggregate transaction accounts over $15.5 million and 10% against that portion of total transaction accounts in excess of $115.1 million. The first $15.5 million of otherwise reservable balances are exempted from the reserve requirements. The Bank is in compliance with these requirements. The requirements are adjusted annually by the FRB. The FRB began paying interest on reserves in 2008, currently 1.25%.

Federal Home Loan Bank System

        Sterling Bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank System, which consists of 11 regional Federal Home Loan Banks. The Federal Home Loan Bank provides a central credit facility primarily for member institutions. Members of the Federal Home Loan Bank are required to acquire and hold shares of capital stock in the Federal Home Loan Bank. Sterling Bank was in compliance with this requirement at June 30, 2017. Based on redemption provisions of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis, the stock has no quoted market value and is carried at cost. Sterling Bank reviews for impairment, based on the ultimate recoverability, the cost basis of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Indianapolis stock. As of June 30, 2017, no impairment has been recognized.

Holding Company Regulation

        Sterling Bancorp is a unitary thrift holding company subject to regulation and supervision by the Federal Reserve Board. The Federal Reserve Board has enforcement authority over Sterling Bancorp and its non-savings institution subsidiaries. Among other things, this authority permits the Federal Reserve Board to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to be a risk to Sterling Bank.

        As a unitary thrift holding company, Sterling Bancorp's activities will be limited to those activities permissible by law for financial holding companies. A financial holding company may engage in activities that are financial in nature, incidental to financial activities or complementary to a financial activity. Such activities include lending and other activities permitted for bank holding companies under Section 4(c)(8) of the Bank Holding Company Act, insurance and underwriting equity securities.

        Federal law prohibits a unitary thrift holding company, directly or indirectly, or through one or more subsidiaries, from acquiring more than 5% of another savings institution or unitary thrift holding company without prior written approval of the Federal Reserve Board, and from acquiring or retaining control of any depository institution not insured by the FDIC. In evaluating applications by holding companies to acquire savings institutions, the Federal Reserve Board must consider such things as the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the company and institution involved, the effect of the acquisition on and the risk to the federal deposit insurance fund, the convenience and

99


Table of Contents

needs of the community and competitive factors. A unitary thrift holding company may not acquire a savings institution in another state and hold the target institution as a separate subsidiary unless it is a supervisory acquisition under Section 13(k) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act or the law of the state in which the target is located authorizes such acquisitions by out-of-state companies.

        Capital Requirements.    As a unitary thrift holding company, Sterling Bancorp is subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements that are similar to those that apply to Sterling Bank. See "Regulation and Supervision-Federal Banking Regulation-Capital Requirements."

        The Dodd-Frank Act extended the "source of strength" doctrine to unitary thrift holding companies. The Federal Reserve Board has promulgated regulations implementing the "source of strength" policy that require holding companies to act as a source of strength to their subsidiary depository institutions by providing capital, liquidity and other support in times of financial stress.

        The Federal Reserve Board has issued a policy statement regarding the payment of dividends and the repurchase of shares of common stock by bank holding companies and unitary thrift holding companies. In general, the policy provides that dividends should be paid only out of current earnings and only if the prospective rate of earnings retention by the holding company appears consistent with the organization's capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition. Regulatory guidance provides for prior regulatory consultation with respect to capital distributions in certain circumstances such as where the company's net income for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid over that period, is insufficient to fully fund the dividend or the company's overall rate of earnings retention is inconsistent with the company's capital needs and overall financial condition. The ability of a holding company to pay dividends may be restricted if a subsidiary bank becomes undercapitalized. The policy statement also states that a holding company should inform the Federal Reserve Board supervisory staff prior to redeeming or repurchasing common stock or perpetual preferred stock if the holding company is experiencing financial weaknesses or if the repurchase or redemption would result in a net reduction, as of the end of a quarter, in the amount of such equity instruments outstanding compared with the beginning of the quarter in which the redemption or repurchase occurred. These regulatory policies may affect the ability of Sterling Bancorp to pay dividends, repurchase shares of common stock or otherwise engage in capital distributions.

        In order for Sterling Bancorp to be regulated as a unitary thrift holding company by the Federal Reserve Board, rather than as a bank holding company, Sterling Bank must qualify as a "qualified thrift lender" under federal regulations or satisfy the "domestic building and loan association" test under the Internal Revenue Code. Under the qualified thrift lender test, a savings institution is required to maintain at least 65% of its "portfolio assets" (total assets less: (i) specified liquid assets up to 20% of total assets; (ii) intangible assets, including goodwill; and (iii) the value of property used to conduct business) in certain "qualified thrift investments" (primarily residential mortgages and related investments, including certain mortgage-backed and related securities) in at least nine out of each 12 month period. At June 30, 2017, Sterling Bank maintained 90.17% of its portfolio assets in qualified thrift investments and was in compliance with the qualified thrift lender requirement.

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

        The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is intended to improve corporate responsibility, to provide for enhanced penalties for accounting and auditing improprieties at publicly traded companies and to protect investors by improving the accuracy and reliability of corporate disclosures pursuant to the securities laws. We have policies, procedures and systems designed to comply with these regulations, and we review and document such policies, procedures and systems to ensure continued compliance with these regulations.

100


Table of Contents

Change in Control Regulations

        Under the Change in Bank Control Act, no person may acquire control of a unitary thrift holding company such as Sterling Bancorp unless the Federal Reserve Board has been given 60 days prior written notice and has not issued a notice disapproving the proposed acquisition, taking into consideration certain factors, including the financial and managerial resources of the acquirer and the competitive effects of the acquisition. Control, as defined under federal law, means ownership, control of or holding irrevocable proxies representing more than 25% of any class of voting stock, control in any manner of the election of a majority of the institution's directors, or a determination by the regulator that the acquiror has the power, directly or indirectly, to exercise a controlling influence over the management or policies of the institution. Acquisition of more than 10% of any class of a unitary thrift holding company's voting stock constitutes a rebuttable determination of control under the regulations under certain circumstances including where, as will be the case with Sterling Bancorp following this offering, the issuer has registered securities under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

        In addition, federal regulations provide that no company may acquire control of a unitary thrift holding company without the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board. Any company that acquires such control becomes subject to registration, examination and regulation by the Federal Reserve Board.

Emerging Growth Company Status

        The JOBS Act, which was enacted in April 2012, has made numerous changes to the federal securities laws to facilitate access to capital markets. Under the JOBS Act, a company with total annual gross revenues of less than $1.07 billion during its most recently completed fiscal year qualifies as an "emerging growth company." Sterling Bancorp, Inc. qualifies as an emerging growth company under the JOBS Act.

        An "emerging growth company" may choose not to hold shareholder votes to approve annual executive compensation (more frequently referred to as "say-on-pay" votes) or executive compensation payable in connection with a merger (more frequently referred to as "say-on-golden parachute" votes). An emerging growth company also is not subject to the requirement that its auditors attest to the effectiveness of the company's internal control over financial reporting, and can provide scaled disclosure regarding executive compensation. Finally, an emerging growth company may elect to comply with new or amended accounting pronouncements in the same manner as a private company, but must make such election when the company is first required to file a registration statement. Such an election is irrevocable during the period a company is an emerging growth company. Sterling Bancorp, Inc. has elected to comply with new or amended accounting pronouncements in the same manner as a public company.

        A company loses emerging growth company status on the earlier of: (i) the last day of the fiscal year of the company during which it had total annual gross revenues of $1.07 billion or more; (ii) the last day of the fiscal year of the issuer following the fifth anniversary of the date of the first sale of common equity securities of the company pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933; (iii) the date on which such company has, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt; or (iv) the date on which such company is deemed to be a "large accelerated filer" under Securities and Exchange Commission regulations (generally, at least $700 million of voting and non-voting equity held by non-affiliates).

101


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT

Our Directors and Executive Officers

        The following table states our directors' names, their ages as of June 30, 2017, the years that they began serving as directors and when their current term as directors of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. expires.

Name
  Position(s) With the Company   Age at
June 30,
2017
  Director
Since
  Expiration
of Term
 

Gary Judd

  Chairman, Chief Executive Officer     76     2008     2019  

Barry Allen

  Director     72     1998     2018  

Jon Fox

  Director     74     1997     2018  

Seth Meltzer

  Director     41     2000     2019  

Sandra Seligman

  Director     70     1984     2020  

Peter Sinatra

  Director     49     2008     2020  

Benjamin Wineman

  Director     41     2013     2019  

Lyle Wolberg

  Director     47     2017     2018  

        The following table sets forth information regarding our executive officers (other than Mr. Judd for whom information is provided above) and their ages as of the date of this prospectus. The executive officers of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. are appointed annually.

Name
  Position(s) With the Company   Age at
June 30,
2017
 

Thomas Lopp

  President, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Operating Officer     53  

Michael Montemayor

  President Commercial and Retail Banking, Chief Lending Officer     48  

The Business Background of Our Directors and Executive Officers

        The following is a brief discussion of the business and banking background and experience of our directors and executive officers for at least the past five years. With respect to directors, the biographies also contain information regarding the person's experience, qualifications, attributes or skills that led to the conclusion that the person should serve as a director. Unless otherwise indicated, directors and senior officers have held their positions for the past five years. Other than Seth Meltzer, who is the son of Sandra Seligman, the sister of the Bank's founder and the Company's Vice President, Scott Seligman, no director has any family relationship, as defined in Item 401 of Regulation S-K, with any other director and none have any family relationship with any of our executive officers.

        Barry Allen, Director.    Mr. Allen, CPA has served as a member of our Board since 1998. He has been a member of the board of directors, chairman of the audit committee, member of the loan committee, and member of the asset and liability committee of Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B. since 1998. Mr. Allen was the Regional Managing Partner, Owner, Member of the Management Committee, and Director of Baker Tilly Virchow Krause, LLP positions. Mr. Allen began his career at PriceWaterhouseCoopers, LLP as a junior accountant in 1969. He resigned in 1972 to found Barry Allen & Associates, P.C. and developed it into a prestigious boutique CPA and Tax Firm, providing services to small and medium sized companies. In 1982, he partnered with another firm and formed Nemes Allen & Company, PLLC, where he was Managing Partner until 2003. Mr. Allen served middle market companies and high net worth individuals. Mr. Allen has previously served on the Board of Directors and acted as Treasurer of Forgotten Harvest, a food rescue organization. Additionally, he served on the Board of Directors of Pathway Family Centers, an adolescent addiction and recovery center. He has a BBA from the University of Detroit, and is a certified public accountant. He also was a Certified Insolvency and Reorganization Accountant, and had a State of Michigan Insurance License

102


Table of Contents

in the past. He currently serves on the Board of the Riviera Dunes Marina Condominium Association as Treasurer, and on the Board of Legend Valve, Inc., a non-publicly traded company.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Allen should serve as a director because of his extensive experience in the business and financial world, as well as his particular expertise in accounting and management issues.

        Jon Fox, Director.    Mr. Fox has served as a member of our Board since 1997. Mr. Fox has forty-two years of financial experience, including twenty years of executive level commercial banking management experience. Mr. Fox was an advisor for PEM, a real estate holding company, a founder of the Americans for International Aid and Adoption, and a Director for the Community Housing Network since 1976. Previously, Mr. Fox was a Director of the Macomb Savings Bank, Mortgage Bankers Association, Kiwanis #1 (Detroit) from 1966 to 1967, and Clawson Manor from 1965 to 1967. Mr. Fox was also the Head of Commercial Lending in Detroit, Michigan at City National Bank in 1964, and was a prior Head of Commercial Real Estate Lending at Comerica. He was a board member of Ryan Homes from 1965 to 1967, the President of Fox Manor from 1967 to 1970, and an Advisor and Finance Committee member of Vista Maria from 1963 to 1965. He has a BS in Finance from Wayne State University.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Fox should serve as a director because of his significant financial and executive level commercial banking experience.

        Seth Meltzer, Director.    Mr. Meltzer has served as a member of our Board since October 2000. Mr. Meltzer has worked for the Seligman Group, a family owned real estate and investment company, as its President since 2001. Mr. Meltzer worked for various subsidiaries of the Seligman Group from 1991 to 1998. Mr. Meltzer interned at Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B. from 1993 until 1997. In 1998, Mr. Meltzer began work for Seligman & Associates, Inc. as its Vice President until his promotion to President. Mr. Meltzer led the Bank's initial development of online banking from 1998-2001. He has since ran the Seligman Group's management affiliate (Seligman Western Enterprises, Ltd.) from 2005 to date. Mr. Meltzer is a director of the Seligman Family Office and President/CEO of the Seligman Group. He is a director of both the Company and the Seligman Group. He has a BS in Finance from the University of Arizona.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Meltzer should serve as a director because of his investment expertise and deep historical knowledge of the Company. He helped guide the Bank through the 2008 financial crisis and was instrumental in curing Sterling's troubled asset and OREO portfolio. He currently chairs the Bank's ALCO Committee.

        Sandra Seligman, Director.    Ms. Seligman has served as a member of our Board since its inception. Ms. Seligman is a philanthropist, actively dedicating her professional time and expertise to the charitable communities of Greater Detroit, Miami, and New York City. Through the Seligman Family Foundation, Ms. Seligman contributes to the Mount Sinai Medical Center in Florida, the University of San Francisco Medical Center in California, the Beaumont Health System, and Wayne State University Medical School in Michigan. In addition to Sterling Bancorp and Sterling Bank and Trust, F.S.B. Board of Directors, where she has been a member of the boards since 1984. Ms. Seligman currently sits on the Board of Directors of the Wolfsonian-Florida International University, the Museum of Contemporary Art of Detroit, the Detroit Institute of Arts, and the Jewish Women's Foundation of the Jewish Federation of Detroit. She has a BS from Michigan State University.

        Our Board believes that Ms. Seligman should serve as a director because of her long term commitment to and experience with the Company. Additionally, Ms. Seligman's significant involvement with community and charitable groups brings unique insights to the Board.

103


Table of Contents

        Peter Sinatra, Director.    Mr. Sinatra has served as a member of our Board since 2004, as Chairman of our Compensation Committee since 2008, and as CEO of Quantum since 2010. Mr. Sinatra is also a Senior Managing Partner with The Seligman Group Family Office since 2004. He is a member of Seligman's Investment Committee, managing traditional and privately held investments in the community banking, commercial real estate, aerospace, film, and asset management industries since 2004. Prior to joining Seligman, Mr. Sinatra held leadership positions with Bank of America, N.A. in Divisional Sales Management from 1999 to 2004 and with Fidelity Investments in Product Management & Development from 1993 to 1999. Mr. Sinatra started his career at Arthur Andersen & Co. as a consultant in the financial services industry in 1991. Mr. Sinatra has served on numerous boards, including Sentient Flight Group from 2007 to 2009. He is a member of the CFA Institute, the Boston Security Analysts Society, the San Francisco Security Analysts Society, and the Investment Management Consultants Association (IMCA). Mr. Sinatra received his BA in Mathematics from College of the Holy Cross.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Sinatra should serve as a director because of his considerable experience in the financial, institutional asset and wealth management industries.

        Benjamin Wineman, Director.    Mr. Wineman has served as a member of our Board since 2013. Mr. Wineman has extensive commercial real estate and financial experience. Currently, Mr. Wineman is a Principal at Mid-America Real Estate Corporation, where he has worked since 2001. Mid-America is based in Chicago, Illinois, and is one of the companies within Mid-America Real Estate Group, a midwestern full-service retail real estate organization with offices in Chicago (downtown and suburban Oakbrook Terrace), Detroit, Milwaukee, and Minneapolis. Mr. Wineman co-leads Mid-America's Retail Investment Sales Group, focusing specifically on the disposition of shopping centers and retail properties throughout the greater Midwest region for institutional, REIT, and private owners. Prior to employment with Mid-America, Mr. Wineman worked at LaSalle Investment Management (JLL) as a Financial Analyst in the Private Equity Acquisitions Group, where he was responsible for the valuation, due diligence, and closing of commercial real estate transactions on behalf of its institutional pension fund clients from 1998 to 2001. Mr. Wineman graduated from DePauw University in 1998 with a Bachelor's of Arts Degree. Within the International Council of Shopping Centers (ICSC), he is a member of the Illinois State Committee and the Government Relations National Economic Policy Sub-Committee. Within the community, Mr. Wineman is a member of the Executive Committees of the Harold E. Eisenberg Foundation and the Ravinia Festival Associates Board, where he is the incoming Board President.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Wineman should serve as a director because of his extensive commercial real estate and financial experience.

        Lyle Wolberg, Director.    Mr. Wolberg joined our Board in August 2017. He is one of the founding partners of Telemus Capital Partners, a financial advisory firm he co-founded in 2005. Mr. Wolberg was a former Financial Advisor at Merrill Lynch from 1994 to 1997 and Senior Vice President-Investments at UBS Financial Services from 1999 to 2005. Mr. Wolberg has more than twenty-one years of industry experience across all facets of financial wealth planning and investment management. He is a certified financial planner. He also serves on the Executive Board of Temple Shir Shalom, is a trustee for the Children's Hospital of Michigan Foundation, and is Past President and Co-Founder of the Berkley Educational Foundation.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Wolberg should serve as a director because of his extensive experience in the financial and wealth management industries.

        Gary Judd, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer.    Mr. Judd has served as our chairman, and chief executive officer since August 2008. Additionally, he served as our president from August 2008 until December 2016. He began his banking career with Citibank, serving over fifteen years, including

104


Table of Contents

assignments over eight years in international banking based in New York, the Middle East, and India. Mr. Judd held positions in commercial lending, operations, treasury/foreign exchange, and country management. He held domestic positions in the Operating Group in New York, Citicorp, working on acquisitions in California, and ending as Citibank's Consumer Group's senior executive for Manhattan south of Forty Second Street. Mr. Judd was also responsible as a business manager for a large-scale consumer banking system development project. He then served as a general partner of Campbell Oil, Ltd., a private oil and gas exploration and production company in Denver, Colorado.

        Mr. Judd was co-founder, president, chief executive officer, and director of Vectra Bank. After its sale to Zions Bancorporation, he served as president, chief executive officer, and chairman of Vectra Bank Colorado and as a vice president of Zions Bancorporation, serving on its Executive Committee. Mr. Judd then served as president and director of Metyor, Inc., a technology start-up company based in Sydney, Australia, before returning to banking as a senior executive and director with WestStar Bank/Vail Banks, becoming president and chief executive officer in 2004. Following the sale of Vail Banks to U.S. Bank, he served as chairman of U.S. Bank's Denver, Colorado Board. He holds a M.A. from Johns Hopkins University School of Advanced International Studies.

        Our Board believes that Mr. Judd should serve as a director because he has broad banking and executive management experience spanning fifty years.

        Thomas Lopp, President, Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operations Officer.    Mr. Lopp was elected President in December 2016, and has served as Chief Operating Officer since September 2009, and as Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer since 2002. He has been a member of the Company since 1997. In 2015, he obtained additional responsibility as the executive in charge of the Southern California expansion. Prior to serving as our Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer, he served as the Director of the Consumer Loan Division from 2000 to 2002 and the Divisional Controller from 1997 to 2000. Prior to joining the Company in 1997, he served as a senior financial analyst at First of America Bank Corporation, credit card product manager at NBD Bank, N.A., and credit card portfolio analyst for Security Bancorp, Inc., later acquired by First of America Bank Corporation.

        Michael Montemayor, President Commercial and Retail Banking, Chief Lending Officer.    Mr. Montemayor has served as our Chief Lending Officer since 2006 and has been with the Company since 1992. He has also served as Executive Vice President from 2006 to 2016 and President of Commercial and Retail Banking from December 2016 to present and has also served as the Retail Branch Executive from 2013 to present. Prior to serving as our Chief Lending Officer he worked as Director of Commercial Lending from 2003 to his appointment as Chief Lending Officer in 2006, Commercial Loan Officer from 1995 to 1997, Construction Lending Manager from 1997 to 2003 and Branch Manager/Regional Branch Manager and Residential Lending Supervisor from 1993 to 1995.

Board Independence

        Following the completion of this offering, we expect to be a "controlled company" under the rules of Nasdaq because more than 50% of our outstanding voting power will be held by the Seligman family trustee. See "Principal and Selling Shareholders." We do not intend to rely upon the "controlled company" exception relating to the board of directors and committee independence requirements under the rules of Nasdaq. The "controlled company" exception does not modify the independence requirements for the audit committee, and we intend to comply with the audit committee requirements of the Exchange Act and the rules of Nasdaq. Absent the use of the "controlled company" exception, the rules of the NASDAQ Capital Market, independent directors must comprise a majority of our board of directors within a specified period of time of this offering. The rules of the NASDAQ Capital Market, as well as those of the SEC, also impose several other requirements with respect to the independence of our directors. Our board of directors has evaluated the independence of its members based upon the rules of the NASDAQ Capital Market and the SEC. Applying these standards, our

105


Table of Contents

board of directors has affirmatively determined that, with the exception of Mr. Judd, Mr. Sinatra, Mr. Meltzer and Ms. Seligman, each of our current directors is an independent director, as defined under the applicable rules.

Election and Classification of Directors

        In accordance with the terms of our charter, our board of directors is divided into three classes, Class I, Class II and Class III, with each class serving staggered three-year terms and is divided as follows:

Transactions With Certain Related Persons

        The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 generally prohibits publicly traded companies from making loans to their executive officers and directors, but it contains a specific exemption from the prohibition for loans made by federally insured financial institutions, such as Sterling Bank, to their executive officers and directors in compliance with federal banking regulations. At June 30, 2017, we had no outstanding loans to directors or executive officers.

Committees of the Board of Directors

        Our board of directors has established or will establish prior to the completion of this offering standing committees, including an Audit Committee, Compensation Committee, and a Nominating Committee. Each of these committees operates under a written charter, which governs its composition, responsibilities and operations. Our board of directors also may establish such other committees as it deems appropriate, in accordance with applicable law and regulations and our corporate governance documents.

        Audit Committee.    The Audit Committee assists the board of directors in fulfilling its responsibilities for general oversight of the integrity of our financial statements, compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, the independent auditors' qualifications and independence, and the performance of our internal audit and risk management function and independent auditors. Among other things, the Audit Committee:

        The Audit Committee works closely with management as well as our independent auditors. The Audit Committee has the authority to obtain advice and assistance from and receive appropriate

106


Table of Contents

funding to engage outside legal, accounting or other advisors as the Audit Committee deems necessary to carry out its duties.

        The Audit Committee is composed solely of members who satisfy the applicable independence and other requirements of the SEC and the NASDAQ Capital Market for Audit Committees and Mr. Allen is the Company's "audit committee financial expert" as such term is defined in applicable SEC regulations. The Audit Committee has adopted a written charter that among other things, specifies the scope of its rights and responsibilities. The charter will be available on our website upon commencement of this offering.

        Compensation Committee.    The Compensation Committee is responsible for discharging the board of directors' responsibilities relating to compensation of the executives and directors. Among other things, the Compensation Committee:

        The Compensation Committee has adopted a written charter that, among other things, specifies the scope of its rights and responsibilities. The charter will be available on our website upon commencement of this offering.

        Nominating Committee.    The Nominating Committee is responsible for making recommendations to our board of directors regarding candidates for directorships and the size and composition of our board of directors. In addition, the Nominating Committee is responsible for overseeing our corporate governance guidelines and reporting and making recommendations to our board of directors concerning governance matters. Among other things, the Nominating Committee:

        The written charter for our Nominating Committee will be available on our website upon commencement of this offering.

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

        Our board of directors will adopt a code of business conduct and ethics (our "Code of Ethics") that applies to all of our directors, officers and employees, including our principal executive officer,

107


Table of Contents

principal financial officer, principal accounting officer and persons performing similar functions. The Code of Ethics is available upon written request to our General Counsel, One Towne Square, Suite 1900, Southfield, Michigan 48076.

        If we amend or grant any waiver from a provision of our Code of Ethics that applies to our executive officers, we will publicly disclose such amendment or waiver on our website and as required by applicable law, including by filing a Current Report on Form 8-K.

108


Table of Contents


EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

        As an emerging growth company under the JOBS Act, we have opted to comply with the executive compensation disclosure rules applicable to "smaller reporting companies" as such term is defined in the rules promulgated under the Securities Act, which permit us to limit reporting of executive compensation to our principal executive officer and our two other most highly compensated executive officers, which are referred to as our "named executive officers."

        The compensation reported in the Summary Compensation Table below is not necessarily indicative of how we will compensate our named executive officers in the future. We will continue to review, evaluate and modify our compensation framework to maintain a competitive total compensation package. As such, and as a result of our becoming a publicly traded company, the compensation program following this offering could vary from our historical practices.

        Our named executive officers, which consist of our principal executive officer and the Company's two other most highly compensated executive officers, are:

Summary Compensation Table

        The following table sets forth information regarding the compensation paid, awarded to, or earned for our fiscal year ended December 31, 2016 for each of our named executive officers.

Name and Principal Position
  Year   Salary
($)
  Bonus
($)
  Change in
Pension Value and
Nonqualified Deferred
Compensation Earnings
($)
  Total
($)(1)
 

Gary Judd, Chief Executive Officer

    2016   $ 250,000   $ 350,000   $ 0   $ 600,000  

Thomas Lopp, President, COO and CFO

    2016   $ 168,701   $ 72,500   $ 28,159   $ 269,360  

Michael Montemayor, Chief Lending Officer

    2016   $ 166,586   $ 75,000   $ 38,296   $ 279,882  

(1)
Each named executive officer also received miscellaneous perquisites in amounts of less than $10,000 in 2016.

        No equity awards were granted to our named executive officers in 2016 and there were no outstanding equity awards as of December 31, 2016.

        The bonus amount set forth above with respect to Mr. Judd was determined pursuant to his employment agreement described below. With respect to Messrs. Lopp and Montemayor, bonuses are discussed by the Compensation Committee at the beginning of each fiscal year based on various performance metrics that are driven by the Company's annual strategic plan. Following determination of Company performance for the applicable year, Mr. Judd makes a recommendation to the Compensation Committee with respect to the appropriate bonus amounts for Messrs. Lopp and Montemayor in light of such results. The final bonus amount is then determined by the Compensation Committee. Following completion of its initial public offering, the Company anticipates that its Compensation Committee will review its compensation programs in light of customary public company practice, and its bonus criteria and determinations may materially differ in the near term.

Employment Agreements

        The Company and the Bank jointly entered into an employment agreement with Gary Judd, our Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, in July 2008, as amended. Under the terms of the

109


Table of Contents

agreement, Mr. Judd was initially entitled to an annual base salary of $225,000, which may be adjusted annually in the discretion of the Board. Mr. Judd was also entitled to an annual bonus in the discretion of the Board based upon the achievement of objectives set by the Board.

        The employment agreement may be terminated by either party, with or without cause, and due to death, disability and mutual agreement. If Mr. Judd is terminated for any reason, he is entitled to any base salary earned but not yet paid, any bonus awarded but not yet paid, reimbursement of business expenses incurred but not yet paid and any other benefits accrued and earned through the date of termination in accordance with applicable plans and programs of the Bank. If he is terminated without cause, in addition, he will be entitled to a continuation of his base salary, at the rate in effect on the date of his termination for a period of one year (the "Severance Period") and continued participation in benefit programs and plans and other benefits made available to employees of the Bank until the expiration of the Severance Period. In the event Mr. Judd is unable to participate in any employee benefit plan based on its terms, he will receive the economic equivalent of the benefits provided under the plan through the end of the Severance Period. The employment agreement also contains confidentiality and non-competition provisions.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

        None of our executive officers currently serves, or in the past year has served, as a member of the board of directors or compensation committee of any entity that has one or more executive officers serving on our board of directors or compensation committee.

Incentive Compensation Plans

        The Company does not currently have any equity compensation plans in place, but will adopt an equity incentive plan prior to closing the initial public offering, which is described below.

2017 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan

        The purposes of the Sterling Bancorp, Inc. Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan (the "Omnibus Plan") are to promote the interests of the Company and its shareholders by providing eligible employees, directors and consultants with additional incentives to remain with the Company and its subsidiaries, to increase their efforts to make the Company more successful, to reward such persons by providing an opportunity to acquire shares of common stock on favorable terms, and to attract and retain the best available personnel to participate in the ongoing business operations of the Company.

Shares Subject to the Omnibus Plan.

        Initially, there will be            shares of our common stock reserved for issuance under the Omnibus Plan. No awards have yet been granted under the Omnibus Plan. The common stock may be authorized, but unissued, or reacquired common stock.

Administration of the Omnibus Plan.

        The Omnibus Plan may be administered by the Compensation Committee or such other committee or individuals as appointed by the Board of Directors. Each committee shall have such authority and be responsible for such functions as the Board of Directors has assigned to it. Members of the committee shall serve for such period of time as the Board of Directors may determine and shall be subject to removal by the Board of Directors at any time. The Board of Directors may also at any time terminate the functions of the committee and reassume all powers and authorities previously delegated to the committee.

110


Table of Contents

Types of Awards.

        The Omnibus Plan provides for the award of incentive stock options, nonstatutory stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, stock appreciation rights, performance units and performance shares.

        Options.    The Omnibus Plan permits the granting of options to purchase shares of common stock intended to qualify as incentive stock options under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and also options to purchase shares of common stock that do not qualify as incentive stock options.

        An optionee, or a transferee of an optionee, shall have no rights as a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares of common stock made subject to an option unless and until such optionee exercises such option and is issued the shares purchased thereby. No adjustments shall be made for distributions, dividends, allocations, or other rights with respect to any shares of common stock prior to the exercise of such option.

        The terms of any option shall be set forth in an award agreement in such form as the committee shall from time to time determine, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Omnibus Plan. No Option shall have a term in excess of ten (10) years from the date that the option is granted. In no event shall the exercise price of any common stock made the subject of an option be less than the fair market value of such common stock, determined as of the date of the grant. Except as set forth otherwise in an award agreement, options will generally be forfeited upon a termination of a participant's employment or service for cause, and a participant will generally have up to the earlier of (i) three (3) months following the date services cease or the expiration of the date of the option to exercise any vested option for a termination for any reason other than cause, death or disability, and (ii) twelve (12) months or the expiration of the date of the option to exercise any vested option for a termination due to death or disability.

        Restricted Stock Awards.    The Omnibus Plan permits the granting of restricted stock awards, which are subject to such restrictions, conditions and other terms as the committee may determine in addition to those set forth in the Omnibus Plan.

        The committee may, at the time a grant is made, prescribe restrictions in addition to or other than time vesting, including the satisfaction of corporate or individual performance objectives, which shall be applicable to all or any portion of the restricted stock. None of the restricted stock may be sold, transferred, assigned, pledged or otherwise encumbered or disposed of prior to the date on which such restricted stock vests in accordance with the Omnibus Plan. Except as otherwise determined by the committee, prior to vesting, holders of restricted stock shall not have the right to vote such shares or the right to receive any dividends; and such shares shall be forfeited immediately and permanently in the event of termination. However, a participant shall become 100% vested in his or her restricted stock in the event he or she terminates employment by reason of death or disability.

        Restricted Stock Units.    The Omnibus Plan permits the granting of restricted stock units to be granted at any time as determined by the committee and subject to an award agreement for the participant. At any time after the grant of restricted stock units, the committee may reduce or waive any vesting criteria that must be met to receive a payout as long as such reduction or waiver does not violate Code Section 409A. The committee may award dividend equivalents in connection with the grant of restricted stock units that may be settled in cash, in shares of equivalent value, or in some combination thereof. All unearned restricted stock units will be forfeited to the Company, in accordance with the terms of the award agreement.

        Stock Appreciation Rights.    The Omnibus Plan permits the granting of stock appreciation rights ("SARs"), which are rights to receive a number of shares of common stock or, in the discretion of the committee, an amount in cash or a combination of shares of common stock and cash. The per share

111


Table of Contents

base price for exercise or settlement of SARs shall be determined by the committee, but shall be a price that is equal to or greater than the fair market value of such shares. Generally, the base price of SARs may not be reduced without shareholder approval. When a participant exercises his or her SARs, the stock options related to such SARs shall automatically be cancelled with respect to an equal number of underlying shares.

        Performance Awards.    Performance units and performance shares may also be granted under the Omnibus Plan. Performance units and performance shares are awards granted to eligible employees, consultants or outside directors at any time that will result in a payment to a participant only if performance goals established by the committee are achieved. Each performance share shall have an initial value equal to the fair market value of a share of common stock on the date of the grant. The committee shall set performance goals, which depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or value of performance units or shares that will be paid out to the participants. The committee may set performance objectives based upon the achievement of Company-wide, divisional, or individual goals, applicable federal or state securities laws, or any other basis determined by the committee.

        Payment of earned performance units or shares shall be made in a single lump sum, within a specified number of days following the close of the applicable performance period. Performance units and shares may not be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned, or otherwise alienated or hypothecated, other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution. Further, a participant's rights under the Omnibus Plan shall be exercisable during the participant's lifetime only by the participant or the participant's legal representative.

Adjustments.

        The committee will make appropriate adjustments in outstanding awards and the number of shares of common stock available for issuance under the Omnibus Plan should any change be made to the common stock by reason of any stock split, reverse stock split, stock dividend, recapitalization, combination of shares, exchange of shares or other change affecting the outstanding common stock as a class without the Company's receipt of consideration.

Amendments and Termination.

        The Omnibus Plan will become effective on the date of its adoption by the Board of Directors. Unless earlier terminated, the Omnibus Plan shall terminate automatically ten (10) years after its adoption only with respect to the Company's ability to grant incentive stock options under the Omnibus Plan. The Board of Directors may terminate or amend the Omnibus Plan at any time and for any reason, in its discretion; however, certain amendments, including amendments that increase the number of shares of common stock available for issuance under the Omnibus Plan or change the class of persons who are eligible for the grant of incentive stock options, shall be subject to the approval of the Company's shareholders. Amendments will be submitted for shareholder approval to the extent necessary and desirable to comply with applicable laws.

Change in Control.

        In the event that the Company is a party to a change of control, generally, outstanding awards that are not yet vested shall be subject to the agreement of merger or consolidation or asset sale. With regard to options, the committee, in its discretion may provide that options shall become 100% vested and exercisable on the date of the change of control. However, each option that is assumed or otherwise continued in effect in connection with a change of control shall be appropriately adjusted, immediately after such change of control to apply to the number and class of securities which would have been issuable to the optionee in connection with the consummation of such change of control had

112


Table of Contents

the option been exercised immediately prior to such change of control. With respect to restricted stock, a participant shall be 100% vested on the date of a change of control.

Forfeiture Provision.

        To the extent an award of our common stock expires, is surrendered pursuant to an exchange program or becomes unexercisable without having been exercised, forfeited to or repurchased by the Company due to failure to vest, the unpurchased shares will become available for future grant or sale under the Omnibus Plan, unless the Omnibus Plan has terminated. Notwithstanding the foregoing (and except with respect to shares of restricted stock that are forfeited rather than vesting), shares that have actually been issued under the Omnibus Plan under any award will not be returned to the Omnibus Plan and will not become available for future distribution under the Omnibus Plan; provided, however, that if shares issued pursuant to awards granted under the Omnibus Plan are repurchased by or are forfeited to the Company, such shares will become available for future grant under the Omnibus Plan. Shares used to pay the exercise price of an award or to satisfy the tax withholding obligations related to an award will become available for future grant or sale under the Omnibus Plan. To the extent an award under the Omnibus Plan is paid out in cash rather than shares, such cash payment will not result in reducing the number of shares available for issuance under the Omnibus Plan.

Director Compensation

        The following table sets forth for the year ended December 31, 2016 certain information as to total compensation paid to non-employee directors. Mr. Judd did not receive any additional compensation for service on the Board or the Bank's board of directors. In addition, Mr. Wolberg was appointed to the Board in August of 2017 and is not included in the table below.

Name
  Fees Earned or
Paid in Cash
($)
  Stock Awards
($)
  Total
($)
 

Barry Allen

  $ 33,500     0   $ 33,500  

Jon Fox

  $ 33,500     0   $ 33,500  

Seth Meltzer

    0     0     0  

Sandra Seligman

    0     0     0  

Peter Sinatra

    0     0     0  

Benjamin Wineman

  $ 32,500     0   $ 32,500  

Director Fees

        Board members of the Company receive fees for board and committee meetings attended. Board members currently receive $1,250 for each Board meeting, $250 for each committee meeting attended, and $500 for each committee meeting chaired. In 2016, Board fees were $1,000 per meeting and $250 for each committee meeting.

113


Table of Contents


CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

        In addition to the compensation arrangements with directors and executive officers described in "Executive Compensation" above, the following is a description of transactions since January 1, 2016, to which we have been a party in which the amount involved exceeded or will exceed $120,000, and in which any of our directors, executive officers or beneficial holders of more than five percent of our capital stock, or their immediate family members or entities affiliated with them, had or will have a direct or indirect material interest.

Policies and Procedures Regarding Related Party Transactions

        Transactions by the Company or Bank with related parties are subject to certain regulatory requirements and restrictions, including Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act (which govern certain transactions by the Bank with its affiliates) and the Federal Reserve's Regulation O (which governs certain loans by the Bank to its executive officers, directors and principal shareholders). Both the Company and the Bank have Affiliate Transactions Policies. The Affiliate Transaction Policy limits covered transactions with any single affiliate to less than 10%, and with all affiliates, to less than 20%, of unimpaired capital and surplus. All covered transactions with affiliates must be made on terms and conditions that are consistent with safe and sound banking practices, and require appropriate security. Neither the Company nor the Bank may purchase low-quality assets from an affiliate. Transactions between the Company or Bank and affiliates must be made on terms and under circumstances that are substantially the same, or at least as favorable to the Company or the Bank, respectively, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with unaffiliated companies. All service agreements are reviewed annually. No loans or extensions of credit will be made to an affiliate unless the affiliate is engaged in activities that a bank holding company may conduct.

        The Bank's Regulation O Policy requires any extension of credit to insiders be on the same terms as, and following the same underwriting procedures, as those in place for non-insider customers. The Board of Directors must approve any loan to an insider which does not qualify as an exception and that causes the aggregate of loans outstanding to that individual and any related interests of that individual to exceed $25,000, or 5%, of the Bank's capital. The aggregate of all loans to insiders shall not exceed 5% of the Bank's equity capital. As for executive officers of the Bank, general purpose loans may not exceed $100,000 in the aggregate or 2.5% of capital, whichever is less, and all such loans must be reported to the Board of Directors. All loans to directors and officers, including renewals, require the prior approval of the Board of Directors with the exception of mortgage loans on an officer or director's primary residence when made in accordance with underwriting standards acceptable to the secondary market. All insiders are identified on an annual basis, and are required to submit an annual report of borrowings from the Bank.

        Our Board of Directors will adopt a related person transactions policy, effective upon consummation of this offering, pursuant to which our executive officers, directors and principal shareholders, including their immediate family members, will not be permitted to enter into a related person transaction with us without the consent of our Audit Committee, another independent committee of our board or the full board. Any request for us to enter into a transaction with an executive officer, director, principal shareholder or any of such persons' immediate family members, in which the amount involved exceeds $120,000, will be required to be presented to our Audit Committee for review, consideration and approval. All of our directors, executive officers and employees will be required to report to our Audit Committee any such related person transaction. In approving or rejecting the proposed transaction, our Audit Committee will take into account, among other factors it deems appropriate, whether the proposed related person transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third-party under the same or similar circumstances, the extent of the related person's interest in the transaction and, if applicable, the impact on a director's independence. Under the policy, if we should discover related person transactions that have not been

114


Table of Contents

approved, our Audit Committee will be notified and will determine the appropriate action, including ratification, rescission or amendment of the transaction.

Indemnification of Officers and Directors

        Our amended and restated bylaws will generally require us to indemnify our officers and directors to the fullest extent permitted by law, and to advance expenses incurred by our directors and officers prior to the final disposition of any action or proceeding arising by reason of the fact that any such person is or was our agent. In addition, our amended and restated bylaws will permit us to provide such other indemnification and advancement of expenses to our other employees and agents as permitted by law and authorized by the Board from time to time. We will also have the power to secure insurance on behalf of any director, officer, employee or other agent for any liability arising out of his or her status as such, regardless of whether we would have the power to indemnify such person against such liability pursuant to our amended and restated bylaws.

Related-Party Transactions

        The Bank has a sublease agreement with Seligman & Associates ("S&A") for office space, plus related expenses, in Southfield, MI at an annual amount of $16,012 for 2017. The Bank also reimburses S&A for usage of the S&A Bloomberg terminal and other miscellaneous expenses.

        The Bank leases 7,560 square feet of warehouse space from S&A at 1630 Thorncroft in Troy, MI at an annual base rent of $39,236 for 2017. In addition to the lease amount, the Bank reimburses S&A for a proportionate share of certain expenses, such as property tax, utilities, snow removal and lawn care. The Bank directly reimburses S&A for long-distance telephone carrier access.

        The Bank leases office space from Transamerica Pyramid Properties, LLC in San Francisco under the lease agreement dated August 26, 2016. In turn, the Bank subleases 75% of that space to Pioneer Realty, a subsidiary of S&A, at an annual base rent amount of $254,775 for 2017.

        The Bank also subleases storage space at 545 Sansome Street from Pioneer Realty, an affiliate of S&A, for an annual base rent amount of $3,000 for 2017.

        From time to time, the Company makes charitable donations to the Seligman Family Foundation, including $900 thousand in 2016 and $600 thousand through August 31, 2017. Ms. Seligman and Mr. Meltzer are members of the Board of Trustees of the Seligman Family Foundation.

        Sandra Seligman is a Director of the Company and the Bank and is the sister of the Bank's founder, Scott J. Seligman. In 2016 and 2017 to date Sandra Seligman did not receive compensation for her service to the Board of Directors or any other compensation from the Company.

        Seth Meltzer is a Director of the Company and the Bank and is the son of Sandra Seligman. In 2016 and 2017 to date, Mr. Meltzer did not receive compensation for his service to the Board of Directors or any other compensation from the Company.

        In April 2017, the Bank acquired 100% of the assets of Quantum, an investment advisory company, from related entities of the Company, including Mr. Sinatra, a member of the Board. The purchase price of $2.9 million was derived from a valuation performed by Plante & Moran, LLC, an independent public accounting firm. In addition to a payment of $584 thousand for his 20% equity stake in Quantum, Mr. Sinatra has received salary compensation of $192 thousand in his role as CEO of Quantum from the closing of the acquisition through August 31, 2017 pursuant to a pre-existing employment agreement between Quantum and Mr. Sinatra.

115


Table of Contents


PRINCIPAL AND SELLING SHAREHOLDERS

        The following table sets forth information as of August 31, 2017 regarding the beneficial ownership of our common stock, and as adjusted to reflect the completion of this offering:

        We have determined beneficial ownership in accordance with the rules of the SEC. These rules generally provide that a person is the beneficial owner of securities if such person has or shares the power to vote or direct the voting of securities, or to dispose or direct the disposition of securities, or has the right to acquire such powers within 60 days. Except as disclosed in the footnotes to this table and subject to applicable community property laws, we believe that each person identified in the table has sole voting and investment power over all of the shares shown opposite such person's name.

        The percentage of beneficial ownership is based on 45,271,000 shares of our common stock outstanding as of August 31, 2017 and                        shares to be outstanding after the completion of this offering (or                        shares if the underwriter exercises its purchase option in full). The information in the table below assumes that 5,072,000 outstanding shares of our non-voting common stock will become voting common stock, to be effected prior to the completion of this offering.

116


Table of Contents

        Unless otherwise indicated, the address for each listed shareholder is: c/o Sterling Bancorp, Inc., One Towne Square, Suite 1900, Southfield, Michigan 48076.

 
   
   
   
  Shares Beneficially Owned After the Offering  
 
  Shares Beneficially
Owned as of
August 31, 2017
   
 
 
   
   
  Percent,
assuming no
exercise of
underwriter's
purchase option
  Percent,
assuming full
exercise of
underwriter's
purchase option
 
Name and Address of Beneficial Owner
  Number of
Shares
  Percent   Shares to be
Sold in the
Offering
  Number of
Shares
 

Directors:

                                     

Barry Allen

                                 

Jon Fox

                                 

Seth Meltzer(1)

    1,882,000     4.2 %                        

Sandra Seligman(2)

                                 

Peter Sinatra

                                 

Benjamin Wineman

                                 

Lyle Wolberg

                                 

Named Executive Officers:

                                     

Gary Judd

    169,000                              

Thomas Lopp

                                 

Michael Montemayor

                                 

All directors and executive officers as a group (10 persons total)

    2,051,000     4.5 %                        

5% Shareholders:

                                     

Scott J. Seligman 1993 Irrevocable Dynasty Trust(3)

    2,992,000     6.6 %                        

Scott J. Seligman 1993 Long Term Irrevocable Dynasty Trust(4)

    7,288,000     16.1 %                        

K.I.S.S. Dynasty Trust No. 9(5)

    15,871,000     35.1 %                        

K.I.S.S. Dynasty Trust No. 5(6)

    9,526,000     21.0 %                        

Erwin A. Rubenstein(7)

    37,547,000     82.9 %                        

Scott J. Seligman Revocable Living Trust(8)

    4,684,000     10 %                        

Other Selling Shareholders:

                                     

Rachel S. Meltzer Revocable Living Trust

    989,000     2.2 %                        

Sandra Seligman 1993 Long Term Irrevocable Trust(9)

    1,870,000     4.1 %                        

(1)
Consists of 1,882,000 shares of common stock of the Company that are held by The Seth Seligman Meltzer Revocable Living Trust.

(2)
Excludes 9,526,000 shares of common stock held by the K.I.S.S. Dynasty Trust No. 5 and 1,870,000 shares held by the Sandra Seligman 1993 Long Term Irrevocable Trust, for which in each case Ms. Seligman is the grantor, but has no voting or dispositive power over the shares held in such trust.

(3)
Consists of 2,992,000 shares of common stock of the Company that are held by the trust, as to which Mr. Seligman disclaims beneficial ownership except to the extent of his pecuniary interest, if any, therein.

(4)
Consists of 7,288,000 shares of common stock of the Company that are held by the trust, as to which Mr. Seligman disclaims beneficial ownership except to the extent of his pecuniary interest, if any, therein.

(5)
Consists of 15,871,555 shares of common stock of the Company that are held by the trust, as to which Mr. Seligman disclaims beneficial ownership except to the extent of his pecuniary interest, if any, therein.

(6)
Consists of 9,526,000 shares of common stock of the Company that are held by the trust, as to which Ms. Seligman disclaims beneficial ownership except to the extent of her pecuniary interest, if any, therein.

(7)
Consists of shares owned by the Scott J. Seligman 1993 Irrevocable Dynasty Trust, Scott J. Seligman 1993 Long Term Irrevocable Dynasty Trust, K.I.S.S. Dynasty Trust No. 9, K.I.S.S. Dynasty Trust No. 5 and Sandra Seligman 1993 Long Term Irrevocable Trust holding an aggregate of 82.9% of the voting common stock in the Company. Mr. Rubenstein, trustee to the Seligman family, holds sole voting and dispositive power over shares held by such trusts.

(8)
Mr. Scott J. Seligman, vice president of the Company and founder of the Bank, holds sole voting and dispositive power over shares held by this trust.

(9)
Consists of 1,870,000 shares of common stock of the Company that are held in trust, as to which Ms. Seligman disclaims beneficial ownership except to the extent of her pecuniary interest, if any, therein.

117


Table of Contents


DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

        The following discussion is a summary of the terms of our capital stock and our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws following certain amendments that we intend to make in connection with this offering, as well as certain applicable provisions of Michigan law. Forms of our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws as they will be in effect following this offering have been filed as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.

Authorized Capitalization

        Our authorized capital stock currently consists of 490,000,000 shares of common stock, 10,000,000 shares of non-voting common stock and 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock. The following description summarizes certain important terms of our capital stock, as they are expected to be in effect immediately prior to the completion of this offering. We expect to amend our existing restated articles of incorporation and bylaws such that they will reflect the descriptions of those charter documents below. Because it is only a summary, it does not contain all the information that may be important to you. For a complete description of the matters set forth in this section titled "Description of Capital Stock," you should refer to our second amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws, which are included as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part, and to the applicable provisions of Michigan law. Immediately following the completion of this offering, our authorized capital stock will consist of 500,000,000 shares of common stock, no value per share, and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock.

Common Stock

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation authorizes us to issue up to 500,000,000 shares of common stock.

        Each holder of our common stock is entitled to one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of the shareholders, including the election of directors. Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws do not provide for cumulative voting rights. As a result, the holders of a majority of the shares entitled to vote in any election of directors are able to elect all of the directors standing for election, if they should so choose.

        Subject to preferences that may be applicable to any then outstanding preferred stock, the holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by the Board out of legally available funds.

        In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, holders of our common stock are entitled to share ratably in the net assets legally available for distribution to shareholders after the payment of all of our debts and other liabilities, subject to the satisfaction of any liquidation preference granted to the holders of any outstanding shares of preferred stock.

        Holders of our common stock have no preemptive, conversion or subscription rights, and there are no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to our common stock. The rights, preferences and

118


Table of Contents

privileges of our common stock are subject to, and may be adversely affected by, the rights, preferences and privileges of any series of preferred stock that we may issue in the future.

        All of our outstanding shares are, and the shares to be issued in this offering will be, duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

Preferred Stock

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation authorize us to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock in one or more series. Our Board is authorized, subject to limitations prescribed by Michigan law, to issue preferred stock in one or more series, to establish from time to time the number of shares to be included in each series and to fix the designation, powers, preferences and rights of the shares of each series and any of its qualifications, limitations or restrictions, in each case without further vote or action by our shareholders. Our Board can also increase or decrease the number of shares of any series of preferred stock, but not below the number of shares of that series then outstanding, without any further vote or action by our shareholders. Our Board may authorize the issuance of preferred stock with voting or conversion rights that could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of our common shares. The issuance of preferred stock, while providing flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions and other corporate purposes, could, among other things, have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our Company and might adversely affect the market price of our common stock and the voting and other rights of the holders of our common stock.

Anti -Takeover Effects of Certain Provisions of Our Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws and Michigan Law

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws contain certain provisions that could have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing another party from acquiring control of us, and therefore could adversely affect the market price of our common stock. These provisions and certain provisions of the Michigan Business Corporation Act (as it may be amended from time to time, the "MBCA"), which are summarized below, may also discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids, and are designed, in part, to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to negotiate first with the Board. We believe that the benefits of increased protection of our potential ability to negotiate more favorable terms with an unfriendly or unsolicited acquirer outweigh the disadvantages of potentially discouraging a proposal to acquire us.

        Our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws contain provisions that:

119


Table of Contents

        The provisions of our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws could have the effect of discouraging others from attempting hostile takeovers and, as a consequence, they might also inhibit temporary fluctuations in the market price of our common stock that often result from actual or rumored hostile takeover attempts. These provisions might also have the effect of preventing changes in our management. It is possible that these provisions could make it more difficult to accomplish transactions that our shareholders might otherwise deem to be in their best interests.

        We may also opt-in to the provisions of Chapter 7A of the MBCA. In general, subject to certain exceptions, Chapter 7A of the MBCA prohibits a Michigan corporation from engaging in a "business combination" with an "interested shareholder" for a period of five years following the date that such shareholder became an interested shareholder, unless: (i) prior to such date, the board of directors approved the business combination; or (ii) on or subsequent to such date, the business combination is approved by at least 90% of the votes of each class of the corporation's stock entitled to vote and by at least two-thirds of such voting stock not held by the interested shareholder or such shareholder's affiliates. The MBCA defines a "business combination" to include certain mergers, consolidations, dispositions of assets or shares and recapitalizations. An "interested shareholder" is defined by the MBCA to include a beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of 10% or more of the voting power of the outstanding voting shares of the corporation. While our Board to date has not elected to opt-in to these provisions, any future decision to do so could have an anti-takeover effect.

Limitation on Liability and Indemnification of Officers and Directors

        Our second amended and restated articles eliminate the liability of our directors for monetary damages to the fullest extent under the MBCA and other applicable law. The MBCA permits a corporation to eliminate or limit a director's liability to the corporation or its shareholders for money damages for any action taken or any failure to take any action as a director, except liability for:

120


Table of Contents

        The limitation of liability in our second amended and restated articles of incorporation does not affect the availability of equitable remedies such as injunctive relief or rescission, nor will it limit the liability of our directors under federal securities laws.

        Our amended and restated bylaws generally require us to indemnify our officers and directors to the fullest extent permitted by law, and to advance expenses incurred by our directors and officers prior to the final disposition of any action or proceeding arising by reason of the fact that any such person is or was our agent. In addition, our amended and restated bylaws permit us to provide such other indemnification and advancement of expenses to our other employees and agents as permitted by law and authorized by the Board from time to time. We also have the power to secure insurance on behalf of any director, officer, employee or other agent for any liability arising out of his or her status as such, regardless of whether we would have the power to indemnify such person against such liability pursuant to our amended and restated bylaws.

        The limitation of liability and indemnification provisions in our second amended and restated articles of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws may discourage our shareholders from bringing lawsuits against our directors for breach of their fiduciary duties. They may also reduce the likelihood of derivative litigation against our directors and officers, even though an action, if successful, might benefit us and our shareholders. A shareholder's investment may be harmed to the extent we pay the costs of settlement and damage awards against directors and officers pursuant to these indemnification provisions.

        At present, there is no pending litigation or proceeding involving any of our directors or executive officers as to which indemnification is required or permitted, and we are not aware of any threatened litigation or proceeding that may result in a claim for indemnification.

Choice of Forum

        Our amended and restated bylaws provides that the courts of the State of Michigan located in Oakland County and the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Michigan will be the exclusive forum for: any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf; any action asserting a claim of breach of fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors, officers or employees to us or our shareholders; any action asserting a claim against us arising pursuant to the MBCA; or any actions asserting a claim otherwise governed by the State of Michigan's internal affairs doctrine. The enforceability of similar choice of forum provisions has been challenged in legal proceedings, and it is possible that a court could find these types of provisions to be inapplicable or unenforceable.

Transfer Agent and Registrar

        The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is                .

Listing

        We expect our common stock to be approved for listing on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the symbol "            ."

121


Table of Contents


SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

        Prior to this offering, there has been no established public market for our common stock. Future sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that such sales may occur, could adversely affect market prices prevailing from time to time. Furthermore, because only a limited number of shares will be available for sale shortly after this offering due to existing contractual and legal restrictions on resale as described below, there may be sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market after the restrictions lapse. This may adversely affect the prevailing market price and our ability to raise equity capital in the future.

        Upon completion of this offering, we will have               shares of common stock outstanding (or               shares if the underwriter exercises its purchase option in full). Of these shares,               shares of our common stock (or               shares if the underwriter exercises its purchase option in full) sold in this offering will be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, except for any shares purchased by our "affiliates," as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. The remaining               shares of our common stock (or               shares if the underwriter exercises its purchase option in full) outstanding are "restricted shares" as defined in Rule 144. Restricted shares may be sold in the public market only if registered under the Securities Act or if they qualify for an exemption from registration under Rule 144. As a result of the contractual 180-day lock-up period described below,              of these shares will be available for sale in the public market only after 180 days from the date of this prospectus (generally subject to volume and other offering limitations).

Rule 144

        In general, a person who has beneficially owned restricted shares of our common stock for at least six months would be entitled to sell such securities, provided that (i) such person is not deemed to have been one of our affiliates at the time of, or at any time during the 90 days preceding, the sale and (ii) we are subject to the Exchange Act periodic reporting requirements for at least 90 days before the sale. Persons who have beneficially owned restricted shares of our common stock for at least six months but who are our affiliates at the time of, or any time during the 90 days preceding, the sale, would be subject to additional restrictions, by which such person would be entitled to sell within any three-month period only a number of securities that does not exceed the greater of the following:

provided, in each case, that we are subject to the Exchange Act periodic reporting requirements for at least 90 days before the sale. Such sales both by affiliates and by non-affiliates must also comply with the manner of sale and notice provisions of Rule 144 to the extent applicable.

        Additionally, a person who is not deemed to be, or have been, at any time during the three months preceding a sale, our affiliate, and who has beneficially owned for at least one year shares of our common stock that are restricted securities, will be entitled to freely sell such shares of our common stock under Rule 144 without regard to the current public information requirements of Rule 144.

122


Table of Contents

Registration Statement on Form S-8

        In connection with or as soon as practicable following the completion of this offering, we intend to file a registration statement with the SEC on Form S-8 to register an aggregate of               shares of our common stock reserved for future issuance under our equity incentive plans, as described further under "Executive Compensation—Incentive Compensation Plans." That registration statement will become effective upon filing and shares of common stock covered by such registration statement will be eligible for sale in the public market immediately after the effective date of such registration statement (unless held by affiliates) subject to the lock-up agreements described below.

Lock-up Agreements

        We, the selling shareholders and each of our directors and executive officers and certain other persons have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not to offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of, otherwise dispose of or transfer any shares of our common stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for common stock for a period of 180 days after the date of this prospectus, without the prior written consent of Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P. See "Underwriting." The underwriter does not have any present intention or arrangement to release any shares of our common stock subject to lock-up agreements prior to the expiration of the 180-day lock-up period.

123


Table of Contents


CERTAIN MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF COMMON STOCK

        The following is a discussion of certain material United States federal income tax consequences relevant to non-U.S. holders, as defined below, of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our common stock. The following summary is based on current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, Treasury regulations and judicial and administrative authority, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. This section does not consider state, local, estate or foreign tax consequences, nor does it address tax consequences to special classes of investors including, but not limited to, tax-exempt organizations, insurance companies, banks or other financial institutions, partnerships or other entities classified as partnerships for United States federal income tax purposes, dealers in securities, persons liable for the alternative minimum tax, traders in securities that elect to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for their securities holdings, persons who have acquired our common stock as compensation or otherwise in connection with the performance of services, or persons that will hold our common stock as a position in a hedging transaction, "straddle," "conversion transaction" or other risk reduction transaction. Tax consequences may vary depending upon the particular status of an investor. The summary is limited to non-U.S. holders who will hold our common stock as "capital assets" (generally, property held for investment). Investors should consult their tax advisors concerning the U.S. federal income tax consequences in light of their own specific situation, as well as consequences arising under other federal tax laws (such as the federal estate, gift or Medicare tax laws) and the laws of any other taxing jurisdiction.

        As used herein, a "U.S. holder" is:

        A "non-U.S. holder" is an individual, corporation, estate or trust that is not a U.S. holder. Special rules may apply to certain non-U.S. holders such as controlled foreign corporations, passive foreign investment companies, expatriated entities subject to Section 7874 of the Code, and, in certain circumstances, individuals who are U.S. expatriates. Consequently, non-U.S. holders should consult their tax advisors to determine the U.S. federal, state, local, non-U.S. and other tax consequences that may be relevant to them in light of their particular circumstances.

        If an entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for United States federal income tax purposes holds our common stock, the tax treatment of a partner in the partnership will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. If you are treated as a partner in such an entity holding our common stock, you should consult your tax advisor as to the United States federal income tax consequences applicable to you.

Distributions

        Distributions with respect to our common stock will be treated as dividends when paid to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits as determined for United States federal income tax purposes. Except as described below, if you are a non-U.S. holder of our shares, dividends

124


Table of Contents

paid to you are subject to withholding of United States federal income tax at a 30% rate or at a lower rate if you are eligible for the benefits of an income tax treaty that provides for a lower rate. Even if you are eligible for a lower treaty rate, we and other payors will generally be required to withhold at a 30% rate (rather than the lower treaty rate) on dividends paid to you, unless you have furnished to us or another payor:

        If you are eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax under a tax treaty, you may obtain a refund of any amounts withheld in excess of that rate by timely filing a refund claim with the Internal Revenue Service.

        If dividends paid to you are "effectively connected" with your conduct of a trade or business within the United States, or, if required by a tax treaty, the dividends are attributable to a permanent establishment that you maintain in the United States, we and other payors generally are not required to withhold tax from the dividends, provided that you have furnished to us or another payor a valid Internal Revenue Service Form W-8ECI or an acceptable substitute form upon which you represent, under penalties of perjury, that:

        "Effectively connected" dividends are taxed at rates applicable to United States citizens, resident aliens and domestic United States corporations. If you are a corporate non-U.S. holder, "effectively connected" dividends that you receive may, under certain circumstances, be subject to an additional "branch profits tax" at a 30% rate or at a lower rate if you are eligible for the benefits of an income tax treaty that provides for a lower rate.

        To the extent any portion of a distribution on our common stock is not from current or accumulated earnings and profits, it will be considered a return of capital for tax purposes and will reduce the tax basis of your investment. A distribution that exceeds the current and accumulated earnings and profits and the tax basis of your shares will be treated as gain or loss from the sale or exchange of your shares. Any such distributions will be subject to withholding tax in the same manner as dividends, unless the IRS issues a withholding certificate authorizing a reduced rate or an exemption from withholding.

Sale or Redemption

        Subject to the discussion of backup withholding and foreign accounts below, if you are a non-U.S. holder, you generally will not be subject to United States federal income or withholding tax on gain realized on the sale, exchange or other disposition of our common stock unless the gain is "effectively connected" with your conduct of a trade or business in the United States or the gain is attributable to a permanent establishment that you maintain in the United States, if that is required by an applicable income tax treaty as a condition to subjecting you to United States taxation on a net income basis. In

125


Table of Contents

certain circumstances, redemption of our stock will be characterized as a dividend for United States income tax purposes and will be taxed under the rules described in the preceding section.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

        Payment of dividends, and the tax withheld on those payments, are subject to information reporting requirements. These information reporting requirements apply regardless of whether withholding was reduced or eliminated by an applicable income tax treaty. Under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty or agreement, copies of the information returns reporting such dividends and withholding may also be made available to the tax authorities in the country in which the non-U.S. holder resides. U.S. backup withholding will generally apply on payment of dividends to non-U.S. holders unless such non-U.S. holders furnish to the payor a Form W-8BEN or, in the case of a foreign entity shareholder, Form W-8BEN-E (or other applicable form), or otherwise establish an exemption and the payor does not have actual knowledge or reason to know that the holder is a U.S. person, as defined under the Code, that is not an exempt recipient.

        Payment of the proceeds of a sale of our common stock within the United States or conducted through certain U.S.-related financial intermediaries is subject to information reporting and, depending on the circumstances, backup withholding, unless the non-U.S. holder, or beneficial owner thereof, as applicable, certifies that it is a non-U.S. holder on Form W-8BEN or, in the case of a foreign entity shareholder, Form W-8BEN-E (or other applicable form), or otherwise establishes an exemption and the payor does not have actual knowledge or reason to know the holder is a U.S. person, as defined under the Code, that is not an exempt recipient.

        Currently, the back-up withholding tax rate is 28%. Any amount withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a non-U.S. holder is allowable as a credit against the non-U.S. holder's United States federal income tax, which may entitle the non-U.S. holder to a refund, provided that the non-U.S. holder timely provides the required information to the Internal Revenue Service. Moreover, certain penalties may be imposed by the Internal Revenue Service on a non-U.S. holder who is required to furnish information but does not do so in the proper manner. Non-U.S. holders should consult with their tax advisors regarding the application of backup withholding in their particular circumstances and the availability of and procedure for obtaining an exemption from backup withholding under current Treasury regulations.

Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act

        Under Sections 1471 through 1474 of the Code and the Treasury regulations and administrative guidance promulgated thereunder (collectively, FATCA), a 30% withholding tax may be imposed on distributions of dividends and payments of gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of our common stock made to a "foreign financial institution" or a "non-financial foreign entity" (in each case, as defined in the Code), regardless of whether such foreign institution or entity is a beneficial owner or an intermediary. To avoid such withholding, in the case of a foreign financial institution, the foreign financial institution must undertake certain diligence and reporting obligations and, in the case of a non-financial foreign entity, the non-financial foreign entity must either certify it does not have any "substantial United States owners" (as defined in the Code) or furnish identifying information regarding each substantial United States owner and satisfy certain other requirements, unless the foreign financial institution or non-financial foreign entity otherwise qualifies for an exemption from these rules.

        If the payee is a foreign financial institution and is subject to the diligence and reporting requirements described above, it must enter into an agreement with the U.S. Department of the Treasury requiring, among other things, that it undertake to identify accounts held by certain "U.S. persons" or "U.S.-owned foreign entities" (in each case, as defined in the Code), annually report

126


Table of Contents

certain information about such accounts and withhold 30% on certain payments to non-compliant foreign financial institutions and certain other account holders. A foreign financial institution generally certifies compliance with these requirements on a valid Internal Revenue Service Form W-8BEN-E. Foreign financial institutions located in jurisdictions that have an intergovernmental agreement with the United States governing FATCA may be subject to different rules.

        If the payee is a non-financial foreign entity, it generally provides the required certification on a valid Internal Revenue Service Form W-8BEN-E. Foreign entities located in jurisdictions that have an intergovernmental agreement with the United States governing these withholding and reporting requirements may be subject to different rules.

        These withholding taxes would be imposed on dividends paid with respect to our common stock to foreign financial institutions or non-financial foreign entities (including in their capacity as agents or custodians for beneficial owners of our common stock) that fail to satisfy the above requirements. However, under the applicable Treasury Regulations and IRS guidance, withholding under FATCA generally will not apply to payments of gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of our common stock before January 1, 2019. Under certain circumstances, a non-U.S. holder might be eligible for refunds or credits of such taxes.

        Prospective non-U.S. holders should consult with their tax advisors regarding the possible implications of FATCA on their investment in our common stock.

127


Table of Contents


UNDERWRITING

        We, the selling shareholders and the underwriter named below will enter into an underwriting agreement with respect to the shares of common stock being offered hereby. Subject to the terms and conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, the underwriter has agreed to purchase from us, and we and the selling shareholders have agreed to sell, the number of shares of our common stock set forth opposite its name in the table below.

Name
  Number of
Shares
 

Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P. 

       

Total

       

        The underwriter is committed to purchase and pay for all such shares of common stock if any are purchased.

        We and certain selling shareholders have granted to the underwriter an option, exercisable no later than 30 days after the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to an aggregate of                additional shares of common stock at the public offering price less the underwriting discount set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. The underwriter may exercise this option only to cover over-allotments, if any, made in connection with this offering. To the extent the option is exercised and the conditions of the underwriting agreement are satisfied, we and the selling shareholders will be obligated to sell to the underwriter, and the underwriter will be obligated to purchase, these additional shares of common stock.

        The underwriter proposes to offer the shares of common stock directly to the public at the offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus and to certain securities dealers at the public offering price less a concession not in excess of $            per share. The underwriter may allow, and these dealers may re-allow, a concession not in excess of $             per share on sales to other dealers. After the public offering of the common stock, the underwriter may change the offering price and other selling terms.

        The following table shows the per share and total underwriting discount that we will pay to the underwriter and the proceeds we will receive and the selling shareholders will receive before expenses. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriter's over-allotment option to purchase additional shares.

 
  Per Share   Total Without
Over-Allotment
  Total With
Over-Allotment
 

Price to public

                                                    

Underwriting discount

                   

Proceeds to us, before expenses

                   

Proceeds to selling shareholders, before expenses

                   

        We estimate that the total expenses of the offering payable by us, excluding the underwriting discount, will be approximately $             million. We have agreed to reimburse the underwriter for its actual out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with the offering, including, without limitation, legal fees and expenses, marketing, syndication and travel expenses, which amount shall not exceed $750,000 in the aggregate.

        The shares of common stock are being offered by the underwriter, subject to prior sale, when, as and if issued to and accepted by them, subject to approval of certain legal matters by counsel for the underwriter and other conditions specified in the underwriting agreement. The underwriter reserves the right to withdraw, cancel or modify this offer and to reject orders in whole or in part.

128


Table of Contents

        The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the underwriter is conditional and may be terminated at its discretion based on its assessment of the state of the financial markets. The obligations of the underwriter may also be terminated upon the occurrence of the events specified in the underwriting agreement. The underwriting agreement provides that the underwriter is obligated to purchase all the shares of common stock in this offering if any are purchased, other than those shares covered by the over-allotment option described above.

        Lock-up Agreement.    We, each of our executive officers and directors, the selling shareholders and certain other persons, have agreed, subject to certain exceptions for a period of 180 days after the date of this prospectus, not to sell, offer, agree to sell, contract to sell, hypothecate, pledge, grant any option to sell, make any short sale, or otherwise dispose of or hedge, directly or indirectly, any shares of our common stock or securities convertible into, exchangeable or exercisable for any shares of our common stock or warrants or other rights to purchase shares of our common stock or other similar securities without, in each case, the prior written consent of Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P. These restrictions are expressly agreed to preclude us, and our executive officers and directors, the selling shareholders and certain other persons, from engaging in any hedging or other transaction or arrangement that is designed to, or which reasonably could be expected to, lead to or result in a sale, disposition or transfer, in whole or in part, of any of the economic consequences of ownership of our common stock, whether such transaction would be settled by delivery of common stock or other securities, in cash or otherwise.

        Indemnity.    We have agreed to indemnify the underwriter, and persons who control the underwriter, against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, and to contribute to payments that the underwriter may be required to make in respect of these liabilities.

        Stabilization.    In connection with this offering, the underwriter may engage in stabilizing transactions, over-allotment transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids.

129


Table of Contents

        These stabilizing transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids may have the effect of raising or maintaining the market price of our common stock or preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our common stock. As a result, the price of our common stock in the open market may be higher than it would otherwise be in the absence of these transactions. Neither we nor the underwriter makes any representation or prediction as to the effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our common stock. These transactions may be effected on the Nasdaq Capital Market, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.

        NASDAQ Capital Market Listing.    We expect the shares to be approved for listing on the NASDAQ Capital Market, subject to notice of issuance, under the symbol "            ."

        Offering Price Determination.    Before this offering, there has been no public market for our common stock. The initial public offering price will be determined through negotiations between us, the selling shareholders and the underwriter. In addition to prevailing market conditions, the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price are:

        An active trading market for the shares may not develop. It is also possible that after the offering the shares will not trade in the public market at or above the initial public offering price.

        From time to time, the underwriter and its affiliates have provided, and may continue to provide, investment banking services to us in the ordinary course of its businesses, and may receive compensation for such services. The underwriter and its affiliates may also make investment recommendations and/or publish or express independent research views in respect of those securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long and/or short positions in those securities and instruments.

        Electronic Distribution.    A prospectus in electronic format may be made available by e-mail or on the websites or through online services maintained by the underwriter or its affiliates. In those cases, prospective investors may view offering terms online and may be allowed to place orders online. The underwriter may agree with us to allocate a specific number of shares for sale to online brokerage account holders. Any such allocation for online distributions will be made by the underwriter on the same basis as other allocations. Other than the prospectus in electronic format, the information on the underwriter's website and any information contained on any other website maintained by the underwriter is not part of this prospectus, has not been approved and/or endorsed by the underwriter or us and should not be relied upon by investors.

130


Table of Contents

        Selling Restrictions.    Other than in the United States, no action has been taken by us or the underwriter that would permit a public offering of the securities offered by this prospectus in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required. The securities offered by this prospectus may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, nor may this prospectus or any other offering material or advertisements in connection with the offer and sale of any such securities be distributed or published in any jurisdiction, except under circumstances that will result in compliance with the applicable rules and regulations of that jurisdiction. Persons into whose possession this prospectus comes are advised to inform themselves about and to observe any restrictions relating to the offering and the distribution of this prospectus. This prospectus does not constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation of an offer to buy any securities offered by this prospectus in any jurisdiction in which such an offer or a solicitation is unlawful.

131


Table of Contents


LEGAL MATTERS

        The validity of the shares of common stock being offered by this prospectus will be passed upon for us by Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP, Detroit, Michigan. Certain legal matters will be passed upon for the underwriter by Manatt, Phelps & Phillips LLP, San Francisco, California.


EXPERTS

        The consolidated financial statements of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 and for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2016, included in this prospectus, have been audited by Crowe Horwath LLP, independent registered public accounting firm as stated in their report herein. Such consolidated financial statements are included in reliance upon the report of such firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.


WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

        Sterling Bancorp, Inc. has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission a registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933 with respect to the shares of common stock offered hereby. As permitted by the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission, this prospectus does not contain all the information set forth in the registration statement. Such information can be examined without charge at the public reference facilities of the Securities and Exchange Commission located at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549, and copies of such material can be obtained from the Securities and Exchange Commission at prescribed rates. The Securities and Exchange Commission's telephone number is 1-800-SEC-0330. In addition, the Securities and Exchange Commission maintains a web site (http://www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including Sterling Bancorp, Inc. The statements contained in this prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement are, of necessity, brief descriptions of the material terms of, and should be read in conjunction with, such contract or document.

132


Table of Contents


STERLING BANCORP, INC.
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

UNAUDITED CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

       

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016

    F-2  

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016

    F-3  

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016

    F-4  

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016

    F-5  

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016

    F-6  

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

    F-7  

AUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

   
 
 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

    F-34  

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2016 and 2015

    F-35  

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015

    F-36  

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015

    F-37  

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015

    F-38  

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015

    F-39  

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

    F-40  

F-1


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

(dollars in thousands)

 
  June 30,
2017
  December 31,
2016
 
 
  (unaudited)
   
 

Assets

             

Cash and due from banks

  $ 25,974   $ 22,124  

Investment securities available for sale, at fair value

    102,501     75,606  

Investment securities, restricted stock, at cost

    18,360     18,360  

Mortgage loans held for sale

    579     4,714  

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses of $16,246 and $14,822

    2,205,530     1,982,439  

Leasehold improvements and equipment, net

    6,863     5,855  

Cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    30,357     30,028  

Deferred tax asset

    9,795     9,516  

Other assets

    16,212     14,959  

Total assets

  $ 2,416,171   $ 2,163,601  

Liabilities and Shareholders' Equity

             

Liabilities:

             

Noninterest-bearing deposits

  $ 66,455   $ 59,231  

Interest-bearing deposits

    1,729,869     1,555,914  

Total deposits

    1,796,324     1,615,145  

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    359,312     308,198  

Subordinated notes (face amount of $50,000 less unamortized issuance costs of $596 and $662, respectively)

    49,404     49,338  

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

    36,848     28,648  

Total liabilities

    2,241,888     2,001,329  

Shareholders' equity:

   
 
   
 
 

Preferred stock, authorized 1,000,000 shares; no shares issued and outstanding at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively

         

Common stock, voting, no par value, authorized 490,000,000 shares, issued and outstanding 40,199,000 shares at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively

    22,863     22,863  

Common stock, non-voting, no par value, authorized 10,000,000 shares, issued and outstanding 5,072,000 shares at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively

    2,885     2,885  

Additional paid-in capital

    12,290     15,118  

Retained earnings

    136,371     121,446  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (126 )   (40 )

Total shareholders' equity

    174,283     162,272  

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 2,416,171   $ 2,163,601  

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-2


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income (Unaudited)

(dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2017   2016  

Interest income

             

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 54,881   $ 40,663  

Interest and dividends on investment securities

    849     566  

Other interest

        16  

Total interest income

    55,730     41,245  

Interest expense

             

Interest on deposits

    7,311     5,112  

Interest on Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    1,700     1,032  

Interest on subordinated notes

    1,816     426  

Total interest expense

    10,827     6,570  

Net interest income

    44,903     34,675  

Provision for loan losses

    1,200     (917 )

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    43,703     35,592  

Non-interest income

             

Service charges and fees

    1,901     967  

Investment management and advisory fees

    1,141     1,813  

Gain on sale of investment securities

    73      

Gain on sale of other real estate owned, net

        32  

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    17     568  

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    4,419     5,096  

Income on cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    583     583  

Other income

    265     229  

Total non-interest income

    8,399     9,288  

Non-interest expense

             

Salaries and employee benefits

    10,687     8,390  

Occupancy and equipment

    2,805     2,511  

Professional fees

    664     637  

Advertising and marketing

    422     638  

FDIC assessments

    506     440  

Data processing

    486     489  

Other

    3,695     2,881  

Total non-interest expense

    19,265     15,986  

Income before income taxes

    32,837     28,894  

Income tax expense

    13,483     11,728  

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166  

Income per share, basic and diluted

  $ 0.43   $ 0.38  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    45,271,000     45,271,000  

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-3


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Unaudited)

(dollars in thousands)

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2017   2016  

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

             

Unrealized gains (losses) on investment securities available for sale arising during the period, net of tax effect of $45 and ($51) in 2017 and 2016, respectively

    (133 )   99  

Less: reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income of $73 and $—, included in gain on sale of investment securities and tax effect of ($26) and ($—) included in income tax expense in 2017 and 2016, respectively

    47      

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

    (86 )   99  

Comprehensive income

  $ 19,268   $ 17,265  

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-4


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Condensed Consolidated Statement of Changes in Shareholders' Equity (Unaudited)

(dollars in thousands except per share amounts)

 
  Common Stock    
   
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
   
 
 
  Additional
Paid-in
Capital
  Retained
Earnings
  Total
Shareholders'
Equity
 
 
  Voting   Nonvoting  

Balance at January 1, 2017

  $ 22,863   $ 2,885   $ 15,118   $ 121,446   $ (40 ) $ 162,272  

Net income

                19,354         19,354  

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity

            222             222  

Distribution recorded to members of merged entity (Note 1)

            (3,050 )           (3,050 )

Other comprehensive loss

                    (86 )   (86 )

Dividends distributed ($0.10 per share)

                (4,429 )       (4,429 )

Balance at June 30, 2017

  $ 22,863   $ 2,885   $ 12,290   $ 136,371   $ (126 ) $ 174,283  

Balance at January 1, 2016

 
$

22,863
 
$

2,885
 
$

14,418
 
$

96,779
 
$

(667

)

$

136,278
 

Net income

                17,166         17,166  

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity

            78             78  

Other comprehensive income

                    99     99  

Dividends distributed ($0.10 per share)

                (4,572 )       (4,572 )

Balance at June 30, 2016

  $ 22,863   $ 2,885   $ 14,496   $ 109,373   $ (568 ) $ 149,049  

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-5


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (Unaudited)

(dollars in thousands)

 
  Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
 
  2017   2016  

Cash Flows from Operating Activities

             

Net income

  $ 19,354   $ 17,166  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

             

Provision for loan losses

    1,200     (917 )

Deferred income taxes

    (235 )   (595 )

Net realized gains on sale of investment securities available for sale

    (73 )    

Investment securities available for sale amortization and accretion, net

    (37 )   26  

Depreciation and amortization on leasehold improvements and equipment

    528     587  

Amortization of intangible

    225     225  

Gain on sale of other real estate owned

        (32 )

Origination, premium paid and purchase of loans, net of principal payments

    (43,897 )   (28,132 )

Proceeds from the sale of mortgage loans held for sale

    48,049     27,182  

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    (17 )   (568 )

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    (4,419 )   (5,096 )

Increase in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    (329 )   (355 )

Net change in servicing assets

    781     465  

Other

    66      

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

             

Other assets

    (762 )   (290 )

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

    6,669     1,719  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    27,103     11,385  

Cash Flows From Investing Activities

   
 
   
 
 

Investment securities available for sale:

             

Maturities and principal receipts

    42,589     32,935  

Sales

    15,713      

Purchases

    (85,218 )   (47,535 )

Loans originated, net of repayments

    (344,532 )   (408,541 )

Proceeds from the sale of portfolio loans

    124,662     189,300  

Purchase of leasehold improvements and equipment

    (1,503 )   (539 )

Proceeds from the sale of other real estate owned

        1,312  

Net cash used in investing activities

    (248,289 )   (233,068 )

Cash Flows From Financing Activities

   
 
   
 
 

Net increase in deposits

    181,179     219,401  

Proceeds from advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    1,320,000     3,017,000  

Repayments of advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    (1,245,000 )   (3,037,000 )

Net change in line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank

    (23,886 )   (4,041 )

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes

        28,250  

Payment of debt issuance costs

        (381 )

Distribution to members of merged entity

    (3,050 )    

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity

    222     78  

Dividends paid to shareholders

    (4,429 )   (4,572 )

Net cash provided by financing activities

    225,036     218,735  

Net increase (decrease) in cash and due to banks

    3,850     (2,948 )

cash and due to banks at beginning of period

    22,124     13,616  

cash and due to banks at end of period

  $ 25,974   $ 10,668  

Supplemental cash flows information

             

Cash paid:

             

Interest

  $ 10,645   $ 6,034  

Income taxes

  $ 10,200   $ 4,100  

Supplemental noncash disclosures

             

Transfer from loans to other real estate owned

  $   $ 48  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-6


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

(dollars in thousands)

Note 1—Nature of Operations and Basis of Presentation

Nature of Operations

        Sterling Bancorp, Inc. (the "Company") is a unitary thrift holding company that was incorporated in 1989 and the parent company to its wholly owned subsidiary, Sterling Bank and Trust, f.s.b. (the "Bank"). The Company's business is conducted through the Bank which was formed in 1984. The Company is headquartered in Southfield, Michigan and its operations are in the financial services industry. Management evaluates the performance of its business based on one reportable segment, community banking.

        The Company is subject to regulation, examination and supervision by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve ("Federal Reserve"). The Bank is a federally chartered stock savings bank which is subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the office of the Comptroller of the Currency ("OCC") of the U.S. Department of Treasury and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC") and a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") system. The Bank originates construction, commercial real estate, residential mortgage and consumer loans and receives deposits from its customers located primarily in California and Michigan. The Bank operates through a network of 26 branches; one branch at its headquarters and 24 branches located in San Francisco and Los Angeles, California and a newly opened branch located in New York, New York.

Basis of Presentation

        The condensed consolidated balance sheet as of June 30, 2017, and the condensed consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders' equity and cash flows for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 are unaudited. The unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the same basis as the annual consolidated financial statements and reflect, in the opinion of management, all adjustments, consisting of a normal and recurring nature that are necessary for a fair presentation of the financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the periods presented. The financial data and other financial information disclosed in these notes to the condensed consolidated financial statements related to these periods are also unaudited. The results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 2017 are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the year ended December 31, 2017 or for any future annual or interim period. The consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2016 included herein was derived from the audited financial statements as of that date. These unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

Merger of Quantum Fund, LLC

        On April 24, 2017, the Bank acquired all the outstanding equity interests of Quantum Fund, LLC, an entity controlled by the Company's principal shareholder who owns, directly and indirectly 80% of the members' interests with the remaining 20% members' interest held by a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank, for $2.9 million in cash. The entity operates a registered investment advisory business with assets held under management of approximately $425 million. In 2017, the Bank recorded the assets and liabilities transferred at their carrying amounts, consisting primarily of a customer-related intangible asset, in the accounts of the entity transferred. Prior to 2017, the consolidated financial statements have been retrospectively adjusted to include the results of the

F-7


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 1—Nature of Operations and Basis of Presentation (Continued)

Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, and the entity under common control on a combined basis, since the entities were under common control for the periods presented.

        In April 2017, upon closing of the merger transaction, the Company paid the purchase price of $2.9 million plus the settlement of certain liabilities to the members. Such amount has been reflected as a distribution to the members on the condensed consolidated statement of changes in shareholders' equity.

Stock Split

        In September 2017, the Board of Directors approved a 1,000 for one stock split to be effected as a stock dividend on the Company's voting and non-voting common stock. The stock split was effected on September 11, 2017. In addition, the Board of Directors and shareholders approved an increase in the number of authorized shares of common stock to 500 million consisting of 490 million shares of voting common stock, no par value, and 10 million shares of non-voting common stock, no par value. All share and per share amounts presented in these condensed consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, have been retroactively adjusted, where applicable, to reflect the stock split.

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Principles of Consolidation

        The accompanying condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared using accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP"). The condensed consolidated financial statements include the results of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, and an entity under common control that was merged with the Company in April 2017 (note 1). All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in the consolidation.

Use of Estimates

        The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Fair Value Measurements

        The Bank utilizes fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities and to determine fair value disclosures. The determination of fair values of financial instruments often requires the use of estimates. In cases where quoted market values in an active market are not available, the Bank uses present value techniques and other valuations methods, as disclosed in note 8, to estimate the fair value of its financial instruments. These valuation methods require considerable judgment and the resulting estimates of fair value can be significantly affected by the assumptions made and methods used.

F-8


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        Investments securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Additionally, from time to time, the Bank may be required to record other assets and liabilities on a nonrecurring basis, such as impaired loans, other real estate owned, nonmarketable equity securities and certain other assets and liabilities. These nonrecurring fair value adjustments generally involve write-downs of individual assets or application of lower of amortized cost or fair value accounting.

Income per Share, Basic and Diluted

        Basic income per share represents net income available to common shareholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted income per share represents net income available to common shareholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, plus the effect of outstanding dilutive potential common shares. The Company did not have any dilutive securities therefore, basic and diluted income per share is the same for all periods presented.

Recently Issued Accounting Guidance

        In March 2017, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued Accounting Standards Update ("ASU") No. 2017-08, Receivables-Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs (Subtopic 310-20): Premium Amortization on Purchased Callable Debt Securities, which amends the amortization period for certain purchased callable debt securities held at a premium. The amendments shorten the amortization period to the earliest call date. Under current U.S. GAAP, entities generally amortize the premium as an adjustment of yield over the contractual life of the instrument. The amendments do not change the accounting for securities held at a discount. ASU No. 2017-08 will be effective for annual reporting periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. The amendments should be applied using a modified-retrospective transition method as of the beginning of the period of adoption. Early adoption is permitted, including adoption in an interim period. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of ASU No. 2017-08 on its consolidated financial statements, but it is not expected to have a material impact due to the Company has not typically acquired callable securities with purchase premiums.

        In August 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-15, Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments, to reduce current diversity in practice in how certain cash receipts and cash payments are presented and classified in the statement of cash flows. ASU No. 2016-15 will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early adoption is permitted, including adoption in an interim period. The amendments should be applied using a retrospective transition method to each period presented. The Company has early adopted ASU No. 2016-15 in these annual consolidated financial statements.

        In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments, which is intended to improve financial reporting by requiring recording of credit losses on loans and other financial instruments on a more timely basis. The guidance will replace the current incurred loss accounting model with an expected loss approach and requires the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The guidance requires enhanced disclosures to help investors and other financial statement users better

F-9


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

understand significant estimates and judgments used in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of an organization's portfolio. ASU No. 2016-13 is effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2019. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of ASU No. 2016-13 but expects to recognize a one-time cumulative effect adjustment to the allowance for loan losses as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which ASU No. 2016-13 is effective. The Company has not yet determined the magnitude of any such one-time adjustment or the overall impact of ASU No. 2016-13 on its consolidated financial statements.

        In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) which require lessees to recognize the following for all leases, except for short-term leases, at the commencement date: (1) a lease liability which is a lessee's obligation to make lease payments arising from a lease, measured on a discounted basis; and (2) a right-of-use asset, which is an asset that represents the lessee's right to use, or control the use of, a specified asset for the lease term. Lessor accounting is largely unchanged. ASU No. 2016-02 will also require expanded disclosures. ASU No. 2016-02 is effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the ASU No. 2016-02 on its financial condition and results of operations. The Company will record a right-of-use asset and a lease liability on its consolidated balance sheet for the leases of its facilities in place at adoption of this ASU.

        In January 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-01, Financial Instruments—Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, which, among other things, (i) requires equity investments, with certain exceptions, to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in net income, (ii) simplifies the impairment assessment of equity investments without readily determinable fair values by requiring a qualitative assessment to identify impairment, (iii) eliminates the requirement for public business entities to disclose the methods and significant assumptions used to estimate the fair value that is required to be disclosed for financial instruments measured at amortized cost on the balance sheets, (iv) requires public business entities to use the exit price notion when measuring the fair value of financial instruments for disclosure purposes, (v) requires an entity to present separately in other comprehensive income the portion of the total change in the fair value of a liability resulting from a change in the instrument-specific credit risk when the entity has elected to measure the liability at fair value in accordance with the fair value option for financial instruments, (vi) requires separate presentation of financial assets and financial liabilities by measurement category and form of financial asset on the balance sheets or the accompanying notes to the financial statements and (viii) clarifies that an entity should evaluate the need for a valuation allowance on a deferred tax asset related to investment securities. ASU No. 2016-01 is effective retrospectively for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of adopting ASU No. 2016-01 on the consolidated financial statements. The Company plans to provide the additional required disclosures, but this ASU is not expected to have a material impact on the Company's financial condition or results of operations.

        In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606), which is intended to improve and converge the financial reporting requirements for revenue contracts with customers. Previous accounting guidance comprised broad revenue recognition

F-10


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

concepts along with numerous industry-specific requirements. Under the new guidance, an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods and services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration in exchange for those goods and services. It also establishes a five-step model which entities must follow to recognize revenue. In April 2016, the FASB clarified the following two aspects: identifying performance obligations and the licensing implementation guidance while retaining the related principles for those areas. In May 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-12, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606): Narrow -Scope Improvements and Practical Expedients, to provide a limited number of changes to its revenue recognition standard. The amendments clarify the assessment of the likelihood that revenue will be collected from a contract, the guidance for presenting sales taxes and similar taxes, and the timing for measuring customer payments that are not in cash. The amendment also specifies that a contract should be considered complete if all, or substantially all, of its revenue has been collected prior to making the transition to the new standard. In addition, the update clarifies the disclosure requirements for transition to the new standard by adjusting amounts from prior reporting periods. In December 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-20, Technical Corrections and Improvement to Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers. The banking industry does not expect significant changes because major sources of revenue are from financial instruments that have been excluded from the scope of the new guidance including loans, derivatives, debt and equity securities, etc. However, the new guidance affects other fees charged by banks, such as asset management fees, credit card interchange fees, deposit account fees, etc. Adoption of ASU No. 2014-09 may be made on a full retrospective basis with practical expedients, or on a modified retrospective basis with a cumulative effect adjustment on the initial application along with supplementary disclosures. ASU No. 2014-09 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company does not expect ASU No. 2014-09 and its related amendments to have a material impact on revenue closely associated with financial instruments, including interest income. The Company is currently in the process of performing an overall assessment of its revenue streams impacted by ASU No. 2014-09, including deposit related fees and asset management fees, to assess the impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements and determine its transition method.

F-11


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities

        The following tables summarize the amortized cost and fair value of investment securities available for sale at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 and the corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and losses:

 
  June 30, 2017  
 
   
  Gross
Unrealized
   
 
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 
 
  Gain   Loss  

Available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 82,111   $   $ (90 ) $ 82,021  

Mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by U.S. agencies residential pass-through:

                         

Guaranteed by GNMA

    11,440         (66 )   11,374  

Issued by FNMA

    2,860         (23 )   2,837  

Total mortgage-backed securities

    14,300         (89 )   14,211  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,099     53         2,152  

Collateralized debt obligations

    608         (19 )   589  

Other securities

    3,045         (45 )   3,000  

Equity securities

    528             528  

Total

  $ 102,691   $ 53   $ (243 ) $ 102,501  

 

 
  December 31, 2016  
 
   
  Gross
Unrealized
   
 
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 
 
  Gain   Loss  

Available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 70,072   $ 7   $ (39 ) $ 70,040  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,411     51         2,462  

Collateralized debt obligations

    610         (25 )   585  

Other securities

    2,045         (55 )   1,990  

Equity securities

    529             529  

Total

  $ 75,667   $ 58   $ (119 ) $ 75,606  

        Other securities consist of an investment in a qualified community reinvestment act investment fund, which is a publicly-traded mutual fund. Equity securities consist of an investment in Pacific Coast Banker's Bank, a thinly traded, restricted stock, and an investment in a service corporation. All interest and dividends on investment securities are taxable.

        The proceeds from sale of investment securities available for sale were $15,713 for the six months ended June 30, 2017. Gross gains of $74 and gross losses of $1 were realized on these sales for the six months ended June 30, 2017.

F-12


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities (Continued)

        The table summarizes the amortized cost and fair value of the investment securities available for sale, shown by contractual maturity at June 30, 2017. Securities with no stated maturity are shown separately.

 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 

U.S. Treasury securities

             

Due less than one year

  $ 82,111   $ 82,021  

Mortgage backed securities-residential

    14,300     14,211  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,099     2,152  

Collateralized debt obligations

    608     589  

Other securities

    3,045     3,000  

Equity securities

    528     528  

Total

  $ 102,691   $ 102,501  

        Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities if borrowers have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

        The table summarizes investment securities available for sale at fair value, with unrealized losses at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 aggregated by major security type and length of time the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, as follows:

 
  June 30, 2017  
 
  Less than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Total  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
 

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 82,021   $ (90 ) $   $   $ 82,021   $ (90 )

Mortage-backed securities

    14,211     (89 )           14,211     (89 )

Collateralized debt obligations

            589     (19 )   589     (19 )

Other securities

    3,000     (45 )           3,000     (45 )

Total

  $ 99,232   $ (224 ) $ 589   $ (19 ) $ 99,821   $ (243 )

 

 
  December 31, 2016  
 
  Less than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Total  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
 

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 41,518   $ (39 ) $   $   $ 41,518   $ (39 )

Collateralized debt obligations

            585     (25 )   585     (25 )

Other securities

    1,990     (55 )           1,990     (55 )

Total

  $ 43,508   $ (94 ) $ 585   $ (25 ) $ 44,093   $ (119 )

F-13


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities (Continued)

        As of June 30, 2017, the Company's security portfolio consisted of 14 securities, with 12 in an unrealized loss position. For investment securities in an unrealized loss position, management has both the intent and ability to hold these investments until the recovery of the decline; thus, the impairment was determined to be temporary. Total other-than-temporary impairment recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax, was $0 and $554 at June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Note 4—Loans

        Major categories of loans were as follows:

 
  June 30,
2017
  December 31,
2016
 

Construction loans

  $ 188,751   $ 146,600  

Residential real estate loans, mortgage

    1,776,353     1,617,087  

Commercial real estate loans, mortgage

    220,779     201,394  

Commercial and industrial loans, lines of credit

    40,359     36,793  

Other consumer loans

    62     63  

Total loans

    2,226,304     2,001,937  

Less: unearned discount and fees

    (4,528 )   (4,676 )

Less: allowance for loan losses

    (16,246 )   (14,822 )

Loans, net

  $ 2,205,530   $ 1,982,439  

        Loans with carrying values of $858.9 million and $839.6 million were pledged as collateral on FHLB borrowings at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively.

        The table presents the activity in the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment for the periods indicated, as follows:

 
  Six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016  
 
  Construction   Residential
Real
Estate
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Commercial
Lines of
Credit
  Other
Consumer
  Unallocated   Total  

June 30, 2017

                                           

Allowance for loan losses:

                                           

Beginning balance

  $ 679   $ 11,863   $ 915   $ 373   $ 2   $ 990   $ 14,822  

Provision for loan losses

    385     570     252     12     (1 )   (18 )   1,200  

Charge offs

                             

Recoveries

    104     39     80         1         224  

Ending balance

  $ 1,168   $ 12,472   $ 1,247   $ 385   $ 2   $ 972   $ 16,246  

June 30, 2016

                                           

Allowance for loan losses:

                                           

Beginning balance

  $ 317   $ 8,192   $ 1,530   $ 392   $ 2   $ 551   $ 10,984  

Provision for loan losses

    (198 )   1,162     (2,245 )   36         328     (917 )

Charge offs

        (19 )                   (19 )

Recoveries

    253     14     1,839                 2,106  

Ending balance

  $ 372   $ 9,349   $ 1,124   $ 428   $ 2   $ 879   $ 12,154  

F-14


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The table presents the balance in the allowance for loan losses and the recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment and based on our impairment model as of June 30, 2017 as follows:

 
  Construction   Residential
Real Estate
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Commercial
Lines of Credit
  Other
Consumer
  Unallocated   Total  

Ending balances:

                                           

Individually evaluated for impairment

  $   $ 38   $ 33   $ 104   $   $   $ 175  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

  $ 1,168   $ 12,434   $ 1,214   $ 281   $ 2   $ 972   $ 16,071  

Loans*:

                                           

Loans individually evaluated for impairment           

  $   $ 123   $ 2,863   $ 358   $   $   $ 3,344  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment           

    188,751     1,776,230     217,916     40,001     62         2,222,960  

Total ending loans balance

  $ 188,751   $ 1,776,353   $ 220,779   $ 40,359   $ 62   $   $ 2,226,304  

*
The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-15


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The table presents the activity in the allowance for loan losses and balance in the allowance for loan losses and recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016, as follows:

 
  Construction   Residential
Real Estate
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Commercial
Lines of Credit
  Other
Consumer
  Unallocated   Total  

Allowance for loan losses:

                                           

Beginning balance

  $ 317   $ 8,192   $ 1,530   $ 392   $ 2   $ 551   $ 10,984  

Provision for loan losses

    52     3,578     (2,768 )   (19 )   (2 )   439     1,280  

Charge offs

        (24 )                   (24 )

Recoveries

    310     117     2,153         2         2,582  

Ending balance

  $ 679   $ 11,863   $ 915   $ 373   $ 2   $ 990   $ 14,822  

Ending balances:

                                           

Individually evaluated for impairment

  $   $ 21   $ 61   $ 107   $   $   $ 189  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

  $ 679   $ 11,842   $ 854   $ 266   $ 2   $ 990   $ 14,633  

Loans*:

                                           

Loans individually evaluated for impairment           

  $   $ 72   $ 2,950   $ 369   $   $   $ 3,391  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment           

    146,600     1,617,015     198,444     36,424     63         1,998,546  

Total ending loans balance

  $ 146,600   $ 1,617,087   $ 201,394   $ 36,793   $ 63   $   $ 2,001,937  

*
The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-16


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The following tables present information related to impaired loans by class of loans as of and for the periods indicated:

 
  At June 30, 2017  
 
  Unpaid
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
  Allowance for
Loan Losses
Allocated
 

With no related allowance for loan losses recorded:

                   

Commercial real estate:

                   

Retail

  $ 1,461   $ 1,281   $  

Gas stations

    455     8      

Commercial lines of credit, private banking

    150     151      

Subtotal

    2,066     1,440      

With an allowance for loan losses recorded:

                   

Residential real estate, first mortgage

    123     123     38  

Commercial real estate, offices

    1,586     1,574     33  

Commercial lines of credit, private banking

    207     207     104  

Subtotal

    1,916     1,904     175  

Total

  $ 3,982   $ 3,344   $ 175  


 
  At December 31, 2016  
 
  Unpaid
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
  Allowance for
Loan Losses
Allocated
 

With no related allowance for loan losses recorded:

                   

Commercial real estate:

                   

Retail

  $ 1,491   $ 1,316   $  

Gas stations

    476     39      

Commercial lines of credit, private banking

    154     154      

Subtotal

    2,121     1,509      

With an allowance for loan losses recorded:

                   

Residential real estate, first mortgage

    72     72     21  

Commercial real estate, offices

    1,606     1,595     61  

Commercial lines of credit private banking

    215     215     107  

Subtotal

    1,893     1,882     189  

Total

  $ 4,014   $ 3,391   $ 189  

        The unpaid principal balance is not reduced for partial charge offs. The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-17


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

 
  Six Months Ended June 30,  
 
  2017   2016  
 
  Average
Recorded
Investment
  Interest
Income
Recognized
  Cash
Basis
Interest
Recognized
  Average
Recorded
Investment
  Interest
Income
Recognized
  Cash
Basis
Interest
Recognized
 

With no related allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

  $ 1,299   $ 33   $ 34   $ 1,366   $ 33   $ 35  

Offices

                266          

Gas stations

    23             85          

Commercial lines of credit, private banking

    152     4     4     159     4     4  

Subtotal

    1,474     37     38     1,876     37     39  

With an allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Residential real estate, first mortgage

    121     3     5     73     2     2  

Commercial real estate, offices

    1,590     39     38     1,630     37     42  

Commercial lines of credit, private banking

    211     7     7     229     7     7  

Subtotal

    1,922     49     50     1,932     46     51  

Total

  $ 3,396   $ 86   $ 88   $ 3,808   $ 83   $ 90  

        The following tables present the recorded investment in nonaccrual and loans past due over 90 days still on accrual by class of loans as of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016:

 
  June 30, 2017   December 31, 2016  
 
  Nonaccrual   Loans
Past Due
Over 90 Days
Still Accruing
  Nonaccrual   Loans
Past Due
Over 90 Days
Still Accruing
 

Residential real estate:

                         

Residential first mortgage

  $ 463   $ 105   $ 272   $ 155  

Commercial real estate:

                         

Retail

    89         99      

Offices

    8         39      

Total

  $ 560   $ 105   $ 410   $ 155  

        The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-18


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The following tables present the aging of the recorded investment in past due loans as of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 by class of loans:

 
  30 - 59 Days
Past Due
  60 - 89 Days
Past Due
  Greater than
89 Days
Past Due
  Total
Past Due
  Loans Not
Past Due
  Total  

June 30, 2017

                                     

Construction

  $ 1,524   $   $   $ 1,524   $ 187,227   $ 188,751  

Residential real estate:

                                     

Residential first mortgage

    423     6     568     997     1,757,931     1,758,928  

Residential second mortgage

    69             69     17,356     17,425  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

            89     89     10,788     10,877  

Apartments

                    60,542     60,542  

Offices

                    27,655     27,655  

Hotel

                    72,974     72,974  

Industrial

                    16,143     16,143  

Gas stations

            8     8     1,615     1,623  

Other

                    30,965     30,965  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

                    18,186     18,186  

C&I lending

                    22,173     22,173  

Other consumer loans

                    62     62  

Total

  $ 2,016   $ 6   $ 665   $ 2,687   $ 2,223,617   $ 2,226,304  


 
  30 - 59 Days
Past Due
  60 - 89 Days
Past Due
  Greater than
89 Days
Past Due
  Total
Past Due
  Loans Not
Past Due
  Total  

December 31, 2016

                                     

Construction

  $   $   $   $   $ 146,600   $ 146,600  

Residential real estate:

                                     

Residential first mortgage

    416     398     427     1,241     1,598,481     1,599,722  

Residential second mortgage

                    17,365     17,365  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

            99     99     17,205     17,304  

Apartments

                    56,198     56,198  

Offices

                    19,418     19,418  

Hotel

                    66,545     66,545  

Industrial

                    16,330     16,330  

Gas stations

            39     39     1,690     1,729  

Other

                    23,870     23,870  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

                    18,240     18,240  

C&I lending

        227         227     18,326     18,553  

Other consumer loans

                    63     63  

Total

  $ 416   $ 625   $ 565   $ 1,606   $ 2,000,331   $ 2,001,937  

        The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-19


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The Company considers the performance of the loan portfolio and its impact on the allowance for loan losses. For residential real estate and consumer loan classes, the Company also evaluates credit quality based on the aging status of the loan, which is presented above, and by payment activity. The Company reviews the status of nonperforming loans which include loans 90 days past due and still accruing and nonaccrual loans.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the balance of outstanding loans classified as troubled debt restructurings was $3,128 and $3,134, respectively. The Company has an allowance for loan losses of $71 and $81 on these loans at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively. The terms of certain loans have been modified as troubled debt restructurings by the Company. The modification of the terms of such loans included one or a combination of the following: a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan; an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk; extension of the amortization period of the loan; change in loan payments to interest only for a defined period for the loan; or a permanent reduction of the recorded investment in the loan. The Company has no commitments to lend additional amounts to these customers. Furthermore, there were no loan modifications during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 that were considered troubled debt restructurings and no troubled debt restructurings that subsequently defaulted during those periods.

        The terms of certain other loans have been modified during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 that did not meet the definition of a troubled debt restructuring. The modification of these loans involved either a modification of the terms of a loan to borrowers who were not experiencing financial difficulties or a delay in a payment. These other loans that were modified were not considered significant.

Credit Quality

        The Company categorizes loans into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic trends, among other factors. The Company analyzes loans individually by classifying the loans as to credit risk. This analysis includes homogeneous loans such as residential real estate and consumer loans and non-homogeneous loans, such as construction and commercial real estate loans and commercial lines of credit. This analysis is performed monthly. The Company uses the following definitions for risk ratings:

        Pass Loans:    Loans are of satisfactory quality.

F-20


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the risk rating of loans by class of loans was as follows:

 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

June 30, 2017

                               

Construction

  $ 181,136   $ 4,982   $ 2,633   $   $ 188,751  

Residential real estate:

                               

Residential first mortgage

    1,758,465         463         1,758,928  

Residential second mortgage

    17,425                 17,425  

Commercial real estate:

                               

Retail

    9,596     1,192     89         10,877  

Apartments

    60,542                 60,542  

Offices

    26,992     663             27,655  

Hotel

    72,974                 72,974  

Industrial

    16,143                 16,143  

Gas stations

    1,615         8         1,623  

Other

    25,443     4,788     734         30,965  

Commercial lines of credit:

                               

Private banking

    17,979         207         18,186  

C&I lending

    21,950     223             22,173  

Other consumer loans

    62                 62  

Total

  $ 2,210,322   $ 11,848   $ 4,134   $   $ 2,226,304  

F-21


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)


 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

December 31, 2016

                               

Construction

  $ 142,561   $ 4,039   $   $   $ 146,600  

Residential real estate:

                               

Residential first mortgage

    1,599,449         192     81     1,599,722  

Residential second mortgage

    17,365                 17,365  

Commercial real estate:

                               

Retail

    15,988     1,217     99         17,304  

Apartments

    56,198                 56,198  

Offices

    18,513     905             19,418  

Hotel

    66,545                 66,545  

Industrial

    16,330                 16,330  

Gas stations

    1,690         39         1,729  

Other

    23,074         796         23,870  

Commercial lines of credit:

                               

Private banking

    18,025         215         18,240  

C&I lending

    18,326     227             18,553  

Other consumer loans

    63                 63  

Total

  $ 1,994,127   $ 6,388   $ 1,341   $ 81   $ 2,001,937  

        The following table presents portfolio loans sold during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 by portfolio segment:

 
  Residential
Real Estate
 

2017

       

Sales

  $ 120,243  

2016

   
 
 

Sales

  $ 184,204  

Note 5—Mortgage Servicing Rights

        The Bank records servicing assets from the sale of mortgage loans to the secondary market for which servicing has been retained. Mortgage loans serviced for others are not included in the condensed consolidated balance sheets. The principal balance of these loans are as follows:

 
  June 30,
2017
  December 31,
2016
 

Mortgage loan portfolios serviced for:

             

FNMA

  $ 69,928   $ 61,562  

FHLB

    92,382     91,244  

Private investors

    322,060     256,910  

F-22


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 5—Mortgage Servicing Rights (Continued)

        Custodial escrow balances maintained with these serviced loans were $13,582 and $7,902 at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively.

        Activity for mortgage servicing rights and the related valuation allowance are as follows:

 
  Six months ended
June 30,
 
 
  2017   2016  

Mortgage servicing rights:

             

Beginning of period

  $ 4,454   $ 1,371  

Additions

    1,547     2,447  

Amortization

    (702 )   (316 )

End of period

    5,299     3,502  

Valuation allowance at beginning of period

    40     98  

Additions (recoveries)

    80     150  

Valuation allowance at end of period

    120     248  

Net carrying amount

  $ 5,179   $ 3,254  

        Mortgage servicing assets, included in other assets, were $5,179 and $4,414 at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively. Servicing fee income, included in other non-interest income, was $903 and $419 for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

        The fair value of mortgage servicing rights was $5,555, and $4,929 at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively. The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is highly sensitive to changes in underlying assumptions. Changes in prepayment speed assumptions have the most significant impact on the estimate of the fair value of mortgage servicing rights. The fair value at June 30, 2017 was determined using discount rates ranging from 9.5% to 12.0%, prepayment speeds ranging from 6.8% to 35.4%, depending on the stratification of the specific right, and a weighted average default rate of 0.2%. The fair value at December 31, 2016 was determined using discount rates ranging from 9.5% to 12.0%, prepayment speeds ranging from 6.8% to 36.5%, depending on the stratification of the specific right, and a weighted average default rate of 0.2%.

F-23


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 6—Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings

        Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) borrowings consist of the following:

 
  June 30,
2017
  Interest Rates   December 31,
2016
  Interest Rates

Short-term fixed rate advances

  $ 135,000   1.21%   $ 75,000   0.74%

Short-term adjustable rate advances

    15,000   1.38%*        

Total short-term FHLB advances

    150,000         75,000    

Long-term fixed rate advances

    205,000   0.98% - 3.84%     205,000   0.98% - 3.84%

Total FHLB advances

    355,000         280,000    

FHLB overdraft line of credit

    4,312   1.38%*     28,198   0.90%*

Total

  $ 359,312       $ 308,198    

*
At period end.

FHLB Advances

        At June 30, 2017, fixed rate advances totaled $340,000 with maturity dates ranging from July 2017 to October 2026. Also, at June 30, 2017, the Bank had a variable rate advance of $15,000 (interest rate of 1.38% at June 30, 2017) with a maturity date of December 2017. At December 31, 2016, fixed rate advances totaled $280,000 with maturity dates ranging from January 2017 to October 2026.

        Interest on advances is payable monthly and each advance is payable at its maturity date, and may contain a prepayment penalty if paid before maturity. At June 30, 2017, advances totaling $172,000 were callable by the FHLB and are required to be repaid upon the request of the FHLB. At June 30, 2017, the Bank had additional borrowing capacity of $283 million from the FHLB.

FHLB Overdraft Line of Credit

        The Bank has established an overdraft line of credit agreement with the FHLB providing maximum borrowings of $50,000. The average borrowings outstanding during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 was $10,127 and $17,253, respectively. At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the Bank had $4,312 and $28,198, respectively, outstanding under this agreement. Borrowings accrue interest at a variable rate based on the FHLB's overnight cost of funds rate, which was 1.38% and 0.90% at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively. The agreement has a one-year term and currently terminates in October 2017. Management plans to extend the agreement for another one-year term.

        The FHLB advances and the overdraft line of credit are collateralized by pledged loans totaling $858.9 million at June 30, 2017.

Other Borrowings

        The Company has available credit lines with other banks totaling $35 million. There were no amounts outstanding under these credit lines during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016.

F-24


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 7—Subordinated Notes

        During the period of April through September 2016, the Company issued subordinated notes ("Notes") to accredited investors in the aggregate principal amount of $50 million. Issuance costs of $729 were netted against the proceeds. In April and August 2016, the Company contributed cash proceeds of $27 million and $6.25 million respectively, to the Bank as capital to support its growth and the remaining proceeds were retained by the Company.

        At June 30, 2017, the balance outstanding under the Notes was $49,404, net of unamortized debt issuance costs of $596. The Notes bear interest at 7% per annum, payable semi-annually in arrears, through April 2021 after which the Notes will have a variable interest rate of the three-month LIBOR rate plus a margin of 5.82%. The Notes mature in April 2026. Interest expense on these Notes was $1,816 and $426 for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

        On or after April 14, 2021, the Company may redeem the Notes, in whole or in part, at an amount equal to 100% of the outstanding principal amount being redeemed plus accrued interest, in a principal amount with integral multiples of $1. The Notes are not redeemable by the Company prior to April 14, 2021 except in the event of (i) the Notes no longer qualify as Tier 2 Capital, (ii) the interest on the Notes is determined by law to be not deductible for Federal Income Tax reporting or (iii) the Company is considered an investment company pursuant to the Investment Company Act of 1940. The Notes are not subject to redemption by the noteholder.

        The Notes are unsecured obligations and are subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future indebtedness, deposits and other liabilities of the Company's current and future subsidiaries, including the Bank's deposits as well as the Company's subsidiaries liabilities to general creditors and liabilities arising during the ordinary course of business. The Notes may be included in Tier 1 capital of the Bank and Tier II capital for the Company under current regulatory guidelines and interpretations. As long as the Notes are outstanding, the Company is permitted to pay dividends if prior to such dividends, the Bank is considered well-capitalized, as defined below.

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments

        The Company's financial instruments include assets carried at fair value, as well as assets carried at cost or amortized cost but disclosed at fair value in these condensed consolidated financial statements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. In determining fair value, the Company applies the market approach, which uses prices and other relevant data based on market transactions involving identical or comparable assets and liabilities. The inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value are prioritized into a three-level hierarchy. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

F-25


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The Company used the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate the fair value of each type of financial instrument:

Investment Securities Available for Sale

        The fair values for investment securities available for sale are determined by quoted market prices, if available (Level 1). For investment securities available for sale where quoted prices are not available, fair values are calculated based on market prices of similar securities (Level 2). For investment securities available for sale where quoted prices or market prices of similar securities are not available, fair values are calculated using discounted cash flows or other market indicators (Level 3). Discounted cash flows are calculated using spread to LIBOR curves that are updated to incorporate loss severities, volatility, credit spread and optionality. During times when trading is more liquid, broker quotes are used (if available) to validate the model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as defaults and deferrals on individual securities are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations.

Impaired Loans

        The fair value of collateral dependent impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses is generally based on recent real estate appraisals. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments are usually significant and typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value.

Assets Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

        The table below presents the assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis categorized by the level of inputs used in the valuation of each asset at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at June 30, 2017  
 
  Total   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Financial Assets

                         

Investment securities available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasuries securities

  $ 82,021   $ 82,021   $   $  

Mortgage-backed securities

    14,211           14,211        

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,152         2,152      

Collateralized debt obligations

    589             589  

Other securities

    3,000     3,000          

Equity securities

    528             528  

Total investment securities available for sale

  $ 102,501   $ 85,021   $ 16,363   $ 1,117  

F-26


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2016  
 
  Total   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Financial Assets

                         

Investment securities available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasuries securities

  $ 70,040   $ 70,040   $   $  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,462         2,462      

Collateralized debt obligations

    585             585  

Other securities

    1,990     1,990          

Equity securities

    529             529  

Total investment securities available for sale

  $ 75,606   $ 72,030   $ 2,462   $ 1,114  

Assets Measured at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

        From time to time, the Bank may be required to measure certain other financial assets at fair value on a non-recurring basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP. These adjustments to fair value usually result from the application of lower of cost or fair value accounting or write-downs of individual assets. There were no financial assets held at fair value on a non-recurring basis at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively.

        There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2.

        The table below presents a reconciliation and income statement classification of gains and losses for all assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for six months ended June 30, 2017 and year ended December 31, 2016:

 
  Fair Value Measurements Using Significant
Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
 
 
  Investment Securities Available for Sale  
 
  June 30, 2017   December 31, 2016  
 
  Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
  Equity
Securities
  Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
  Equity
Securities
 

Balance of recurring Level 3 assets at beginning of period

  $ 585   $ 529   $ 1,064   $ 530  

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):

                         

Included in income—realized

        (1 )   (898 )   (1 )

Included in other comprehensive loss

    4         1,015      

Sales

            (596 )    

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

                 

Balance at end of period

  $ 589   $ 528   $ 585   $ 529  

F-27


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        Unrealized losses on Level 3 investments at June 30, 2017 were $19 for collateralized debt obligations and $0 for equity securities. In addition to the amounts included in income for the six months ended June 30, 2017 as presented in the table above, the Company also recorded interest income of $10 on collateralized debt obligations and dividend income of $24 on equity securities. Unrealized losses on Level 3 investments at December 31, 2016 were $25 for collateralized debt obligations and $0 for equity securities. In addition to the amounts included in income for the year ended December 31, 2016 as presented in the table above, the Company also recorded interest income of $18 on collateralized debt obligations and dividend income of $28 on equity securities.

        The fair value of collateralized debt obligations is determined by calculating discounted cash flows using LIBOR curves plus spreads that adjust for loss severities, volatility, credit risk and optionality. When available, broker quotes are used to validate the internal model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as assumptions about specific-issuer defaults and deferrals are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations. Assumptions are reviewed on a quarterly basis as specific-issuer deferral and defaults that occurred are compared to those that were projected and ongoing assumptions are adjusted in accordance with the level of unexpected deferrals and defaults that occurred.

        The following table presents quantitative information about recurring Level 3 fair value measurements at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016:

 
  Fair Value   Valuation Technique   Unobservable Inputs   Range
(Weighted Average)

June 30, 2017

                 

Collateralized debt obligations

  $ 589   Discounted cash flow   Collateral default rate   0%

            Recovery probability   15%

December 31, 2016

                 

Collateralized debt obligations

  $ 585   Discounted cash flow   Collateral default rate   0%

            Recovery probability   15%

        The fair value of equity securities of $528 and $529 at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively, was determined internally by considering the financial performance of the underlying entities and the Company's investment in those entities. Adjustments were considered for differences identified by management in regards to profitability, capital levels, and asset quality among other financial measures. As of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the Company noted that the fair value of equity securities approximated the cost basis in those equity securities.

F-28


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The carrying amounts and estimated fair values of financial instruments not carried at fair value, at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 are as follows:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at June 30, 2017  
 
  Carrying
Amount
 
 
  Fair Value   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3  

Financial Assets

                               

Cash and due from banks

  $ 25,974   $ 25,974   $ 25,974   $   $  

Investment securities, restricted stock

    18,360     NA *   N/A *   N/A *   N/A *

Mortgage loans held for sale

    579     589         589      

Loans, net

    2,205,530     2,238,952             2,238,952  

Accrued interest receivable

    9,170     9,170         229     8,941  

Financial Liabilities

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Demand deposits

  $ 1,424,260   $ 1,424,260   $ 1,424,260   $   $  

Time deposits

    372,064     371,394         371,394      

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    359,312     353,080         353,080      

Subordinated notes

    49,404     49,898         49,898      

Accrued interest payable

    4,396     4,396     1,040     3,356      

*
It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.


 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2016  
 
  Carrying
Amount
 
 
  Fair Value   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3  

Financial Assets

                               

Cash and due from banks

  $ 22,124   $ 22,124   $ 22,124   $   $  

Investment securities, restricted stock

    18,360     NA *   N/A *   N/A *   N/A *

Mortgage loans held for sale

    4,714     4,781         4,781      

Loans, net

    1,982,439     2,004,048             2,004,048  

Accrued interest receivable

    8,169     8,169         113     8,056  

Financial Liabilities

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Demand deposits

  $ 1,179,150   $ 1,179,150   $ 1,179,150   $   $  

Time deposits

    435,995     435,602           435,602        

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    308,198     300,990         300,990      

Subordinated notes

    49,338     49,461         49,461      

Accrued interest payable

    4,214     4,214     990     3,224      

*
It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.

        The following methods and assumptions, not previously presented, were used to estimate the fair value of the financial instrument for which it is practicable to estimate that value:

        Cash and Due from Banks.    The carrying amounts of cash and short-term instruments approximate fair values and are classified as Level 1.

        Investment Securities, Restricted Stock.    It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.

F-29


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        Loans.    Fair value of loans, excluding loans held for sale, are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality resulting in a Level 3 classification. Impaired loans are valued at the lower of cost or fair value as described previously. The methods utilized to estimate the fair value of loans do not necessarily represent an exit price.

        Loans Held for Sale.    The fair values of loans held for sale is estimated based upon binding contracts and quotes from third party investors.

        Accrued Interest Receivable.    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate fair value resulting in a Level 2 and Level 3 classification. Interest receivable is reflected as Level 2 or Level 3 depending upon the classification of the related investment securities available for sale and loans.

        Deposits.    The fair values disclosed for demand deposits (e.g., interest and non-interest checking, passbook savings, and certain types of money market accounts) are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (i.e., their carrying amount) resulting in a Level 1 classification. Fair values for fixed rate certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flows calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings.    The fair values of FHLB borrowings are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses based on the current borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Subordinated Notes.    The fair value of subordinated notes is based on quoted prices for subordinated notes with similar interest rate and structural characteristics and other observable market data resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Accrued Interest Payable.    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate fair value resulting in a Level 1 and Level 2 classification. Interest payable is reflected as Level 1 or Level 2 depending upon the classification of the related deposits.

Note 9—Regulatory Capital Requirements

        The Bank is subject to the capital adequacy requirements of the OCC. The Company, as a thrift holding company, is subject to the capital adequacy requirements of the Federal Reserve. Capital adequacy guidelines and prompt corrective action regulations involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classifications are also subject to qualitative judgments by regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors, and the regulators can lower classifications in certain cases. Prompt corrective action provisions are not applicable to thrift holding companies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate regulatory action that could have a direct material effect on the condensed consolidated financial statements.

        The final rules implementing Basel III became effective on January 1, 2015 with full compliance with all requirements being phased in over a multi-year schedule, and fully phased in by January 1, 2019. Under the Basel III rules, the Company must hold a capital conservation buffer over the

F-30


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 9—Regulatory Capital Requirements (Continued)

adequately capitalized risk-based capital ratios. The capital conservation buffer is being phased in from 0.0% for 2015 to 2.50% by 2019. The capital conservation buffer is 1.25% for 2017. The net unrealized gain or loss on investment securities available for sale is not included in regulatory capital. Management believes that as of June 30, 2017, the Company and the Bank meet all regulatory capital requirements to which they are subject.

        Prompt corrective action regulations provide five classifications, including well-capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, and critically undercapitalized, although these terms are not used to represent overall financial condition. The minimum requirements, excluding significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized categories, are as follows:

 
  Capital
Weighted
Assets
   
   
 
 
  Tier 1
Capital to
Average
Assets
   
 
 
  Common
Tier 1
(CET1)
 
 
  Total   Tier 1  

Well Capitalized

    10.0 %   8.0 %   5.0 %   6.5 %

Adequately Capitalized

    8.0 %   6.0 %   4.0 %   4.5 %

Undercapitalized

    6.0 %   4.0 %   3.0 %   3.0 %

        At June 30, 2017, the most recent regulatory notifications categorized the Bank as well capitalized. There have been no conditions or events since these notifications that management believes would have changed the Bank's category.

        At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the Bank exceeded all capital requirements to be categorized as well-capitalized and the Company exceeded the Capital Adequacy requirements as presented below. The Company and the Bank's actual and minimum required capital amounts and ratios at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 are as follows:

 
  Actual   For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
  To be Well
Capitalized
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  

June 30, 2017

                                     

Total adjusted capital to risk weighted assets:

                                     

Consolidated

  $ 239,160     16.11 % $ 118,787     8.00 %   NA     NA  

Bank

    221,067     14.89     118,787     8.00   $ 148,483     10.00 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk weighted assets

                                     

Consolidated

    173,510     11.69     89,090     6.00     NA     NA  

Bank

    204,821     13.79     89,090     6.00     118,787     8.00  

Common Tier 1 (CET1)

                                     

Consolidated

    173,510     11.69     66,817     4.50     NA     NA  

Bank

    204,821     13.79     66,817     4.50     96,514     6.50  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

                                     

Consolidated

    173,510     7.62     91,084     4.00     NA     NA  

Bank

    204,821     8.99     91,084     4.00     113,855     5.00  

F-31


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 9—Regulatory Capital Requirements (Continued)


 
  Actual   For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
  To be Well
Capitalized
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  

December 31, 2016

                                     

Total adjusted capital to risk weighted assets:

                                     

Consolidated

  $ 225,625     17.07 % $ 105,716     8.00 %   N/A     N/A  

Bank

    207,891     15.73     105,716     8.00   $ 132,146     10.00 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk weighted assets

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     12.22     79,287     6.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,069     14.61     79,287     6.00     105,716     8.00  

Common Tier 1 (CET1)

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     12.22     59,466     4.50     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,056     14.61     59,466     4.50     85,895     6.50  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     7.74     83,404     4.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,069     9.26     83,404     4.00     104,255     5.00  

Dividend Restrictions

        As noted above, banking regulations require the Bank to maintain certain capital levels and may limit the dividends paid by the bank to the holding company or by the holding company to its shareholders. The Company's principal source of funds for dividend payments is dividends received from the Bank and banking regulations limit the dividends that may be paid. Also, pursuant to the terms of the subordinated note agreements, the Company may pay dividends if it is "well capitalized" as defined by regulatory guidelines. At June 30, 2017, $54.7 million of consolidated retained earnings were available to pay dividends to the Company's shareholders.

        The Qualified Thrift Lender ("QTL") test requires that a minimum of 65% of assets be maintained in housing-related finance and other specified areas. If the QTL test is not met, limits are placed on growth, branching, new investments, FHLB Advances and dividends, or the Bank must convert to a commercial bank charter. Management believes that the QTL test has been met.

Note 10—Related Party Transactions

        As disclosed in Note 1, the Company purchased an entity owned 80% by its principal shareholder and 20% by a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank. At the time of the purchase in April 2017, the Director was and will continue as the Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") of the purchased entity. For the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, the condensed consolidated statements of income include compensation-related expenses of $125 and $250, respectively, for the Director's services as CEO of this purchased entity.

        From time to time, the Company makes charitable contributions to a foundation which certain members of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank, and whom are also related to the Company's principal shareholder, serve as trustees of the foundation. The Company paid $450 to the foundation during the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016.

F-32


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 10—Related Party Transactions (Continued)

        The Bank leases certain storage and office space from entities owned by the Company's principal shareholders. Amounts paid under such leases totaled $19 and $16 for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

        The Bank provides monthly data processing and programming services to entities controlled by the Company's principal shareholders. Aggregate fees paid amounted to $48 and $30 for the six months ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Note 11—Commitments and Contingencies

Legal Proceedings

        The Company and its subsidiaries may be subject to legal actions and claims arising from contracts or other matters from time to time in the ordinary course of business. Management is not aware of any pending or threatened litigation where the ultimate disposition or resolution could have a material adverse effect on its financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

        Some financial instruments, such as loan commitments, credit lines, letters of credit, and overdraft protection, are issued to meet customer financing needs. These are agreements to provide credit or to support the credit of others, as long as conditions established in the contract are met, and usually have expiration dates. Commitments may expire without being used. Off-balance-sheet risk to credit loss exists up to the face amount of these instruments, although material losses are not anticipated. The same credit policies are used to make such commitments as are used for loans, including obtaining collateral at exercise of the commitment. The following is a summary of the total amount of loan commitments and standby letters of credit outstanding at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016:

 
  June 30,
2017
  December 31,
2016
 

Standby letters of credit

  $ 70   $ 72  

Commitment to originate loans

    230,257     125,110  

Unused lines of credit

    154,854     116,810  

Note 12—Subsequent Events

Borrowings

        On August 14, 2017, the Company sold an additional $15 million in aggregate principal amount of 7.0% Fixed to Floating Subordinated Notes to accredited investors due April 15, 2026. The terms of the subordinated note purchase agreements were substantially identical to the subordinated notes that were previously sold in 2016, except that the first interest payment on the notes included accrued interest from April 15, 2017.

Sale of Mortgage Loans

        In August 2017, the Company committed to sell a portfolio of residential mortgage loans with an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $141 million to accredited investors. The selling price for the loans was 102.25% times the unpaid principal balance with mortgage servicing retained by the Company.

F-33


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Board of Directors and Shareholders
Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
Southfield, Michigan

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, shareholders' equity, and cash flows for the years then ended. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of Sterling Bancorp Inc.'s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

        We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) and in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement. Sterling Bancorp, Inc. is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Our audit included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.'s internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall consolidated financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. at December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years then ended, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

    /s/ Crowe Horwath LLP
    Crowe Horwath LLP

Grand Rapids, Michigan
September 15, 2017

F-34


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(dollars in thousands)

 
  December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  

Assets

             

Cash and due from banks

  $ 22,124   $ 13,616  

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

        1,992  

Investment securities available for sale, at fair value

    75,606     46,678  

Investment securities, restricted stock, at cost

    18,360     17,125  

Mortgage loans held for sale

    4,714     2,711  

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses of $14,822 and $10,984

    1,982,439     1,575,802  

Leasehold improvements and equipment, net

    5,855     4,892  

Cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    30,028     29,331  

Deferred tax asset

    9,516     8,798  

Other assets

    14,959     11,063  

Total assets

  $ 2,163,601   $ 1,712,008  

Liabilities and Shareholders' Equity

             

Liabilities:

             

Noninterest-bearing deposits

  $ 59,231   $ 44,298  

Interest-bearing deposits

    1,555,914     1,185,462  

Total deposits

    1,615,145     1,229,760  

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    308,198     326,437  

Subordinated notes (face amount of $50,000 less unamortized issuance costs of $662)

    49,338      

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

    28,648     19,533  

Total liabilities

    2,001,329     1,575,730  

Commitments and contingencies (note 15)

   
 
   
 
 

Shareholders' equity:

   
 
   
 
 

Preferred stock, authorized 1,000,000 shares, no shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively

         

Common stock, voting, no par value, authorized 490,000,000 shares, issued and outstanding 40,199,000 shares at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively

    22,863     22,863  

Common stock, non-voting, no par value, authorized 10,000,000 shares, issued and outstanding 5,072,000 shares at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively

    2,885     2,885  

Additional paid-in capital

    15,118     14,418  

Retained earnings

    121,446     96,779  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (40 )   (667 )

Total shareholders' equity

    162,272     136,278  

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 2,163,601   $ 1,712,008  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-35


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Income

(dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  

Interest income

             

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 89,566   $ 65,111  

Interest and dividends on investment securities

    1,211     806  

Other interest

    26     33  

Total interest income

    90,803     65,950  

Interest expense

             

Interest on deposits

    11,428     6,526  

Interest on Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    2,439     1,539  

Interest on subordinated notes and other

    1,978     43  

Total interest expense

    15,845     8,108  

Net interest income

    74,958     57,842  

Provision for loan losses

    1,280     525  

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    73,678     57,317  

Non-interest income

             

Service charges and fees

    2,456     1,336  

Investment management and advisory fees

    3,209     3,378  

Investment securities losses, net

    (898 )    

Gain on sale of other real estate owned, net

    31     102  

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    1,541     1,551  

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    8,016     658  

Income on cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    1,166     1,159  

Other income

    485     433  

Total non-interest income

    16,006     8,617  

Non-interest expense

             

Salaries and employee benefits

    17,812     15,772  

Occupancy and equipment

    4,891     4,430  

Professional fees

    1,466     1,219  

Advertising and marketing

    1,449     773  

FDIC assessments

    990     725  

Data processing

    986     876  

Other

    5,641     4,341  

Total non-interest expense

    33,235     28,136  

Income before income taxes

    56,449     37,798  

Income tax expense

    23,215     15,287  

Net income

  $ 33,234   $ 22,511  

Income per share, basic and diluted

  $ 0.73   $ 0.49  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic and diluted

    45,271,000     46,148,000  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-36


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

(dollars in thousands)

 
  Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2016   2015  

Net income

  $ 33,234   $ 22,511  

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

             

Unrealized gains (losses) on investment securities available for sale arising during the year, net of tax effect of ($8) and $29 in 2016 and 2015, respectively

    43     (55 )

Less: reclassification adjustment for losses included in net income of $898 and $— included in investment securities losses, net, and tax effect of $314 and $— included in income tax expense, in 2016 and 2015, respectively

    584      

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

    627     (55 )

Comprehensive income

  $ 33,861   $ 22,456  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-37


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders' Equity

(dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

 
  Common Stock    
   
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
   
 
 
  Additional
Paid-in
Capital
  Retained
Earnings
  Total
Shareholders'
Equity
 
 
  Voting   Nonvoting  

Balance at January 1, 2015

  $ 27,607   $ 4,432   $ 14,192   $ 81,268   $ (612 ) $ 126,887  

Net income

                22,511         22,511  

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity (Note 1)

            226             226  

Other comprehensive loss

                    (55 )   (55 )

Dividends distributed ($0.15 per share)

                (7,000 )       (7,000 )

Repurchase of shares of common stock (Note 10)

    (4,744 )   (1,547 )               (6,291 )

Balance at December 31, 2015

    22,863     2,885     14,418     96,779     (667 )   136,278  

Net income

                33,234         33,234  

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity

            700             700  

Other comprehensive income

                    627     627  

Dividends distributed ($0.19 per share)

                (8,567 )       (8,567 )

Balance at December 31, 2016

  $ 22,863   $ 2,885   $ 15,118   $ 121,446   $ (40 ) $ 162,272  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-38


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(dollars in thousands)

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  

Cash Flows From Operating Activities

             

Net income

  $ 33,234   $ 22,511  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

             

Provision for loan losses

    1,280     525  

Deferred income taxes

    (1,041 )   (541 )

Net realized losses on sale of investment securities available for sale

    898      

Investment securities available for sale amortization and accretion, net

    33     (64 )

Depreciation and amortization of leasehold improvements and equipment

    1,058     1,120  

Amortization of intangible

    450     450  

Gain on sale of other real estate owned

    (31 )   (108 )

Loans originated for sale

    (72,279 )   (90,798 )

Proceeds from the sale of mortgage loans held for sale

    71,817     91,306  

Gain on sale of mortgage loans

    (1,541 )   (1,551 )

Gain on sale of portfolio loans

    (8,016 )   (658 )

Increase in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    (697 )   (734 )

Net change in servicing assets

    624     244  

Other

    67     6  

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

             

Other assets

    (7,308 )   (3,536 )

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

    10,156     6,321  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    28,704     24,493  

Cash Flows From Investing Activities

             

Investment securities available for sale:

             

Maturities and principal receipts

    66,359     49,707  

Sales

    596      

Purchases

    (93,871 )   (63,846 )

Purchases of investment securities, restricted stock

    (1,235 )   (7,703 )

Redemptions of investment securities, restricted stock

        3,228  

Loans originated, net of repayments

    (687,318 )   (463,866 )

Purchases of portfolio loans

        (1,099 )

Proceeds from the sale of portfolio loans

    287,368     23,693  

Purchase of leasehold improvements and equipment

    (2,004 )   (1,497 )

Proceeds from the sale of other real estate owned

    1,359     509  

Net cash used in investing activities

    (428,746 )   (460,874 )

Cash Flows From Financing Activities

             

Net increase in deposits

    385,385     276,525  

Proceeds from advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    5,004,000     1,574,800  

Repayments of advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    (5,034,000 )   (1,397,800 )

Net change in line of credit with Federal Home Loan Bank

    11,761     1,352  

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes

    50,000      

Payment of debt issuance costs

    (729 )    

Repurchase of shares of common stock

        (6,291 )

Capital contributions from controlling member of merged entity

    700     226  

Dividends paid to shareholders

    (8,567 )   (7,000 )

Net cash provided by financing activities

    408,550     441,812  

Net increase in cash and due from banks

    8,508     5,431  

Cash and due from banks at beginning of period

    13,616     8,185  

Cash and due from banks at end of period

  $ 22,124   $ 13,616  

Supplemental cash flows information

             

Cash paid:

             

Interest

  $ 14,594   $ 7,494  

Income taxes

  $ 26,350   $ 14,890  

Supplemental noncash disclosures

             

Transfer from loans to other real estate owned

  $ 48   $ 1,681  

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-39


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

(dollars in thousands)

Note 1—Nature of Operations and Basis of Presentation

Nature of Operations

        Sterling Bancorp, Inc. (the "Company") is a unitary thrift holding company that was incorporated in 1989 and the parent company to its wholly owned subsidiary, Sterling Bank and Trust, f.s.b. (the "Bank"). The Company's business is conducted through the Bank which was formed in 1984. The Company is headquartered in Southfield, Michigan and its operations are in the financial services industry. Management evaluates the performance of its business based on one reportable segment, community banking.

        The Company is subject to regulation, examination and supervision by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve ("Federal Reserve"). The Bank is a federally chartered stock savings bank which is subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the office of the Comptroller of the Currency ("OCC") of the U.S. Department of Treasury and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC") and a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") system. The Bank originates construction, commercial real estate, residential mortgage and consumer loans and receives deposits from its customers located primarily in California and Michigan. The Bank operates through a network of 26 branches; one branch at its headquarters and 24 branches located in San Francisco and Los Angeles, California and a newly opened branch located in New York, New York.

Basis of Presentation

Merger of Quantum Fund, LLC

        On April 24, 2017, the Bank acquired all the outstanding equity interests of Quantum Fund, LLC, an entity controlled by the Company's principal shareholder who owns, directly and indirectly 80% of the members' interests with the remaining 20% members' interest held by a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank, for $2.9 million in cash. The entity operates a registered investment advisory business with assets held under management of approximately $425 million. In 2017, the Bank recorded the assets and liabilities transferred at their carrying amounts, consisting primarily of a customer-related intangible asset, in the accounts of the entity transferred. Prior to 2017, the consolidated financial statements have been retrospectively adjusted to include the results of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, and the entity under common control on a combined basis, since the entities were under common control for the periods presented. The retrospective adjustments made to include the results of Quantum in these consolidated financial statements increased total shareholders' equity by $2,361 at January 1, 2015, increased total shareholders' equity and other assets at December 31, 2016 and 2015 by approximately $2,000 and $1,500 respectively, and decreased net income for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 by approximately $1,200 and $600, respectively.

Stock Split

        In September 2017, the Board of Directors approved a 1,000 for one stock split to be effected as a stock dividend on the Company's voting and non-voting common stock. The stock split was effected on September 11, 2017. In addition, the Board of Directors and shareholders approved an increase in the number of authorized shares of common stock to 500 million consisting of 490 million shares of voting common stock, no par value, and 10 million shares of non-voting common stock, no par value. All

F-40


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 1—Nature of Operations and Basis of Presentation (Continued)

share and per share amounts presented in these consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, have been retroactively adjusted, where applicable, to reflect the stock split.

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Principles of Consolidation

        The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared using accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP"). The consolidated financial statements include the results of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, and an entity under common control that was merged with the Company in April 2017 (note 1). All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in the consolidation.

Use of Estimates

        The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Fair Value Measurements

        The Bank utilizes fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities and to determine fair value disclosures. The determination of fair values of financial instruments often requires the use of estimates. In cases where quoted market values in an active market are not available, the Bank uses present value techniques and other valuations methods, as disclosed in note 12, to estimate the fair value of its financial instruments. These valuation methods require considerable judgment and the resulting estimates of fair value can be significantly affected by the assumptions made and methods used.

        Investments securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Additionally, from time to time, the Bank may be required to record other assets and liabilities on a nonrecurring basis, such as impaired loans, other real estate owned, nonmarketable equity securities and certain other assets and liabilities. These nonrecurring fair value adjustments generally involve write-downs of individual assets or application of lower of amortized cost or fair value accounting.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

        For the purposes of the accompanying statements of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents are defined as the amounts included in the consolidated balance sheets under the caption "Cash and due from banks" which includes cash and time deposits, and other deposits held with other banks with original maturities of three months or less. Cash on hand or on deposit at December 31, 2016 and 2015 of $6,516 and $2,568, respectively, was required to be held to meet regulatory reserve and clearing requirements.

F-41


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        The Company presents the cash flows from customer loans, deposit transactions and short-term borrowings on a net basis in its consolidated statements of cash flows.

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

        Interest-bearing deposits with other banks, consisting of certificates of deposit, have maturities greater than three months and are carried at cost.

Concentration of Credit Risk

        The Company's loan portfolio consists primarily of residential real estate loans which are collateralized by real estate. At December 31, 2016, residential real estate loans accounted for 81% of the loan portfolio. In addition, most of these residential loans and other commercial loans have been made to individuals and businesses in the state of California which are dependent on the area economy for their livelihoods and servicing of their loan obligation. At December 31, 2016, approximately 99% of the loan portfolio was originated in California.

Investment Securities

        Investment securities are classified as either available for sale or held to maturity. Management determines the classification of the investment securities when they are purchased.

        Investment securities available for sale are stated at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses excluded from income and shown as a separate component of shareholders' equity in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of income taxes. Held to maturity securities are carried at amortized cost when management has the positive intent and ability to hold them to maturity. The amortized cost of debt securities classified as held to maturity or available for sale is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts over the contractual life of the investment security using the effective interest method or, in the case of mortgage-backed securities, over the estimated life of the investment security using the effective yield method.

        Interest income includes amortization or accretion of purchase premium or discount. Gains and losses on sales are recorded on the settlement date and determined using the specific identification method.

        Management evaluates the investment securities for other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") at least on a quarterly basis and more frequently when economic or market conditions warrant such an evaluation. In determining OTTI for debt securities, management considers many factors, including: (1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, (3) whether the market decline was affected by macroeconomic conditions, and (4) whether the Company has the intent to sell the debt security or more likely than not will be required to sell the debt security before its anticipated recovery. The assessment of whether an other-than-temporary decline exists involves a high degree of subjectivity and judgment and is based on the information available to management at a point in time. A charge is recognized against income for all or a portion of the impairment if the loss is determined to be other than temporary.

F-42


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        If the Bank intends to sell the debt security or it is more likely than not that the Bank will be required to sell the debt security prior to the recovery of its amortized cost basis, the debt security is written down to fair value, and the full amount of any impairment charge is recorded as a loss in the consolidated statements of income. If the Bank does not intend to sell the debt security and it is more likely than not that the Bank will not be required to sell the debt security prior to recovery of its amortized cost basis, only the current period credit loss of any impairment of a debt security is recognized in the consolidated statements of income, with the remaining impairment recorded in other comprehensive income.

        The OTTI review for equity securities includes an analysis of the facts and circumstances of each individual investment. A decline in value of equity security that is considered other than temporary is recorded in the consolidated statements of income.

Investment Securities, Restricted Stock

        The Bank is a member of the FHLB system. Members are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other factors, and may invest additional amounts. The FHLB stock is carried at cost, classified as a restricted security, and periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. The FHLB stock does not have a readily determinable fair value and no quoted market value as the ownership is restricted to member institutions and the FHLB stock is pledged as collateral on FHLB borrowings. Cash and stock dividends are reported as income in interest and dividends on invesment securities in the consolidated statements of income. Cash dividends received amounted to $730 and $544 for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Mortgage Loans Held for Sale

        Residential real estate loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market are carried at the lower of amortized cost or fair value in the aggregate as determined by outstanding commitments from investors. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recorded as a valuation allowance and charged to the consolidated statements of income. Residential real estate loans originated as held for investment are periodically sold with servicing retained in order to manage liquidity, interest rate or concentration risk. Loans that are transferred into loans held for sale from loans held for investment, due to a change in intent, are recorded at the lower of amortized cost or fair value.

        When loans originally classified as held for sale or as held for investment are reclassified due to a change in intent or ability to hold, cash flows associated with the loans will be classified in the consolidated statements of cash flows as operating or investing, as appropriate, in accordance with the initial classification of the loans.

        Residential real estate loans held for sale are generally sold with servicing rights retained. The carrying value of residential real estate loans sold is reduced by the amount allocated to the servicing right. Gains and losses on sales of residential real estate loans are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the related loan sold.

F-43


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Loans

        Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are stated at the principal balance outstanding, net of unamortized fees and costs on originated loans and allowances for loan losses. Loan origination fees and certain direct loan origination costs are deferred and amortized over the lives of the respective loans as a yield adjustment using the effective interest method.

        Interest income on loans is accrued as earned using the interest method over the term of the loan. The accrual of interest income is discontinued at the time the loan is 90 days past due or earlier if conditions warrant (i.e. nonaccrual loan), unless the loan is secured and in the process of collection. In all cases, loans are placed on nonaccrual status or charged off at an earlier date if collection of principal or interest is considered doubtful. When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, interest accrued and unpaid during prior periods is reversed. Any payments on nonaccrual loans are applied first to outstanding loan principal amounts and then to the recovery of the charged off loan amounts. Any excess is treated as a recovery of interest and fees. Loans are returned to accrual status after all principal and interest amounts contractually due are made and future payments are reasonably assured.

        A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Loans, for which the terms have been modified, and for which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, are considered troubled debt restructurings, as defined below, and classified as impaired.

        Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due. Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired. Management determines the significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower's prior payment record, and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed.

        Construction and commercial real estate loans and commercial lines of credit are individually evaluated for impairment. If a loan is impaired, a portion of the allowance for loan losses is allocated so that the loan is reported, net, at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan's existing rate or at the fair value of collateral if repayment is expected solely from the collateral or operations of collateral. Large groups of smaller balance homogeneous loans, such as consumer and residential real estate loans, are collectively evaluated for impairment, and accordingly, are not separately identified for impairment disclosures.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

        The Bank periodically grants concessions to its customers in an attempt to protect as much of its investment as possible and minimize risk of loss. Loans which have been modified resulting in a concession, and which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, are considered troubled debt restructurings. To determine whether a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty, an evaluation is performed of the probability that the borrower will be in payment default on any of its debt in the

F-44


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

foreseeable future without the modification. This evaluation is performed under the Company's internal underwriting policy.

        Troubled debt restructurings are separately identified for impairment disclosures and are measured at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan's effective rate at inception. If a troubled debt restructuring is considered a collateral dependent loan, the loan is reported, net, at the fair value of the collateral. For loans that are considered troubled debt restructurings that subsequently go into default, the Company determines the amount to reserve in accordance with the accounting policy for the allowance for loan losses on loans individually identified as impaired.

Allowance for Loan Losses

        The allowance for loan losses is a valuation allowance for probable incurred credit losses, increased or decreased by the provision (benefit) for loan losses and decreased by charge offs less recoveries. Loan losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of a loan balance is confirmed. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. Management estimates the allowance balance required using past loan loss experience, the nature and volume of the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, economic conditions, and other factors. Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for any loan that, in management's judgment, should be charged off.

        The allowance consists of specific and general components. The specific component relates to loans that are individually classified as impaired. The general component covers all other loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for general economic conditions and other qualitative factors by loan segment.

        The general reserve component covers all nonimpaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for qualitative factors. The historical loss experience is determined by portfolio segment, discussed below, and is based on the actual loss history experienced over the most recent three years. This actual loss experience is supplemented with economic and other factors based on the risks present for each portfolio segment. These economic and other risk factors include consideration of the following: levels of and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge offs and recoveries; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards; other changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; national and local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations.

        The following portfolio segments have been identified:

F-45


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Cash Surrender Value of Bank-Owned Life Insurance

        The Bank has purchased life insurance policies on certain officers and employees; in addition, the Bank still owns policies on retired and former employees. Cash surrender value of bank owned life insurance is recorded at the amount that can be realized under the insurance contract at the balance sheet date, which is the cash surrender value adjusted for other charges or other amounts due that are probable at settlement.

Long-Lived Assets

        Long-lived assets, such as property and equipment, and definite-lived intangible assets, are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. If circumstances require long-lived assets or asset groups to be tested for possible impairment, the Company compares the undiscounted cash flows expected to be generated by that asset or asset group to its carrying amount. If the carrying amount of the long-lived asset or asset group is not recoverable on an undiscounted cash flow basis, an impairment charge is recognized to the extent that the carrying amount exceeds its fair value. Fair value is determined

F-46


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

through various valuation techniques, such as discounted cash flow models and third-party independent appraisals.

        Definite-lived intangible assets, consisting of customer-related intangibles, are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of ten years. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, customer-related intangibles totaled $4,500, less accumulated amortization of $3,150 and $2,700, respectively. Amortization expense related to the customer-related intangibles was $450 for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. Future annual amortization is $450 for each of the years 2017 through 2019.

Mortgage Servicing Rights

        Servicing assets (i.e. mortgage servicing rights) are recognized separately when residential real estate loans are sold with servicing rights retained by the Bank. Mortgage servicing rights are initially recorded at fair value. Fair value is determined based on market prices for comparable mortgage servicing contracts, when available or alternatively, is based on a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income. The servicing assets are subsequently measured using the amortization method which requires servicing assets to be amortized into non-interest income in proportion to, and over the period of, the estimated future net servicing income of the underlying loans.

        Servicing assets are evaluated for impairment based upon the fair value of the mortgage servicing rights as compared to its carrying amount. Impairment is determined by stratifying rights into groupings based on predominant risk characteristics, such as interest rate, loan type, and investor type. Impairment is recognized through a valuation allowance for an individual grouping, to the extent that fair value is less than the carrying amount. If the Company later determines that all or a portion of the impairment no longer exists for a particular grouping, a reduction of the allowance may be recorded as an increase to income. The fair values of servicing assets are subject to significant fluctuations due to changes in estimated and actual prepayment speeds and default rates and losses.

        Servicing fee income is recorded for fees earned for servicing loans. The fees are based on a contractual percentage of the outstanding principal, or a fixed amount per loan and are recognized as income when earned. The Bank also records late fees and ancillary fees related to loan servicing which were not material for the periods presented.

Transfers of Financial Assets

        Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales, when control over the assets has been relinquished. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when the assets have been isolated from the Company, the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

F-47


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Other Real Estate Owned

        Other real estate owned consists of properties acquired through or instead of loan foreclosure. These properties, as held for sale properties, are recorded at fair value, less costs to sell when acquired, establishing a new cost basis for the property. These properties are maintained at the lower of cost or fair value less costs to sell. If fair value declines below this cost basis, a valuation allowance is recorded with an expense to gain on sale of other real estate owned, net recorded in non-interest income on the consolidated statements of income. Operating costs after acquisition are expensed in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of income. At December 31, 2015, the Bank had other real estate owned of $1,280 which has been included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheet. At December 31, 2016, no other real estate owned was held. At December 31, 2016, approximately $110 of loans secured by residential real estate were in the process of foreclosure.

Loan Commitments and Related Financial Instruments

        Financial instruments include off-balance sheet credit instruments, such as commitments to make loans and commercial letters of credit, issued to meet customer financing needs. The face amount for these items represents the exposure to loss, before considering customer collateral or ability to repay. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.

Assets Held under Administration and Investment Management and Advisory Fees

        The Company does not include assets held in fiduciary or agency capacities in the consolidated balance sheets as such assets held under administration are not assets of the Company. Fees from asset management activities are recorded on an accrual basis over the period in which the service is provided. Fees, as set forth in the underlying client contract, are a function of the market value of assets administrated and managed.

Income Taxes

        Income taxes are provided for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred taxes of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period the change occurs. Deferred tax assets are reduced, through a valuation allowance, if necessary, by the amount of such benefits that are not expected to be realized based on current available evidence.

        A tax position is recognized as a benefit only if it is "more likely than not" that the tax position would be sustained in a tax examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur. The amount recognized is the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized on examination. For tax positions not meeting the more likely than not test, no tax benefit is recorded. The Company recognizes interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense.

F-48


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Income per Share, Basic and Diluted

        Basic income per share represents income available to common shareholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted income per share represents net income available to common shareholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, plus the effect of outstanding dilutive potential common shares. The Company did not have any dilutive securities therefore, basic and diluted income per share is the same for all periods presented.

Recently Issued Accounting Guidance

        In March 2017, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued Accounting Standards Update ("ASU") No. 2017-08, Receivables-Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs (Subtopic 310-20): Premium Amortization on Purchased Callable Debt Securities, which amends the amortization period for certain purchased callable debt securities held at a premium. The amendments shorten the amortization period to the earliest call date. Under current U.S. GAAP, entities generally amortize the premium as an adjustment of yield over the contractual life of the instrument. The amendments do not change the accounting for securities held at a discount. ASU No. 2017-08 will be effective for annual reporting periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. The amendments should be applied using a modified-retrospective transition method as of the beginning of the period of adoption. Early adoption is permitted, including adoption in an interim period. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of ASU No. 2017-08 on its consolidated financial statements, but it is not expected to have a material impact due to the Company has not typically acquired callable securities with purchase premiums.

        In August 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-15, Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments, to reduce current diversity in practice in how certain cash receipts and cash payments are presented and classified in the statement of cash flows. ASU No. 2016-15 will be effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early adoption is permitted, including adoption in an interim period. The amendments should be applied using a retrospective transition method to each period presented. The Company has early adopted ASU No. 2016-15 in these annual consolidated financial statements.

        In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments, which is intended to improve financial reporting by requiring recording of credit losses on loans and other financial instruments on a more timely basis. The guidance will replace the current incurred loss accounting model with an expected loss approach and requires the measurement of all expected credit losses for financial assets held at the reporting date based on historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The guidance requires enhanced disclosures to help investors and other financial statement users better understand significant estimates and judgments used in estimating credit losses, as well as the credit quality and underwriting standards of an organization's portfolio. ASU No. 2016-13 is effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods, beginning after December 15, 2019. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of ASU No. 2016-13 but expects to recognize a one-time cumulative effect adjustment to the allowance for loan losses as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which ASU No. 2016-13 is effective. The Company has not yet determined the

F-49


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

magnitude of any such one-time adjustment or the overall impact of ASU No. 2016-13 on its consolidated financial statements.

        In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) which require lessees to recognize the following for all leases, except for short-term leases, at the commencement date: (1) a lease liability which is a lessee's obligation to make lease payments arising from a lease, measured on a discounted basis; and (2) a right-of-use asset, which is an asset that represents the lessee's right to use, or control the use of, a specified asset for the lease term. Lessor accounting is largely unchanged. ASU No. 2016-02 will also require expanded disclosures. ASU No. 2016-02 is effective for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the ASU No. 2016-02 on its financial condition and results of operations. The Company will record a right-of-use asset and a lease liability on its consolidated balance sheet for the leases of its facilities in place at adoption of this ASU.

        In January 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-01, Financial Instruments—Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities, which, among other things, (i) requires equity investments, with certain exceptions, to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in net income, (ii) simplifies the impairment assessment of equity investments without readily determinable fair values by requiring a qualitative assessment to identify impairment, (iii) eliminates the requirement for public business entities to disclose the methods and significant assumptions used to estimate the fair value that is required to be disclosed for financial instruments measured at amortized cost on the balance sheets, (iv) requires public business entities to use the exit price notion when measuring the fair value of financial instruments for disclosure purposes, (v) requires an entity to present separately in other comprehensive income the portion of the total change in the fair value of a liability resulting from a change in the instrument-specific credit risk when the entity has elected to measure the liability at fair value in accordance with the fair value option for financial instruments, (vi) requires separate presentation of financial assets and financial liabilities by measurement category and form of financial asset on the balance sheets or the accompanying notes to the financial statements and (viii) clarifies that an entity should evaluate the need for a valuation allowance on a deferred tax asset related to investment securities. ASU No. 2016-01 is effective retrospectively for annual periods and interim periods within those annual periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of adopting ASU No. 2016-01 on the consolidated financial statements. The Company plans to provide the additional required disclosures, but this ASU is not expected to have a material impact on the Company's financial condition or results of operations.

        In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606), which is intended to improve and converge the financial reporting requirements for revenue contracts with customers. Previous accounting guidance comprised broad revenue recognition concepts along with numerous industry-specific requirements. Under the new guidance, an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods and services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration in exchange for those goods and services. It also establishes a five-step model which entities must follow to recognize revenue. In April 2016, the FASB clarified the following two aspects: identifying performance obligations and the licensing implementation guidance while retaining the related principles for those areas. In May 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-12,

F-50


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 2—Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606): Narrow -Scope Improvements and Practical Expedients, to provide a limited number of changes to its revenue recognition standard. The amendments clarify the assessment of the likelihood that revenue will be collected from a contract, the guidance for presenting sales taxes and similar taxes, and the timing for measuring customer payments that are not in cash. The amendment also specifies that a contract should be considered complete if all, or substantially all, of its revenue has been collected prior to making the transition to the new standard. In addition, the update clarifies the disclosure requirements for transition to the new standard by adjusting amounts from prior reporting periods. In December 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-20, Technical Corrections and Improvement to Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers. The banking industry does not expect significant changes because major sources of revenue are from financial instruments that have been excluded from the scope of the new guidance including loans, derivatives, debt and equity securities, etc. However, the new guidance affects other fees charged by banks, such as asset management fees, credit card interchange fees, deposit account fees, etc. Adoption of ASU No. 2014-09 may be made on a full retrospective basis with practical expedients, or on a modified retrospective basis with a cumulative effect adjustment on the initial application along with supplementary disclosures. ASU No. 2014-09 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company does not expect ASU No. 2014-09 and its related amendments to have a material impact on revenue closely associated with financial instruments, including interest income. The Company is currently in the process of performing an overall assessment of its revenue streams impacted by ASU No. 2014-09, including deposit related fees and asset management fees, to assess the impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements and determine its transition method.

Note 3—Investment Securities

        The following tables summarize the amortized cost and fair value of investment securities available for sale at December 31, 2016 and 2015 and the corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and losses:

 
  December 31, 2016  
 
   
  Gross
Unrealized
   
 
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 
 
  Gain   Loss  

Available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 70,072   $ 7   $ (39 ) $ 70,040  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,411     51         2,462  

Collateralized debt obligations

    610         (25 )   585  

Other securities

    2,045         (55 )   1,990  

Equity securities

    529             529  

Total

  $ 75,667   $ 58   $ (119 ) $ 75,606  

F-51


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities (Continued)

 
  December 31, 2015  
 
   
  Gross
Unrealized
   
 
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 
 
  Gain   Loss  

Available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 40,039   $ 5   $ (30 ) $ 40,014  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,970     78         3,048  

Collateralized debt obligations

    2,104         (1,040 )   1,064  

Other securities

    2,045         (23 )   2,022  

Equity securities

    530             530  

Total

  $ 47,688   $ 83   $ (1,093 ) $ 46,678  

        Other securities consist of an investment in a qualified community reinvestment act investment fund, which is a publicly-traded mutual fund. Equity securities consist of an investment in Pacific Coast Banker's Bank, a thinly traded, restricted stock, and an investment in a service corporation. All interest and dividends on investment securities are taxable.

        The proceeds from the sale of investment securities available for sale were $596 with $898 of gross losses realized on these sales for the year ended December 31, 2016.

        The table summarizes the amortized cost and fair value of investment securities available for sale, shown by contractual maturity at December 31, 2016. Securities with no stated maturity are shown separately.

 
  Amortized
Cost
  Fair
Value
 

U.S. Treasury securities

             

Due less than one year

  $ 70,072   $ 70,040  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,411     2,462  

Collateralized debt obligations

    610     585  

Other securities

    2,045     1,990  

Equity securities

    529     529  

Total

  $ 75,667   $ 75,606  

        Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities if borrowers have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

F-52


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities (Continued)

        The table summarizes investment securities available for sale, at fair value, with unrealized losses at December 31, 2016 and 2015 aggregated by major security type and length of time the individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, as follows:

 
  December 31, 2016  
 
  Less than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Total  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
 

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 41,518   $ (39 ) $   $   $ 41,518   $ (39 )

Collateralized debt obligations

            585     (25 )   585     (25 )

Other securities

    1,990     (55 )           1,990     (55 )

Total

  $ 43,508   $ (94 ) $ 585   $ (25 ) $ 44,093   $ (119 )

 

 
  December 31, 2015  
 
  Less than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Total  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Losses
 

U.S. Treasury securities

  $ 31,313   $ (30 ) $   $   $ 31,313   $ (30 )

Collateralized debt obligations

            1,064     (1,040 )   1,064     (1,040 )

Other securities

            2,022     (23 )   2,022     (23 )

Total

  $ 31,313   $ (30 ) $ 3,086   $ (1,063 ) $ 34,399   $ (1,093 )

        As of December 31, 2016, the Company's security portfolio consisted of 13 securities, with five in an unrealized loss position. For investment securities in an unrealized loss position, management has both the intent and ability to hold these investments until the recovery of the decline; thus, the impairment was determined to be temporary.

        The Company holds a collateralized debt obligation with a carrying value of $610 at December 31, 2016. The security was rated high quality at inception, but at December 31, 2016, Moody's rated the security as B1, which is defined as "extremely speculative". The issuers of the security are primarily banks. The Company uses in-house and third party other-than-temporary impairment evaluation models to compare the present value of expected cash flows to the previous estimate to ensure there are no adverse changes in cash flows during the period. The other-than-temporary impairment model considers the structure and term of the collateralized mortgage obligations and the financial condition of the underlying issuers. Assumptions used in the model include expected future default rates and prepayments. The security remained classified as available for sale and represented $25 of the unrealized losses reported at December 31, 2016. At December 31, 2015, the Company held another collateralized mortgage obligation and had recognized other-than temporary impairment on it in prior years. All of the cumulative other-than-temporary impairment recognized at December 2015 related to this collateralized mortgage obligation, which was sold during 2016.

F-53


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 3—Investment Securities (Continued)

        The table below presents a rollforward of the cumulative credit losses recognized in the consolidated statements of income for the periods ended December 31:

 
  2016   2015  

Beginning balance, January 1,

  $ 2,507   $ 2,507  

Reduction for previous credit losses realized on securities sold during the year

    (2,507 )    

Ending balance, December 31

  $   $ 2,507  

        Total other-than-temporary impairment recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax was $0 and $655 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Note 4—Loans

        Major categories of loans at December 31, 2016 and 2015 were as follows:

 
  2016   2015  

Construction loans

  $ 146,600   $ 74,573  

Residential real estate loans, mortgage

    1,617,087     1,282,321  

Commercial real estate loans, mortgage

    201,394     193,637  

Commercial and industrial loans, lines of credit

    36,793     38,377  

Other consumer loans

    63     90  

Total loans

    2,001,937     1,588,998  

Less: unearned discount and fees

    (4,676 )   (2,212 )

Less: allowance for loan losses

    (14,822 )   (10,984 )

Loans, net

  $ 1,982,439   $ 1,575,802  

        Loans with carrying values of $839.6 million and $833.2 million were pledged as collateral on FHLB borrowings at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

F-54


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The table presents the activity in the allowance for loan losses and recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31, 2016  
 
  Construction   Residential
Real Estate
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Commercial
Lines of Credit
  Other
Consumer
  Unallocated   Total  

Allowance for loan losses:

                                           

Beginning balance

  $ 317   $ 8,192   $ 1,530   $ 392   $ 2   $ 551   $ 10,984  

Provision for loan losses

    52     3,578     (2,768 )   (19 )   (2 )   439     1,280  

Charge offs

        (24 )                   (24 )

Recoveries

    310     117     2,153         2         2,582  

Ending balance

  $ 679   $ 11,863   $ 915   $ 373   $ 2   $ 990   $ 14,822  

Ending balances:

                                           

Individually evaluated for impairment

  $   $ 21   $ 61   $ 107   $   $   $ 189  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

  $ 679   $ 11,842   $ 854   $ 266   $ 2   $ 990   $ 14,633  

Loans*:

                                           

Loans individually evaluated for impairment           

  $   $ 72   $ 2,950   $ 369   $   $   $ 3,391  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment           

    146,600     1,617,015     198,444     36,424     63         1,998,546  

Total ending loans balance

  $ 146,600   $ 1,617,087   $ 201,394   $ 36,793   $ 63   $   $ 2,001,937  

*
The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-55


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

 
  Year Ended December 31, 2015  
 
  Construction   Residential
Real Estate
  Commercial
Real Estate
  Commercial
Lines of Credit
  Other
Consumer
  Unallocated   Total  

Allowance for loan losses:

                                           

Beginning balance

  $ 203   $ 4,350   $ 4,682   $ 235   $ 4   $ 541   $ 10,015  

Provision for loan losses

    30     3,871     (3,489 )   107     (4 )   10     525  

Charge offs

        (90 )   (86 )               (176 )

Recoveries

    84     61     423     50     2         620  

Ending balance

  $ 317   $ 8,192   $ 1,530   $ 392   $ 2   $ 551   $ 10,984  

Ending balances:

                                           

Individually evaluated for impairment

  $   $ 25   $ 780   $ 155   $   $   $ 960  

Collectively evaluated for impairment

  $ 317   $ 8,167   $ 750   $ 237   $ 2   $ 551   $ 10,024  

Loans*:

                                           

Loans individually evaluated for impairment           

  $ 17   $ 74   $ 6,680   $ 776   $   $   $ 7,547  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment           

    74,556     1,282,247     186,957     37,601     90         1,581,451  

Total ending loans balance

  $ 74,573   $ 1,282,321   $ 193,637   $ 38,377   $ 90   $   $ 1,588,998  

*
The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

F-56


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The following tables present information related to impaired loans by class of loans as of and for the periods indicated:

 
   
   
   
  Year Ended December 31, 2016  
 
  At December 31, 2016  
 
   
   
  Cash
Basis
Interest
Recognized
 
 
  Unpaid
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
  Allowance for
Loan Losses
  Average
Recorded
Investment
  Interest
Income
Recognized
 

With no related allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

  $ 1,491   $ 1,316   $   $ 1,347   $ 69   $ 64  

Gas stations

    476     39         67          

Commercial lines of credit, Private banking

    154     154         157     6     5  

Subtotal

    2,121     1,509         1,571     75     69  

With an allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Residential real estate, first mortgage

    72     72     21     73     3     3  

Commercial real estate, offices

    1,606     1,595     61     1,610     73     67  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

    215     215     107     223     19     18  

Subtotal

    1,893     1,882     189     1,906     95     88  

Total

  $ 4,014   $ 3,391   $ 189   $ 3,477   $ 170   $ 157  

F-57


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

 
  At December 31, 2015   Year Ended December 31, 2015  
 
  Unpaid
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
  Allowance for
Loan Losses
Allocated
  Average
Recorded
Investment
  Interest
Income
Recognized
  Cash Basis
Interest
Recognized
 

With no related allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Construction

  $ 134   $ 17   $   $ 73   $   $  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

    1,549     1,383         1,418     74     68  

Offices

    667     281         540          

Gas stations

    2,049     1,633         1,688     87     80  

Commercial lines of credit, Private banking

    160     160         163     9     8  

Subtotal

    4,559     3,474         3,882     170     156  

With an allowance for loan losses recorded:

                                     

Construction

    73     74     25     75     4     3  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Offices

    1,649     1,633     422     1,650     71     59  

Industrial

    838     835     84     844     49     45  

Other

    915     915     274     967     53     49  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

    234     234     117     244     14     12  

C&I lending

    382     382     38     390     17     16  

Subtotal

    4,091     4,073     960     4,170     208     184  

Total

  $ 8,650   $ 7,547   $ 960   $ 8,052   $ 378   $ 340  

        The unpaid principal balance is not reduced for partial charge offs. The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

        Also presented in the above table is the average recorded investment of the impaired loans and the related amount of interest recognized during the time within the period that the impaired loans were impaired. When the ultimate collectability of the total principal of an impaired loan is in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, all payments are applied to principal under the cost recovery method. When the ultimate collectability of the total principal of an impaired loan is not in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, contractual interest is credited to interest income when received under the cash basis method. In the table above, all interest recognized represents cash collected. The average balances are calculated based on the month-end balances of the loans for the period reported.

F-58


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The following tables present the recorded investment in nonaccrual and loans past due over 90 days still on accrual by class of loans as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
  2016   2015  
 
  Nonaccrual   Loans Past
Due Over 90
Days Still
Accruing
  Nonaccrual   Loans Past
Due Over 90
Days Still
Accruing
 

Construction

  $   $   $ 18   $  

Residential real estate:

                         

Residential first mortgage

    272     155     512     136  

Commercial real estate:

                         

Retail

    99         119      

Offices

    39         281      

Gas stations

            101      

Total

  $ 410   $ 155   $ 1,031   $ 136  

        The recorded investment in loans excludes unearned discount and fees and accrued interest receivable on loans which were not significant.

        The following tables present the aging of the recorded investment in past due loans as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 by class of loans:

 
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  Greater than
89 Days
Past Due
  Total
Past Due
  Loans Not
Past Due
  Total  

December 31, 2016

                                     

Construction

  $   $   $   $   $ 146,600   $ 146,600  

Residential real estate:

                                     

Residential first mortgage

    416     398     427     1,241     1,598,481     1,599,722  

Residential second mortgage

                    17,365     17,365  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

            99     99     17,205     17,304  

Apartments

                    56,198     56,198  

Offices

                    19,418     19,418  

Hotel

                    66,545     66,545  

Industrial

                    16,330     16,330  

Gas stations

            39     39     1,690     1,729  

Other

                    23,870     23,870  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

                    18,240     18,240  

C&I lending

        227         227     18,326     18,553  

Other consumer loans

                    63     63  

Total

  $ 416   $ 625   $ 565   $ 1,606   $ 2,000,331   $ 2,001,937  

F-59


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

 
  30 - 59
Days
Past Due
  60 - 89
Days
Past Due
  Greater than
89 Days
Past Due
  Total
Past Due
  Loans Not
Past Due
  Total  

December 31, 2015

                                     

Construction

  $   $   $ 18   $ 18   $ 74,555   $ 74,573  

Residential real estate:

                                     

Residential first mortgage

    163         648     811     1,267,542     1,268,353  

Residential second mortgage

                    13,968     13,968  

Commercial real estate:

                                     

Retail

            119     119     26,669     26,788  

Apartments

                    42,132     42,132  

Offices

            281     281     21,162     21,443  

Hotel

                    64,138     64,138  

Industrial

                    8,448     8,448  

Gas stations

            101     101     7,168     7,269  

Other

                    23,419     23,419  

Commercial lines of credit:

                                     

Private banking

                    23,224     23,224  

C&I lending

                    15,153     15,153  

Other consumer loans

                    90     90  

Total

  $ 163   $   $ 1,167   $ 1,330   $ 1,587,668   $ 1,588,998  

        The Company considers the performance of the loan portfolio and its impact on the allowance for loan losses. For residential real estate and consumer loan classes, the Company also evaluates credit quality based on the aging status of the loan, which is presented above, and by payment activity. The Company reviews the status of nonperforming loans which include loans 90 days past due and still accruing and nonaccrual loans.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

        At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the balance of outstanding loans identified as troubled debt restructurings was $3,134 and $4,782 respectively. The Company has an allowance for loan losses of $81 and $448 on these loans at December 31, 2016 and 2015 respectively. The terms of certain loans have been modified as troubled debt restructurings by the Company. The modification of the terms of such loans included one or a combination of the following: a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan; an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk; extension of the amortization period of the loan; change in loan payments to interest only for a defined period for the loan; or a permanent reduction of the recorded investment in the loan. The Company has no commitments to lend additional amounts to these customers. Furthermore, there were no loan modifications during 2016 and 2015 that were considered troubled debt restructurings and no troubled debt restructurings that subsequently defaulted during those years.

        The terms of certain other loans have been modified during the years ending December 31, 2016 and 2015 that did not meet the definition of a troubled debt restructuring. The modification of these loans involved either a modification of the terms of a loan to borrowers who were not experiencing

F-60


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

financial difficulties or a delay in a payment. These other loans that were modified were not considered significant.

Credit Quality

        The Company categorizes loans into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, and current economic trends, among other factors. The Company analyzes loans individually by classifying the loans as to credit risk. This analysis includes homogeneous loans such as residential real estate and consumer loans and non-homogeneous loans, such as commercial lines of credit, construction and commercial real estate loans. This analysis is performed monthly. The Company uses the following definitions for risk ratings:

        Pass:    Loans are of satisfactory quality.

F-61


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the risk rating of loans by class of loans was as follows:

 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

December 31, 2016

                               

Construction

  $ 142,561   $ 4,039   $   $   $ 146,600  

Residential real estate:

                               

Residential first mortgage

    1,599,449         192     81     1,599,722  

Residential second mortgage

    17,365                 17,365  

Commercial real estate:

                               

Retail

    15,988     1,217     99         17,304  

Apartments

    56,198                 56,198  

Offices

    18,513     905             19,418  

Hotel

    66,545                 66,545  

Industrial

    16,330                 16,330  

Gas stations

    1,690         39         1,729  

Other

    23,074         796         23,870  

Commercial lines of credit:

                               

Private banking

    18,025         215         18,240  

C&I lending

    18,326     227             18,553  

Other consumer loans

    63                 63  

Total

  $ 1,994,127   $ 6,388   $ 1,341   $ 81   $ 2,001,937  

 

 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

December 31, 2015

                               

Construction

  $ 73,816   $ 739   $ 18   $   $ 74,573  

Residential real estate:

                               

Residential first mortgage

    1,267,816         411     126     1,268,353  

Residential second mortgage

    13,968                 13,968  

Commercial real estate:

                               

Retail

    24,569         2,219         26,788  

Apartments

    42,132                 42,132  

Offices

    19,523         1,920         21,443  

Hotel

    64,138                 64,138  

Industrial

    8,448                 8,448  

Gas stations

    7,169         100         7,269  

Other

    22,504         915         23,419  

Commercial lines of credit:

                               

Private banking

    22,830         160     234     23,224  

C&I lending

    14,731     40     382         15,153  

Other consumer loans

    90                 90  

Total

  $ 1,581,734   $ 779   $ 6,125   $ 360   $ 1,588,998  

F-62


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 4—Loans (Continued)

        The following table presents portfolio loans purchased and/or sold during the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 by portfolio segment:

 
  Residential
Real
Estate
 

2016

       

Purchases

  $  

Sales

    279,352  

2015

   
 
 

Purchases

  $ 1,017  

Sales

    23,036  

Note 5—Leasehold Improvements and Equipment

        Leasehold improvements and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization are determined using the straight-line method. Leasehold improvements and equipment at December 31, 2016 and 2015, are as follows:

 
  Estimated
Useful
Life
(in years)
  2016   2015  

Leasehold improvements

  *   $ 7,638   $ 7,055  

Furniture and equipment

  3 - 7     9,739     8,916  

        17,377     15,971  

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization

        (11,522 )   (11,079 )

      $ 5,855   $ 4,892  

*
Amortized over the shorter of the lease term or estimated useful life

        The amount charged to occupancy and equipment in the consolidated statements of income for depreciation and amortization was $1,058 and $1,120 for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Note 6—Mortgage Servicing Rights

        The Bank records servicing assets from the sale of mortgage loans to the secondary market for which servicing has been retained. Mortgage loans serviced for others are not included in the

F-63


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 6—Mortgage Servicing Rights (Continued)

consolidated balance sheets. The principal balance of these loans at December 31, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:

 
  2016   2015  

Mortgage loan portfolios serviced for:

             

FNMA

  $ 61,562   $ 41,322  

FHLB

    91,244     66,638  

Private investors

    256,910     18,337  

        Custodial escrow balances maintained with these serviced loans were $7,902 and $732 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

        Activity for mortgage servicing rights and the related valuation allowance are as follows:

 
  2016   2015  

Mortgage servicing rights:

             

Beginning of year

  $ 1,371   $ 392  

Additions

    3,766     1,125  

Amortization

    (683 )   (146 )

End of year

    4,454     1,371  

Valuation allowance at beginning of year

    98      

Additions (recoveries)

    (58 )   98  

Valuation allowance at end of year

    40     98  

Net carrying amount

  $ 4,414   $ 1,273  

        Mortgage servicing assets, included in other assets, were $4,414 and $1,273 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Servicing fee income, included in other non-interest income, was $1,115 and $235 for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

        The fair value of mortgage servicing rights was $4,929 and $1,273 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is highly sensitive to changes in underlying assumptions. Changes in prepayment speed assumptions have the most significant impact on the estimate of the fair value of mortgage servicing rights. The fair value at December 31, 2016 was determined using discount rates ranging from 9.5% to 12.0%, prepayment speeds ranging from 6.8% to 36.5%, depending on the stratification of the specific right, and a weighted average default rate of 0.2%. The fair value at December 31, 2015 was determined using discount rates ranging from 9.5% to 12.0%, prepayment speeds ranging from 6.4% to 34.7%, depending on the stratification of the specific right, and a weighted average default rate of 0.2%.

Note 7—Deposits

        Time deposits of $250,000 and over were $160,153 and $163,719 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

F-64


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 7—Deposits (Continued)

        At December 31, 2016, the scheduled maturities of time deposits included in interest-bearing deposits were as follows:

2017

  $ 361,400  

2018

    29,670  

2019

    8,729  

2020

    10,726  

2021

    25,470  

  $ 435,995  

Note 8—Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings

        Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) borrowings at December 31, 2016 and 2015 consist of the following:

 
  2016   Interest Rates   2015   Interest Rates

Short-term fixed rate advances

  $ 75,000   0.74%   $ 170,000   0.38% - 0.61%

Short-term adjustable rate advances

            75,000   0.58%*

Total short-term FHLB advances

    75,000         245,000    

Long-term fixed rate advances

    205,000   0.98% - 3.84%     65,000   0.58% - 3.84%

Total FHLB advances

    280,000         310,000    

FHLB overdraft line of credit

    28,198   0.90%*     16,437   0.58%*

Total

  $ 308,198         326,437    

*
At period end.

FHLB Advances

        At December 31, 2016, fixed rate advances totaled $280,000 with maturity dates ranging from January 2017 to October 2026. At December 31, 2015, fixed rate advances totaled $235,000 with maturity dates ranging from January 2016 to September 2017. Also, at December 31, 2015, the Bank had variable rate advances totaling $75,000 (interest rate of 0.58% at December 31, 2015) which matured in 2016.

        Interest on advances is payable monthly and each advance is payable at its maturity date, and may contain a prepayment penalty if paid before maturity. At December 31, 2016, advances totaling $172,000 were callable by the FHLB and are required to be repaid upon the request of the FHLB. At December 31, 2016, the Bank had additional borrowing capacity of $318 million from the FHLB.

F-65


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 8—Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings (Continued)

        The contractual annual maturities of FHLB advances at December 31, 2016 are as follows:

2017

  $ 90,000  

2018

     

2019

    11,000  

2020

    11,000  

2021

    11,000  

Thereafter

    157,000  

  $ 280,000  

FHLB Overdraft Line of Credit

        The Bank has established an overdraft line of credit agreement with the FHLB providing maximum borrowings of $50,000. The average amount outstanding during the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 was $13,571 and $7,846, respectively. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Bank had $28,198 and $16,437, respectively, outstanding under this agreement. Borrowings accrue interest based on a variable rate based on the FHLB's overnight cost of funds rate, which was 0.90% and 0.58% at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The agreement has a one-year term and currently terminates in October 2017. Management plans to extend the agreement for another one-year term.

        The FHLB advances and the overdraft line of credit are collateralized by pledged loans totaling $839.6 million at December 31, 2016.

Other Borrowings

        The Company had available credit lines with other banks totaling $35 million. There were no amounts outstanding under these credit lines during the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015.

Note 9—Subordinated Notes

        During the period of April through September 2016, the Company issued subordinated notes ("Notes") to accredited investors in the aggregate principal amount of $50 million. Issuance costs of $729 were netted against the proceeds. The Company contributed cash proceeds of $33,250 to the Bank to support its growth and the remaining proceeds were retained by the Company.

        At December 31, 2016, the balance outstanding under the Notes was $49,338, net of unamortized debt issuance costs of $662. The Notes bear interest at 7% per annum, payable semi-annually in arrears, through April 2021 after which the Notes will have a variable interest rate of the three-month LIBOR rate plus a margin of 5.82%. The Notes mature in April 2026. Interest expense on these Notes was $1,978 for the year ended December 31, 2016.

        On or after April 14, 2021, the Company may redeem the Notes, in whole or in part, at an amount equal to 100% of the outstanding principal amount being redeemed plus accrued interest, in a principal amount with integral multiples of $1. The Notes are not redeemable by the Company prior to April 14, 2021 except in the event of (i) the Notes no longer qualify as Tier 2 Capital, (ii) the interest on the Notes is determined by law to be not deductible for Federal Income Tax reporting or (iii) the Company

F-66


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 9—Subordinated Notes (Continued)

is considered an investment company pursuant to the Investment Company Act of 1940. The Notes are not subject to redemption by the noteholder.

        The Notes are unsecured obligations and are subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future indebtedness, deposits and other liabilities of the Company's current and future subsidiaries, including the Bank's deposits as well as the Company's subsidiaries liabilities to general creditors and liabilities arising during the ordinary course of business. The Notes may be included in Tier 1 capital of the Bank and Tier II capital for the Company under current regulatory guidelines and interpretations. As long as the Notes are outstanding, the Company is permitted to pay dividends if prior to such dividend, the Bank is considered well-capitalized as defined below.

Note 10—Shareholders' Equity

Capital Stock

        The Company's authorized capital stock consists of (i) 490,000,000 shares of voting common stock, no par value and 10,000,000 shares of non-voting common stock, no par value and (ii) 1,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock (200,000 shares designated as Series A Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Shares).

No Par, Common Stock

        Holders of voting common stock are entitled to one vote per share and to receive dividends. The holders have no preemptive, conversion or subscription rights, and there is no redemption or sinking fund provisions with respect to such shares. Common stock is subordinate to the series preferred stock as described below with respect to dividend rights or rights upon liquidation, winding up, and dissolution of the Company.

        Holders of nonvoting common stock have equal and identical rights, preferences and limitations, as holders of voting common stock. The nonvoting common stock does not have any voting rights.

        In March 2015, the Company entered into an Assignment and Stock Repurchase Agreement with its principal shareholder whereby the Company repurchased 1,875,000 shares of voting common stock ($1.77 per share) and 1,683,000 shares of non-voting stock ($1.77 per share) in exchange for cash of $2,791, as well as the assignment of a promissory note in the amount of $3,500, held by its principal shareholder that was issued by the seller at the time the shares were purchased. The note, including interest of $43, was paid in full by the Company and the shares were cancelled.

Preferred Stock

        The shares of preferred stock may be divided into and issued in one or more series. The Board of Directors is authorized to issue preferred stock from time to time in one or more series, with such designations and such relative voting, dividend, liquidation and other rights, preferences and limitations as may be adopted by the Board of Directors. No shares of preferred stock are currently issued or outstanding.

F-67


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 11—Employee Benefit Plans

Defined Contribution Retirement Plan

        The Company has a defined contribution retirement plan that allows for annual employee contributions up to the lesser of 100% of eligible compensation or $18, which are matched equal to 100% of the first 3% of the amount contributed. Dependent on the level of the Company's financial performance, there is a mandatory contribution, in addition to an employee match of up to 1% of the amount contributed based on a tiered scale. The Company's contribution to the plan was $432 and $294 for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Supplemental Retirement Benefit Plan

        An unfunded supplemental retirement benefit plan covers certain employees. The agreements are subject to various terms and conditions but generally provide covered employees with a specified retirement benefit if they retire from the Company at a normal retirement date. The agreements also provide for the payment of vested amounts upon termination. The participant can elect to receive the payout as a lump sum or as an annuity. The supplemental retirement obligation liability was $2,397 and $2,165 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. The expense, net of forfeitures, incurred for the supplemental retirement benefit plan was $254 and $235 for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Benefit payments of $22 and $20 were made during 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Spilt Dollar Life Insurance Agreement

        In October 1997, the Company entered into an endorsement split-dollar life insurance agreement with its principal shareholder and former chief executive officer. Pursuant to the plan, a portion of the death benefits arising from life insurance policies owned by the Company will be paid to beneficiaries designated by the principal shareholder and not to the Company. The estimated present value of this post retirement benefit is accrued by the Company and was $4,217 and $4,227 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments

        The Company's financial instruments include assets carried at fair value, as well as assets carried at cost or amortized cost but disclosed at fair value in these consolidated financial statements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability in the principal most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. In determining fair value, the Company applies the market approach, which uses prices and other relevant data based on market transactions involving identical or comparable assets and liabilities. The inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value are prioritized into a three-level hierarchy. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

F-68


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The Company used the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate the fair value of each type of financial instrument:

Investment Securities Available for Sale

        The fair values for investment securities are determined by quoted market prices, if available (Level 1). For securities where quoted prices are not available, fair values are calculated based on market prices of similar investment securities (Level 2). For investment securities where quoted prices or market prices of similar investment securities are not available, fair values are calculated using discounted cash flows or other market indicators (Level 3). Discounted cash flows are calculated using spread to LIBOR curves that are updated to incorporate loss severities, volatility, credit spread and optionality. During times when trading is more liquid, broker quotes are used (if available) to validate the model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as defaults and deferrals on individual investment securities are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations.

Impaired Loans

        The fair value of collateral dependent impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses is generally based on recent real estate appraisals. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments are usually significant and typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value.

Other Real Estate Owned

        Nonrecurring adjustments to certain commercial and residential real estate properties classified as other real estate owned are measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value, less costs to sell. Fair values are generally based on third party appraisals of the property. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments are usually significant and typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value.

F-69


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

Assets Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

        The table below presents the assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis categorized by the level of inputs used in the valuation of each asset at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at
December 31, 2016
 
 
  Total   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Financial Assets

                         

Investment securities available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasuries securities

  $ 70,040   $ 70,040   $   $  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    2,462         2,462      

Collateralized debt obligations

    585             585  

Other securities

    1,990     1,990          

Equity securities

    529             529  

Total investment securities available for sale

  $ 75,606   $ 72,030   $ 2,462   $ 1,114  

 

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at
December 31, 2015
 
 
  Total   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Financial Assets

                         

Investment securities available for sale:

                         

U.S. Treasuries securities

  $ 40,014   $ 40,014   $   $  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    3,048         3,048      

Collateralized debt obligations

    1,064             1,064  

Other securities

    2,022     2,022          

Equity securities

    530             530  

Total investment securities available for sale

  $ 46,678   $ 42,036   $ 3,048   $ 1,594  

        There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during 2016 and 2015.

Assets Measured at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

        From time to time, the Bank may be required to measure certain other financial assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP. These adjustments to fair value usually result from the application of lower of cost or fair value accounting or write-downs of individual assets. For assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis which were still held on the consolidated

F-70


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

balance sheet at December 31, 2015, the following table provides the level of valuation assumptions used to determine each adjustment and the related carrying value:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements at
December 31, 2015
 
 
  Carrying
Value
  Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Impaired loans, net of specific allowance for loan losses

  $ 344   $   $   $ 344  

        At December 31, 2015, impaired loans had a loan amount of $382 with a valuation allowance of $38, resulting in no additional provision for loan losses as of and for the year ended December 31, 2015.

        The table below presents a reconciliation and income statement classification of gains and losses for all assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
  Fair Value Measurements Using Significant
Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
 
 
  Investment Securities Available for Sale  
 
  2016   2015  
 
  Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
  Equity
Securities
  Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
  Equity
Securities
 

Balance of recurring Level 3 assets at beginning of period

  $ 1,064   $ 530   $ 1,029   $ 521  

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized):

                         

Included in income-realized

    (898 )   (1 )       9  

Included in other comprehensive loss

    1,015         35      

Sales

    (596 )            

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

                 

Balance at end of period

  $ 585   $ 529   $ 1,064   $ 530  

        Unrealized losses on Level 3 investments at December 31, 2016 were $25 for collateralized debt obligations and $— for equity securities. In addition to the amounts included in income for the year ended December 31, 2016 as presented in the table above, the Company also recorded interest income of $18 on collateralized debt obligations and dividend income of $28 on equity securities. Unrealized losses on Level 3 investments at December 31, 2015 were $1,040 for collateralized debt obligations and $— for equity securities. In addition to the amounts included in income for the year ended December 31, 2015 as presented in the table above, the Company also recorded interest income of $16 on collateralized debt obligations and dividend income of $12 on equity securities.

F-71


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The fair value of collateralized debt obligations is determined by calculating discounted cash flows using LIBOR curves plus spreads that adjust for loss severities, volatility, credit risk and optionality. When available, broker quotes are used to validate the internal model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as assumptions about specific-issuer defaults and deferrals are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations. Assumptions are reviewed on a quarterly basis as specific-issuer deferral and defaults that occurred are compared to those that were projected and ongoing assumptions are adjusted in accordance with the level of unexpected deferrals and defaults that occurred.

        The following table presents quantitative information about recurring Level 3 fair value measurements at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
  Fair Value   Valuation Technique   Unobservable Inputs   Range
(Weighted Average)

2016

                 

Collateralized debt obligations

  $ 585   Discounted cash flow   Collateral default rate   0%

            Recovery probability   15%

2015

   
 
 

 

 

 

 

 

Collateralized debt obligations

  $ 1,064   Discounted cash flow   Collateral default rate   10 - 15% (12.5%)

            Recovery probability   10%

        The significant unobservable inputs used on the fair value measurement of the Company's collateralized debt obligations are probabilities of specific-issuer defaults and specific-issuer recovery assumptions. Significant increases in specific-issuer default assumptions or decreases in specific-issuer recovery assumptions would result in a significantly lower fair value measurement. Conversely, decreases in specific-issuer default assumptions or increases in specific-issuer recovery assumptions would result in a significantly higher fair value measurement.

        The fair value of equity securities of $529 and $530 at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, was determined internally by considering the financial performance of the underlying entities and the Company's investment in those entities. Adjustments were considered for differences identified by management in regard to profitability, capital levels, and asset quality among other financial measures. At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company noted that the fair value of equity securities approximated the cost basis in those equity securities.

        As discussed previously, the fair values of collateral dependent impaired loans and other real estate owned carried at fair value are determined by third party appraisals. Management adjusts these appraised values based on the age of the appraisal and the type of the property. The following table

F-72


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

presents quantitative information about level 3 fair value measurements for the larger classes of financial instruments measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis at December 31, 2015:

 
  Fair Value   Valuation Technique   Unobservable Inputs   Range
(Weighted Average)
 

2015

                     

Impaired loans

  $ 344   Sales comparison approach   Management discount for property type and recent market volatility     79 %

        The carrying amounts and estimated fair values of financial instruments not carried at fair value at December 31, 2016 and 2015, are as follows:

 
  Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2016  
 
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair Value   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3  

Financial Assets

                               

Cash and due from banks

  $ 22,124   $ 22,124   $ 22,124   $   $  

Investment Securities, restricted stock

    18,360     N/A *   N/A *   N/A *   N/A *

Loans held for sale

    4,714     4,781         4,781      

Loans, net

    1,982,439     2,004,048             2,004,048  

Accrued interest receivable

    8,169     8,169         113     8,056  

Financial Liabilities

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Demand deposits

  $ 1,179,150   $ 1,179,150   $ 1,179,150          

Time deposits

  $ 435,995   $ 435,602       $ 435,602      

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    308,198     300,990         300,990      

Subordinated notes

    49,338     49,461         49,461      

Accrued interest payable

    4,214     4,214     990     3,224      

*
It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.

F-73


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

 
  Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2015  
 
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair Value   Level 1   Level 2   Level 3  

Financial Assets

                               

Cash and due from banks

  $ 13,616   $ 13,616   $ 13,616   $   $  

Interest-bearing deposits with other banks

    1,992     1,992     1,992            

Federal Home Loan Bank, restricted stock

    17,125     N/A *   N/A *   N/A *   N/A *

Loans held for sale

    2,711     2,739           2,739      

Loans, net

    1,575,802     1,584,311             1,584,311  

Accrued interest receivable

    6,062     6,062         117     5,945  

Financial Liabilities

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Demand deposits

  $ 799,217   $ 799,217   $ 799,217   $      

Time deposits

    430,543     430,843         430,843      

Federal Home Loan Bank borrowings

    326,437     326,437         326,437      

Accrued interest payable

    2,963     2,963     149     2,814      

*
It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.

        The following methods and assumptions, not previously presented, were used to estimate the fair value of the financial instrument for which it is practicable to estimate that value:

        Cash and Due from Banks.    The carrying amounts of cash and short-term instruments approximate fair values and are classified as Level 1.

        Interest-bearing deposits with other banks.    The carrying amounts of interest-bearing deposits with other banks approximate fair value and are classified as Level 1.

        Investment Securities, Restricted Stock.    It is not practical to determine the fair value of FHLB stock due to restrictions placed on its transferability.

        Loans.    Fair value of loans, excluding loans held for sale, are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality resulting in a Level 3 classification. Impaired loans are valued at the lower of cost or fair value as described previously. The methods utilized to estimate the fair value of loans do not necessarily represent an exit price.

        Loans Held for Sale.    The fair value of loans held for sale is estimated based upon binding contracts and quotes from third-party investors.

        Accrued Interest Receivable.    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate fair value resulting in a Level 2 and Level 3 classification. Interest receivable is reflected as Level 2 or Level 3 depending upon the classification of the related investment securities available for sale and loans.

        Deposits.    The fair values disclosed for demand deposits (e.g., interest and non-interest checking, passbook savings, and certain types of money market accounts) are, by definition, equal to the amount

F-74


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 12—Fair Values of Financial Instruments (Continued)

payable on demand at the reporting date (i.e., their carrying amount) resulting in a Level 1 classification. Fair values for fixed rate certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flows calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Federal Home Loan Bank Borrowings.    The fair values of the Company's FHLB borrowings are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses based on the current borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Subordinated Notes.    The fair value of the Company's subordinated notes is based on quoted prices for subordinated notes with similar interest rate and structural characteristics and other observable market data resulting in a Level 2 classification.

        Accrued Interest Payable.    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate fair value. Interest payable is reflected as Level 1 or Level 2 depending upon the classification of the related deposits.

Note 13—Income Taxes

        The components of the consolidated income tax expense are as follows:

 
  2016   2015  

Current:

             

Federal

  $ 19,131   $ 12,610  

State

    5,125     3,218  

Total current expense

    24,256     15,828  

Deferred:

             

Federal

    (936 )   (380 )

State

    (105 )   (161 )

Total deferred benefit

    (1,041 )   (541 )

Total income tax expense

  $ 23,215   $ 15,287  

        Effective tax rates differ from federal statutory rate of 35% applied to income before income taxes due to the following:

 
  2016   2015  

Federal income tax expense at statutory rates

  $ 19,757   $ 13,229  

Effect of:

             

State taxes, net of federal benefit

    3,263     1,987  

Loss incurred by pass-through entity

    414     198  

Income from bank-owned life insurance

    (247 )   (192 )

Other, net

    28     65  

Total

  $ 23,215   $ 15,287  

F-75


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 13—Income Taxes (Continued)

        The components of deferred tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2016 and 2015 were comprised of the following:

 
  2016   2015  

Deferred tax assets:

             

Allowance for loan losses

  $ 6,023   $ 4,448  

Net unrealized loss on investment securities available for sale

    21     344  

Other than temporary impairment of investment securities available for sale

        1,015  

Supplemental retirement benefit plan

    974     877  

Deferred loan fee income

    1,899     896  

State franchise tax

    1,847     1,078  

Other

    870     972  

Total deferred tax assets

    11,634     9,630  

Deferred tax liabilities:

             

FHLB stock dividends

    (175 )   (176 )

Mortgage servicing rights

    (1,794 )   (516 )

Other

    (149 )   (140 )

Total deferred tax liabilities

    (2,118 )   (832 )

Net deferred tax asset

  $ 9,516   $ 8,798  

        Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income. A valuation allowance is provided when it is more likely than not that some portion of the deferred tax asset will not be realized. Based on its evaluation, the Company believes it is more likely than not that the deferred tax asset at December 31, 2016 and 2015, will be realized.

        The Company is subject to U.S. federal income tax. The Company is no longer subject to examination by the Internal Revenue Service for the years before 2013.

        There were no unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2016, and the Company does not expect the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits to significantly increase in the next twelve months.

Note 14—Related Party Transactions

        As disclosed in Note 1, the Company purchased an entity owned 80% by its principal shareholder and 20% by a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank. At the time of the purchase in April 2017, the Director was and will continue as the Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") of the purchased entity. For the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, the consolidated statements of income include compensation-related expenses of $760 and $750, respectively, for the Director's services as CEO of this purchased entity.

        From time to time, the Company makes charitable contributions to a foundation which certain members of the Board of Directors of the Company and Bank, and whom are also related to the

F-76


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 14—Related Party Transactions (Continued)

Company's principal shareholder, serve as trustees of the foundation. The Company paid $900 and $300 to the foundation during 2016 and 2015, respectively.

        The Bank leases certain storage and office space from entities owned by the Company's principal shareholders. Amounts paid under such leases totaled $32 for 2016 and 2015.

        The Bank provides monthly data processing and programming services to entities controlled by the Company's principal shareholders. Aggregate fees paid amounted to $158 and $136 during 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Note 15—Commitments and Contingencies

Legal Proceedings

        The Company and its subsidiaries may be subject to legal actions and claims arising from contracts or other matters from time to time in the ordinary course of business. Management is not aware of any pending or threatened litigation where the ultimate disposition or resolution could have a material adverse effect on its financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Lease Commitments

        The Company leases its corporate headquarters and branch offices through noncancelable operating leases with terms that range from years 2009 to 2029, with renewal options thereafter. Rent expense was approximately $2,770 and $2,374 for 2016 and 2015, respectively.

        At December 31, 2016, the minimum annual rental payments under noncancelable operating leases were as follows:

2017

  $ 2,924  

2018

    2,870  

2019

    2,833  

2020

    2,638  

2021

    2,050  

Thereafter

    6,710  

  $ 20,025  

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

        Some financial instruments, such as loan commitments, credit lines, letters of credit, and overdraft protection, are issued to meet customer financing needs. These are agreements to provide credit or to support the credit of others, as long as conditions established in the contract are met, and usually have expiration dates. Commitments may expire without being used. Off-balance-sheet risk to credit loss exists up to the face amount of these instruments, although material losses are not anticipated. The same credit policies are used to make such commitments as are used for loans, including obtaining

F-77


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 15—Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

collateral at exercise of the commitment. The following is a summary of the total amount of loan commitments and standby letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
  2016   2015  

Standby letters of credit

  $ 70   $ 72  

Commitment to originate loans

    125,110     100,851  

Unused lines of credit

    116,810     71,717  

Note 16—Regulatory Capital Requirements

        The Bank is subject to the capital adequacy requirements of the OCC. The Company, as a thrift holding company, is subject to the capital adequacy requirements of the Federal Reserve. Capital adequacy guidelines and prompt corrective action regulations involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Capital amounts and classifications are also subject to qualitative judgments by regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors, and the regulators can lower classifications in certain cases. Prompt corrective action provisions are not applicable to thrift holding companies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate regulatory action that could have a direct material effect on the consolidated financial statements.

        The final rules implementing Basel III became effective on January 1, 2015 with full compliance with all requirements being phased in over a multi-year schedule, and fully phased in by January 1, 2019. Under the Basel III rules, the Company must hold a capital conservation buffer over the adequately capitalized risk-based capital ratios. The capital conservation buffer is being phased in from 0.0% for 2015 to 2.50% by 2019. The capital conservation buffer is 0.625% for 2016. The net unrealized gain or loss on investment securities available for sale is not included in regulatory capital. Management believes that as of December 31, 2016, the Company and the Bank meet all regulatory capital requirements to which they are subject.

        Prompt corrective action regulations provide five classifications, including well capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized, and critically undercapitalized, although these terms are not used to represent overall financial condition. The minimum requirements, excluding significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized categories, are as follows:

 
  Capital Weighted
Assets
   
   
 
 
  Tier 1
Capital to
Average
Assets
   
 
 
  Common
Tier 1
(CET1)
 
 
  Total   Tier 1  

Well Capitalized

    10.0 %   8.0 %   5.0 %   6.5 %

Adequately Capitalized

    8.0 %   6.0 %   4.0 %   4.5 %

Undercapitalized

    6.0 %   4.0 %   3.0 %   3.0 %

        At December 31, 2016, the most recent regulatory notifications categorized the Bank as well capitalized. There have been no conditions or events since these notifications that management believes would have changed the Bank's category.

F-78


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 16—Regulatory Capital Requirements (Continued)

        At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Bank exceeded all capital requirements to be categorized as well-capitalized and the Company exceeded the Capital Adequacy requirements as presented below. The Company and the Bank's actual and minimum required capital amounts and ratios at December 31, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:

 
  Actual   For Capital
Adequacy
Purposes
  To be Well
Capitalized
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  

December 31, 2016

                                     

Total adjusted capital to risk weighted assets:

                                     

Consolidated

  $ 225,625     17.07 % $ 105,716     8.00 %   N/A     N/A  

Bank

    207,891     15.73     105,716     8.00   $ 132,146     10.00 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk weighted assets

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     12.22     79,287     6.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,069     14.61     79,287     6.00     105,716     8.00  

Common Tier 1 (CET1)

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     12.22     59,466     4.50     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,069     14.61     59,466     4.50     85,895     6.50  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

                                     

Consolidated

    161,465     7.74     83,404     4.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    193,069     9.26     83,404     4.00     104,255     5.00  

 

 
  Actual   For Capital
Adequacy
Purposes
  To be Well
Capitalized
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  

December 31, 2015

                                     

Total adjusted capital to risk weighted assets:

                                     

Consolidated

  $ 147,209     13.94 % $ 84,452     8.00 %   N/A     N/A  

Bank

    145,723     13.80     84,452     8.00   $ 105,565     10.00 %

Tier 1 (core) capital to risk weighted assets

                                     

Consolidated

    136,225     12.90     63,339     6.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    134,739     12.76     63,339     6.00     84,452     8.00  

Common Tier 1 (CET1)

                                     

Consolidated

    136,225     12.90     47,504     4.50     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    134,739     12.76     47,504     4.50     68,617     6.50  

Tier 1 (core) capital to adjusted tangible assets

                                     

Consolidated

    136,225     8.42     64,695     4.00     N/A     N/A  

Bank

    134,739     8.33     64,695     4.00     80,868     5.00  

F-79


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 16—Regulatory Capital Requirements (Continued)

Dividend Restrictions

        As noted above, Banking regulations require the Bank to maintain certain capital levels and may limit the dividends paid by the bank to the holding company or by the holding company to its shareholders. The Company's principal source of funds for dividend payments is dividends received from the Bank and banking regulations limit the dividends that may be paid. Also, pursuant to the terms of the subordinated note agreements, the Company may pay dividends if it is "well capitalized" as defined by regulatory guidelines. At December 31, 2016, $55.1 million of consolidated retained earnings were available to pay dividends to the Company's shareholders.

        The Qualified Thrift Lender ("QTL") test requires that a minimum of 65% of assets be maintained in housing-related finance and other specified areas. If the QTL test is not met, limits are placed on growth, branching, new investments, FHLB Advances and dividends, or the Bank must convert to a commercial bank charter. Management believes that the QTL test has been met.

Note 17—Condensed Financial Information of Sterling Bancorp (Parent Only)

        Financial statements of Sterling Bancorp (Parent company only) are shown below. The Parent company has no significant operating activities.


CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

 
  December 31,  
 
  2016   2015  

ASSETS

             

Cash

  $ 17,750   $ 1,446  

Investment in subsidiaries

    193,875     134,792  

Other assets

    722     40  

Total assets

  $ 212,347   $ 136,278  

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY

             

Liabilities:

             

Subordinated notes

  $ 49,338   $  

Other liabilities

    737      

Total liabilities

    50,075      

Total shareholders' equity

    162,272     136,278  

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 212,347   $ 136,278  

F-80


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 17—Condensed Financial Information of Sterling Bancorp (Parent Only) (Continued)


CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 
  Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2016   2015  

Expenses:

             

Interest expense

  $ 1,978   $ 43  

Other expense

    84     70  

Total expenses

    2,062     113  

Loss before income tax and undistributed subsidiary income

    (2,062 )   (113 )

Income tax benefit

    (722 )   (40 )

Loss before undistributed subsidiary income

    (1,340 )   (73 )

Equity in undistributed subsidiary income

    34,574     22,584  

Net income

  $ 33,234   $ 22,511  

Other comprehensive income

             

Equity in other comprehensive income (loss) of subsidiaries

    627     (55 )

Total comprehensive income

  $ 33,861   $ 22,456  

F-81


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 17—Condensed Financial Information of Sterling Bancorp (Parent Only) (Continued)


CONDENSED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

 
  Year Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2016   2015  

Cash flows from operating activities

             

Net income

  $ 33,234   $ 22,511  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities:

             

Equity in undistributed subsidiaries income

    (34,574 )   (22,584 )

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

             

Change in other assets

    (682 )   (28 )

Change in other liabilities

    805      

Net cash used in operating activities

    (1,217 )   (101 )

Cash flows from investing activities

             

Capital contributed to subsidiary (bank)

    (33,250 )    

Dividends received from subsidiaries

    10,067     7,766  

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

    (23,183 )   7,766  

Cash flows from financing activities

             

Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes

    50,000      

Payment of debt issuance costs

    (729 )      

Repurchase of shares of common stock

        (6,291 )

Dividends paid to shareholders

    (8,567 )   (7,000 )

Net cash provided by (used) in financing activities

    40,704     (13,291 )

Net increase (decrease) in cash

    16,304     (5,626 )

Cash, beginning of year

    1,446     7,072  

Cash, end of year

  $ 17,750   $ 1,446  

Supplemental cash flows information:

             

Cash paid for:

             

Interest

  $ 1,750   $ 43  

Income taxes

         

Dividends

        The Parent received cash dividends from its subsidiaries of $10,067 and $7,766 during the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Note 18—Subsequent Events

Borrowings

        On August 14, 2017, the Company sold an additional $15 million in aggregate principal amount of 7.0% Fixed to Floating Subordinated Notes to accredited investors due April 15, 2026. The terms of the subordinated note purchase agreements were substantially identical to the subordinated notes that

F-82


Table of Contents


Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(dollars in thousands)

Note 18—Subsequent Events (Continued)

were previously sold in 2016, except that the first interest payment on the notes included accrued interest from April 15, 2017.

Sale of Mortgage Loans

        In August 2017, the Company committed to sell a portfolio of residential mortgage loans with an aggregate unpaid principal balance of $141 million to accredited investors. The selling price for the loans was 102.25% times the unpaid principal balance with mortgage servicing retained by the Company.

F-83


Table of Contents

 

        Until                        , 2017, all dealers that buy, sell or trade our common stock, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers' obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriter and with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.

            Shares

LOGO

COMMON STOCK



PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS



LOGO

                        , 2017

        Neither we nor the underwriter has authorized anyone to provide information different from that contained in this prospectus. When you make a decision about whether to invest in our common stock, you should not rely upon any information other than the information in this prospectus. Neither the delivery of this prospectus nor the sale of our common stock means that information contained in this prospectus is correct after the date of this prospectus. This prospectus is not an offer to sell or solicitation of an offer to buy these shares of common stock in any circumstances under which the offer or solicitation is unlawful.

   


Table of Contents


PART II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 13.    Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

        The following table sets forth all costs and expenses, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, in connection with the sale of shares of our common stock being registered, all of which will be paid by us. All amounts shown are estimates, except for the SEC registration fee, the FINRA filing fee and the NASDAQ listing fee.

SEC registration fee

  $    *    

FINRA filing fee

        *    

NASDAQ listing fee

        *    

Accountants' fees and expenses

        *    

Printing fees and expenses

        *    

Legal fees and expenses

        *    

Transfer agent's fees

        *    

Miscellaneous

        *    

Total

  $    *    

*
To be provided by amendment.

Item 14.    Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Michigan Business Corporation Act

        The Corporation is organized under the Michigan Business Corporation Act (the "MBCA") which, in general, empowers Michigan corporations to indemnify a person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to a threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative and whether formal or informal, other than an action by or in the right of the corporation, by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, partner, trustee, employee or agent of another enterprise, against expenses, including attorney's fees, judgments, penalties, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred in connection therewith if the person acted in good faith and in a manner reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation or its shareholders and, with respect to a criminal action or proceeding, if the person had no reasonable cause to believe his or her conduct was unlawful.

        The MBCA also empowers Michigan corporations to provide similar indemnity to such a person for expenses, including attorney's fees, and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by the person in connection with actions or suits by or in the right of the corporation if the person acted in good faith and in a manner the person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the interests of the corporation or its shareholders, except in respect of any claim, issue or matter in which the person has been found liable to the corporation, unless the court determines that the person is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnification in view of all relevant circumstances, in which case indemnification is limited to reasonable expenses incurred. If a person is successful in defending against a derivative action or third-party action, the MBCA requires that a Michigan corporation indemnify the person against expenses incurred in the action.

        The MBCA also permits a Michigan corporation to purchase and maintain on behalf of such a person insurance against liabilities incurred in such capacities. The Corporation has obtained a policy of directors' and officers' liability insurance.

II-1


Table of Contents

        The MBCA further permits Michigan corporations to limit the personal liability of directors for a breach of their fiduciary duty. However, the MBCA does not eliminate or limit the liability of a director for any of the following: (i) the amount of a financial benefit received by a director to which he or she is not entitled; (ii) intentional infliction of harm on the corporation or the shareholders; (iii) a violation of Section 551 of the MBCA; or (iv) an intentional criminal act. If a Michigan corporation adopts such a provision, then the Michigan corporation may indemnify its directors without a determination that they have met the applicable standards for indemnification set forth above, except, in the case of an action or suit by or in the right of the corporation, only against expenses reasonably incurred in the action. The foregoing does not apply if the director's actions fall into one of the exceptions to the limitation on personal liability discussed above, unless a court determines that the person is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnification in view of all relevant circumstances.

The Corporation's Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws

        Each of the Corporation's Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws to become effective upon the closing of this offering limit the personal liability of directors for a breach of their fiduciary duty except under the circumstances required to be excepted under Michigan law described above.

Insurance

        We have obtained a policy of directors' and officers' liability insurance, under which our directors and officers of the Company are insured within the limits and subject to the limitations of the policy.

Underwriting Agreement

        Reference is made to the form of underwriting agreement to be filed as Exhibit 1.1 hereto for provisions providing that the underwriter is obligated under certain circumstances to indemnify our directors, officers and controlling persons against certain liabilities under the Securities Act.

        Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.

Item 15.    Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

        The following sets forth information regarding unregistered securities that were sold by the Company within the past three years.

II-2


Table of Contents

Item 16.    Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules:

        The exhibits and financial statement schedules filed as part of this registration statement are as follows:

Exhibit
No.
  Description
  1.1 * Form of Underwriting Agreement
        
  3.1   Restated Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., as amended, as currently in effect.
        
  3.2 * Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., to be effective as of the closing of this offering.
        
  3.3   Bylaws of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., as currently in effect.
        
  3.4 * Amended and Restated Bylaws of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., to be effective immediately prior to this offering.
        
  4.1 * Form of Common Stock Certificate of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
        
  5.1 * Opinion of Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP.
        
  10.1 Employment Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc., Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B. and Gary Judd.
        
  10.2 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc., Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B. and Gary Judd.
        
  10.3 *† Sterling Bancorp, Inc. 2017 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan.
        
  10.4   Form of Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc. and the several purchasers of the Subordinated Notes and Form of Note.
        
  21   Subsidiaries of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
        
  23.1   Consent of Crowe Horwath LLP.
        
  23.2 * Consent of Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP (set forth in Exhibit 5.1).
        
  24.1   Power of Attorney (set forth on the signature page to this Registration Statement).

*
To be filed by amendment.

Denotes compensatory plan or arrangement.

        No financial statement schedules are filed because the required information is not applicable or is included in the consolidated financial statements or related notes.

Item 17.    Undertakings

        The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriter at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriter to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

        Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the indemnification provisions

II-3


Table of Contents

described herein, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

        The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

II-4


Table of Contents


EXHIBIT INDEX

Exhibit No.   Description
  1.1 * Form of Underwriting Agreement
        
  3.1   Restated Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., as amended, as currently in effect.
        
  3.2 * Second Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., to be effective as of the closing of this offering.
        
  3.3   Bylaws of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., as currently in effect.
        
  3.4 * Amended and Restated Bylaws of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., to be effective immediately prior to this offering.
        
  4.1 * Form of Common Stock Certificate of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
        
  5.1 * Opinion of Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP.
        
  10.1 Employment Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc., Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B. and Gary Judd.
        
  10.2 Amended and Restated Employment Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc., Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B. and Gary Judd.
        
  10.3 *† Sterling Bancorp, Inc. 2017 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan.
        
  10.4   Form of Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc. and the several purchasers of the Subordinated Notes and Form of Note.
        
  21   Subsidiaries of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.
        
  23.1   Consent of Crowe Horwath LLP.
        
  23.2 * Consent of Honigman Miller Schwartz and Cohn LLP (set forth in Exhibit 5.1).
        
  24.1   Power of Attorney (set forth on the signature page to this Registration Statement).

*
To be filed by amendment.

Denotes compensatory plan or arrangement

II-5


Table of Contents


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized in the City of Southfield, State of Michigan on October 19, 2017.

  STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

By:

 

/s/ GARY JUDD


Gary Judd
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
(Duly Authorized Representative)

POWER OF ATTORNEY

        KNOW ALL BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Gary Judd and Thomas Lopp, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, each with the full power of substitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place or stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this registration statement (including post-effective amendments), and to sign any registration statement for the same offering covered by this registration statement that is to be effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) promulgated under the Securities Act, and all post-effective amendments thereto, and to file the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or their or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, this registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signatures
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ GARY JUDD


Gary Judd
 

Chief Executive Officer and Chairman (Principal Executive Officer)

  October 19, 2017


/s/ THOMAS LOPP


Thomas Lopp

 


President, Chief Operations Officer and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)


 


October 19, 2017



/s/ BARRY ALLEN


Barry Allen

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017



/s/ JON FOX


Jon Fox

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017



/s/ SETH MELTZER


Seth Meltzer

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017


II-6


Table of Contents

Signatures
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ SANDRA SELIGMAN


Sandra Seligman
 

Director

 

October 19, 2017



/s/ PETER SINATRA


Peter Sinatra

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017



/s/ BENJAMIN WINEMAN


Benjamin Wineman

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017



/s/ LYLE WOLBERG


Lyle Wolberg

 


Director


 


October 19, 2017


II-7




Exhibit 3.1

 

 

ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
(Domestic profit corporation)

 

Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972, as amended, the undersigned corporation executes the following Articles:

 

ARTICLE I

 

The name of the corporation is Dykema NameHolding Corporation No. 2.

 

ARTICLE II

 

The purposes for which the corporation is organized are to engage in any activity within the purposes for which corporations may be organized under the Business Corporation Act of Michigan.

 

ARTICLE III

 

The total authorized capital of the corporation is 5,000,000 shares of common stock, $0.01 par value per share.

 

ARTICLE IV

 

The address and the mailing address of the initial registered office is 35th Floor, 400 Renaissance Center, Detroit, Michigan 48243. The name of the initial resident agent at the registered office is Paul R. Rentenbach.

 

ARTICLE V

 

The name and address of the incorporator are: Paul R. Rentenbach, 35th Floor, 400 Renaissance Center, Detroit, Michigan 48243.

 

ARTICLE VI

 

When a compromise or arrangement or a plan of reorganization of the corporation is proposed between the corporation and its creditors or any class of them or between the corporation and its shareholders or any class of them, a court of equity jurisdiction within the state, on application of the corporation or of a creditor or shareholder thereof, or on application of a receiver appointed for the corporation, may order a meeting of the creditors or class of creditors or of the shareholders or class of shareholders to be affected by the proposed compromise or arrangement or

 



 

reorganization, to be summoned in such manner as the court directs. If a majority in number representing 3/4 in value of the creditors or class of creditors, or of the shareholders or class of shareholders to be affected by the proposed compromise or arrangement or a reorganization, agree to a compromise or arrangement or a reorganization of the corporation as a consequence of the compromise or arrangement, the compromise or arrangement and the reorganization, if sanctioned by the court to which the application has been made, shall be binding on all the creditors or class of creditors, or on all the shareholders or class of shareholders and also on the corporation.

 

ARTICLE VII

 

No director of the corporation shall be personally liable to the corporation or its shareholders for monetary damages for broach of fiduciary duty as a director, provided that the foregoing shall not eliminate or limit the liability of a director for any of the following: (i) a breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or its shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or knowing violation of law; (iii) a violation of Section 551(1) of the Michigan Business Corporation Act, as the same exists or hereafter may be amended; (iv) a transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit; or (v) an act or omission occurring before the effective date of these Articles of Incorporation. If the Michigan Business Corporation Act hereafter is amended to authorize the further elimination or limitation of the liability of directors, then the liability of a director of the corporation, in addition to the limitation on personal liability contained herein, shall be eliminated or limited to the fullest extent permitted by the Michigan Business Corporation Act as so amended. No amendment or repeal of this Article VII shall apply to or have any effect on the liability or alleged liability of any director of the corporation for or with respect to any acts or omissions of such director occurring prior to the effective date of any such amendment or repeal.

 

I, the incorporator sign my name this September 21, 1989.

 

 

/s/ Paul R. Rentenbach

 

Paul R. Rentenbach

 

DOCUMENT WILL BE RETURNED TO NAME AND MAILING ADDRESS INDICATED IN THE BOX BELOW. Include name, street and number (or P.O. box), city, state and ZIP code.

 

Name of person or organization remitting fees:

 

Dykema Gossett

 

 

 

 

 

 

Paul R. Rentenbach

Dykema Gossett

35th Floor, 400 Renaissance Center

Detroit, Michigan  48243

 

Preparer’s name and business telephone number:

 

Paul R. Rentenbach

(313) 568-6973

 

2



 

 

RESTATED ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
For use by domestic profit corporations

 

Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972, as amended, the undersigned corporation executes the following Articles:

 

1.                                      The present name of the corporation is:

Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

 

 

2.                                      The corporation identification number (CID) assigned by the Bureau is:

236-008.

 

 

3.                                      All former names of the corporation are:

Dykema Nameholding Corporation No. 2.

 

 

4.                                      The date of filing the original Articles of Incorporation was:

September 22, 1989

 

The following Restated Articles of Incorporation supersede the Articles of Incorporation as amended and shall be the Articles of Incorporation for the corporation:

 

ARTICLE I

 

The name of the corporation is Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

 

ARTICLE II

 

The purpose for which the corporation is organized is to become a registered thrift holding company under the federal Home Owners’ Loan Act, as amended, or a registered bank holding company under the federal Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, or both, and to engage in any other activity within the purposes for which corporations may be organized under the Business Corporation Act of Michigan, as it exists on the date hereof and as it may be amended from time to time hereafter (the “Michigan Business Corporation Act”).

 

3



 

ARTICLE III

 

The aggregate number of shares of all classes of the capital stock which the corporation has authority to issue is 2,000,000, which shall be divided into a class of 1,000,000 shares (“Common Shares”) of common stock and a class of 1,000,000 shares (“Preferred Shares”) of preferred stock.

 

Preferred Shares

 

Subject to the limitations and restrictions set forth in this Article III, the Board of Directors is authorized and empowered at any time, and from time to time, to designate and issue any authorized and unissued Preferred Shares (whether or not previously designated as shares of a particular series, and including Preferred Shares of any series issued and thereafter acquired by the corporation) as shares of one or more series, hereby or hereafter to be designated. Each different series of Preferred Shares may vary as to dividend rate, redemption price, liquidation price, voting rights and conversion rights, if any, all of which shall be fixed as hereinafter provided. Each series of Preferred Shares issued hereunder shall be so designated as to distinguish the shares thereof from the shares of the other series and classes. All Preferred Shares of any one series shall be alike in every particular.

 

The rights, qualifications, limitations or restrictions of each series of Preferred Shares shall be as stated and expressed in the resolution or resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors which provides for the issuance of such series, which resolutions shall determine, fix or alter the following:

 

(1)                                 The distinctive designation and number of shares comprising such series, which number may (except where otherwise provided by the Board of Directors in creating such series) be increased or decreased (but not below the number of shares then outstanding) from time to time by action of the Board of Directors;

 

(2)                                 The rate of the annual dividends thereon and the relation which such dividends shall bear to the dividends payable on any other class of capital stock or on any other series of Preferred Shares, the terms and conditions upon which and the periods in respect of which dividends shall be payable, whether and upon what conditions such dividends shall be cumulative and if cumulative, the date or dates from which dividends shall accumulate;

 

(3)                                 The amount per share, if any, which the holders of Preferred Shares of such series shall be entitled to receive, in addition to any dividends accrued and unpaid thereon, (a) upon the redemption thereof, plus the premium payable upon redemption, if any; or (b) upon the voluntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation; or (c) upon the involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation;

 

(4)                                 The conversion or exchange rights, if any, of such series, including without limitation, the price or prices, rate or rates, provisions for the adjustment thereof (including provisions for protection against the dilution or impairment of such rights), and all other terms and conditions upon which Preferred Shares constituting such series may be convertible into, or exchangeable for shares of any other class or classes or series;

 

(5)                                 Whether the shares of such series shall be redeemable, and, if redeemable, whether redeemable for cash, property or rights, including securities of any other corporation, at the option of either the holder or the corporation or upon the happening of a specified event, the limitations and restrictions with respect to such redemption, the time or times when, the price or prices or rate or rates at which, the adjustments with which and the manner in which such shares shall be redeemable, including the manner of selecting shares of such series for redemption if less than all shares are to be redeemed;

 

4



 

(6)                                 Whether the shares of such series shall be subject to the operation of a purchase, retirement, or sinking fund, and, if so, whether and upon what conditions such purchase, retirement or sinking fund shall be cumulative or noncumulative, the extent to which and the manner in which such fund shall be applied to the purchase or redemption of the shares of such series for retirement or to other corporate purposes and the terms and provisions relative to the operation thereof;

 

(6)                                 The voting rights per share, if any, of each such series, and whether and under what conditions the shares of such series (alone or together with the shares of one or more other series) shall be entitled to vote separately as a single class, upon any merger, share exchange or other transaction of the corporation, or upon any other matter, including (without limitation) the elections of one or more additional directors of the corporation in case of dividend arrearage or other specified events;

 

(7)                                 Whether the issuance of any additional shares of such series, or of any shares of any other series shall be subject to restrictions as to issuance or as to the power, preferences or rights of any such other series; and

 

(8)                                 Any other preferences, privileges and powers and relative, participating, optional or other special rights and qualifications, limitations or restrictions of such series, as the Board of Directors may deem advisable and as shall not be inconsistent with the provisions of these Articles of Incorporation.

 

Common Shares

 

None of the Common Shares shall be entitled to any preferences, and each Common Share shall be equal to every other share of such class of stock in every respect.

 

After payment or declaration of full cumulative dividends on all shares having priority over the Common Shares as to dividends, and after making all sinking or retirement fund payments on all series of Preferred Shares and on any other stock of the corporation ranking as to dividends or assets prior to the Common Shares providing for the same, dividends on the Common Shares may be declared and paid, but only when and as determined by the Board of Directors.

 

On any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the corporation, after there shall have been paid to or set aside for the holders of all shares having priority over the Common Shares the full preferential amounts to which they are respectively entitled, the holders of the Common Shares shall be entitled to receive pro rata all the remaining assets of the corporation available for distribution to its shareholders.

 

At all meetings of shareholders of the corporation, the holders of the Common Shares shall be entitled to one vote for each Common Share held by them of record.

 

General Provisions

 

No shareholder of this corporation shall by reason of his holding shares of any class have any preemptive or preferential right to purchase or subscribe to any shares of any class of this corporation, now or hereafter to be authorized, or any notes, debentures, bonds, or other securities convertible into or carrying options or warrants to purchase shares of any class, now or hereafter to be authorized, whether or not the issuance of any such shares or such notes, debentures, bonds, or other securities, would adversely affect the dividend or voting rights of such shareholder, other than such rights, if any, as the Board of Directors, in its discretion from time to time may grant and at such price as the Board of Directors in its

 

5



 

discretion may fix; and the Board of Directors may issue shares of any class of this corporation, or any notes, debentures, bonds, or other securities convertible into or carrying options or warrants to purchase shares of any class, without offering any such shares of any class, either in whole or in part, to the existing shareholders of any class.

 

ARTICLE IV

 

The address and the mailing address of the current registered office of the corporation is One Towne Square, 17th Floor, Southfield, Michigan 48076.

 

The name of the current resident agent at the registered office is Richard Zamojski.

 

ARTICLE V

 

The Board of Directors shall be divided into three classes as nearly equal in number as possible, with the term of office of one class expiring each year. The first class of the first board of directors shall be elected to hold office for a term expiring at the annual meeting of shareholders in 1994, directors of the second class shall be elected to hold office for a term expiring at the next succeeding annual meeting, and directors of the third class shall be elected to hold office for a term expiring at the third succeeding annual meeting. During the intervals between annual meetings of shareholders, any vacancy occurring in the Board of Directors caused by resignation, removal, death or incapacity, and any newly created directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors, shall be filled only by a majority vote of the directors then in office, whether or not a quorum. Each director chosen to fill a vacancy shall hold office for the unexpired term in respect of which such vacancy occurred. Each director chosen to fill a newly created directorship shall hold office until the next election of the class for which such director shall have been chosen. When the number of directors is changed, any newly created directorships or any decrease in directorships shall be so apportioned among the classes as to make all classes as nearly equal in number as possible. Any director may be removed from office as a director at any time, but only for cause, by the affirmative vote of shareholders of record holding a majority of the outstanding shares of stock of the corporation entitled to vote in elections of directors given at a meeting of the shareholders specifically called for that purpose.

 

ARTICLE VI

 

Directors and officers of the corporation shall be indemnified in connection with any actual or threatened action or proceeding (including civil, criminal, administrative or investigative proceedings) arising out of their service to the corporation or to another organization at the corporation’s request, and shall be paid expenses incurred in defending any such proceeding in advance of its final disposition to the fullest extent permitted by law. Persons who are not directors or officers of the Company may be similarly indemnified in respect of such service to the extent authorized at any time by the Board of Directors or the Bylaws of the corporation. The provisions of this Article shall be applicable to actions or proceedings commenced after the adoption hereof, whether arising from acts or omissions occurring before or after the adoption hereof, and to persons who have ceased to be directors, officers or employees, and shall inure to the benefit of their heirs, executors, and administrators. The right to indemnification and advancement of expenses conferred hereunder shall be a contract right which may not be modified retroactively without the written consent of the director or officer and shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to indemnification or advancement of expenses such person may have or to which such person may be entitled.

 

If a claim under this Article VI is not paid in full by the corporation within thirty days after a written claim has been received by the corporation, the indemnitee may at any time thereafter bring suit

 

6



 

against the corporation to recover the unpaid amount of the claim. If successful in whole or in part in any such suit or in a suit brought by the corporation to recover advances, the indemnitee shall be entitled to be paid also the expense of prosecuting or defending such claim. In any action brought by the indemnitee to enforce a right hereunder (other than an action brought to enforce a claim for expenses incurred in defending any proceeding in advance of its final disposition where the required undertaking has been tendered to the corporation) it shall be a defense that, and in any action brought by the corporation to recover advances the corporation shall be entitled to recover such advances if, the indemnitee has not met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in the Michigan Business Corporation Act. Neither the failure of the corporation (including its Board of Directors, a committee of its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel, or its shareholders) to have made a determination prior to the commencement of such action that indemnification of the indemnitee is proper in the circumstances because the indemnitee has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in the Michigan Business Corporation Act, nor an actual determination by the corporation (including its Board of Directors, a committee of its Board of Directors, independent legal counsel, or its shareholders) that the indemnitee has not met such applicable standard of conduct, shall be a defense to an action brought by the indemnitee or create a presumption that the indemnitee has not met the applicable standard of conduct. In any action brought by the indemnitee to enforce a right hereunder or by the corporation to recover payments by the corporation of advances, the burden of proof shall be on the corporation.

 

ARTICLE VII

 

No director of the corporation shall be personally liable to the corporation or its shareholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a director, provided that the foregoing shall not eliminate or limit the liability of a director for any of the following: (i) a breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or its shareholders; (ii) acts or omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or knowing violation of law; (iii) a violation of Section 551(1) of the Michigan Business Corporation Act; or (iv) any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit. If the Michigan Business Corporation Act hereafter is amended to authorize the further elimination or limitation of the liability of directors, then the liability of a director of the corporation, in addition to the limitation on personal liability contained herein, shall be eliminated or limited to the fullest extent permitted by the Michigan Business Corporation Act as so amended. No amendment or repeal of this Article VIII shall apply to or have any effect on the liability or alleged liability of any director of the corporation for or with respect to any acts or omissions of such director occurring prior to the effective date of any such amendment or repeal.

 

ARTICLE VIII

 

Notwithstanding any other provisions of these Articles of Incorporation, no amendment to these Articles of Incorporation shall amend or repeal any or all of the provisions of Articles V, VI or VII or this Article VIII of these Articles of Incorporation, and the shareholders of the corporation shall not have the right to amend or repeal any or all provisions of the Bylaws of the corporation, unless so adopted by the affirmative vote of the holders of not less than three-fourths of the outstanding shares of stock of the corporation generally entitled to vote in the election of directors, considered for purposes of this Article VIII as a class; provided, however, that in the event the Board of Directors of the corporation shall recommend to the shareholders the adoption of any such amendment of a nature described in this Article IX, the shareholders of record holding a majority of the outstanding shares of stock of the corporation entitled to vote in elections of directors, considered for the purposes of this Article VIII as a class, may amend, modify or repeal any or all of such provisions.

 

*    *    *    *    *     *

 

7



 

These Restated Articles of Incorporation were duly adopted on January 19, 1994, in accordance with the provisions of Section 642 of the Michigan Business Corporation Act and were duly adopted by the written consent of all the shareholders entitled to vote in accordance with Section 407(2) of the Michigan Business Corporation Act.

 

Signed this January 20, 1994.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Richard Zamojski

 

 

Richard Zamojaki

 

 

President

 

8


 

APR 21 2004 Bureau of Commercial Services Document will be returned to the name and address you enter above. If left blank, document will be mailed to the registered office. CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION For use by Domestic Profit and Nonprofit Corporations (Please read information and instructions on the last page) Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972, (profit corporations), or Act 162, Public Acts of 1982 (nonprofit corporations), the undersigned corporation executes the following Certificate: 9 25775931.1 3.Article III of the Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended to read as follows: Article III of the Restated Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended by the addition of Item (i) to Article III, which Item (i) is set forth in its entirety on the Attachment to the Certificate of Amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., which Attachment consists of seven (7) pages 1.The present name of the corporation is:Sterling Bancorp, Inc. 2.The identification number assigned by the Bureau is: 236-008 MICHIGAN DEPARTMENT OF CONSUMER & INDUSTRY SERVICES BUREAU OF COMMERCIAL SERVICES Date Received APR 20 2004 (FOR BUREAU USE ONLY) This document is effective on the date filed, unless a subsequent effective date within 90 days after received date is stated in the document 517-663-2525 Ref #41343 Attn: Cheryl J. Bixby MICHIGAN RUNNER SERVICE P.O. Box 266 Eaton Rapids, MI 48827 FILED Administrator EFFECTIVE DATE:

 


COMPLETE ONLY ONE OF THE FOLLOWING: 10 25775931.1 5. (For profit and nonprofit corporations whose Articles state the corporation is organized on a stock or on a membership basis.) The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation was duly adopted on the 17th day of March , 2004 , by the shareholders if a profit corporation, or by the shareholders or members if a nonprofit corporation (check one of the following) at a meeting the necessary votes were cast in favor of the amendment by written consent of the shareholders or members having not less than the minimum number of votes required by statute in accordance with Section 407(1) and (2) of the Act if a nonprofit corporation, or Section 407(1) of the Act if a profit corporation. Written notice to shareholders or members who have not consented in writing has been given. (Note: Written consent by less than all of the shareholders or members is permitted only if such provision appears in the Articles of Incorporation.) by written consent of all the shareholders or members entitled to vote in accordance with section 407(3) of the Act if a nonprofit corporation, or Section 407(2) of the Act if a profit corporation. by consents given by electronic transmission in accordance with Section 407(3) if a profit corporation. by the board of a profit corporation pursuant to section 611(2). Nonprofit Corporations Signed this day of , By (Signature President, Vice President, Chairperson or Vice Chairperson (Type or Print Name) Profit Corporations and Professional Service Corporations Signed this 17th day of March, 2004 By /s/ Thomas St. Dennis (Signature of an authorized officer or agent) Thomas St. Dennis, Chairman (Type or Print Name) 4.(For amendments adopted by unanimous consent of incorporators before the first meeting of the board of directors or trustees.) The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation was duly adopted on theday of , , in accordance with the provisions of the Act by the unanimous consent of the incorporator(s) before the first meeting of the Board of Directors or Trustees. Signed this day of (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name) (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name)

 

 

Attachment to the Certificate of Amendment to

the Articles of Incorporation of

Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

 

(i)                                     Series A Preferred Shares. Subject in all cases to the other provisions of this Article III, the following sets forth the designation, preferences, limitations as to dividends, voting and other rights, and the terms and conditions of redemption of the Series A Preferred Shares (defined below) of the corporation.

 

(a)                                 There is hereby established a series of Preferred Shares designated “Series A Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Shares, par value $0.01 per share” (the “Series A Preferred Shares”), which shall consist of 200,000 authorized shares.

 

(b)                                 All shares of Series A Preferred Shares redeemed, purchased, exchanged, or otherwise acquired by the Corporation shall be restored to the status of authorized but unissued shares of Preferred Shares.

 

(c)                                  The Series A Preferred Shares shall, with respect to dividend rights, rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, and redemption rights, rank (i) junior to any other series of Preferred Shares hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors, the terms of which specifically provide that such series shall rank prior to the Series A Preferred Shares as to the payment of dividends and distribution of assets upon liquidation (the “Senior Preferred Shares”), (ii) pari passu with any other series of Preferred Shares hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors, the terms of which specifically provide that such series shall rank pari passu with the Series A Preferred Shares as to the payment of dividends and distribution of assets upon liquidation (the “Parity Preferred Shares”), and (iii) prior to any other class or series of capital shares, including, without limitation, the Common Shares of the Corporation, whether now existing or hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors (collectively, the “Junior Shares”).

 

(d)                                 (1)                                 Subject to the rights of any Senior Preferred Shares, the holders of the then outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to receive, as and when declared by the Board of Directors, out of funds legally available for the payment of dividends, cumulative preferential cash dividends at an annual rate equal to the 90 day Libor rate as in effect at the beginning of each quarterly period plus 280 basis points of the $100 per share liquidation preference (i.e., $3.91 per annum per share as of the date hereof). Such dividends shall accrue and be cumulative from the date of original issue and shall be payable in equal quarterly amounts in arrears on or before the last day of each March, June, September, and December or, if such day is not a business day, the next succeeding business day (each, a “Dividend Payment Date”) (for the purposes of this Subparagraph (1) of this Paragraph (d), a “business day” is any day, other than a Saturday, Sunday, or legal holiday, on which banks in Detroit, Michigan, are open for business). The first dividend, which shall be paid on June 30, 2004, will be for less than a full quarter.  All dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares, including any dividend for any partial dividend period, shall be computed on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months. Dividends will be payable to holders of record as they appear in the share records of the corporation at the close of business on the applicable record date, which

 

1



 

shall be the 16th day of the calendar month in which the applicable Dividend Payment Date falls or on such other date designed by the Board of Directors for the payment of dividends that is not more than 30 nor less than ten days prior to such Dividend Payment Date (each, a “Dividend Record Date”).

 

(2)                                 No dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares shall be declared by the Board of Directors or paid or set apart for payment by the corporation if any regulatory requirement or agreement of the corporation, including any agreement relating to its indebtedness, prohibits such declaration, payment, or setting apart for payment, would constitute a violation of, breach of, or a default under, such regulatory requirement or agreement or if such declaration, payment, or setting aside shall be restricted or prohibited by law.

 

(3)                                 Dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares shall accrue and be cumulative regardless of whether the Corporation has earnings, regardless of whether there are funds legally available for the payment of such dividends, and regardless of whether such dividends are declared. Accrued but unpaid dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares will accumulate as of the Dividend Payment Date on which they first become payable. Except as set forth below in this Subparagraph (3), no dividends shall be declared or paid or set apart for payment on any Common Shares or any other series of Preferred Shares ranking, as to dividends, on a parity with or junior to the Series A Preferred Shares (other than a dividend in shares of Junior Shares) for any period unless full cumulative dividends have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof is set apart for such payment on the Series A Preferred Shares for all past dividend periods and the then current dividend period. When dividends are not paid in full (and a sum sufficient for such full payment is not so set apart) upon the Series A Preferred Shares and the shares of any other series of Preferred Shares ranking on a parity as to dividends with the Series A Preferred Shares, all dividends declared upon the Series A Preferred Shares and any other series of Preferred Shares ranking on a parity as to dividends with the Series A Preferred Shares shall be declared pro rata, so that the amount of dividends declared per share of Series A Preferred Shares and such other series of Preferred Shares shall in all cases bear to each other the same ratio that accrued dividends per share on the Series A Preferred Shares and such other series of Preferred Shares (which shall not include any accrual in respect of unpaid dividends for prior dividend periods if such Preferred Shares do not have a cumulative dividend) bear to each other. No interest shall be payable in respect of any dividend payment on the Series A Preferred Shares that may be in arrears. Holders of shares of the Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to any dividend, whether payable in cash, property, or shares, in excess of full cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares as provided above. Any dividend payment made on shares of the Series A Preferred Shares shall first be credited against the earliest accumulated but unpaid dividend due with respect to such shares that remains payable.

 

(4)                                 Except as provided in Subparagraph (3) of this Paragraph (d) of this Item (i) of this Article III, unless full cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or

 

2



 

declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof is set apart for payment for all past dividend periods and the then current dividend period:  (i) no dividends (other than in shares of Junior Shares) shall be declared or paid or set aside for payment nor shall any other distribution be declared or made upon the Common Shares (or any other Preferred Shares ranking junior to or on a parity with the Series A Preferred Shares as to dividends or upon liquidation); and (ii) no shares of Common Shares (or any other Preferred Shares ranking junior to or on a parity with the Series A Preferred Shares as to dividends or upon liquidation) shall be redeemed, purchased, or otherwise acquired for any consideration (nor shall any moneys be paid to or made available for a sinking fund for the redemption of any such shares) by the Corporation (except by conversion into or exchange for Junior Shares.

 

(e)                                  Subject to the rights of any Senior Preferred Shares, upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the affairs of the Corporation, and before any distribution of assets shall be made in respect of any Junior Shares, the holders of the Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to be paid out of the assets of the corporation legally available for distribution to its shareholders a liquidation preference of $100 per share in cash (or property having a fair market value as determined by the Board of Directors valued at $100 per share), plus an amount equal to any accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of payment. After payment of the full amount of the liquidating distributions to which they are entitled, the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall have no right or claims to any of the remaining assets of the corporation. In the event that, upon any such voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the affairs of the corporation, the available assets of the corporation are insufficient to pay the amount of the liquidation distributions on all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares and the corresponding amounts payable on all shares of Parity Preferred Shares, then the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall share ratably in any such distribution of assets in proportion to the full liquidating distributions to which they would otherwise be respectively entitled. Neither the consolidation or merger of the corporation with or into any other corporation, trust, or entity (or of any other corporation with or into the corporation) nor the sale, lease, or conveyance of all or substantially all of the property or business of the corporation shall be deemed to constitute a liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation for the purpose of this Paragraph (e) of this Item (i).

 

(f)                                   (1)                                 The corporation, at its option, upon not less than 30 or more than 60 days written notice, may redeem shares of Series A Preferred Shares, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time, for a cash redemption price of $100 per share, plus all accrued and unpaid dividends to the date fixed for redemption (except as provided below).

 

(2)                                 The redemption price of the Series A Preferred Shares (other than the portion thereof consisting of accrued but unpaid dividends) shall be payable solely out of funds legally available for the redemption of capital shares, but subject to any regulatory requirements or agreement of the corporation, including any agreement relating to its indebtedness, which prohibits the

 

3



 

redemption of capital shares or provides that such redemption would constitute a violation of, or a breach of or a default under such regulatory requirement or agreement or any legal restriction or prohibition. Holders of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed shall surrender such shares at the place designated in the notice of redemption and shall be entitled to the redemption price and any accrued and unpaid dividends payable upon such redemption following such surrender. If notice of redemption has been given and if the corporation has set aside in trust the funds necessary for the redemption, then from and after the redemption date; (i) dividends shall cease to accrue on such shares of Series A Preferred Shares; (ii) such shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall no longer be deemed outstanding; and (iii) all rights of the holders of such shares shall terminate, except the right to receive the redemption price. If less than all of the outstanding Series A Preferred Shares are to be redeemed, the Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed shall be selected pro rata (as nearly as may be practicable without creating fractional shares) or by any other equitable method determined by the corporation.

 

(3)                                 Unless full cumulative dividends on all shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof set apart for payment, no shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall be redeemed unless all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares are simultaneously redeemed, and the corporation shall not purchase or otherwise acquire directly or indirectly any shares of Series A Preferred Shares (except by exchange for Junior Shares); however, the foregoing shall not prevent the purchase or acquisition of shares of Series A Preferred Shares pursuant to the purchase or exchange offer made on the same terms to holders of all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares.

 

(4)                                 Notice of redemption shall be mailed by the corporation, postage prepaid, not less than 30 nor more than 60 days prior to the redemption date, addressed to the respective holders of record of the Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed at their respective addresses as they appear on the shares transfer records of the corporation. No failure to give or defect in such notice shall affect the validity of the proceedings for the redemption of any shares of Series A Preferred Shares except as to the holder to whom notice was defective or not given. Each notice shall state: (i) the redemption date; (ii) the redemption price; (iii) the number of shares of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed; (iv) the place or places where the Series A Preferred Shares is to be surrendered for payment of the redemption price; and (v) that dividends on the shares to be redeemed will cease to accrue on such redemption date. If fewer than all shares of the Series A Preferred Shares held by any holder are to be redeemed, the notice mailed to such holder shall also specify the number of shares of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed from such holder.

 

(5)                                 The holders of Series A Preferred Shares at the close of business on a Dividend Record Date shall be entitled to receive the dividend payable with respect to such Series A Preferred Shares on the corresponding Dividend Payment Date notwithstanding the redemption thereof between such Dividend Record Date and the corresponding Dividend Payment Date or the corporation’s

 

4



 

default in the payment of the dividend due. Except as provided above, the corporation will make no payment or allowance for unpaid dividends, regardless of whether in arrears on called Series A Preferred Shares.

 

(6)                                 The Series A Preferred Shares have no stated maturity and shall not be subject to any sinking fund or mandatory redemption. The Series A Preferred Shares are not convertible into any other securities of the corporation.

 

(g)                                  (1)                                 Except as may be required by law or as otherwise expressly provided in this Item (i) of this Article III, the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to vote. On all matters with respect to which the Series A Preferred Shares are entitled to vote, each share of Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to one vote.

 

(2)                                 As long as any shares of Series A Preferred Shares remain outstanding, the corporation shall not, without the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of at least two-thirds of the outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares (voting as a separate class): (i) amend, alter, or repeal the provisions of these Restated Articles of Incorporation, whether by merger, consolidation, or otherwise (an “Event”), so as to materially and adversely affect any right, preference, privilege, or voting power of the Series A Preferred Shares or the holders thereof; however, as long as the Series A Preferred Shares remain outstanding with its terms materially unchanged, taking into account that upon the occurrence of an Event, the corporation may not be the surviving entity, the occurrence of an Event shall not be deemed to materially and adversely affect such rights, preferences, privileges, or voting power of the holders of Series A Preferred Shares, and (ii) any increase in the amount of authorized shares of the Series A Preferred Shares or any other series of Preferred Shares, in each case ranking on a parity with or junior to the Series A Preferred Shares with respect to payment of dividends or the distribution of assets upon liquidation, dissolution, or winding up, shall not be deemed to materially and adversely affect such rights, preferences, privileges, or voting powers.

 

(3)                                 Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to vote, and the foregoing voting provisions shall not apply, if at or prior to the time when the act with respect to which such vote would otherwise be required is effected, all outstanding shares of the Series A Preferred Shares have been redeemed or called for redemption, and sufficient funds have been deposited in trust for the benefit of the holders of the Series A Preferred Shares to effect such redemption.

 

5


 

Document will be returned to the name and address you enter above. If left blank, document will be mailed to the registered office. CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION For use by Domestic Profit and Nonprofit Corporations (Please read information and instructions on the last page) Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972, (profit corporations), or Act 162, Public Acts of 1982 (nonprofit corporations), the undersigned corporation executes the following Certificate: 3.Article III of the Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended to read as follows: The Section entitled “Common Shares” of Article III of the Restated Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended in its entirety by the amendment which is set forth in its entirety on the Attachment to the Certificate of Amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., which Attachment consists of one (1) page. 1.The present name of the corporation is:Sterling Bancorp, Inc. 2.The identification number assigned by the Bureau is: 236008 MICHIGAN DEPARTMENT OF LABOR & ECONOMIC GROWTH BUREAU OF COMMERCIAL SERVICES Date Received (FOR BUREAU USE ONLY) This document is effective on the date filed, unless a subsequent effective date within 90 days after received date is stated in the document. Name Clark Hill PLC c/o Jeffrey J. Van Winkle Address 200 Ottawa St. N.W., Suite 600 CityStateZip Code Grand Rapids MI 49503 EFFECTIVE DATE:

 


COMPLETE ONLY ONE OF THE FOLLOWING: 5. Profit Corporation Only: Shareholder or Board Approval The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation proposed by the board was duly adopted on the 21 day of May, 2008, by the: (check one of the following)  shareholders at a meeting in accordance with Section 611(3) of the Act.  written consent of the shareholders having not less than the minimum number of votes required by statute in accordance with Section 407(1) of the Act. Written notice to shareholders who have not consented in writing has been given. (Note: Written consent by less than all of the shareholders or members is permitted only if such provision appears in the Articles of Incorporation.)  written consent of all the shareholders entitled to vote in accordance with Section 407(2) of the Act.  board of a profit corporation pursuant to section 611(2) of the Act. Profit Corporations and Professional Service Corporations Signed this 7 day of July, 2008 By /s/ Aretha Glover-Bohannon (Signature of an authorized officer or agent) Aretha Glover-Bohannon (Type or Print Name) 4. Profit or Nonprofit Corporations: For amendments adopted by unanimous consent of incorporators before the first meeting of the board of directors or trustees. The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation was duly adopted on theday of , in accordance with the provisions of the Act by the unanimous consent of the incorporator(s) before the first meeting of the Board of Directors or Trustees. Signed this day of (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name) (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name)

 

 

ATTACHMENT TO:
CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION OF
STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

Common Stock.

 

(a)                                 Authorized Shares. The total number of shares of common stock that the Corporation shall have authority to issue is 1,000,000 shares, consisting of two classes of common stock:

 

(i)                                     980,000 shares of common stock (the “Common Shares”); and

 

(ii)                                  20,000 shares of non-voting common stock (the “Non-Voting Common Shares”).  (The Common Shares and the Non-Voting Common Shares shall collectively be referred to as the “Common Stock.”).

 

(b)                                 Relative Rights and Preferences.  The relative rights, privileges, and limitations of the Common Shares and the Non-Voting Common Shares shall be identical in all respects, share for share, except the voting power for the election of directors and for all other purposes shall be vested exclusively in the holders of the Common Shares, unless otherwise required by law. On all matters with respect to which the Common Shares are entitled to vote, each Common Share shall be entitled to one vote.

 

(c)                                  Dividends. After payment or declaration of full cumulative dividends on all shares having priority over the Common Stock as to dividends, and after making all sinking or retirement fund payments on all series of Preferred Shares and on any other stock of the Corporation ranking as to dividends or assets prior to the Common Stock providing for the same, dividends on the Common Stock may be declared and paid, but only when and as determined by the Board of Directors.

 

(d)                                 Liquidating Distribution. On any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Corporation, after there shall have been paid to or set aside for the holders of all shares having priority over the Common Stock the full preferential amounts to which they are respectively entitled, the holders of the Common Stock shall be entitled to receive pro rata all the remaining assets of the Corporation available for distribution to its shareholders.

 



 

 

CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
For use by domestic corporations

 

Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972 (profit corporations), or Act 162, Public Acts of 1982 (nonprofit corporations), the undersigned corporation executes the following Certificate:

 

1.                                      The present name of the corporation is Dykema Nameholding Corporation No. 2.

 

2.                                      The corporation identification number assigned by the Bureau is: 236-008.

 

3.                                      The location of its registered office is 400 Renaissance Center, 35th Floor, Detroit, Michigan 48243.

 

4.                                      Article I of the corporation’s Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended to read as follows:

 

“The name of the corporation is Sterling Bancorp, Inc.”

 

5.                                      The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation was duly adopted on the 12th day of January, 1994, by written consent of all the shareholders entitled to vote in accordance with Section 407(2) of the Act.

 

Signed this 18th day of January 1994.

 

 

/s/ Paul R. Rentenbach

 

Paul R. Rentenbach, President

 



 

DOCUMENT WILL BE RETURNED TO NAME AND MAILING ADDRESS INDICATED IN THE BOX BELOW. Include name, street and number (or P.O. box), city, state and ZIP code.

 

Name of person or organization remitting fees:

 

Janice M. Thieleman

 

 

 

 

 

Dykema Gossett, PLLC

DYKEMA GOSSETT PLLC

 

Preparer’s name and business telephone number:

400 Renaissance Center

 

 

Detroit, Michigan 48243

 

Janice M. Thieleman

 

 

 

Attention: Mr. Paul R. Rentenbach

 

(313) 568-6706

 

INFORMATION AND INSTRUCTIONS

 

1.

The amendment cannot be filed until this form, or a comparable document, is submitted.

 

 

 

 

2.

Submit one original copy of this document. Upon filing, a microfilm copy will be prepared for the records of the Corporation and Securities Bureau. The original copy will be returned to the address appearing in the box above as evidence of filing.

 

 

 

Since this document must be microfilmed, it is important that the filing be legible. Documents with poor black and white contrast, or otherwise illegible, will be rejected.

 

 

3.

This document is to be used pursuant to the provisions of section 631 of the Act for the purpose of amending the articles of incorporation of a domestic profit or nonprofit corporation. Do not use this form for restated articles. A nonprofit corporation is one incorporated to carry out any lawful purpose or purposes not involving pecuniary profit or gain for its directors, officers, shareholders, or members. A nonprofit corporation formed on a nonstock directorship basis, as authorized by Section 302 of the Act, may or may not have members, but if it has members, the members are not entitled to vote.

 

 

4.

Item 2 — Enter the identification number previously assigned by the Bureau. If this number is unknown, leave it blank.

 

 

5.

Item 4 — The article being amended must be set forth in its entirety. However, if the article being amended is divided into separately identifiable sections, only the sections being amended need be included.

 

 

6

This document is effective on the date approved and filed by the Bureau. A later effective date, no more than 90 days after the date of delivery, may be stated.

 

 

7.

If the amendment is adopted before the first meeting of the board of directors, item 5(a) must be completed and signed in ink by a majority of the incorporators if more than one listed in Article V of the Articles of Incorporation if a profit corporation, and all the incorporators if a non-profit corporation. If the amendment is otherwise adopted, item 5(b) must be completed and signed in ink by the president, vice-president, chairperson or vice-chairperson of the corporation.

 

 

8.

FEE: (Make remittance payable to the State of Michigan.

 

Include corporation name and CID Number on check or money order)

$10.00

 

Franchise fee for profit corporations (payable only if authorized shares have increased):

 

 

each additional 20,000 authorized shares or portion thereof

$30.00

 

 

 

9.

Mail form and fee to:

 

 

Michigan Department of Commerce

 

 

Corporation and Securities Bureau

 

 

Corporation Division

 

 

P.O. Box 30054

 

 

6546 Mercantile Way

 

 

Lansing, MI 48909

 

 

Telephone: (517) 334-6302

 

 


 

 

CSCL/CD-515 (Rev. 02/17) Document will be returned to the name and address you enter above. If left blank, document will be returned to the registered office. CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION For use by Domestic Profit and Nonprofit Corporations (Please read information and instructions on the last page) Pursuant to the provisions of Act 284, Public Acts of 1972, (profit corporations), or Act 162, Public Acts of 1982 (nonprofit corporations), the undersigned corporation executes the following Certificate: 3.Article III of the Articles of Incorporation is hereby amended to read as follows: The Section entitled “Common Shares” of Article III of the Restated Articles of Incorporation, as amended, is hereby deleted in its entirety and replaced by the amendment which is set forth on the Attachment to the Certificate of Amendment to the Articles of Incorporation of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., which attachment consists of one (1) page. 1.The present name of the corporation is: Sterling Bancorp, Inc. 2.The identification number assigned by the Bureau is: 236008 MICHIGAN DEPARTMENT OF LICENSING AND REGULATORY AFFAIRS CORPORATIONS, SECURITIES & COMMERCIAL LICENSING BUREAU Data Received This document is effective on the date filed, unless a subsequent effective date within 90 days after received date is stated in the document. EFFECTIVE DATE: Name Stephanie Swan Address 222 N. Washington Square CityStateZip Code Lansing MI 48933

 


COMPLETE ONLY ONE OF THE FOLLOWING: 5. Profit Corporation Only: Shareholder or Board Approval The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation proposed by the board was duly adopted on the 31st day of August, 2017, by the: (check one of the following)  shareholders at a meeting in accordance with Section 611(3) of the Act. written consent of the shareholders having not less than the minimum number of votes required by statute in accordance with Section 407(1) of the Act. Written notice to shareholders who have not consented in writing has been given. (Note: Written consent by less than all of the shareholders is permitted only if such provision appears in the Articles of Incorporation.)  written consent of all the shareholders entitled to vote in accordance with Section 407(2) of the Act. board of a profit corporation pursuant to Section 611(2) of the Act. Profit Corporations and Professional Service Corporations Signed this _7th day of September_, 2017 By/s/ Colleen L. Kimmel (Signature of an authorized officer or agent) Colleen L. Kimmel (Type or Print Name) 4.Profit or Nonprofit Corporations: For amendments adopted by unanimous consent of incorporators before the first meeting of the board of directors or trustees. The foregoing amendment to the Articles of Incorporation was duly adopted on the day of ,, in accordance with the provisions of the Act by the unanimous consent of the incorporator(s) before the first meeting of the Board of Directors or Trustees. Signed this day of , (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name) (Signature)(Signature) (Type or Print Name)(Type or Print Name)

 

 

ATTACHMENT TO CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT TO THE

ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION OF STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

Common Stock

 

(a) Authorized Shares.   The total number of shares of common stock that the Corporation shall have authority to issue is 500,000,000 shares, consisting of two classes of common stock:

 

(i)  490,000,000 shares of common stock (the “Common Shares”); and

 

(ii) 10,000,000 shares of non-voting common stock (the “Non-Voting Common Shares”).  (The Common Shares and the Non-Voting Common Shares shall collectively be referred to as the “Common Stock”).

 

(b) Relative Rights and Preferences.  The relative rights, privileges, and limitations of the Common Shares and the Non-Voting Common Shares shall be identical in all respects, share for share, except the voting power for the election of directors and for all other purposes shall be vested exclusively in the holders of the Common Shares, unless otherwise required by law.  On all matters with respect to which the Common Shares are entitled to vote, each Common Share shall be entitled to one vote.

 

(c)  Dividends.  After payment or declaration of full cumulative dividends on all shares having priority over the Common Stock as to dividends, and after making all sinking or retirement fund payments on all series of Preferred Shares and on any other stock of the Corporation ranking as to dividends or assets prior to the Common Stock providing for the same, dividends on the Common Stock may be declared and paid, but only when and as determined by the Board of Directors.

 

(d)  Liquidating Distribution.  On any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Corporation, after there shall have been paid to or set aside for the holders of all shares having priority over the Common Stock the full preferential amounts to which they are respectively entitled, the holders of the Common Stock shall be entitled to receive pro rata all the remaining assets of the Corporation available for distribution to its shareholders.

 




Exhibit 3.3

 

BYLAWS

 

OF

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

ARTICLE I

 

OFFICES.

 

1.01                        Principal Office.  The principal office of the corporation shall be at such place as the Board of Directors shall from time to time determine.

 

1.02                        Other Offices.  The corporation also may have offices at such other places as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine or the business of the corporation requires.

 

ARTICLE II

 

SEAL

 

2.01                        Seal.  The corporation may have a seal in such form as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine.  The seal may be used by causing it or a facsimile to be impressed, affixed, or otherwise reproduced.

 

ARTICLE III

 

CAPITAL STOCK

 

3.01                        Issuance of Shares.  The shares of capital stock of the corporation shall be issued in such amounts, at such times, for such consideration and on such terms and conditions as the Board of Directors shall deem advisable, subject to the Articles of Incorporation and any requirements of the laws of the State of Michigan.

 

(i)                                     Series A Preferred Shares.  Subject in all cases to the other provisions of this Article III, the following sets forth the designation, preferences, limitations as to dividends, voting and other rights, and the terms and conditions of redemption of the Series A Preferred Shares (defined below) of the corporation.

 

(a)                                 There is hereby established a series of Preferred Shares designated “Series A Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Shares, par value $0.01 per share” (the “Series A Preferred Shares”), which shall consist of 200,000 authorized shares.

 

(b)                                 All shares of Series A Preferred Shares redeemed, purchased, exchanged, or otherwise acquired by the Corporation shall be restored to the status of authorized but unissued shares of Preferred Shares.

 



 

(c)                                  The Series A Preferred Shares shall, with respect to dividend rights, rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, and redemption rights, rank (i) junior to any other series of Preferred Shares hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors, the terms of which specifically provide that such series shall rank prior to the Series A Preferred Shares as to the payment of dividends and distribution of assets upon liquidation (the “Senior Preferred Shares”), (ii) pari passu with any other series of Preferred Shares hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors, the terms of which specifically provide that such series shall rank pari passu with the Series A Preferred Shares as to the payment of dividends and distribution of assets upon liquidation (the “Parity Preferred Shares”), and (iii) prior to any other class or series of capital shares, including, without limitation, the Common Shares of the Corporation, whether now existing or hereafter duly established by the Board of Directors (collectively, the “Junior Shares”).

 

(d)                                 (1)  Subject to the rights of any Senior Preferred Shares, the holders of the then outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to receive, as and when declared by the Board of Directors, out of funds legally available for the payment of dividends, cumulative preferential cash dividends at an annual rate equal to the 90 day Libor rate as in effect at the beginning of each quarterly period plus 280 basis points of the $100 per share liquidation preference (i.e., $3.91 per annum per share as of the date hereof).  Such dividends shall accrue and be cumulative from the date of original issue and shall be payable in equal quarterly amounts in arrears on or before the last day of each March, June, September, and December or, if such day is not a business day, the next succeeding business day (each, a “Dividend Payment Date”) (for the purposes of this Subparagraph (1) of this Paragraph (d), a “business day” is any day, other than a Saturday, Sunday, or legal holiday, on which banks in Detroit, Michigan, are open for business).  The first dividend, which shall be paid on June 30, 2004, will be for less than a full quarter.  All dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares, including any dividend for any partial dividend period, shall be computed on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months.  Dividends will be payable to holders of record as they appear in the share records of the corporation at the close of business on the applicable record date, which shall be the 15th day of the calendar month in which the applicable Dividend Payment Date falls or on such other date designed by the Board of Directors for the payment of dividends that is not more than 30 nor less than ten days prior to such Dividend Payment Date (each, a “Dividend Record Date”).

 

(2)                                 No dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares shall be declared by the Board of Directors or paid or set apart for payment by the corporation if any regulatory requirement or agreement of the corporation, including any agreement relating to its indebtedness, prohibits such declaration, payment, or setting apart for payment, would constitute a violation of, breach of, or a default under, such regulatory requirement or agreement or if such declaration, payment, or setting aside shall be restricted or prohibited by law.

 

(3)                                 Dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares shall accrue and be cumulative regardless of whether the Corporation has earnings, regardless of whether there are funds legally available for the payment of such dividends, and regardless of whether such dividends are declared.  Accrued but unpaid dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares will accumulate as of the Dividend Payment Date on which they first become payable.  Except as set forth below in this Subparagraph (3), no dividends shall be declared or paid or set apart for

 

2



 

payment on any Common Shares or any other series of Preferred Shares ranking, as to dividends, on a parity with or junior to the Series A Preferred Shares (other than a dividend in shares of Junior Shares) for any period unless full cumulative dividends have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof is set apart for such payment on the Series A Preferred Shares for all past dividend periods and the then current dividend period.  When dividends are not paid in full (and a sum sufficient for such full payment is not so set apart) upon the Series A Preferred Shares and the shares of any other series of Preferred Shares ranking on a parity as to dividends with the Series A Preferred Shares, all dividends declared upon the Series A Preferred Shares and any other series of Preferred Shares ranking on a parity as to dividends with the Series A Preferred Shares shall be declared pro rata, so that the amount of dividends declared per share of Series A Preferred Shares and such other series of Preferred Shares shall in all cases bear to each other the same ratio that accrued dividends per share on the Series A Preferred Shares and such other series of Preferred Shares (which shall not include any accrual in respect of unpaid dividends for prior dividend periods if such Preferred Shares do not have a cumulative dividend) bear to each other.  No interest shall be payable in respect of any dividend payment on the Series A Preferred Shares that may be in arrears.  Holders of shares of the Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to any dividend, whether payable in cash, property, or shares, in excess of full cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares as provided above.  Any dividend payment made on shares of the Series A Preferred Shares shall first be credited against the earliest accumulated but unpaid dividend due with respect to such shares that remains payable.

 

(4)                                 Except as provided in Subparagraph (3) of this Paragraph (d) of this Item (i) of this Article III, unless full cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Shares have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof is set apart for payment for all past dividend periods and the then current dividend period: (i) no dividends (other than in shares of Junior Shares) shall be declared or paid or set aside for payment nor shall any other distribution be declared or made upon the Common Shares (or any other Preferred Shares ranking junior to or on a parity with the Series A Preferred Shares as to dividends or upon liquidation); and (ii) no shares of Common Shares (or any other Preferred Shares ranking junior to or on a parity with the Series A Preferred Shares as to dividends or upon liquidation) shall be redeemed, purchased, or otherwise acquired for any consideration (nor shall any moneys be paid to or made available for a sinking fund for the redemption of any such shares) by the Corporation (except by conversion into or exchange for Junior Shares.

 

(e)                                  Subject to the rights of any Senior Preferred Shares, upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the affairs of the Corporation, and before any distribution of assets shall be made in respect of any Junior Shares, the holders of the Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to be paid out of the assets of the corporation legally available for distribution to its shareholders a liquidation preference of $100 per share in cash (or property having a fair market value as determined by the Board of Directors valued at $100 per share), plus an amount equal to any accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of payment.  After payment of the full amount of the liquidating distributions to which they are entitled, the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall have no right or claims to any of the remaining assets of the corporation.  In the event that, upon any such voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the affairs of the corporation, the available assets of the corporation are

 

3



 

insufficient to pay the amount of the liquidation distributions on all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares and the corresponding amounts payable on all shares of Parity Preferred Shares, then the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall share ratably in any such distribution of assets in proportion to the full liquidating distributions to which they would otherwise be respectively entitled.  Neither the consolidation or merger of the corporation with or into any other corporation, trust, or entity (or of any other corporation with or into the corporation) nor the sale, lease, or conveyance of all or substantially all of the property or business of the corporation shall be deemed to constitute a liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation for the purpose of this Paragraph (e) of this Item (i).

 

(f)                                   (1)  The corporation, at its option, upon not less than 30 or more than 60 days written notice, may redeem shares of Series A Preferred Shares, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time, for a cash redemption price of $100 per share, plus all accrued and unpaid dividends to the date fixed for redemption (except as provided below).

 

(2)                                 The redemption price of the Series A Preferred Shares (other than the portion thereof consisting of accrued but unpaid dividends) shall be payable solely out of funds legally available for the redemption of capital shares, but subject to any regulatory requirements or agreement of the corporation, including any agreement relating to its indebtedness, which prohibits the redemption of capital shares or provides that such redemption would constitute a violation of, or a breach of or a default under such regulatory requirement or agreement or any legal restriction or prohibition.  Holders of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed shall surrender such shares at the place designated in the notice of redemption and shall be entitled to the redemption price and any accrued and unpaid dividends payable upon such redemption following such surrender.  If notice of redemption has been given and if the corporation has set aside in trust the funds necessary for the redemption, then from and after the redemption date:  (i) dividends shall cease to accrue on such shares of Series A Preferred Shares; (ii) such shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall no longer be deemed outstanding; and (iii) all rights of the holders of such shares shall terminate, except the right to receive the redemption price.  If less than all of the outstanding Series A Preferred Shares are to be redeemed, the Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed shall be selected pro rata (as nearly as may be practicable without creating fractional shares) or by any other equitable method determined by the corporation.

 

(3)                                 Unless full cumulative dividends on all shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall have been or contemporaneously are declared and paid or declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof set apart for payment, no shares of Series A Preferred Shares shall be redeemed unless all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares are simultaneously redeemed, and the corporation shall not purchase or otherwise acquire directly or indirectly any shares of Series A Preferred Shares (except by exchange for Junior Shares); however, the foregoing shall not prevent the purchase or acquisition of shares of Series A Preferred Shares pursuant to the purchase or exchange offer made on the same terms to holders of all outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares.

 

(4)                                 Notice of redemption shall be mailed by the corporation, postage prepaid, not less than 30 nor more than 60 days prior to the redemption date, addressed to the respective holders of record of the Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed at their respective

 

4



 

addresses as they appear on the shares transfer records of the corporation.  No failure to give or defect in such notice shall affect the validity of the proceedings for the redemption of any shares of Series A Preferred Shares except as to the holder to whom notice was defective or not given.  Each notice shall state: (i) the redemption date; (ii) the redemption price; (iii) the number of shares of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed; (iv) the place or places where the Series A Preferred Shares is to be surrendered for payment of the redemption price; and (v) that dividends on the shares to be redeemed will cease to accrue on such redemption date.  If fewer than all shares of the Series A Preferred Shares held by any holder are to be redeemed, the notice mailed to such holder shall also specify the number of shares of Series A Preferred Shares to be redeemed from such holder.

 

(5)                                 The holders of Series A Preferred Shares at the close of business on a Dividend Record Date shall be entitled to receive the dividend payable with respect to such Series A Preferred Shares on the corresponding Dividend Payment Date, notwithstanding the redemption thereof between such Dividend Record Date and the corresponding Dividend Payment Date or the corporation’s default in the payment of the dividend due.  Except as provided above, the corporation will make no payment or allowance for unpaid dividends, regardless of whether in arrears on called Series A Preferred Shares.

 

(6)                                 The Series A Preferred Shares have no stated maturity and shall not be subject to any sinking fund or mandatory redemption.  The Series A Preferred Shares are not convertible into any other securities of the corporation.

 

(g)                                  (1)  Except as may be required by law or as otherwise expressly provided in this Item (i) of this Article III, the holders of Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to vote.  On all matters with respect to which the Series A Preferred Shares are entitled to vote, each share of Series A Preferred Shares shall be entitled to one vote.

 

(2)                                 As long as any shares of Series A Preferred Shares remain outstanding, the corporation shall not, without the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of at least two-thirds of the outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Shares (voting as a separate class): (i) amend, alter, or repeal the provisions of these Restated Articles of Incorporation, whether by merger, consolidation, or otherwise (an “Event”), so as to materially and adversely affect any right, preference, privilege, or voting power of the Series A Preferred Shares or the holders thereof; however, as long as the Series A Preferred Shares remain outstanding with its terms materially unchanged, taking into account that upon the occurrence of an Event, the corporation may not be the surviving entity, the occurrence of an Event shall not be deemed to materially and adversely affect such rights, preferences, privileges, or voting power of the holders of Series A Preferred Shares, and (ii) any increase in the amount of authorized shares of the Series A Preferred Shares or any other series of Preferred Shares, in each case ranking on a parity with or junior to the Series A Preferred Shares with respect to payment of dividends or the distribution of assets upon liquidation, dissolution, or winding up, shall not be deemed to materially and adversely affect such rights, preferences, privileges, or voting powers.

 

(3)                                 Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Series A Preferred Shares shall not be entitled to vote, and the foregoing voting provisions shall not apply, if at or prior to the time when the act with respect to which such vote would otherwise be required is effected, all

 

5



 

outstanding shares of the Series A Preferred Shares have been redeemed or called for redemption, and sufficient funds have been deposited in trust for the benefit of the holders of the Series A Preferred Shares to effect such redemption.

 

3.02                        Certificates for Shares.  The shares of the corporation shall be represented by certificates signed by the Chairman of the Board of Directors (if such office is filled), President or a Vice President of the corporation, and also may be signed by the Treasurer, Assistant Treasurer, Secretary or Assistant Secretary of the corporation, and may be sealed with the seal of the corporation or a facsimile thereof.  A certificate representing shares shall state upon its face that the corporation is formed under the laws of the State of Michigan, the name of the person to whom it is issued, the number and class of shares, and the designation of the series, if any, which the certificate represents, and such other provisions as may be required by the laws of the state of Michigan.

 

3.03                        Transfer of Shares.  The shares of the capital stock of the corporation are transferable only on the books of the corporation and only upon surrender of the certificate therefor, properly endorsed for transfer, and the presentation of such evidences of ownership and validity of the assignment as the corporation may require.

 

3.04                        Registered Shareholders.  The corporation shall be entitled to treat the person in whose name any share of stock is registered as the owner thereof for purposes of dividends and other distributions in the course of business, or in the course of recapitalization, merger, plan of share exchange, reorganization, sale of assets, liquidation or otherwise and for the purpose of votes, approvals and consents by shareholders, and for the purpose of notices to shareholders, and for all other purposes whatever, and shall not be bound to recognize any equitable or other claim to or interest in such shares on the part of any other person, whether or not the corporation shall have notice thereof, save as expressly required by the laws of the State of Michigan.

 

3.05                        Lost or Destroyed Certificates.  Upon the presentation to the corporation of a proper affidavit attesting the loss, destruction or mutilation of any certificate or certificates for shares of stock of the corporation, the Board of Directors shall direct the issuance of a new certificate or certificates to replace the certificates so alleged to be lost, destroyed or mutilated.  The Board of Directors may require as a condition precedent to the issuance of new certificates a bond or agreement of indemnity, in such form and amount and with such sureties, or without sureties, as the Board of Directors may direct or approve.

 

ARTICLE IV

 

SHAREHOLDERS AND MEETINGS OF SHAREHOLDERS

 

4.01                        Place of Meetings.  All meetings of shareholders shall be held at the principal office of the corporation or at such other place as shall be determined by the Board of Directors and stated in the notice of meeting.

 

4.02                        Annual meeting.  The annual meeting of the shareholders of the corporation shall be held on such date, and at such times as the Board of Directors may select.  Directors shall be

 

6



 

elected at each annual meeting and such other business, as may properly come before the meeting, shall be considered.

 

4.03                        Special Meetings.  Special meetings of shareholders may be called only by the Board of Directors, or by the Chairman of the Board of Directors (if such office is filled) or by the President.  At any special meeting of shareholders, the business which may be transacted shall be limited to that which was specifically stated in the notice of such special meeting provided to shareholders.

 

4.04                        Notice of Meetings.  Except as otherwise provided by statute, written notice of the time, place and purposes of a meeting of shareholders shall be given not less than 10 nor more than 60 days before the date of the meeting to each shareholder of record entitled to vote at the meeting, either personally or by mailing such notice to his or her last address as it appears on the books of the corporation.  No notice need be given of an adjourned meeting of the shareholders provided the time and place to which such meeting is adjourned are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken and at the adjourned meeting only such business is transacted as might have been transacted at the original meeting.  However, if after the adjournment a new record date is fixed for the adjourned meeting a notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given to each shareholder of record on the new record date entitled to notice as provided in this Bylaw.

 

4.05                        Record Dates.  The Board of Directors may fix in advance a date as the record date for the purpose of determining shareholders entitled to notice of and to vote at a meeting of shareholders or an adjournment thereof, or to express consent or to dissent from a proposal without a meeting, or for the purpose of determining shareholders entitled to receive payment of a dividend or allotment of a right, or for the purpose of any other action.  The date fixed shall not be more than 60 nor less than 10 days before the date of the meeting, nor more than 60 days before any other action.  In such case only such shareholders as shall be shareholders of record on the date so fixed shall be entitled to notice of and to vote at such meeting or adjournment thereof, or to express consent or to dissent from such proposal, or to receive payment of such dividend or to receive such allotment of rights, or to participate in any other action, as the case may be, notwithstanding any transfer of any stock on the books of the corporation, or otherwise, after any such record date.  Nothing in this Bylaw shall affect the rights of a shareholder and his or her transferee or transferor as between themselves.

 

4.06                        List of Shareholders.  The Secretary of the corporation or the agent of the corporation having charge of the stock transfer records for shares of the corporation shall make and certify a complete list of the shareholders entitled to vote at a shareholders’ meeting or any adjournment thereof.  The list shall be: arranged alphabetically within each class and series, with the address of, and the number of shares held by, each shareholder; produced at the time and place of the meeting; subject to inspection by any shareholder during the whole time of the meeting; and prima facie evidence as to who are the shareholders entitled to examine the list or vote at the meeting.

 

4.07                        Quorum.  Except in circumstances requiring a greater quorum by the Articles of Incorporation or by the laws of the State of Michigan, the shareholders present at a meeting in person or by proxy who, as of the record date for such meeting, were holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of the corporation entitled to vote at the meeting shall constitute a quorum at

 

7



 

the meeting. Whether or not a quorum is present, a meeting of shareholders may be adjourned by a vote of the shares present in person or by proxy.  When the holders of a class or series of shares are entitled to vote separately on an item of business, this Bylaw applies in determining the presence of a quorum of such class or series for transaction of such item of business.

 

4.08                        Proxies.  A shareholder entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders or to express consent or dissent without a meeting may authorize other persons to act for the shareholder by proxy.  A proxy shall be signed by the shareholder or the shareholder’s authorized agent or representative and shall not be valid after the expiration of three years from its date unless otherwise provided in the proxy.  A proxy is revocable at the pleasure of the shareholder executing it except as otherwise provided by the laws of the State of Michigan,

 

4.09                        Voting.  Each outstanding share is entitled to one vote on each matter submitted to a vote, unless otherwise provided in the Articles of Incorporation.  Votes shall be cast in writing signed by the shareholder or the shareholder’s proxy.  Except as otherwise provided by the Articles of Incorporation, directors shall be elected by a plurality of the votes cast at any election.

 

ARTICLE V

 

DIRECTORS

 

5.01                        Number.  The business and affairs of the corporation shall be managed by a Board of Directors.  The Board of Directors shall consist of not less than five (5) nor more than fifteen (15) persons, and the number of directors shall be fixed by the Board of Directors from time to time.  The directors need not be residents of Michigan or shareholders of the corporation.

 

5.02                        Election, Nomination, Resignation and Removal.  Directors shall be elected at each annual meeting of the shareholders, each to hold office for the term specified in the Articles of Incorporation and until the director’s successor is elected, or until the director’s resignation or removal.  A shareholder may nominate one or more persons for election as a director at an annual meeting of shareholders only if written notice of such shareholder’s intent to nominate such person or persons has been received by the Secretary of the corporation not later than sixty (60) days in advance of such annual meeting, which notice shall set forth (a) the names and residence or business addresses of each person to be nominated and of the shareholder intending to make the nomination, (b) a representation that the shareholder is a record owner of stock entitled to vote at such meeting, and (c) such other information regarding each proposed nominee as would be required to be included in a proxy statement under the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission applicable to persons who are nominated for election by the Board of Directors of the corporation.  A director may resign by written notice to the corporation.  The resignation is effective upon its receipt by the Secretary of the corporation or at such subsequent time as may be set forth in the notice of resignation.  A director or the entire Board of Directors may be removed, but only for cause, by vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote at an election of directors.

 

5.03                        Vacancies.  Vacancies in the Board of Directors occurring by reason of death, resignation, removal, increase in the number of directors or otherwise may be filled only by the

 

8



 

affirmative vote of a majority of the remaining directors though less than a quorum of the Board of Directors.  Each person so elected shall serve as a director for a term of office continuing until the next election of the class of directors for which such new director was elected.  A vacancy that will occur at a specified date, by reason of a resignation effective at a later date or otherwise, may be filled before the vacancy occurs, but the newly elected director may not take office until the vacancy occurs.

 

5.04                        Annual Meeting.  The Board of Directors shall meet each year immediately after the annual meeting of the shareholders, or within three days of such time excluding Sundays and legal holidays if such later time is deemed advisable, at the place where such meeting of the shareholders has been held or such other place as the Board of Directors may determine, for the purpose of appointing officers and considering such other business as may properly be brought before the meeting; provided that, if less than a majority of the directors appear at the annual meeting of the Board of Directors, the holding of such annual meeting shall not be required and the matters which might have been taken up therein may be taken up at any later regular or special meeting, or by written consent.

 

5.05                        Regular and Special Meetings.  Regular meetings of the Board of Directors may be held at such times and places as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine.  Special meetings of the Board of Directors may be called by the Chairman of the Board of Directors (if such office is filled) or the President and shall be called by the President or Secretary upon the written request of any two directors.

 

5.06                        Notices.  No notice shall be required for annual or regular meetings of the Board of Directors or for adjourned meetings, whether regular or special.  Two days’ written notice shall be given for special meetings of the Board of Directors, and such notice shall state the time, place and purpose or purposes of the meeting.

 

5.07                        Quorum.  A majority of the Board of Directors then in office, or of the members of a committee thereof, constitutes a quorum for the transaction of business.  The vote of a majority of the directors present at any meeting at which there is a quorum shall be the acts of the Board of Directors or of the committee, except as a larger vote may be required by the laws of the State of Michigan.  A member of the Board of Directors or of a committee designated by the Board of Directors may participate in a meeting by means of conference telephone or similar communication equipment by means of which all persons participating in the meeting can communicate with each other.  Participation in a meeting in this manner constitutes presence in person at the meeting.

 

5.08                        Executive and Other Committees.  The Board of Directors may, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board of Directors, appoint three or more members of the Board of Directors as an executive committee to exercise all powers and authorities of the Board of Directors in management of the business and affairs of the corporation, except that the committee shall not have power or authority to (a) amend the Articles of Incorporation; (b) adopt an agreement of merger or consolidation; (c) recommend to shareholders the sale, lease or exchange of all or substantially all of the corporation’s property and assets; (d) recommend to shareholders a dissolution of the corporation or revocation of a dissolution; (e) amend these Bylaws; (f) fill vacancies in the Board of Directors; or (g) unless expressly organized for that

 

9



 

purpose and authorized by the Board of Directors, declare a dividend or authorize the issuance of stock.

 

The Board of Directors from time to time may, by like resolution, appoint such other committees of one or more directors to have such authority as shall be specified by the Board of Directors in the resolution making such appointments.  The Board of Directors may designate one or more directors as alternate members of any committee who may replace an absent or disqualified member at any meeting thereof.

 

5.09                        Dissents.  A director who is present at a meeting of the Board of Directors, or a committee thereof of which the director is a member, at which action an a corporate matter is taken is presumed to have concurred in that action unless the director’s dissent is entered in the minutes of the meeting or unless the director files a written dissent to the action with the person acting as secretary of the meeting before the adjournment thereof or shall forward such dissent by registered mail to the Secretary of the corporation promptly after the adjournment of the meeting.  Such right to dissent does not apply to a director who voted in favor of such action.  A director who is absent from a meeting of the Board of Directors, or a committee thereof of which the director is a member, at which any such action is taken is presumed to have concurred in the action unless the director files a written dissent with the Secretary of the corporation within a reasonable time after the director has knowledge of the action.

 

5.10                        Compenstion.  The Board of Directors, by Affirmative vote of a majority of directors in office and irrespective of any personal interest of any of them, may establish reasonable compensation of directors for services to the corporation as directors or officers.

 

ARTICLE VI

 

NOTICES, WAIVERS OF NOTICE AND MANNER OF ACTING

 

6.01                        Notices.  All notices of meetings required to be given to shareholders, directors or any committee of directors may be given by mail, telecopy, telegram, radiogram or cablegram to any shareholder, director or committee member at his or her last address as it appears on the books of the corporation.  Such notice shall be deemed to be given at the time when the same shall be mailed or otherwise dispatched.

 

6.02                        Waiver of Notice.  Notice of the time, place and purpose of any meeting of shareholders, directors or committee of directors may be waived by telecopy, telegram, radiogram, cablegram or other writing, either before or after the meeting, or in such other manner as may be permitted by the laws of the State of Michigan.  Attendance of a person at any meeting of shareholders, in person or by proxy, or at any meeting of directors or of a committee of directors, constitutes a waiver of notice of the meeting except as follows:

 

(a)                                 In the case of a shareholder, unless the shareholder at the beginning of the meeting objects to holding the meeting or transacting business at the meeting, or unless with respect to consideration of a particular matter at the meeting that is not within the purpose or purposes described in the meeting notice, the shareholder objects to considering the matter when it is presented.

 

10


 

(b)                                 In the case of a director, unless he or she at the beginning of the meeting, or upon his or her arrival, objects to the meeting or the transacting of business at the meeting and does not thereafter vote for or assent to any action taken at the meeting.

 

6.03                        Action Without a Meeting.  Except as may be provided otherwise in the Articles of Incorporation for action to be taken by shareholders, any action required or permitted at any meeting of shareholders or directors or committee of directors may be taken without a meeting, without prior notice and without a vote, if all of the shareholders or directors or committee members entitled to vote thereon consent thereto in writing, before or after the action is taken.

 

ARTICLE VII

 

OFFICERS

 

7.01                        Number.  The Board of Directors shall appoint a President, a Secretary and a Treasurer, and may appoint a Chairman of the Board of Directors, and one or more Vice Presidents, Assistant Secretaries or Assistant Treasurers.  Any two or more of the above offices, except those of President and Vice President, may be held by the same person.  No officer shall execute, acknowledge, certify or verify an instrument in more than one capacity if the instrument is required by law, the Articles of Incorporation or these Bylaws to be executed, acknowledged, certified or verified by one or more officers.

 

7.02                        Term of Office, Resignation and Removal.  An officer shall hold office for the term for which he or she is appointed and until his or her successor is appointed, or until his or her resignation or removal.  An officer may resign by written notice to the corporation.  The resignation is effective upon its receipt by the corporation or at a subsequent time specified in the notice of resignation.  An officer may be removed by the Board of Directors with or without cause.  The appointment of a person to serve as an officer of the corporation does not of itself create contract rights.

 

7.03                        Vacancies.  The Board of Directors may fill any vacancies in any office occurring for whatever reason and at whatever time.

 

7.04                        Authority.  All officers, employees and agents of the corporation shall have such authority and perform such duties in the conduct and management of the business and affairs of the corporation as may be designated by the Board of Directors and these Bylaws.

 

ARTICLE VIII

 

DUTIES OF OFFICERS

 

8.01                        Chairman of the Board of Directors.  The Chairman of the Board of Directors, if such office is filled, shall be the chief executive officer of the corporation and shall preside at all meetings of the shareholders and of the Board of Directors at which the Chairman is present.  The Chairman shall see that all orders and resolutions of the Board of Directors are carried into effect, and the Chairman shall have the general powers of supervision and management usually vested in the chief executive officer of a corporation, including the authority to vote all securities of other corporations and business organizations held by the corporation.

 

11



 

8.02                        President.  If the office of Chairman is filled, the President shall be the chief operating officer of the corporation and shall have the general powers of supervision and management over the day-to-day operations of the corporation.  In the absence or disability of the Chairman of the Board of Directors, or if that office has not been filled, the President also shall perform the duties of the Chairman of the Board as set forth in these Bylaws.

 

8.03                        Vice Presidents.  The Vice Presidents, in order of their seniority, as determined by the Board of Directors, shall, in the absence or disability of the President, perform the duties and exercise the powers of the President and shall perform such other duties as the Board of Directors or the President may from time to time prescribe.

 

8.04                        Secretary.  The Secretary shall attend all meetings of the Board of Directors and of shareholders and shall record all votes and minutes of all proceedings in a book to be kept for that purpose, shall give or cause to be given notice of all meetings of the shareholders and of the Board of Directors, and shall keep in safe custody the seal of the corporation and, when authorized by the Board of Directors, affix the same to any instrument requiring it, and when so affixed it shall be attested by the signature of the Secretary, or by the signature of the Treasurer or an Assistant Secretary.  The Secretary may delegate any of the duties, powers and authorities of the Secretary to one or more Assistant Secretaries, unless such delegation is disapproved by the Board of Directors.

 

8.05                        Treasurer.  The Treasurer shall have the custody of the corporate funds and securities; shall keep full and accurate accounts of receipts and disbursements in books of the corporation; and shall deposit all moneys and other valuable effects in the name and to the credit of the corporation in such depositories as may be designated by the Board of Directors.  The Treasurer shall render to the President and directors, whenever they may require it, an account of his or her transactions as Treasurer and of the financial condition of the corporation.  The Treasurer may delegate any of his or her duties, powers and authorities to one or more Assistant Treasurers unless such delegation is disapproved by the Board of Directors.

 

8.06                        Assistant Secretaries and Treasurers.  The Assistant Secretaries, in the order of their seniority, shall perform the duties and exercise the powers and authorities of the Secretary in case of the Secretary’s absence or disability.  The Assistant Treasurers, in the order of their seniority, shall perform the duties and exercise the powers and authorities of the Treasurer in case of the Treasurer’s absence or disability.  The Assistant Secretaries and Assistant Treasurers shall also perform such duties as may be delegated to them by the Secretary and Treasurer, respectively, and also such duties as the Board of Directors may prescribe.

 

ARTICLE IX

 

SPECIAL CORPORATE ACTS

 

9.01                        Orders for Payment of Money.  All checks, drafts, notes, bonds, bills of exchange and orders for payment of money of the corporation shall be signed by such officer or officers or such other person or persons as the Board of Directors may from time to time designate.

 

12



 

9.02                        Contracts and Conveyances.  The Board of Directors of the corporation may in any instance designate the officer and/or agent who shall have authority to execute any contract, conveyance, mortgage or other instrument on behalf of the corporation, or may ratify or confirm any execution.  when the execution of any instrument has been authorized without specification of the executing officers or agents, the Chairman of the Board of Directors, the President or any Vice President, and the Secretary or Assistant Secretary or Treasurer or Assistant Treasurer, may execute the same in the name and on behalf of this corporation and may affix the corporate seal thereto.

 

ARTICLE X

 

BOOKS AND RECORDS

 

10.01                 Maintenance of Books and Records.  The proper officers and agents of the corporation shall keep and maintain such books, records and accounts of the corporation’s business and affairs, minutes of the proceedings of its shareholders, Board of Directors and committees, if any, and such stock ledgers and lists of shareholders, as the Board of Directors shall deem advisable, and as shall be required by the laws of the State of Michigan and other states or jurisdictions empowered to impose such requirements.  Books, records and minutes may be kept within or without the State of Michigan in a place which the Board of Directors shall determine.

 

10.02                 Reliance on Books and Records.  In discharging his or her duties, a director or an officer of the corporation, when acting in good faith, may rely upon information, opinions, reports, or statements (including financial statements and other financial data) if prepared or presented by any of the following:

 

(a)                                 One or more directors, officers, or employees of the corporation, or of a business organization under joint control or common control, whom the director or officer reasonably believes to be reliable and competent in the matters presented.

 

(b)                                 Legal counsel, public accountants, engineers, or other persons as to matters the director or officer reasonably believes are within the person’s professional or expert competence.

 

(c)                                  A committee of the Board of Directors of which he or she is not a member if the director or officer reasonably believes the committee merits confidence.

 

A director or officer is not entitled to rely on the information set forth above if he or she has knowledge concerning the matter in question that makes reliance otherwise permitted unwarranted.

 

13



 

ARTICLE XI

 

INDEMNIFICATION

 

11.01                 INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS.

 

Subject to and in accordance with the provisions of the Corporation’s Articles of Incorporation, the Corporation shall indemnify a person (including the heirs, personal representatives, and administrators of such person) who was or is a party to, or who is threatened to be made a party to, a threatened, pending, or completed action, suit, or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative, or investigative and whether formal or informal, including, without limitation, an action by or in the right of the Corporation, by reason of the fact that he or she is or was a director of the Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a director of the Corporation or any wholly owned subsidiary of the Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a director (or in a similar capacity) of another foreign or domestic corporation or any other entity, whether for profit or not, against expenses, including attorneys’ fees, judgments, penalties, fines, and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with the action, suit, or proceeding; provided, however, that any indemnification provided pursuant to this Section 11.01 must be consistent with and permitted by laws and regulations applicable to federally insured depository institutions, including but not limited to regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  This Section 11.01 is intended to grant the persons herein described the fullest protection not prohibited by existing law in effect as of the effective date of the Articles of Incorporation of the Corporation or such greater protection as may be permitted or not prohibited under succeeding provisions of law.

 

11.02                 INDEMNIFICATION OF OFFICERS, EMPLOYEES, AGENTS, AND OTHERS.

 

Subject to and in accordance with the provisions of the Corporation’s Articles of Incorporation, the Corporation has the power to indemnify a person (including heirs, personal representatives, and administrators of such person) who was or is a party to, or who is threatened to be made a party to, a threatened, pending, or completed action, suit, or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative, or investigative and whether formal or informal, including, without limitation, an action by or in the right of the Corporation, by reason of the fact that he or she is or was an officer, employee, or agent of the Corporation or any wholly owned subsidiary of the Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as an officer, partner, trustee, employee, or agent of another foreign or domestic corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, or other enterprise, whether for profit or not, against expenses, including attorneys’ fees, judgments, penalties, fines, and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with the action, suit, or proceeding, if the person acted in good faith in a manner he or she reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Corporation (including its wholly owned subsidiaries) or its shareholders, and with respect to a criminal action or proceeding, if the person had no reasonable cause to believe his or her conduct was unlawful.  An indemnification under this Section 11.02, unless ordered by a court, shall be made by the Corporation only as authorized in the specific case upon a determination that indemnification of the officer, employee, or agent is proper in the circumstances because he or she has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in this Section 11.02; upon an evaluation of the reasonableness of expenses and amounts paid in settlement; and upon a determination that indemnification provided pursuant to this Section 11.02 is consistent with and permitted by laws and regulations applicable to federally insured depository institutions, including but not limited to regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  This determination and evaluation shall be made in any of the following ways: (i) by a majority

 

14



 

vote of a quorum of the board consisting of directors who are not parties or threatened to be made parties to the action, suit, or proceeding; (ii) by independent legal counsel in a written opinion; or (iii) by the shareholders who are not parties or threatened to be made parties to the action, suit, or proceeding.

 

11.03                 ADVANCEMENT OF EXPENSES.

 

Subject to and not in dimunition of rights contained in the Corporation’s Articles of Incorporation, and upon a determination that any advance or reimbursement made pursuant to this Section 11.03 is consistent with and permitted by laws and regulations applicable to federally insured depository institutions, including but not limited to regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Corporation shall pay or reimburse the reasonable expenses incurred by a person described in Section 11.01 above in defending an action, suit, or proceeding described in such Section 11.01 in advance of the final disposition of the proceeding.  Also upon a determination that any advance or reimbursement made pursuant to this Section 11.03 is consistent with and permitted by laws and regulations applicable to federally insured depository institutions, including but not limited to regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Corporation shall pay or reimburse the reasonable expenses incurred by a person described in Section 11.02 in defending an action, suit, or proceeding described in such Section 11.02 in advance of the final disposition of the proceeding upon receipt of a written undertaking by or on behalf of such person, executed personally or on his or her behalf, to repay the advance if it is ultimately determined that the person is not entitled to be indemnified by the Corporation.  Such undertaking shall be by unlimited general obligation of the person on whose behalf advances are made but need not be secured.

 

11.04                 INDEMNIFICATION: INSURANCE.

 

The Corporation shall have power to purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee, or agent of the Corporation or any wholly owned subsidiary of the Corporation or is liable as a director of the Corporation or any wholly owned subsidiary of the Corporation, or is or was serving, at the request of the Corporation, as a director, officer, employee, or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, or other enterprise, against any liability asserted against him or her and incurred by him or her in any such capacity or arising out of his or her status as such, regardless of whether the Corporation would have power to indemnify him or her against such liability under the provisions of this Article XI; provided, however, that any such insurance shall only provide coverage that is consistent with and permitted by laws and regulations applicable to federally insured depository institutions, including but not limited to regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation .

 

11.05                 INDEMNIFICATION: CONSTITUENT CORPORATIONS.

 

For the purposes of this Article XI, references to the Corporation include all constituent corporations absorbed in a consolidation or merger and the resulting or surviving corporation, so that a person who is or was a director or officer of such constituent corporation or is or was serving at the request of such constituent corporation as a director or officer of another

 

15



 

corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, or other enterprise shall (as shall his/her heirs, executors, and administrators) stand in the same position, under the provisions of this Article, with respect to the resulting or surviving corporation as he/she would if he/she had served the resulting or surviving corporation in the same capacity.

 

ARTICLE XII

 

CONTROL SHARES AND CONTROL SHARE ACQUISITIONS

 

12.01                 Control Share Acquisitions.  If the corporation is or becomes subject to Chapter 7B of the Michigan Business Corporation Act, effective on the first day on which the corporation has 100 or more shareholders of record, shares of capital stock of the corporation constituting “control shares” acquired in “control share acquisitions” (as defined in Chapter 7B) shall have the same voting rights as were accorded such shares before the “control share acquisition” only to the extent granted by resolution approved by the shareholders of the corporation in accordance with Chapter 7B.

 

12.02                 Redemption of Control Shares.  Control shares as to which all of the following conditions are met may be redeemed by the corporation, upon approval by the Board of Directors, at any time after such conditions have been met:

 

(a)                                 (i)                                     An acquiring person statement has been filed with the corporation, a meeting of the shareholders of the corporation has been held at which the voting rights of the control shares have been submitted to the shareholders for a vote, and the shareholders do not grant full voting rights to the control shares; or

 

(ii)                                        If an “acquiring person statement” (as such term appears in Section 795 of the Michigan Business Corporation Act) has not been filed with the corporation with respect to a control share acquisition and the redemption is completed during the period ending 60 days after the last acquisition of control shares, or the power to direct the exercise of voting power of control shares, by the acquiring persons; and

 

(b)                                 The consideration to be paid for the control shares consists of cash, property or securities of the corporation, or any combination thereof, including shares of capital stock of the corporation or debt obligations of the corporation; and

 

(c)                                  The price to be paid for the control shares does not exceed the fair value of the shares, as determined by the Board of Directors, which value shall not be less than the highest price paid per share by the acquiring person in the control share acquisition.

 

12.03                 Procedures.  The Board of Directors may, by resolution, adopt procedures for the giving of notice of such redemption to the Nacquiring personn and for the delivery of certificates

 

16



 

representing the control shares to be acquired in exchange for the corporation’s payment of fair value therefor.

 

ARTICLE XIII

 

AMENDMENTS

 

13.01                 Amendments.  The Bylaws of the corporation and any Article or provision thereof may be amended or repealed, in whole or in part, by the vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation or by majority vote of the Board of Directors, provided that notice of the meeting at which such amendment or repeal is to be acted upon includes notice of the proposed amendment or repeal.

 

17




Exhibit 10.1

 

EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

 

THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”), dated as of July 2, 2008, between STERLING BANCORP, INC., a Michigan corporation (the “Company”), STERLING BANK AND TRUST, F.S.B., (the “Bank”), and their affiliated entities (collectively “Employer”) with  their principal offices located at One Towne Square, 17th Floor, Southfield, MI 48076 and Gary Judd, who resides at 3 Cantitoe Lane, Englewood, CO 80113 (the “Executive”).

 

W I T N E S S E T H:

 

WHEREAS, the Employer and the Executive desire to enter into an employment arrangement whereby the Executive will act as the Chairman of the Board of Directors for the Employer entities, as well as, on an interim basis, Chief Executive Officer for the Employer entities, with the latter duties to continue until such time as an acceptable substitute Chief Executive Officer is employed;

 

WHEREAS, the Employer has determined that it is in its best interests, and in the best interest of its shareholders to enter into this Agreement setting forth the obligations and duties of both the Employer and the Executive; and

 

WHEREAS, the Employer wishes to avail itself of the services of the Executive for the period hereinafter provided, and the Executive is willing to be employed by the Employer for said period, upon the terms and conditions provided in this Agreement.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is mutually acknowledged, the Employer and the Executive (individually, a “Party” and together, the “Parties”) agree as follows:

 

1.                                      Employment.  The Employer hereby agrees to employ the Executive, and the Executive hereby agrees to serve the Employer, on the terms and conditions set forth herein.

 

2.                                      Term.  Subject to the provisions for earlier termination as hereinafter provided, the term of this Employment Agreement will begin on the date hereof and will continue for one (2) years hereafter (the “Initial Term of Employment”).  Except as provided in paragraph 14 of this Agreement, which is mandated by Federal statute, this Agreement may be terminated as hereinafter provided.  This Agreement will be automatically renewed for a successive one (1) year term unless either party sends written notice of termination to the other party within sixty (60) days prior to the expiration of this Agreement or any renewals hereof.  The Initial Term of Employment together with any renewal periods will hereinafter be referred to as the “Term of Employment.”  The non-renewal of the term of this Agreement by the Employer will not be a termination without Cause (as defined in Section 8(d)).

 

1



 

3.                                      Position and Duties; Place of Performance.

 

(a)                                 The Executive will serve as Chairman of the Employer during the Term of Employment.   He may serve the Employer under additional titles but in any event the Executives’ title shall include that of Chairman.  The Executive will perform all duties customarily attendant to the position of Chairman and such other duties as may reasonably be assigned from time-to-time by the Company and Bank the Bank Boards of Directors (the “Board”). The Executive will also serve, on an interim basis, as Chief Executive Officer of the Employer until such time as the Employer hires an acceptable substitute Chief Executive Officer.

 

(b)                                 If the Employer fails, without the Executive’s consent, to cause the Executive to be elected to take a position with the Employer, the result of which is that the Executive will no longer remain in the position of Chairman in addition to such other position, then the Executive shall have the right to terminate his services to the Employer by giving written notice within thirty (30) days of such event; provided the Employer has not cured such event within such thirty (30) day period.

 

(c)                                  The Executive will use his best efforts to perform diligently such duties as are consistent with his capacity as Chairman or such other duties as the Board and/or Board reasonably determines, including on an interim basis, the duties associated with being a Chief Executive Officer.  The Executive will devote as much time as necessary per month to the performance of his responsibilities hereunder; and, the Executive may make personal investments, engage in such outside non-competitive business activities or engage in other activities for any charitable or other non-profit institution, provided that such activities do not interfere with the performance of the Executive’s duties hereunder.

 

(d)                                 While it is contemplated that after an initial transition and organizational period, in connection with the Executive’s employment, the Executive will spend no less than two (2) weeks per month at the Employer’s offices in San Francisco, California, it is also understood by the Parties that the Executive may need to spend more of his time at the Employer’s current Michigan headquarters in order to reasonably perform his responsibilities hereunder. The objective of the Parties, in connection with the Executive’s employment, is for the Executive to utilize his professional time and efforts, to advance the goals set forth in the Sterling Operating Model and business plan as approved by the Board and as may be amended by the Board from time to time.

 

4.                                      Base Salary.  The Executive will receive from the Bank (but, internally allocated between the Employer entities) an annual salary of Two Hundred Twenty-Five Thousand Dollars ($225,000) (the “Base Salary”), payable in accordance with the standard practice of the Bank in the payment of salaries of its employees.  The Board will review the Base Salary annually, and may, in its reasonable discretion, adjust the Base Salary.

 

5.                                      Annual Bonus.  The Executive may be paid a bonus annually based upon the attainment of mutually agreed upon objectives, to be determined by the Board.

 

2



 

6.                                      Other Benefits.  During the Term of Employment, the Executive will be provided with such medical, hospitalization, insurance, pension plan, profit sharing and employee benefits and such other similar employment privileges and benefits, including vacation benefits (“Benefits”) as are afforded generally from time to time to other executive employees of the Bank. The Bank and the Executive shall execute an Indemnification Agreement for the benefit of the Executive.

 

7.                                      Expense Reimbursement.  During the Term of Employment, the Executive will be entitled to prompt reimbursement by the Bank for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred by him in performing services under this Agreement, upon submission of such accounts and records as may be required under Bank policy. During the term of this Agreement, the Employer shall provide Executive with a furnished apartment in San Francisco, California, acceptable to both Executive and Employer, as well as reimbursement for all reasonable travel and accommodation related expenses for travel between and among Denver, Colorado, San Francisco, California, and/or Detroit, Michigan, provided that all such expenses are mutually agreed to in advance by the Employer and the Executive.

 

8.                                      Termination of Employment.  The Executive’s employment may be terminated under the following circumstances:

 

(a)                                 Death.  The Executive’s employment is terminated upon his death.

 

(b)                                 Disability.  The Executive’s employment may be terminated by the Employer due to illness or other physical or mental disability of the Executive, resulting in his inability to perform substantially his duties under this Agreement for a period of ninety (90) or more consecutive days or for one hundred eighty (180) days in the aggregate during any consecutive twelve (12) month period (“Disability”).

 

(c)                                  Mutual Agreement.  The Executive’s employment may be terminated at any time by the mutual agreement of the Parties.

 

(d)                                 Cause.  The Executive’s employment may be terminated for Cause.  For purposes of this Agreement, the Bank will have “Cause” to terminate the Executive’s employment upon:

 

(i)                           the Executive’s commission of any crime involving monies or other property or any felony, crime or any offense of moral turpitude, or his fraud, embezzlement, theft, dishonesty, willful misconduct or deliberate injury to the Employer in the performance of his duties hereunder.

 

(ii)                             the Executive’s intentional or grossly negligent refusal or failure to perform his duties or carry out reasonable directions of the  Board;

 

(iii)                              the Executive’s breach of any of his fiduciary duties or making of a willful misrepresentation or omission, which breach or misrepresentation or omission might reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the Employer’s businesses;

 

3



 

(iv)                            the Executive’s breach of any material provision of this Agreement;

 

(v)                               any misappropriation by the Executive of funds or property of the Employer; or

 

(vi)                            the Executive’s failure to perform his duties adequately as determined by the Board.

 

Any termination for “Cause” will not be in limitation of any other right or remedy the Employer may have under this Agreement or otherwise.  In the event that the Executive’s employment is terminated for Cause, any amount due to the Executive under this Section 9(a) may be offset to the extent of any losses resulting, directly or indirectly, to the Employer, from Executive’s conduct resulting in the for Cause termination.

 

9.                                      Compensation Upon Termination Not For Cause.

 

(a)                                 If the Executive’s employment is terminated as a result of the Executive’s death, disability, or by mutual agreement, he, or his estate, will be entitled to:

 

(i)                           any base salary earned but not yet paid;

 

(ii)                             any bonus awarded pursuant to Section 5 of this Agreement but not yet paid;

 

(iii)                              reimbursement in accordance with this Agreement of any business expense incurred by the Executive but not yet paid; and

 

(iv)                            other benefits accrued and earned by the Executive through the date of his death or Disability in accordance with applicable plans and programs of the Bank.

 

(b)                                 If the Executive’s employment is terminated for Cause or expiration of the Term of Employment, including the Initial Term of Employment resulting from any of the Parties providing written notice of termination as provided in Section 2 hereof, he will remain subject to the covenants set forth in Section 10 hereof and he will be entitled to:

 

(i)                           any base salary earned but not yet paid;

 

(ii)                          any bonus awarded pursuant to Section 5 of this Agreement but not yet paid;

 

(iii)                           reimbursement in accordance with this Agreement of any business expense incurred by the Executive but not yet paid; and

 

4



 

(iv)                            other benefits accrued and earned by the Executive through the date of his termination in accordance with applicable plans and programs of the Bank.

 

(c)                                  If the Executive’s employment is terminated without Cause, he will remain subject to the covenants set forth in Section 10 hereof through the expiration of the Severance Period and he will be entitled to:

 

(i)                           any base salary earned but not yet paid;

 

(ii)                          continuation of his Base Salary, at the rate in effect on the date of his termination of employment for a period of one (1) year from the date of such termination (the “Severance Period”);

 

(iii)                       any bonus awarded pursuant to Section 5 of this Agreement but not yet paid;

 

(iv)                         continued participation in all employee benefit plans or programs in which he was participating on the date of his termination of employment, until the expiration of the Severance Period;

 

(v)                           reimbursement in accordance with this Agreement of any business expenses incurred by the Executive but not yet paid to him on the date of his termination of employment; and

 

(vi)                         other benefits that are made available to employees of the Bank in general in accordance with applicable plans and programs of the Employer until the expiration of the Severance Period.

 

In the event that, under the terms of any employee benefit plan referred to in subsection 9(c)(iv) above, the Executive may not continue his participation, he will be provided with the economic equivalent of the benefits provided under any plan in which he was previously eligible to participate for the period specified in subsection 9(c)(iv) above.  The economic equivalent of any benefit foregone will be deemed to be the cost that would be incurred by the Executive in obtaining such benefit on the lowest available individual basis.

 

(d)                                 Any amounts due under this Section 9 are in the nature of severance payments or liquidated damages or both, and will fully compensate the Executive and his dependents or beneficiaries, as the case may be, for any and all direct damages and consequential damages that any of them may suffer as a result of termination of the Executive’s employment, and they are not in the nature of a penalty.

 

10.                               Confidentiality and Non-Competition.

 

(a)                                 The Executive acknowledges that he has had or will have unlimited access to the confidential information and business methods relating to the business and operations of the Employer and that those entities would be irreparably injured and their

 

5



 

goodwill would be irreparably damaged if the Executive were to breach the covenants set forth in this Section 10.  The Executive further acknowledges that the covenants set forth in this Section 10 are reasonable in scope and duration and do not unreasonably restrict the Executive’s association with other business entities, either as an Executive or otherwise as set forth herein.

 

(b)                                 During the Term of Employment and thereafter, except as may be required by law or necessary in connection with any dealings with any public agency or authority, the Executive must not disclose, disseminate, divulge, discuss, copy or otherwise use or suffer to be used, in competition with, or in a manner harmful to the interests of, the Employer, any confidential information (written or oral) respecting any material aspect of Employer’s business, excepting only use of such data or information as is (i) at the time disclosed, through no act or failure to act on the part of the Executive, generally known or available; (ii) furnished to the Executive by a third party as a matter of right and without restriction on disclosure; or (iii) required to be disclosed by court order.  Upon termination of the Term of Employment, the Executive will return to the Employer any and all materials in tangible or electronic form containing confidential information belonging to the Employer.

 

(c)                                  During the Term of Employment and for one (1) year thereafter, the Executive must not in the State of California in which the Employer then regularly conducts business, directly or indirectly, whether as an individual on the Executive’s own account, or as a shareholder, partner, member, joint venturer, director, officer, employee, consultant, creditor and/or agent, of any person, firm or organization or otherwise:

 

(i)                           employ, assist in employing or otherwise associate in business with any employee or officer of the Employer that is, or was during the twelve-month period immediately prior to the termination of the Executive’s employment, employed by the Employer, other than an employee or an officer who is a relative of the Executive by blood or marriage;

 

(ii)                            solicit or encourage any individual or entity that is, or was during the twelve-month period immediately prior to the termination of Executive’s employment with the Employer for any reason, a customer or vendor of the Employer to terminate or otherwise alter his, her or its relationship with the Employer; provided, however, that notwithstanding anything to the contrary, the parties agree that this Section 10 does not prohibit the Executive from pursuing or establishing a business relationship with any current or former customer or vendor of the Employer where such customer or vendor presents himself, herself or itself to Executive unsolicited by him;

 

(iii) induce any person who is a present or future employee, officer, agent, affiliate or customer of the Employer to terminate the relationship; or

 

6



 

(iv)                            engage in disparagement (which will not include the providing of accurate information without invidious intent) of the Employer by any means to any person.

 

7



 

11.                               Rights and Remedies Upon Breach.

 

(a)                                 The Executive expressly agrees and understands that the remedy at law for any breach by the Executive of Section 10 will be inadequate and that the damages flowing from such breach are not readily susceptible to being measured in monetary terms.  Accordingly, it is acknowledged that upon adequate proof of the Executive’s violation of Section 10, the Employer will be entitled, among other remedies, to injunctive relief and may obtain a temporary restraining order restraining any threatened or further breach. Nothing in this Section 11(a) will be deemed to limit the Employer’s remedies at law or in equity for any breach by the Executive of any of the provisions of this Agreement which may be pursued or availed of by the Employer.

 

(b)                                 In the event any arbitrator or court of competent jurisdiction determines that the specified time period or geographical area set forth in Section 10 is unreasonable, arbitrary or against public policy, then a lesser time period or geographical area that is determined by the court to be reasonable, non-arbitrary and not against public policy may be enforced.

 

(c)                                  In the event the Employer has asserted in a formal legal action, including arbitration, that the Executive is violating any legally enforceable provision of Section 10 as to which there is a specific time period during which the Executive is prohibited from taking certain actions or engaging in certain activities, then, in such event the violation will toll the running of the time period from the date of the assertion until the violation ceases.

 

12.                               Withholding Taxes.  All payments to the Executive or his beneficiary will be subject to withholding on account of federal, state and local taxes as required by law.  If any payment hereunder is insufficient to provide the amount of such taxes required to be withheld, the Bank may withhold such taxes from any other payment due the Executive or his beneficiary.

 

13.                               Assignability; Binding Nature.  This Agreement will be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors, heirs (in the case of the Executive) and assigns.  No rights or obligations of the Employer under this Agreement may be assigned or transferred except that such rights or obligations may be assigned or transferred pursuant to (i) a merger or consolidation in which the Employer is not the continuing entity or (ii) a sale or liquidation of all or substantially all of the assets of the Employer, provided that the assignee or transferee is the successor to all or substantially all of the assets of the Employer and such assignee or transferee assumes the liabilities, obligations and duties of the Employer, as contained in this Agreement, either contractually or as a matter of law.  The Employer further agrees that, in the event of a sale of assets or liquidation as described in the preceding sentence, it will use its best efforts to cause such assignee or transferee to expressly assume the liabilities, obligations and duties of the Employer hereunder.  No obligations of the Executive under this Agreement may be assigned or transferred by the Executive.

 

14.                               Bank Regulatory Requirements Compliance Terms.        Due to federal regulatory requirements binding upon the Bank parties hereby acknowledge and agree to the following statutorily mandated terms:

 

8



 

(a)                                                 The Bank’s board of directors may terminate this Agreement at any time, but any termination by the Bank’s board of directors other than termination for cause, shall not prejudice the Executive’s right to compensation or other benefits under the agreement. The Executive shall have no right to receive compensation or other benefits for any period after termination for cause. Termination for cause shall include termination because of the officer or employee’s personal dishonesty, incompetence, willful misconduct, breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit, intentional failure to perform stated duties, willful violation of any law, rule, or regulation (other than traffic violations or similar offenses) or final cease-and-desist order, or material breach of any provision of the contract.

 

(b)                                                          If the Executive is suspended and/or temporarily prohibited from participating in the conduct of the Bank’s affairs by a notice served under section 8 (e) (3) or (g) (1) of Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1818 (e) (3) and (g) (1)) the Bank’s obligations under this Agreement shall be suspended as of the date of service unless stayed by appropriate proceedings. If the charges in the notice are dismissed, the Bank may in its discretion (i) pay the Executive all or part of the compensation withheld while its Agreement obligations were suspended, and (ii) reinstate (in whole or in part) any of its obligations which were suspended.

 

(c)                                                           If the Executive is removed and/or permanently prohibited from participating in the conduct of the Bank’s affairs by an order issued under section 8 (e) (4) or (g) (1) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1818 (e) (4) or (g) (1)), all obligations of the Bank under this Agreement shall terminate as of the effective date of the order, but vested rights of the contracting parties shall not be affected.

 

(d)                                                          If the Bank is in default (as defined in section 3(x)(1) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act), all obligations under this Agreement shall terminate as of the date of default, but this paragraph (b)(4) shall not affect any vested rights of the contracting parties.

 

(e)                                                            All obligations under this Agreement shall be terminated, except to the extent determined that continuation of the Agreement is necessary for the continued operation of the Bank:

 

(i) By the Director or his or her designee, at the time the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation enters into an agreement to provide assistance to or on behalf of the association under the authority contained in 13(c) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act; or

 

(ii) By the Director or his or her designee, at the time the Director or his or her designee approves a supervisory merger to resolve problems related to operation of the association or when the association is determined by the Director to be in an unsafe or unsound condition.

 

Any rights of the parties that have already vested, however, shall not be affected by such action.

 

9



 

15.                               Governing Law, Arbitration and Waiver of Jury Trial.  The Parties agree, to the extent permitted by law, that they EACH HEREBY WAIVES ANY RIGHT TO A TRIAL BY JURY, and agrees not to bring any claim, proceeding or action arising out of or related to this Agreement in any tribunal or court, except as necessary to enforce the provisions of Section 10 of this Agreement, mandate arbitration as provided in this section, or enforce an arbitration award rendered pursuant to this Agreement.  Any and all disputes related to this Agreement or to the parties’ performance hereunder, including but not limited to any dispute alleging that this Agreement was obtained by misrepresentation or mistake, will be submitted for resolution into Arbitration with the American Arbitration Association (“AAA”), in San Francisco, California, to be conducted under then applicable commercial rules promulgated by the AAA.  Notwithstanding the above, the Employer may seek injunctive relief in a California court of competent jurisdiction, to enjoin any breach or anticipatory breach of the Executive’s obligations as set forth in paragraphs 8 and 9 of this Agreement, pending the outcome of an Arbitration of their dispute.   The parties further agree and acknowledge that the Executive is a resident of the State of Colorado and that the Company is a resident of the State of Michigan for traditional jurisdiction and venue purposes, but they are nevertheless voluntarily agreeing to an arbitration venue and personal jurisdiction in the State of California for their mutual convenience.  California law will be applied to the resolution of any dispute related to this Agreement.

 

16.                               Entire Agreement.  Except to the extent otherwise provided herein, this Agreement contains the entire understanding and agreement between the Parties concerning the subject matter hereof and supersedes any prior agreements, whether written or oral, between the Parties concerning the subject matter hereof.

 

17.                               Amendment or Waiver.  No provision in this Agreement may be amended unless such amendment is agreed to in writing and signed by both the Executive and an authorized officer of the Employer other than Executive.  No waiver by either Party of any breach by the other Party of any condition or provision contained in this Agreement to be performed by such other Party will be deemed a waiver of a similar or dissimilar condition or provision at the same or any prior or subsequent time.  Any waiver must be in writing and signed by the Executive or an authorized officer of the Employer, as the case may be.

 

18.                               Severability.  In the event that any provision or portion of this Agreement is determined to be invalid or unenforceable for any reason, in whole or in part, the remaining provisions of this Agreement will be unaffected thereby and will remain in full force and effect to the fullest extent permitted by law.

 

19.                               Survivorship.  The respective rights and obligations of the Parties hereunder will survive any termination of the Executive’s employment with the Employer to the extent necessary to the intended preservation of such rights and obligations as described in this Agreement.

 

20.                               Governing Law.  This Agreement will be governed by and construed and interpreted in accordance with the laws of California, without reference to principles of conflict of laws.

 

10



 

21.                               Notices.  Any notice given to either Party must be in writing and will be deemed to have been given when delivered personally or one (1) day after having been sent by overnight courier service or five (5) days after having been sent by certified or registered mail, postage prepaid, return receipt requested, duly addressed to the Party concerned at the address indicated below or to such changed address as such Party may subsequently give such notice of:

 

If to the Employer:

Sterling Bank & Trust, FSB

 

One Towne Square – 17th Floor

 

Southfield, MI 48076

 

Attn: General Counsel

 

 

If to the Executive:

Mr. Gary Judd

 

3 Cantitoe Lane

 

Englewood, CO 80113

 

22.                               Headings.  The headings of the sections contained in this Agreement are for convenience only and will not be deemed to control or affect the meaning or construction of any provision of this Agreement.

 

23.                               Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, each of which will be deemed an original but all of which together will constitute one and the same instrument.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement as of the date and year first above written.

 

 

STERLING BANK AND TRUST, F.S.B.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Tom Lopp

 

 

 

 

Name:

Tom Lopp

 

 

 

 

Title:

Vice President

 

 

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Tom Lopp

 

 

 

 

Name:

Tom Lopp

 

 

 

 

Title:

EVP

 

 

 

 

 

EXECUTIVE:

 

 

 

/s/ Gary Judd

 

Gary Judd

 

11




Exhibit 10.2

 

AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

 

This AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (“Amendment”) dated July 16, 2014, amends that certain Employment Agreement entered into by and between STERLING BANCORP, INC., a Michigan corporation (the “Company”), STERLING BANK AND TRUST, FSB, (the “Bank”) and their affiliated entities (collectively “Employer”) with their principal offices located at One Towne Square, 19th Floor, Southfield, MI 48076, and Gary Judd, who resides at 3 Cantitoe Lane, Englewood, Co 80113 (the “Executive”), dated July 2, 2008 (the “Agreement”).

 

1.              Paragraph 2 of the Agreement, entitled “Term,” is hereby removed in its entirety and replaced as follows:

 

Term.  Subject to the provisions for earlier termination as hereinafter provided, the term of this Employment Agreement will begin on the date hereof and will continue for two (2) years hereafter (the “Initial Term of Employment”).  Except as provided in paragraph 14 of this Agreement, which is mandated by Federal statute, this Agreement may be terminated as hereinafter provided.  Annually, the Board of Directors of the Employer shall review this Agreement.  Upon the approval of the Board of Directors, this Agreement will be automatically renewed for a successive one (1) year term unless either party sends written notice of termination to the other party within sixty days prior to the expiration of this Agreement or any renewals hereof.  The Initial Term of Employment together with any renewal periods will hereinafter be referred to as the “Term of Employment.”  The nonrenewal of the term of this Agreement by the Employer will not be a termination without Cause (as defined in Section 8(d)).

 

2.              The Employer’s address for noticing purposes, as defined in Paragraph 21 of the Agreement, is deleted in its entirety and replaced as follows:

 

Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

One Towne Square, 19th Floor

Southfield, MI  48076

Attn:  Corporate Counsel

 

3.              This Amendment is made effective retroactively to July 2, 2008.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Amendment as of July 16, 2014.

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

STERLING BANK AND TRUST, FSB

 

 

EXECUTIVE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Thomas Lopp

 

By:

/s/ Thomas Lopp

 

By:

/s/ Gary Judd

 

Thomas Lopp

 

 

Thomas Lopp

 

 

Gary Judd

Its:

Vice President

 

Its:

Executive Vice President

 

 

 

 




Exhibit 10.4

 

SUBORDINATED NOTE PURCHASE AGREEMENT

 

This SUBORDINATED NOTE PURCHASE AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”) is dated as of August 14, 2017, and is made by and among Sterling Bancorp, Inc., a Michigan corporation (“Company”), and the several purchasers of the Subordinated Notes identified on the signature pages hereto (each a “Purchaser” and collectively, the “Purchasers”).

 

RECITALS

 

WHEREAS, Company has requested that the Purchasers purchase from Company up to $15,000,000 in aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes (as defined herein), which aggregate amount is intended to qualify as Tier 2 Capital (as defined herein).

 

WHEREAS, Company has engaged Sandler O’Neill + Partners, L.P., as its exclusive placement agent (“Placement Agent”) for the offering of the Subordinated Notes.

 

WHEREAS, each of the Purchasers is a Qualified Institutional Buyer as such term is defined by Rule 144A (“Rule 144A”) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), or an institutional accredited investor as such term is defined by Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) of Regulation D (“Regulation D”) promulgated under the Securities Act.

 

WHEREAS, the offer and sale of the Subordinated Notes by Company is being made pursuant to Rule 506(b) of Regulation D and in reliance on the exemption under Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act.

 

WHEREAS, each Purchaser is willing to purchase from Company a Subordinated Note in the principal amount set forth on each Purchaser’s signature page (the “Subordinated Note Amount”) in accordance with the terms, subject to the conditions and in reliance on, the recitals, representations, warranties, covenants and agreements set forth herein and in the Subordinated Notes.

 

WHEREAS, the Company previously issued $28,250,000 aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes on April 14, 2016, $6,750,000 aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes on August 5, 2016, and $15,000,000 aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes on September 12, 2016 (collectively, the “Original Subordinated Notes”) pursuant to Subordinated Note Purchase Agreements, dated as of April 14, 2016, August 5, 2016,  and September 12, 2016, among the Company and the Purchasers party thereto, and the Company intends that the Subordinated Notes to be issued pursuant hereto will be consolidated and form a single series with the Original Subordinated Notes.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants, conditions and agreements herein contained and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

 



 

AGREEMENT

 

1.                                      DEFINITIONS.

 

1.1                               Defined Terms.  The following capitalized terms used in this Agreement have the meanings defined or referenced below.

 

Affiliate(s)” means, with respect to any Person, such Person’s immediate family members, partners, members or parent and subsidiary corporations, and any other Person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by, or under common control with said Person and their respective Affiliates.

 

Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto.

 

Bank” means Sterling Bank and Trust, FSB, a federal savings bank and wholly owned subsidiary of Company.

 

Business Day” means any day other than a Saturday, Sunday or any other day on which banking institutions in the State of Michigan or California are permitted or required by any applicable law or executive order to close.

 

Closing” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2.

 

Closing Date” means August 14, 2017.

 

Company” has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto and shall include any successors to Company.

 

Company’s Liabilities” means Company’s obligations under the Transaction Documents.

 

Company’s Reports” means (i) audited financial statements of Company for the year ended December 31, 2016; and (ii) the Company’s reports for the year ended December 31, 2016 and the quarter ended June 30, 2017 as filed with the FRB.

 

Disbursement” has the meaning set forth in Section 3.1.

 

Equity Interest” means any and all shares, interests, participations or other equivalents (however designated) of capital stock of a corporation, any and all equivalent ownership interests in a Person which is not a corporation, and any and all warrants, options or other rights to purchase any of the foregoing.

 

Exchange Act” means the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

Event of Default” has the meaning set forth in the Subordinated Notes.

 

FDIC” means the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.

 

FRB” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.

 

2



 

GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles in effect from time to time in the United States of America.

 

Governmental Agency(ies)” means, individually or collectively, any federal, state, county or local governmental department, commission, board, regulatory authority or agency (including each applicable Regulatory Agency) with jurisdiction over Company, Bank or any of their Subsidiaries.

 

Governmental Licenses” has the meaning set forth in Section 4.3.

 

Hazardous Materials” means flammable explosives, asbestos, urea formaldehyde insulation, polychlorinated biphenyls, radioactive materials, hazardous wastes, toxic or contaminated substances or similar materials, including any substances which are “hazardous substances,” “hazardous wastes,” “hazardous materials” or “toxic substances” under the Hazardous Materials Laws and/or other applicable environmental laws, ordinances or regulations.

 

Hazardous Materials Laws” mean any laws, regulations, permits, licenses or requirements pertaining to the protection, preservation, conservation or regulation of the environment which relates to real property, including:  the Clean Air Act, as amended, 42 U.S.C. Section 7401 et seq.; the Federal Water Pollution Control Act, as amended, 33 U.S.C. Section 1251 et seq.; the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1976, as amended, 42 U.S.C. Section 6901 et seq.; the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, as amended (including the Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act of 1986), 42 U.S.C. Section 9601 et seq.; the Toxic Substances Control Act, as amended, 15 U.S.C. Section 2601 et seq.; the Occupational Safety and Health Act, as amended, 29 U.S.C. Section 651, the Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act of 1986, 42 U.S.C. Section 11001 et seq.; the Mine Safety and Health Act of 1977, as amended, 30 U.S.C. Section 801 et seq.; the Safe Drinking Water Act, 42 U.S.C. Section 300f et seq.; and all comparable state and local laws, laws of other jurisdictions or orders and regulations.

 

Indebtedness” means and includes:  (i) all items arising from the borrowing of money that, according to GAAP as in effect from time to time, would be included in determining total liabilities as shown on the consolidated balance sheet of Company or any Subsidiary of Company; and (ii) all obligations secured by any lien in property owned by Company or any Subsidiary whether or not such obligations shall have been assumed; provided, however, Indebtedness shall not include deposits or other indebtedness created, incurred or maintained in the ordinary course of Company’s or Bank’s business (including federal funds purchased, advances from any Federal Home Loan Bank, secured deposits of municipalities, letters of credit issued by Company or Bank and repurchase arrangements) and consistent with customary banking practices and applicable laws and regulations.

 

Leases” means all leases, licenses or other documents providing for the use or occupancy of any portion of any Property, including all amendments, extensions, renewals, supplements, modifications, sublets and assignments thereof and all separate letters or separate agreements relating thereto.

 

3



 

Material Adverse Effect” means, with respect to any Person, any change or effect that (i) is or would be reasonably likely to be material and adverse to the financial condition, results of operations or business of such Person, or (ii) would materially impair the ability of such Person to perform its obligations under any of the Transaction Documents, or otherwise materially impede the consummation by such Person of the transactions contemplated hereby; provided, however, that “Material Adverse Effect” shall not be deemed to include the impact of (1) changes in banking and similar laws, rules or regulations of general applicability or interpretations thereof by Governmental Agencies, (2) changes in GAAP or regulatory accounting requirements applicable to financial institutions and their holding companies generally, (3) changes after the date of this Agreement in general economic or capital market conditions affecting financial institutions or their market prices generally and not specifically related to Company or Purchasers, (4) direct effects of compliance with this Agreement on the operating performance of Company or Purchasers, including expenses incurred by Company or Purchasers in consummating the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, and (5) the effects of any action or omission taken by Company with the prior written consent of Purchasers, and vice versa, or as otherwise contemplated by this Agreement and the Subordinated Notes.

 

Maturity Date” means April 15, 2026.

 

Original Subordinated Notes” has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto.

 

Person” means an individual, a corporation (whether or not for profit), a partnership, a limited liability company, a joint venture, an association, a trust, an unincorporated organization, a government or any department or agency thereof (including a Governmental Agency) or any other entity or organization.

 

Placement Agent” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals.

 

Property” means any real property owned or leased by Company or any Affiliate or Subsidiary of Company.

 

Purchaser” or “Purchasers” has the meaning set forth in the preamble hereto.

 

Regulation D” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals.

 

Regulatory Agencies” means any federal or state agency charged with the supervision or regulation of depository institutions or holding companies of depository institutions, or engaged in the insurance of depository institution deposits, or any court, administrative agency or commission or other authority, body or agency having supervisory or regulatory authority with respect to Company, Bank or any of their Subsidiaries.

 

Securities Act” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals.

 

Subordinated Note” means the Subordinated Note (or collectively, the “Subordinated Notes”) in the form attached as Exhibit A hereto, as amended, restated, supplemented or modified from time to time, and each Subordinated Note delivered in substitution or exchange for such Subordinated Note.

 

4



 

Subordinated Note Amount” has the meaning set forth in the Recitals.

 

Subsidiary” means with respect to any Person, any corporation or entity in which a majority of the outstanding Equity Interest is directly or indirectly owned by such Person.

 

Tier 2 Capital” has the meaning given to the term “Tier 2 capital” in 12 C.F.R. Part 208 and 12 C.F.R. Part 250, as amended, modified and supplemented and in effect from time to time or any replacement thereof.

 

Transaction Documents” means this Agreement and the Subordinated Notes.

 

1.2                               Interpretations.  The foregoing definitions are equally applicable to both the singular and plural forms of the terms defined.  The words “hereof”, “herein” and “hereunder” and words of like import when used in this Agreement shall refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement.  The word “including” when used in this Agreement without the phrase “without limitation,” shall mean “including, without limitation.” All references to time of day herein are references to Eastern Time unless otherwise specifically provided.  All references to this Agreement and Subordinated Notes shall be deemed to be to such documents as amended, modified or restated from time to time.  With respect to any reference in this Agreement to any defined term, (i) if such defined term refers to a Person, then it shall also mean all heirs, legal representatives and permitted successors and assigns of such Person, and (ii) if such defined term refers to a document, instrument or agreement, then it shall also include any amendment, replacement, extension or other modification thereof.

 

1.3                               Exhibits Incorporated.  All Exhibits attached are hereby incorporated into this Agreement.

 

2.                                      SUBORDINATED DEBT.

 

2.1                               Certain Terms.  Subject to the terms and conditions herein contained, Company proposes to issue and sell to the Purchasers, severally and not jointly, Subordinated Notes in an aggregate principal amount equal to the aggregate of the Subordinated Note Amounts.  Purchasers, severally and not jointly, each agree to purchase the Subordinated Notes from Company on the Closing Date in accordance with the terms of, and subject to the conditions and provisions set forth in, this Agreement and the Subordinated Notes.  The Subordinated Note Amounts shall be disbursed in accordance with Section 3.1.

 

2.2                               The Closing.  The execution and delivery of the Transaction Documents (the “Closing”) shall occur at the offices of Company at 10:00 a.m. (local time) on the Closing Date, or at such other place or time or on such other date as the parties hereto may agree.

 

2.3                               No Right of Offset.  Each Purchaser hereby expressly waives any right of offset it may have against Company.

 

3.                                      DISBURSEMENT.

 

3.1                               Disbursement.  On the Closing Date, assuming all of the terms and conditions set forth in Section 3.2 have been satisfied by Company, each Purchaser shall disburse to Company

 

5



 

an amount equal to (i) the Subordinated Note Amount set forth on such Purchaser’s signature page, plus (ii) accrued interest (at a rate of 7.0% per annum, computed on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months) from April 14, 2016 through, but excluding, the Closing Date, in immediately available funds in exchange for a Subordinated Note with a principal amount equal to such Subordinated Note Amount (the “Disbursement”).  Company will deliver to the respective Purchasers one or more certificates representing the Subordinated Notes in definitive form (or provide evidence of the same with the original to be delivered by Company by overnight delivery on the next Business Day in accordance with the delivery instructions of Purchaser), registered in such names and denominations as such Purchasers may request.

 

3.2                               Conditions Precedent to Disbursement.

 

3.2.1                                 Conditions to the Purchasers’ Obligation. The obligation of each Purchaser to consummate the purchase of the Subordinated Notes to be purchased by it at Closing and to effect the Disbursement is subject to delivery by, or at the direction of, Company to such Purchaser of each of the following (or written waiver by such Purchaser prior to the Closing of such delivery):

 

3.2.1.1                       Authority Documents.

 

(a)                                 A certificate of the Secretary or Assistant Secretary of Company as to (i) the Articles of Incorporation of Company, (ii) the Bylaws of Company, (iii) resolutions of the board of directors of Company, and any committee thereof, authorizing the execution, delivery and performance of the Transaction Documents, and (iv) the incumbency of each officer of Company signing any of the Transaction Documents or other documents to be delivered pursuant hereto;

 

(b)                                 A certificate of existence of Company issued by the Secretary of State of the State of Michigan; and

 

(c)                                  The opinion of Honigman Miller Schwartz & Cohn LLP, counsel to Company, dated as of the Closing Date, substantially in the form set forth at Exhibit B attached hereto, addressed to the Purchasers and Placement Agent.

 

3.2.1.2                       Other Requirements.  Such other additional information regarding Company, Bank and any other Subsidiary of Company and their respective assets, liabilities (including any liabilities arising from, or relating to, legal proceedings) and contracts as a Purchaser may reasonably require.

 

3.2.2                                 Conditions to Company’s Obligation.

 

3.2.2.1                       Since the date of this Agreement, there shall not have been any action taken, or any law, rule or regulation enacted, entered, enforced or deemed applicable to

 

6



 

Company or its Subsidiaries or the transactions contemplated by this Agreement by any Governmental Agency which imposes any restriction or condition that Company determines, in its reasonable good faith judgment, is materially and unreasonably burdensome on Company’s business or would materially reduce the economic benefits of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement to Company.

 

3.2.2.2                       With respect to a given Purchaser, the obligation of Company to consummate the sale of the Subordinated Notes and to effect the Closing is subject to delivery by or at the direction of such Purchaser to Company each of the following (or written waiver by Company prior to the Closing of such delivery).  This Agreement, duly authorized and executed by such Purchaser.

 

4.                                      REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF COMPANY.

 

Company hereby represents and warrants to each Purchaser as follows:

 

4.1                               Organization and Authority.

 

4.1.1                                 Organization Matters of Company and Its Subsidiaries.

 

4.1.1.1                       Company is validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of Michigan and has all requisite corporate power and authority to conduct its business and activities as presently conducted, to own its properties, and to perform its obligations under the Transaction Documents.  Company is duly qualified as a foreign corporation to transact business and is in good standing in each other jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of business, except where the failure so to qualify or to be in good standing would not result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

4.1.1.2                       Each Subsidiary of Company either has been duly organized and is validly existing, or has been duly chartered and is validly existing as a federal savings bank, in each case in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organization, has corporate or other similar power and authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its business and is duly qualified as a foreign corporation to transact business and is in good standing in each jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of business, except where the failure so to qualify or to be in good standing would not result in a Material Adverse Effect.  All of the issued and outstanding shares of capital stock or other equity interests in each Subsidiary of Company have been duly authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and non-assessable and are owned by Company, directly or through Subsidiaries of Company, free and clear of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance or claim; none of the outstanding shares of capital stock of, or other equity interests in, any Subsidiary of Company were issued in violation of the preemptive or similar rights of any security holder of such Subsidiary of Company or any other entity.

 

4.1.1.3                       Bank is a federal savings bank.  The deposit accounts of Bank are insured by the FDIC up to applicable limits.  Bank has not received any notice or other information indicating that Bank is not an “insured depository institution” as defined in 12 U.S.C. Section 1813, nor has any event occurred which could reasonably be expected to adversely affect the status of Bank as an FDIC-insured institution.

 

7



 

4.1.2                                 Capital Stock and Related Matters.  The Articles of Incorporation of Company authorize Company to issue 980,000 shares of common stock, 20,000 shares of non-voting common stock and 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock (200,000 of which have been designated as Series A Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Shares).  As of the date of this Agreement, there are [45,271] shares of Company’s common stock and [5,072] shares of Company’s non-voting common stock issued and outstanding and no shares of Company’s preferred stock are issued and outstanding.  All of the outstanding capital stock of Company has been duly authorized and validly issued and is fully paid and non-assessable.  There are, as of the date hereof, no outstanding options, rights, warrants or other agreements or instruments obligating Company to issue, deliver or sell, or cause to be issued, delivered or sold, additional shares of the capital stock of Company or obligating Company to grant, extend or enter into any such agreement or commitment to any Person other than Company except pursuant to Company’s equity incentive plans duly adopted by Company’s Board of Directors.

 

4.2                               No Impediment to Transactions.

 

4.2.1                                 Transaction is Legal and Authorized.  The issuance of the Subordinated Notes, the borrowing of the aggregate of the Subordinated Note Amounts the execution of the Transaction Documents and compliance by Company with all of the provisions of the Transaction Documents are within the corporate and other powers of Company.

 

4.2.2                                 Agreement.  This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by Company, and, assuming due authorization, execution and delivery by the other parties hereto, constitutes the legal, valid and binding obligations of Company, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as enforcement thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general equitable principles.

 

4.2.3                                 Subordinated NotesThe Subordinated Notes have been duly authorized by Company and when executed by Company and issued, delivered to and paid for by the Purchasers in accordance with the terms of the Agreement, will have been duly executed, authenticated, issued and delivered, and will constitute legal, valid and binding obligations of Company and enforceable in accordance with their terms, except as enforcement thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general equitable principles.

 

4.2.4                                 No Defaults or Restrictions.  Neither the execution and delivery of the Transaction Documents nor compliance with their respective terms and conditions will (whether with or without the giving of notice or lapse of time or both) (i) violate, conflict with or result in a breach of, or constitute a default under:  (1) the Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws of Company; (2) any of the terms, obligations, covenants, conditions or provisions of any corporate restriction or of any contract, agreement, indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, bank loan or credit agreement, or any other agreement or instrument to which Company or Bank, as applicable, is now a party or by which it or any of its properties may be bound or affected; (3) any judgment, order, writ, injunction, decree or demand of any court, arbitrator, grand jury, or Governmental Agency; or (4) any statute, rule or regulation applicable to Company, except, in the case of items (2), (3) or (4), for such violations and conflicts that would not reasonably be expected to have, singularly or

 

8



 

in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on Company, or (ii) result in the creation or imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance of any nature whatsoever upon any property or asset of Company.  Neither Company nor Bank is in default in the performance, observance or fulfillment of any of the terms, obligations, covenants, conditions or provisions contained in any indenture or other agreement creating, evidencing or securing Indebtedness of any kind or pursuant to which any such Indebtedness is issued, or any other agreement or instrument to which Company or Bank, as applicable, is a party or by which Company or Bank, as applicable, or any of its properties may be bound or affected, except, in each case, only such defaults that would not reasonably be expected to have, singularly or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on Company.

 

4.2.5                                 Governmental Consent.  No governmental orders, permissions, consents, approvals or authorizations are required to be obtained by Company that have not been obtained, and no registrations or declarations are required to be filed by Company that have not been filed in connection with, or, in contemplation of, the execution and delivery of, and performance under, the Transaction Documents, except for applicable requirements, if any, of the Securities Act or state securities laws or “blue sky” laws of the various states and any applicable federal or state banking laws and regulations.

 

4.3                               Possession of Licenses and Permits.  Company and its Subsidiaries possess such permits, licenses, approvals, consents and other authorizations (collectively, “Governmental Licenses”) issued by the appropriate Governmental Agencies necessary to conduct the business now operated by them except where the failure to possess such Governmental Licenses would not, individually or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on Company; Company and each Subsidiary of Company is in compliance with the terms and conditions of all such Governmental Licenses, except where the failure so to comply would not, individually or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on Company; all of the Governmental Licenses are valid and in full force and effect, except where the invalidity of such Governmental Licenses or the failure of such Governmental Licenses to be in full force and effect would not have a Material Adverse Effect on Company; and neither Company nor any Subsidiary of Company has received any written notice of proceedings relating to the revocation or modification of any such Governmental Licenses, in each case that would, individually or in the aggregate, have a Material Adverse Effect on Company.

 

4.4                               Financial Condition.

 

4.4.1                                 Company Financial Statements.  The financial statements of Company included in Company’s Reports (including the related notes, where applicable) that have been made available to Purchasers (i) have been prepared from, and are in accordance with, the books and records of Company; (ii) fairly present in all material respects the results of operations, cash flows, changes in stockholders’ equity and financial position of Company and its consolidated Subsidiaries, for the respective fiscal periods or as of the respective dates therein set forth (subject in the case of unaudited statements to recurring year-end audit adjustments normal in nature and amount), as applicable; (iii) complied as to form, as of their respective dates of filing in all material respects with applicable accounting and banking requirements; and (iv) have been prepared in accordance with GAAP consistently applied during the periods involved, except, in each case (x) as indicated in such statements or in the notes thereto, (y) for any statement therein or omission therefrom which was corrected, amended or supplemented or otherwise disclosed or updated in a

 

9



 

subsequent Company’s Report, and (z) to the extent that any unaudited interim financial statements do not contain the footnotes required by GAAP, and were or are subject to normal and recurring year-end adjustments, which were not or are not expected to be material in amount, either individually or in the aggregate.  The books and records of Company have been, and are being, maintained in all material respects in accordance with GAAP and any other applicable legal and accounting requirements.  Company does not have any material liability of any nature whatsoever (whether absolute, accrued, contingent or otherwise and whether due or to become due), except for those liabilities that are reflected or reserved against on the consolidated balance sheet of Company contained in Company’s Reports for Company’s most recently completed quarterly or annual fiscal period, as applicable, and for liabilities incurred in the ordinary course of business consistent with past practice or in connection with this Agreement and the transactions contemplated hereby.

 

4.4.2                                 Absence of Default.  Since the date of the latest audited financial statements, no event has occurred which either of itself or with the lapse of time or the giving of notice or both, would give any creditor of Company the right to accelerate the maturity of any material Indebtedness of Company.  Company is not in default under any other Lease, agreement or instrument, or any law, rule, regulation, order, writ, injunction, decree, determination or award, non-compliance with which could reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect on Company.

 

4.4.3                                 Solvency.  After giving effect to the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, Company has capital sufficient to carry on its business and transactions and is solvent and able to pay its debts as they mature.  No transfer of property is being made and no Indebtedness is being incurred in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement with the intent to hinder, delay or defraud either present or future creditors of Company or any Subsidiary of Company.

 

4.4.4                                 Ownership of Property.  Company and each of its Subsidiaries has good and marketable title as to all real property owned by it and good title to all assets and properties owned by Company and such Subsidiary in the conduct of its businesses, whether such assets and properties are real or personal, tangible or intangible, including assets and property reflected in the most recent balance sheet contained in Company’s Reports or acquired subsequent thereto (except to the extent that such assets and properties have been disposed of in the ordinary course of business, since the date of such balance sheet), subject to no encumbrances, liens, mortgages, security interests or pledges, except (i) those items which secure liabilities for public or statutory obligations or any discount with, borrowing from or other obligations to the Federal Home Loan Bank, inter-bank credit facilities, reverse repurchase agreements or any transaction by Bank acting in a fiduciary capacity, (ii) statutory liens for amounts not yet delinquent or which are being contested in good faith and (iii) such as do not, individually or in the aggregate, materially affect the value of such property and do not materially interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by Company or any of its Subsidiaries.  Company and each of its Subsidiaries, as lessee, has the right under valid and existing Leases of real and personal properties that are material to Company or such Subsidiary, as applicable, in the conduct of its business to occupy or use all such properties as presently occupied and used by it.  Such existing Leases and commitments to Lease constitute or will constitute operating Leases for both tax and financial

 

10



 

accounting purposes and the Lease expense and minimum rental commitments with respect to such Leases and Lease commitments are as disclosed in all material respects in Company’s Reports.

 

4.5                               No Material Adverse Change.  Since the date of the latest audited financial statements included in Company’s Reports, there has been no development or event which has had or would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Company or any of its Subsidiaries.

 

4.6                               Legal Matters.

 

4.6.1                                 Compliance with Law.  Company and each of its Subsidiaries (i) has complied with and (ii) to Company’s knowledge, is not under investigation with respect to, and, to Company’s knowledge, has not been threatened to be charged with or given any notice of any material violation of any applicable statutes, rules, regulations, orders and restrictions of any domestic or foreign government, or any instrumentality or agency thereof, having jurisdiction over the conduct of its business or the ownership of its properties, except where any such failure to comply or violation would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Company.  Company and each of its Subsidiaries (x) is compliant with all applicable statutes, rules, regulations, orders and restrictions of any Governmental Agency concerning data protection and the privacy and security of personal data and the nonpublic personal information of their respective customers, consumers and employees, except, in each case, for any such failure to comply or violation that would not reasonably be expected to have, individually or in the aggregate, a Material Adverse Effect on Company, and (y) at no time during the two years prior to the date hereof has received any written notice asserting any material violations thereof.

 

4.6.2                                 Regulatory Enforcement Actions.  Company and its other Subsidiaries are in compliance in all material respects with all laws administered by and regulations of any Governmental Agency applicable to it or to them, the failure to comply with which would have a Material Adverse Effect.  None of Company, its Subsidiaries nor any of their officers or directors is now operating under any restrictions, agreements, memoranda, commitment letter, supervisory letter or similar regulatory correspondence, or other commitments (other than restrictions of general application) imposed by any Governmental Agency, nor are, to Company’s knowledge, (a) any such restrictions threatened, (b) any agreements, memoranda or commitments being sought by any Governmental Agency, or (c) any legal or regulatory violations previously identified by, or penalties or other remedial action previously imposed by, any Governmental Agency remains unresolved.

 

4.6.3                                 Pending Litigation.  There are no actions, suits, proceedings or written agreements pending, or, to Company’s knowledge, threatened or proposed, against Company or any of its Subsidiaries at law or in equity or before or by any federal, state, municipal, or other governmental department, commission, board, or other administrative agency, domestic or foreign, that, either separately or in the aggregate, would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Company or affect issuance or payment of the Subordinated Notes; and neither Company nor any of its Subsidiaries is a party to or named as subject to the provisions of any order, writ, injunction, or decree of, or any written agreement with, any court, commission, board or agency, domestic or foreign, that either separately or in the aggregate, will have a Material Adverse Effect on Company.

 

11


 

4.6.4           Environmental.  No Property is or, to Company’s knowledge, has been a site for the use, generation, manufacture, storage, treatment, release, threatened release, discharge, disposal, transportation or presence of any Hazardous Materials and neither Company nor any of its Subsidiaries has engaged in such activities.  There are no claims or actions pending or, to Company’s knowledge, threatened against Company or any of its Subsidiaries by any Governmental Agency or by any other Person relating to any Hazardous Materials or pursuant to any Hazardous Materials Law.

 

4.6.5           Brokerage Commissions.  Except for commissions paid to the Placement Agent, neither Company nor any Affiliate of Company is obligated to pay any brokerage commission or finder’s fee to any Person in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

4.6.6           Investment Company Act.  Neither Company nor any of its Subsidiaries is an “investment company” or a company “controlled” by an “investment company,” within the meaning of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

 

4.7          No Misstatement.  No information, exhibit, report, schedule or document, when viewed together as a whole, furnished by Company to Purchasers in connection with the negotiation, execution or performance of this Agreement contains any untrue statement of a material fact, or omits to state a material fact necessary to make the statements contained therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, except for any statement therein or omission therefrom which was corrected, amended or supplemented or otherwise disclosed or updated in a subsequent exhibit, report, schedule or document.

 

4.8          Internal Accounting Controls.  Company, Bank and each other applicable Subsidiary of Company has established and maintains a system of internal control over financial reporting that pertain to the maintenance of records that accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of Company’s assets (on a consolidated basis), provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that Company’s and Bank’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of Company management and Board of Directors, and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of assets of Company on a consolidated basis that could have a material effect on the financial statements.  Company believes such internal control over financial reporting is effective to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of Company’s financial reporting and the preparation of Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP.  Since the conclusion of Company’s last completed fiscal year, to Company’s knowledge there has not been and there currently is not (i) any significant deficiency or material weakness in the design or operation of its internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect its ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information, or (ii) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a role in Company’s or Bank’s internal control over financial reporting.  Company (A) has implemented and maintains disclosure controls and procedures it believes are reasonably designed and maintained to ensure that material information relating to Company is made known to the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer of Company by others within Company and (B) has disclosed, based on its most recent evaluation prior to the date hereof,

 

12



 

to Company’s outside auditors and the audit committee of Company’s Board of Directors any significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal controls over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect Company’s internal controls over financial reporting and of which Company has knowledge.  Such disclosure controls and procedures are effective for the purposes for which they were established.

 

5.             GENERAL COVENANTS, CONDITIONS AND AGREEMENTS.

 

Company hereby further covenants and agrees with each Purchaser as follows:

 

5.1          Compliance with Transaction Documents.  Company shall comply with, observe and timely perform each and every one of the covenants, agreements and obligations under the Transaction Documents.

 

5.2          Affiliate Transactions.  Company shall not itself, nor shall it cause, permit or allow any of its Subsidiaries to enter into any transaction, including, the purchase, sale or exchange of property or the rendering of any service, with any Affiliate of Company except in the ordinary course of business and pursuant to the reasonable requirements of Company’s or such Affiliate’s business and upon terms consistent with applicable laws and regulations and reasonably found by the appropriate board(s) of directors to be fair and reasonable and no less favorable to Company or such Affiliate than would be obtained in a comparable arm’s length transaction with a Person not an Affiliate.

 

5.3          Compliance with Laws.  Company shall not itself, nor shall it cause, permit or allow Bank or any other of its Subsidiaries to (i) engage in any business or activity not permitted by all applicable laws and regulations, except where such business or activity would not reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect on Company, Bank and/or such of its Subsidiaries or (ii) make any loan or advance secured by the capital stock of another bank or depository institution, or acquire the capital stock, assets or obligations of or any interest in another bank or depository institution, in each case other than in accordance with applicable laws and regulations and safe and sound banking practices.

 

5.4          Absence of Control.  It is the intent of the parties to this Agreement that in no event shall Purchasers, by reason of any of the Transaction Documents, be deemed to control, directly or indirectly, Company, and Purchasers shall not exercise, or be deemed to exercise, directly or indirectly, a controlling influence over the management or policies of Company.

 

5.5          Bloomberg.  Company shall use commercially reasonable efforts to cause the Subordinated Notes to be quoted on Bloomberg.

 

5.6          Rule 144A Information.  While any Subordinated Notes remain “restricted securities” within the meaning of the Securities Act, Company will make available, upon request, to any seller of such Subordinated Notes the information specified in Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act, unless Company is then subject to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

13



 

6.             REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS OF PURCHASERS.

 

Each Purchaser hereby represents and warrants to Company, and covenants with Company, severally and not jointly, as follows:

 

6.1          Legal Power and Authority.  It has all necessary power and authority to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under this Agreement and to consummate the transactions contemplated hereby.  It is an entity duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the laws its jurisdiction of organization.

 

6.2          Authorization and Execution.  The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement has been duly authorized by all necessary action on the part of such Purchaser, and this Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered, and, assuming due authorization, execution and delivery by the other parties hereto, is a legal, valid and binding obligation of such Purchaser, enforceable against such Purchaser in accordance with its terms, except as enforcement thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally or by general equitable principles.

 

6.3          No Conflicts.  Neither the execution, delivery or performance of the Transaction Documents nor the consummation of any of the transactions contemplated thereby will conflict with, violate, constitute a breach of or a default (whether with or without the giving of notice or lapse of time or both) under (i) its organizational documents, (ii) any agreement to which it is party, (iii) any law applicable to it or (iv) any order, writ, judgment, injunction, decree, determination or award binding upon or affecting it.

 

6.4          Purchase for Investment.  It is purchasing the Subordinated Note for its own account and not with a view to distribution and with no present intention of reselling, distributing or otherwise disposing of the same.  It has no present or contemplated agreement, undertaking, arrangement, obligation, Indebtedness or commitment providing for, or which is likely to compel, a disposition of the Subordinated Notes in any manner.

 

6.5          Institutional Accredited Investor.  It is and will be on the Closing Date a “qualified institutional buyer” as such term is defined in Rule 144A, or an institutional “accredited investor” as such term is defined in Rule 501(a) of Regulation D and as contemplated by subsections (1), (2), (3) and (7) of Rule 501(a) of Regulation D, and has no less than $5,000,000 in total assets.

 

6.6          Financial and Business Sophistication.  It has such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters that it is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the prospective investment in the Subordinated Notes.  It has relied solely upon its own knowledge of, and/or the advice of its own legal, financial or other advisors with regard to, the legal, financial, tax and other considerations involved in deciding to invest in the Subordinated Notes.

 

6.7          Ability to Bear Economic Risk of Investment.  It recognizes that an investment in the Subordinated Notes involves substantial risk.  It has the ability to bear the economic risk of the prospective investment in the Subordinated Notes, including the ability to hold the Subordinated Notes indefinitely, and further including the ability to bear a complete loss of all of its investment in Company.

 

14



 

6.8          Information.  It acknowledges that:  (i) it is not being provided with the disclosures that would be required if the offer and sale of the Subordinated Notes were registered under the Securities Act, nor is it being provided with any offering circular or prospectus prepared in connection with the offer and sale of the Subordinated Notes; (ii) it has conducted its own examination of Company and the terms of the Subordinated Notes to the extent it deems necessary to make its decision to invest in the Subordinated Notes; and (iii) it has availed itself of publicly available financial and other information concerning Company to the extent it deems necessary to make its decision to purchase the Subordinated Notes.  It has reviewed the information set forth in Company’s Reports and the exhibits and schedules hereto and contained in the data room established by Company as of August 14, 2017.

 

6.9          Access to Information.  It acknowledges that it and its advisors have been furnished with all materials relating to the business, finances and operations of Company that have been requested by it or its advisors and have been given the opportunity to ask questions of, and to receive answers from, persons acting on behalf of Company concerning terms and conditions of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement in order to make an informed and voluntary decision to enter into this Agreement.

 

6.10        Investment Decision.  It has made its own investment decision based upon its own judgment, due diligence and advice from such advisors as it has deemed necessary and not upon any view expressed by any other person or entity, including the Placement Agent.  Neither such inquiries nor any other due diligence investigations conducted by it or its advisors or representatives, if any, shall modify, amend or affect its right to rely on Company’s representations and warranties contained herein.  It is not relying upon, and has not relied upon, any advice, statement, representation or warranty made by any Person by or on behalf of Company, including the Placement Agent, except for the express statements, representations and warranties of Company made or contained in this Agreement.  Furthermore, it acknowledges that (i) the Placement Agent has not performed any due diligence review on behalf of it and (ii) nothing in this Agreement or any other materials presented by or on behalf of Company to it in connection with the purchase of the Subordinated Notes constitutes legal, tax or investment advice.

 

6.11        Private Placement; No Registration; Restricted Legends.  It understands and acknowledges that the Subordinated Notes are being sold by Company without registration under the Securities Act in reliance on the exemption from federal and state registration set forth in, respectively, Rule 506(b) of Regulation D under Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act and Section 18 of the Securities Act, or any state securities laws, and accordingly, may be resold, pledged or otherwise transferred only if exemptions from the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws are available to it.  It is not subscribing for the Subordinated Notes as a result of or subsequent to any advertisement, article, notice or other communication published in any newspaper, magazine or similar media or broadcast over television or radio, or presented at any seminar or meeting.  It further understands and acknowledges that Company will not be obligated in the future to register the Subordinated Notes under the Securities Act or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or under any state securities laws.  Neither the Placement Agent nor Company has made or is making any representation, warranty or covenant, express or implied, as to the availability of any exemption from registration under the Securities Act or any applicable state securities laws for the resale, pledge or other transfer of the Subordinated Notes.  It further acknowledges and agrees that all certificates or other instruments representing the Subordinated

 

15



 

Notes will bear the restrictive legend set forth in the form of Subordinated Note.  It further acknowledges its primary responsibilities under the Securities Act and, accordingly, will not sell or otherwise transfer the Subordinated Notes or any interest therein without complying with the requirements of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder and the requirements set forth in this Agreement.

 

6.12        Placement Agent.  It will purchase the Subordinated Note(s) directly from Company and not from the Placement Agent and understands that neither the Placement Agent nor any other broker or dealer has any obligation to make a market in the Subordinated Notes.

 

6.13        Tier 2 Capital.  If all or any portion of the Subordinated Notes or the Original Subordinated Notes ceases to be deemed, or there is more than an insubstantial risk that all or any portion of the Subordinated Notes will, within one hundred twenty (120) days, ceases to be deemed, Tier 2 Capital, in each case other than due to the limitation imposed on the capital treatment of subordinated debt during the five (5) years immediately preceding the Maturity Date of the Subordinated Notes, and Company notifies the Purchasers of its intent to restructure the Subordinated Notes to qualify as Tier 2 Capital, thereafter the Purchasers will work together with Company in good faith to execute and deliver all agreements as reasonably necessary in order to restructure the applicable portions of the obligations evidenced by the Subordinated Notes to qualify as Tier 2 Capital.

 

6.14        Accuracy of Representations.  It understands that each of the Placement Agent and Company will rely upon the truth and accuracy of the foregoing representations, acknowledgements and agreements in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, and agrees that if any of the representations or acknowledgements made by it are no longer accurate as of the Closing Date, or if any of the agreements made by it are breached on or prior to the Closing Date, it shall promptly notify the Placement Agent and Company.

 

6.15        Representations and Warranties Generally.  The representations and warranties of Purchaser set forth in this Agreement are true and correct as of the date hereof and will be true and correct as of the Closing Date and as otherwise specifically provided herein.  Any certificate signed by a duly authorized representative of Purchaser and delivered to Company or to counsel for Company shall be deemed to be a representation and warranty by Purchaser to Company as to the matters set forth therein.

 

7.             Intentionally omitted.

 

8.             MISCELLANEOUS.

 

8.1          Prohibition on Assignment by Company.  Except as described in Section 8(b) (Merger or Sale of Assets) of the Subordinated Notes, Company may not assign, transfer or delegate any of its rights or obligations under this Agreement or the Subordinated Notes with respect to any Purchasers without the prior written consent of such Purchasers.  In addition, in accordance with the terms of the Subordinated Notes, any transfer of such Subordinated Notes must be made in accordance with the Assignment Form attached thereto and the requirements and restrictions thereof.

 

8.2          Time of the Essence.  Time is of the essence of this Agreement.

 

16



 

8.3          Waiver or Amendment.  No waiver or amendment of any term, provision, condition, covenant or agreement herein or in the Subordinated Notes shall be effective except with the consent of the holders of not less than more than fifty percent (50%) in aggregate principal amount (excluding any Subordinated Notes held by Company or any of its Affiliates) of the Subordinated Notes and Original Subordinated Notes at the time outstanding; provided, however, that without the consent of each holder of an affected Subordinated Note, no such amendment or waiver may:  (i) reduce the principal amount of the Subordinated Note; (ii) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any Subordinated Note; (iii) extend the maturity of any Subordinated Note, (iv) change the currency in which payment of the obligations of Company under this Agreement and the Subordinated Notes are to be made; (v) lower the percentage of aggregate principal amount of outstanding Subordinated Notes required to approve any amendment of this Agreement or the Subordinated Notes; (vi) make any changes to Section 6 (Failure to Make a Payments) of the Subordinated Notes that adversely affects the rights of any holder of a Subordinated Note; or (vii) disproportionately and adversely affect any of the holders of the then outstanding Subordinated Notes.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, Company may amend or supplement the Subordinated Notes without the consent of the holders of the Subordinated Notes to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency or to provide for uncertificated Subordinated Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Subordinated Notes, or to make any change that does not adversely affect the rights of any holder of any of the Subordinated Notes.  No failure to exercise or delay in exercising, by any party hereto or any holder of the Subordinated Notes, of any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege preclude any other or further exercise thereof, or the exercise of any other right or remedy provided by law.  The rights and remedies provided in this Agreement are cumulative and not exclusive of any right or remedy provided by law or equity.  No notice or demand on Company in any case shall, in itself, entitle Company to any other or further notice or demand in similar or other circumstances or constitute a waiver of the rights of Purchasers to any other or further action in any circumstances without notice or demand.  No consent or waiver, expressed or implied, by Purchasers to or of any breach or default by Company in the performance of its obligations hereunder shall be deemed or construed to be a consent or waiver to or of any other breach or default in the performance of the same or any other obligations of Company hereunder.  Failure on the part of Purchasers to complain of any acts or failure to act or to declare an Event of Default, irrespective of how long such failure continues, shall not constitute a waiver by Purchasers of their rights hereunder or impair any rights, powers or remedies on account of any breach or default by Company.

 

8.4          Severability.  Any provision of this Agreement which is unenforceable or invalid or contrary to law, or the inclusion of which would adversely affect the validity, legality or enforcement of this Agreement, shall be of no effect and, in such case, all the remaining terms and provisions of this Agreement shall subsist and be fully effective according to the tenor of this Agreement the same as though any such invalid portion had never been included herein.  Notwithstanding any of the foregoing to the contrary, if any provisions of this Agreement or the application thereof are held invalid or unenforceable only as to particular persons or situations, the remainder of this Agreement, and the application of such provision to persons or situations other than those to which it shall have been held invalid or unenforceable, shall not be affected thereby, but shall continue valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law.

 

17



 

8.5          Notices.  Any notice which any party hereto may be required or may desire to give hereunder shall be deemed to have been given if in writing and if delivered personally, or if mailed, postage prepaid, by United States registered or certified mail, return receipt requested, or if delivered by a responsible overnight commercial courier promising next business day delivery, addressed:

 

if to Company:

 

Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

One Towne Square

Suite 1900

Southfield, MI 48076

Attention: Colleen Kimmel

 

Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

One Towne Square

Suite 1900

Southfield, MI 48076

Attention: Tom Lopp

 

 

 

with a copy to:

 

Honigman Miller Schwartz & Cohn LLP

660 Woodward Avenue

Detroit, MI 48226

Attention: David Jacob

 

 

 

if to a Purchaser:

 

To the address indicated on such Purchaser’s signature page.

 

or to such other address or addresses as the party to be given notice may have furnished in writing to the party seeking or desiring to give notice, as a place for the giving of notice; provided that no change in address shall be effective until five (5) Business Days after being given to the other party in the manner provided for above.  Any notice given in accordance with the foregoing shall be deemed given when delivered personally or, if mailed, three (3) Business Days after it shall have been deposited in the United States mails as aforesaid or, if sent by overnight courier, the Business Day following the date of delivery to such courier (provided next business day delivery was requested).

 

8.6          Successors and Assigns.  This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of the parties and their respective heirs, legal representatives, successors and assigns; except that, unless a Purchaser consents in writing, no assignment made by Company in violation of this Agreement shall be effective or confer any rights on any purported assignee of Company.  The term “successors and assigns” will not include a purchaser of any of the Subordinated Notes from any Purchaser merely because of such purchase.

 

8.7          No Joint Venture.  Nothing contained herein or in any document executed pursuant hereto and no action or inaction whatsoever on the part of a Purchaser, shall be deemed to make a Purchaser a partner or joint venturer with Company.

 

18



 

8.8          Documentation.  All documents and other matters required by any of the provisions of this Agreement to be submitted or furnished to a Purchaser shall be in form and substance satisfactory to such Purchaser.

 

8.9          Entire Agreement.  This Agreement and the Subordinated Notes along with the Exhibits thereto constitute the entire agreement between the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and may not be modified or amended in any manner other than by supplemental written agreement executed by the parties hereto.  No party, in entering into this Agreement, has relied upon any representation, warranty, covenant, condition or other term that is not set forth in this Agreement or in the Subordinated Notes.

 

8.10        Choice of Law.  This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York without giving effect to its laws or principles of conflict of laws.  Nothing herein shall be deemed to limit any rights, powers or privileges which a Purchaser may have pursuant to any law of the United States of America or any rule, regulation or order of any department or agency thereof and nothing herein shall be deemed to make unlawful any transaction or conduct by a Purchaser which is lawful pursuant to, or which is permitted by, any of the foregoing.

 

8.11        No Third Party Beneficiary.  This Agreement is made for the sole benefit of Company and the Purchasers, and no other person shall be deemed to have any privity of contract hereunder nor any right to rely hereon to any extent or for any purpose whatsoever, nor shall any other person have any right of action of any kind hereon or be deemed to be a third party beneficiary hereunder; provided, that the Placement Agent may rely on the representations and warranties contained herein to the same extent as if it were a party to this Agreement.

 

8.12        Legal Tender of United States.  All payments hereunder shall be made in coin or currency which at the time of payment is legal tender in the United States of America for public and private debts.

 

8.13        Captions; Counterparts.  Captions contained in this Agreement in no way define, limit or extend the scope or intent of their respective provisions.  This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed and delivered shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken together shall constitute but one and the same instrument.  In the event that any signature is delivered by facsimile transmission, or by e-mail delivery of a “.pdf” format data file, such signature shall create a valid and binding obligation of the party executing (or on whose behalf such signature is executed) with the same force and effect as if such facsimile signature page were an original thereof.

 

8.14        Knowledge; Discretion.  All references herein to Purchaser’s or Company’s knowledge shall be deemed to mean the knowledge of such party based on the actual knowledge of such party’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer or such other persons holding equivalent offices.  Unless specified to the contrary herein, all references herein to an exercise of discretion or judgment by a Purchaser, to the making of a determination or designation by a Purchaser, to the application of a Purchaser’s discretion or opinion, to the granting or withholding of a Purchaser’s consent or approval, to the consideration of whether a matter or thing is

 

19



 

satisfactory or acceptable to a Purchaser, or otherwise involving the decision making of a Purchaser, shall be deemed to mean that such Purchaser shall decide using the reasonable discretion or judgment of a prudent lender.

 

8.15        Waiver Of Right To Jury Trial.  TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW, THE PARTIES HEREBY KNOWINGLY, VOLUNTARILY AND INTENTIONALLY WAIVE ANY RIGHT THAT THEY MAY HAVE TO A TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LITIGATION ARISING IN ANY WAY IN CONNECTION WITH ANY OF THE TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS, OR ANY OTHER STATEMENTS OR ACTIONS OF COMPANY OR PURCHASERS.  THE PARTIES ACKNOWLEDGE THAT THEY HAVE BEEN REPRESENTED IN THE SIGNING OF THIS AGREEMENT AND IN THE MAKING OF THIS WAIVER BY INDEPENDENT LEGAL COUNSEL SELECTED OF THEIR OWN FREE WILL.  THE PARTIES FURTHER ACKNOWLEDGE THAT (I) THEY HAVE READ AND UNDERSTAND THE MEANING AND RAMIFICATIONS OF THIS WAIVER, (II) THIS WAIVER HAS BEEN REVIEWED BY THE PARTIES AND THEIR COUNSEL AND IS A MATERIAL INDUCEMENT FOR ENTRY INTO THIS AGREEMENT AND (III) THIS WAIVER SHALL BE EFFECTIVE AS TO EACH OF SUCH TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS AS IF FULLY INCORPORATED THEREIN.

 

8.16        Expenses.  Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, each of the parties will bear and pay all other costs and expenses incurred by it or on its behalf in connection with the transactions contemplated pursuant to this Agreement.

 

8.17        Survival.  Each of the representations and warranties set forth in this Agreement shall survive the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby for a period of one year after the date hereof.  Except as otherwise provided herein, all covenants and agreements contained herein shall survive until, by their respective terms, they are no longer operative.

 

[Signature Pages Follow]

 

20



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Company has caused this Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement to be executed by its duly authorized representative as of the date first above written.

 

 

COMPANY:

 

 

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

Gary Judd

 

 

Title:

Chief Executive Officer

 

[Company Signature Page to Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement]

 



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned Purchaser has caused this Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement to be executed by its duly authorized representative as of the date first above written.

 

 

 

PURCHASER:

 

 

 

[INSERT PURCHASER’S NAME]

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

[·]

 

 

Title:

[·]

 

 

 

Address of Purchaser:

 

 

 

[·]

 

 

 

 

 

Principal Amount of Purchased Subordinated Note:

 

 

 

$[·]

 

[Purchaser Signature Page to Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement]

 



 

EXHIBIT A

 

FORM OF SUBORDINATED NOTE

 

[See attached]

 


 

Exhibit A

 

SUBORDINATED NOTE

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

7.0% FIXED TO FLOATING SUBORDINATED NOTE DUE APRIL 15, 2026

 

THE INDEBTEDNESS EVIDENCED BY THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE IS NOT A DEPOSIT AND IS NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION (THE “FDIC”) OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENT AGENCY OR FUND.

 

THE INDEBTEDNESS EVIDENCED BY THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE IS SUBORDINATED AND JUNIOR IN RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO SENIOR INDEBTEDNESS (AS DEFINED IN SECTION 3 OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE) OF STERLING BANCORP, INC. (THE “COMPANY”), INCLUDING OBLIGATIONS OF THE COMPANY TO ITS GENERAL AND SECURED CREDITORS, AND IS UNSECURED.  IT IS INELIGIBLE AS COLLATERAL FOR ANY EXTENSION OF CREDIT BY THE COMPANY OR ANY OF ITS SUBSIDIARIES.  IN THE EVENT OF LIQUIDATION ALL HOLDERS OF SENIOR INDEBTEDNESS OF THE COMPANY SHALL BE ENTITLED TO BE PAID IN FULL WITH SUCH INTEREST AS MAY BE PROVIDED BY LAW BEFORE ANY PAYMENT SHALL BE MADE ON ACCOUNT OF PRINCIPAL OF OR INTEREST ON THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE.  AFTER PAYMENT IN FULL OF ALL SUMS OWING TO SUCH HOLDERS OF SENIOR INDEBTEDNESS, THE HOLDER OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE, TOGETHER WITH THE HOLDERS OF ANY OBLIGATIONS OF THE COMPANY RANKING ON A PARITY WITH THE SUBORDINATED NOTES, SHALL BE ENTITLED TO BE PAID FROM THE REMAINING ASSETS OF THE COMPANY THE UNPAID PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE PLUS ACCRUED AND UNPAID INTEREST THEREON BEFORE ANY PAYMENT OR OTHER DISTRIBUTION, WHETHER IN CASH, PROPERTY OR OTHERWISE, SHALL BE MADE (I) WITH RESPECT TO ANY OBLIGATION THAT BY ITS TERMS EXPRESSLY IS JUNIOR IN THE RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO THE SUBORDINATED NOTES, (II) ANY INDEBTEDNESS BETWEEN THE COMPANY AND ANY OF ITS SUBSIDIARIES OR AFFILIATES OR (III) ON ACCOUNT OF ANY SHARES OF CAPITAL STOCK OF THE COMPANY.

 

THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE WILL BE ISSUED AND MAY BE TRANSFERRED ONLY IN MINIMUM DENOMINATIONS OF $1,000 AND MULTIPLES OF $1,000 IN EXCESS THEREOF.  ANY ATTEMPTED TRANSFER OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE IN A DENOMINATION OF LESS THAN $1,000 SHALL BE DEEMED TO BE VOID AND OF NO LEGAL EFFECT WHATSOEVER.  ANY SUCH PURPORTED TRANSFEREE SHALL BE DEEMED NOT TO BE THE HOLDER OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE FOR ANY PURPOSE, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE RECEIPT OF PAYMENTS ON THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE, AND SUCH PURPORTED TRANSFEREE SHALL BE DEEMED TO HAVE NO INTEREST WHATSOEVER IN THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE.

 

THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE MAY BE SOLD ONLY IN COMPLIANCE WITH APPLICABLE FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS.  THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE

 

A-1



 

HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR ANY APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR ANY OTHER APPLICABLE SECURITIES LAWS.  NEITHER THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE NOR ANY INTEREST OR PARTICIPATION HEREIN MAY BE REOFFERED, SOLD, ASSIGNED, TRANSFERRED, PLEDGED, ENCUMBERED OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF IN THE ABSENCE OF SUCH REGISTRATION OR UNLESS SUCH TRANSACTION IS EXEMPT FROM, OR NOT SUBJECT TO, THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT.

 

CERTAIN ERISA CONSIDERATIONS:

 

THE HOLDER OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE, OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN, BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF OR THEREOF AGREES, REPRESENTS AND WARRANTS THAT IT IS NOT AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN, INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ACCOUNT OR OTHER PLAN OR ARRANGEMENT SUBJECT TO TITLE I OF THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED (“ERISA”), OR SECTION 4975 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED (THE “CODE”) (EACH A “PLAN”), OR AN ENTITY WHOSE UNDERLYING ASSETS INCLUDE “PLAN ASSETS” BY REASON OF ANY PLAN’S INVESTMENT IN THE ENTITY, AND NO PERSON INVESTING “PLAN ASSETS” OF ANY PLAN MAY ACQUIRE OR HOLD THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN, UNLESS SUCH PURCHASER OR HOLDER IS ELIGIBLE FOR THE EXEMPTIVE RELIEF AVAILABLE UNDER U.S. DEPARTMENT OF LABOR PROHIBITED TRANSACTION CLASS EXEMPTION 96-23, 95-60, 91-38, 90-1 OR 84-14 OR ANOTHER APPLICABLE EXEMPTION OR ITS PURCHASE AND HOLDING OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE, OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN, ARE NOT PROHIBITED BY SECTION 406 OF ERISA OR SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE WITH RESPECT TO SUCH PURCHASE AND HOLDING. ANY PURCHASER OR HOLDER OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN WILL BE DEEMED TO HAVE REPRESENTED BY ITS PURCHASE AND HOLDING THEREOF THAT EITHER: (i) IT IS NOT AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN OR OTHER PLAN TO WHICH TITLE I OF ERISA OR SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE IS APPLICABLE, A TRUSTEE OR OTHER PERSON ACTING ON BEHALF OF ANY SUCH EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN OR PLANS, OR ANY OTHER PERSON OR ENTITY USING THE “PLAN ASSETS” OF ANY SUCH EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN OR PLANS TO FINANCE SUCH PURCHASE OR (ii) SUCH PURCHASE OR HOLDING WILL NOT RESULT IN A PROHIBITED TRANSACTION UNDER SECTION 406 OF ERISA OR SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE FOR WHICH FULL EXEMPTIVE RELIEF IS NOT AVAILABLE UNDER APPLICABLE STATUTORY OR ADMINISTRATIVE EXEMPTION.

 

ANY FIDUCIARY OF ANY PLAN WHO IS CONSIDERING THE ACQUISITION OF THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN SHOULD CONSULT WITH HIS OR HER LEGAL COUNSEL PRIOR TO ACQUIRING THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE OR ANY INTEREST HEREIN.

 

A-2



 

Certificate No.: [·]

CUSIP [·]

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

7.0% FIXED TO FLOATING SUBORDINATED NOTE DUE APRIL 15, 2026

 

1.                                      Subordinated Notes.  This Subordinated Note is one of an issue of notes of Sterling Bancorp, Inc., a Michigan corporation (the “Company”) designated as the “7.0% Fixed to Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due April 15, 2026” (the “Subordinated Notes”).

 

2.                                      Payment.  The Company, for value received, promises to pay to                         , or its registered assigns, the principal sum of                  Dollars (U.S.) ($                 ), plus accrued but unpaid interest on April 15, 2026 (“Stated Maturity”) and to pay interest thereon (i) from and including April 14, 2016, the original issue date of the Subordinated Notes to but excluding April 15, 2021 or the earlier redemption date contemplated by Section 4 of this Subordinated Note, at the rate of 7.0% per annum, computed on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months and payable semi-annually in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year (each, a “Fixed Interest Payment Date”), beginning October 15, 2017, and (ii) from and including April 15, 2021 to but excluding the Stated Maturity or the earlier redemption date contemplated by Section 4 of this Subordinated Note, at the rate per annum, reset quarterly, equal to LIBOR determined on the determination date of the applicable interest period plus 582 basis points, computed on the basis of a 360-day year and the actual number of days elapsed and payable quarterly in arrears on January 15, April 15, July 15 and October 15 of each year (each, a “Floating Interest Payment Date”).  An “Interest Payment Date” is either a Fixed Interest Payment Date or a Floating Interest Payment Date, as applicable.  “LIBOR” means the 3-month USD LIBOR, which will be the offered rate for 3-month deposits in U.S. dollars, as that rate appears on the Reuters Screen LIBOR01 Page (or any successor page thereto) as of 11:00 a.m., London time, as observed two London banking days prior to the first day of the applicable floating rate interest period. If 3-month USD LIBOR is not displayed as of such time with respect to any applicable floating rate interest period, then the Company will request the principal London offices of at least two banks to provide a quotation of their rates for deposits in U.S. dollars for a period comparable to the applicable floating rate interest period and the 3-month USD LIBOR for such floating rate interest period shall be the arithmetic mean of such quotations.  A London banking day is a day on which commercial banks and foreign currency markets settle payments and are open for general business in London.

 

Any payment of principal of or interest on this Subordinated Note that would otherwise become due and payable on a day which is not a Business Day shall become due and payable on the next succeeding Business Day, with the same force and effect as if made on the date for payment of such principal or interest, and no interest will accrue in respect of such payment for the period after such day.  The term “Business Day” means any day that is not a Saturday or Sunday and that is not a day on which banks in the States of Michigan or California are generally authorized or required by law or executive order to be closed.

 

A-3



 

3.                                      Subordination.

 

(a)                                 The indebtedness of the Company evidenced by this Subordinated Note, including the principal and interest on this Subordinated Note, shall be subordinate and junior in right of payment to the prior payment in full of all existing claims of creditors of the Company, whether now outstanding or subsequently created, assumed, guaranteed or incurred (collectively, “Senior Indebtedness”), which shall consist of principal of (and premium, if any) and interest, if any, on: (i) all indebtedness and obligations of, or guaranteed or assumed by, the Company for money borrowed, whether or not evidenced by bonds, debentures, securities, notes or other similar instruments, and including, but not limited to, all obligations to the Company’s general and secured creditors; (ii) any deferred obligations of the Company for the payment of the purchase price of property or assets acquired other than in the ordinary course of business; (iii) all obligations, contingent or otherwise, of the Company in respect of any letters of credit, bankers’ acceptances, security purchase facilities and similar direct credit substitutes; (iv) any capital lease obligations of the Company; (v) all obligations of the Company in respect of interest rate swap, cap or other similar agreements, interest rate future or option contracts, currency swap agreements, currency future or option contracts, commodity contracts and other similar arrangements or derivative products; (vi) all obligations that are similar to those in clauses (i) through (v) of other persons for the payment of which the Company is responsible or liable as obligor, guarantor or otherwise arising from an off-balance sheet guarantee; (vii) all obligations of the types referred to in clauses (i) through (vi) of other persons secured by a lien on any property or asset of the Company; and (viii) in the case of (i) through (vii) above, all amendments, renewals, extensions, modifications and refunding’s of such indebtedness and obligations; except “Senior Indebtedness” does not include (A) the Subordinated Notes, (B) any obligation that by its terms expressly is junior to, or ranks equally in right of payment with, the Subordinated Notes, or (C) any indebtedness between the Company and any of its subsidiaries or Affiliates.  This Subordinated Note is not secured by any assets of the Company.  The term “Affiliate(s)” means, with respect to any Person, such Person’s immediate family members, partners, members or parent and subsidiary corporations, and any other Person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by, or under common control with said Person and their respective Affiliates.

 

(b)                                 In the event of any insolvency, dissolution, assignment for the benefit of creditors or any liquidation or winding up of or relating to the Company, whether voluntary or involuntary, holders of Senior Indebtedness shall be entitled to be paid in full before any payment shall be made on account of the principal of or interest on the Subordinated Notes, including this Subordinated Note.  In the event of any such proceeding, after payment in full of all sums owing with respect to the Senior Indebtedness, the registered holders of the Subordinated Notes from time to time (each a “Noteholder” and, collectively, the “Noteholders”), together with the holders of any obligations of the Company ranking on a parity with the Subordinated Notes, shall be entitled to be paid pro rata from the remaining assets of the Company the unpaid principal thereof, and the unpaid interest thereon before any payment or other distribution, whether in cash, property or otherwise, shall be made (i) with respect to any obligation that by its terms expressly is junior to the Subordinated Notes, (ii) any indebtedness between the Company and any of its subsidiaries or affiliates or (iii) on account of any capital stock.

 

(c)                                  If there shall have occurred and be continuing (i) a default in any payment with respect to any Senior Indebtedness or (ii) an event of default with respect to any Senior

 

A-4



 

Indebtedness as a result of which the maturity thereof is accelerated, unless and until such payment default or event of default shall have been cured or waived or shall have ceased to exist, no payments shall be made by the Company with respect to the Subordinated Notes.  The provisions of this paragraph shall not apply to any payment with respect to which the immediately preceding paragraph of this Section 3 would be applicable.

 

(d)                                 Nothing herein shall act to prohibit, limit or impede the Company from issuing additional debt of the Company having the same rank as the Subordinated Notes or which may be junior or senior in rank to the Subordinated Notes.

 

4.                                      Redemption.

 

(a)                                 Redemption Prior to Fifth Anniversary.  This Subordinated Note shall not be redeemable by the Company in whole or in part prior to the fifth anniversary of April 14, 2016, the date upon which this Subordinated Note was originally issued (the “Issue Date”), except in the event of a: (i) Tier 2 Capital Event (as defined below); (ii) Tax Event (as defined below); or (iii) Investment Company Event (as defined below).  Upon the occurrence of a Tier 2 Capital Event, a Tax Event or an Investment Company Event, the Company may redeem this Subordinated Note in whole or in part at any time, upon giving not less than 10 days’ notice to the Noteholder at an amount equal to 100% of the outstanding principal amount being redeemed plus accrued but unpaid interest, to but excluding the redemption date.  “Tier 2 Capital Event” means the receipt by the Company of an opinion of counsel to the Company to the effect that this Subordinated Note, or there is a material risk that this Subordinated Note, no longer qualifies as “Tier 2” Capital (as defined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”)) (or its then equivalent) as a result of a change in interpretation or application of law or regulation by any judicial, legislative or regulatory authority that becomes effective, or any other change, event, occurrence, development or state of facts that arises, after the date of issuance of this Subordinated Note.  “Tax Event” means the receipt by the Company of an opinion of counsel to the Company that as a result of any amendment to, or change (including any final and adopted (or enacted) prospective change) in, the laws (or any regulations thereunder) of the United States or any political subdivision or taxing authority thereof or therein, or as a result of any official administrative pronouncement or judicial decision interpreting or applying such laws or regulations, the interest payable by the Company on the Subordinated Note, or there exists a material risk that interest payable by the Company on the Subordinated Notes, is not, or within 120 days after the receipt of such opinion will not be, deductible by the Company, in whole or in part, for United States federal income tax purposes.  “Investment Company Event” means the receipt by the Company of an opinion of counsel to the Company to the effect that the Company, or there is a material risk that the Company, is or, within 120 days after the receipt of such opinion will be, required to register as an investment company pursuant to the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

 

(b)                                 Redemption on or after Fifth Anniversary.  On or after the fifth anniversary of the Issue Date, this Subordinated Note shall be redeemable at the option of and by the Company, in whole or in part at any time and from time to time upon any Interest Payment Date, at an amount equal to 100% of the outstanding principal amount being redeemed plus accrued but unpaid interest, to but excluding the redemption date, but in all cases in a principal amount with integral multiples of $1,000.  In addition, the Company may redeem all or a portion of the Subordinated

 

A-5



 

Notes, at any time upon the occurrence of a Tier 2 Capital Event, Tax Event or an Investment Company Event.

 

(c)                                  Partial Redemption.   If less than the then outstanding principal amount of this Subordinated Note is redeemed, (i) a new Subordinated Note shall be issued representing the unredeemed portion without charge to the holder thereof and (ii) such redemption shall be effected on a pro rata basis as to the Noteholders.  For purposes of clarity, upon a partial redemption, a like percentage of the principal amount of every Subordinated Note held by every Noteholder shall be redeemed.

 

(d)                                 No Redemption at Option of Noteholder.  This Subordinated Note is not subject to redemption at the option of the Noteholder.

 

(e)                                  Effectiveness of Redemption.  If notice of redemption has been duly given and notwithstanding that this Subordinated Note has been called for redemption but has not yet been surrendered for cancellation, on and after the date fixed for redemption interest shall cease to accrue on the portion of this Subordinated Note called for redemption, this Subordinated Note shall no longer be deemed outstanding with respect to the portion called for redemption and all rights with respect to the portion of this Subordinated Note called for redemption shall forthwith on such date fixed for redemption cease and terminate unless the Company shall default in the payment of the redemption price, except only the right of the holder hereof to receive the amount payable on such redemption, without interest.

 

(f)                                   Regulatory Approvals; Notice of Redemption. Any such redemption shall be subject to receipt of any and all required federal and state regulatory approvals, including, but not limited to, the prior approval of the Federal Reserve.  In the case of any redemption of this Subordinated Note pursuant to paragraph (b) of this Section 4, the Company will give the holder hereof notice of redemption, which notice shall indicate the aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes to be redeemed, not less than 30 nor more than 60 calendar days prior to the redemption date.

 

(g)                                  Purchase and Resale of the Subordinated Notes. Subject to any required federal and state regulatory approvals and the provisions of this Subordinated Note, including, but not limited to, any required prior approval of the Federal Reserve, the Company shall have the right to purchase any of the Subordinated Notes at any time in the open market, private transactions or otherwise.  If the Company purchases any Subordinated Notes, it may, in its discretion, hold, resell or cancel any of the purchased Subordinated Notes.

 

5.                                      Events of Default; Acceleration; Compliance Certificate.  Each of the following events shall constitute an “Event of Default”:

 

(a)                                 the entry of a decree or order for relief in respect of the Company by a court having jurisdiction in the premises in an involuntary case or proceeding under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, or reorganization law, now or hereafter in effect of the United States or any political subdivision thereof, and such decree or order will have continued unstayed and in effect for a period of 60 consecutive days;

 

A-6



 

(b)                                 the commencement by the Company of a voluntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization law, now or hereafter in effect of the United States or any political subdivision thereof, or the consent by the Company to the entry of a decree or order for relief in an involuntary case or proceeding under any such law;

 

(c)                                  the failure of the Company to pay any installment of interest on any of the Subordinated Notes as and when the same will become due and payable, and the continuation of such failure for a period of 30 days;

 

(d)                                 the failure of the Company to pay all or any part of the principal of any of the Subordinated Notes as and when the same will become due and payable; or

 

(e)                                  the failure of the Company to perform any other covenant or agreement on the part of the Company contained in the Subordinated Notes, and the continuation of such failure for a period of 30 days after the date on which notice specifying such failure, stating that such notice is a “Notice of Default” hereunder and demanding that the Company remedy the same, will have been given, in the manner set forth in Section 21, to the Company by Noteholders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the Subordinated Notes outstanding at such time.

 

Unless the principal of this Subordinated Note already shall have become due and payable, if an Event of Default set forth in subsections (a) or (b) above shall have occurred and be continuing, the Noteholder, by notice in writing to the Company, may declare the principal amount of this Subordinated Note to be due and payable immediately and, upon any such declaration the same shall become and shall be immediately due and payable on all outstanding Subordinated Notes, and the Company shall be deemed to have waived any demand, presentment for payment, notice of nonpayment, notice of protest, and all other notices. Notwithstanding the foregoing, upon the occurrence of an Event of Default other than an Event of Default described in Section 5(a) or Section 5(b), no Noteholder may accelerate the Stated Maturity of the Subordinated Notes and make the principal of, and any accrued and unpaid interest on, the Subordinated Notes, immediately due and payable.  The Company, within 45 calendar days after the receipt of written notice from any Noteholder of the occurrence of an Event of Default with respect to this Subordinated Note, shall mail to all Noteholders, at their addresses shown on the Security Register (as defined in Section 14 below), such written notice of Event of Default, unless such Event of Default shall have been cured or waived before the giving of such notice as certified by the Company in writing.

 

6.                                      Failure to Make Payments.  In the event of an Event of Default under Section 5(d) or Section 5(e) above, the Company will, upon demand of the Noteholder, pay to the Noteholder the amount then due and payable on this Subordinated Note for principal and interest (without acceleration of the Note in any manner), with interest on the overdue principal and interest at the rate borne by this Subordinated Note, to the extent permitted by applicable law.  If the Company fails to pay such amount upon such demand, the Noteholder may, among other things, institute a judicial proceeding for the collection of the sums so due and unpaid, may prosecute such proceeding to judgment or final decree and may enforce the same against the Company and collect the amounts adjudged or decreed to be payable in the manner provided by law out of the property of the Company.

 

A-7



 

Upon the occurrence of an Event of Default until such Event of Default is cured by the Company, except as may be required by any state or federal governmental agency, the Company shall not: (a) declare or pay any dividends or distributions on, or redeem, purchase, acquire, or make a liquidation payment with respect to, any of the Company’s capital stock; (b) make any payment of principal of or interest or premium, if any, on or repay, repurchase or redeem any indebtedness of the Company that ranks equal with or junior to the Subordinated Notes; or (c) make any payments under any guarantee that ranks equal with or junior to the Subordinated Notes, other than (i) any dividends or distributions in shares of, or options, warrants or rights to subscribe for or purchase shares of, any class of the Company’s common stock; (ii) any declaration of a non-cash dividend in connection with the implementation of a shareholders’ rights plan, or the issuance of stock under any such plan in the future, or the redemption or repurchase of any such rights pursuant thereto; (iii) as a result of a reclassification of the Company’s capital stock or the exchange or conversion of one class or series of the Company’s capital stock for another class or series of the Company’s capital stock; (iv) the purchase of fractional interests in shares of the Company’s capital stock pursuant to the conversion or exchange provisions of such capital stock or the security being converted or exchanged; or (v) purchases of any class of the Company’s common stock related to the issuance of common stock or rights under any benefit plans for the Company’s directors, officers or employees or any of the Company’s dividend reinvestment plans.

 

7.                                      Affirmative Covenants of the Company.

 

(a)                                 Notice of Certain Events.  To the extent permitted by applicable statute, rule or regulation, the Company shall provide written notice to the Holder of the occurrence of any of the following events as soon as practicable, but in no event later than fifteen (15) Business Days following the Company becoming aware of the occurrence of such event:

 

(i)                                     The Company, or any officer of the Company, becomes subject to any formal, written regulatory enforcement action (as defined by the applicable Regulatory Agency);

 

(ii)                                  The appointment, resignation, removal or termination of the chief executive officer, president, chief operating officer, chief financial officer, chief credit officer or chief lending officer of the Company; or

 

(iii)                               There is a change in ownership of 50% or more of the outstanding securities of the Company entitled to vote for the election of directors.

 

(b)                                 Payment of Principal and Interest. The Company covenants and agrees for the benefit of the Noteholder that it will duly and punctually pay the principal of, and interest on, this Subordinated Note, in accordance with the terms hereof.

 

(c)                                  Maintenance of Office. The Company will maintain an office or agency in the city of Southfield, Michigan where Subordinated Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or for exchange and where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of the Subordinated Notes may be served.  The Company may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Subordinated Notes may be presented or surrendered for any or all such purposes and may from time to time rescind such designations; provided that no such designation or rescission will in any manner relieve the Company of its obligation to maintain an

 

A-8



 

office or agency in the city of Southfield, Michigan.  The Company will give prompt written notice to the Noteholders of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency.

 

(d)                                 Corporate Existence. The Company will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect: (i) the corporate existence of the Company; (ii) the existence (corporate or other) of each subsidiary; and (iii) the rights (charter and statutory), licenses and franchises of the Company and each of its subsidiaries; provided, however, that the Company will not be required to preserve the existence (corporate or other) of any of its subsidiaries or any such right, license or franchise of the Company or any of its subsidiaries if the Board of Directors of the Company determines that the preservation thereof is no longer desirable in the conduct of the business of the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole and that the loss thereof will not be disadvantageous in any material respect to the Noteholders.

 

(e)                                  Maintenance of Properties. The Company will, and will cause each subsidiary to, cause all its properties used or useful in the conduct of its business to be maintained and kept in good condition, repair and working order and supplied with all necessary equipment and will cause to be made all necessary repairs, renewals, replacements, betterments and improvements thereof, all as in the judgment of the Company may be necessary so that the business carried on in connection therewith may be properly and advantageously conducted at all times; provided, however, that nothing in this Section will prevent the Company or any subsidiary from discontinuing the operation and maintenance of any of their respective properties if such discontinuance is, in the judgment of the Board of Directors of the Company or of any subsidiary, as the case may be desirable in the conduct of its business.

 

(f)                                   Waiver of Certain Covenants.  The Company may omit in any particular instance to comply with any term, provision or condition set forth in Section 7(b), Section 7(c), Section 7(d) or Section 7(e) above, with respect to this Subordinated Note if before the time for such compliance the Noteholders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the outstanding Subordinated Notes, by act of such Noteholders, either will waive such compliance in such instance or generally will have waived compliance with such term, provision or condition, but no such waiver will extend to or affect such term, provision or condition except to the extent so expressly waived, and, until such waiver will become effective, the obligations of the Company in respect of any such term, provision or condition will remain in full force and effect.

 

(g)                                  Company Statement as to Compliance.  The Company will deliver to the Noteholders, within 120 days after the end of each fiscal year, an Officer’s Certificate covering the preceding calendar year, stating whether or not, to the best of his or her knowledge, the Company is in default in the performance and observance of any of the terms, provisions and conditions of this Subordinated Note (without regard to notice requirements or periods of grace) and if the Company will be in default, specifying all such defaults and the nature and status thereof of which he or she may have knowledge.

 

(h)                                 Tier 2 Capital.  If all or any portion of the Subordinated Notes ceases to be deemed to be Tier 2 Capital, other than due to the limitation imposed on the capital treatment of subordinated debt during the five years immediately preceding the Stated Maturity of the Subordinated Notes, the Company may promptly notify the Noteholders and thereafter the

 

A-9



 

Company and the Noteholders will work together in good faith to execute and deliver all agreements as reasonably necessary in order to restructure the applicable portions of the obligations evidenced by the Subordinated Notes to qualify as Tier 2 Capital; provided, however, that nothing contained in this Section 7(h) shall limit the Company’s right to redeem the Subordinated Notes upon the occurrence of a Tier 2 Capital Event pursuant to Section 4(a) or Section 4(b).

 

(i)                                     Compliance with Laws.  The Company shall comply with the requirements of all laws, regulations, orders and decrees applicable to it or its properties, except for such noncompliance that would not reasonably be expected to result in a material adverse effect (i) in the condition (financial or otherwise), or in the earnings of the Company, whether or not arising in the ordinary course of business, or (ii) on the ability of the Company to perform its obligations under this Subordinated Note.

 

(j)                                    Taxes and Assessments.  The Company shall punctually pay and discharge all material taxes, assessments, and other governmental charges or levies imposed upon it or upon its income or upon any of its properties; provided, that no such taxes, assessments or other governmental charges need be paid if they are being contested in good faith by the Company.

 

8.                                      Negative Covenants of the Company.

 

(a)                                 Limitation on Dividends.  The Company shall not declare or pay any dividend or make any distribution on capital stock or other equity securities of any kind of the Company if the Company is not “well capitalized” for regulatory purposes immediately prior to the declaration of such dividend or distribution, except for dividends payable solely in shares of common stock of the Company.

 

(b)                                 Merger or Sale of Assets.  The Company shall not merge into another entity or convey, transfer or lease substantially all of  its properties and assets to any person, unless:

 

(i)                                     the continuing entity into which the Company is merged or the person which acquires by conveyance or transfer or which leases substantially all of the properties and assets of the Company shall be a corporation, association or other legal entity organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia and expressly assumes the due and punctual payment of the principal of and any premium and interest on the Subordinated Notes according to their terms, and the due and punctual performance of all covenants and conditions hereof on the part of the Company to be performed or observed; and

 

(ii)                                  immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no Event of Default, and no event which, after notice or lapse of time or both, would become an Event of Default, shall have happened and be continuing.

 

9.                                      Global Subordinated Notes.

 

(a)                                 Provided that applicable depository eligibility requirements are met, upon the written election of any Noteholder that is a Qualified Institutional Buyer, as defined in Rule 144A under the Securities Act, the Company shall use its commercially reasonable efforts to provide that the Subordinated Notes owned by Noteholders that are Qualified Institutional Buyers shall be

 

A-10


 

issued in the form of one or more Global Subordinated Notes (each a “Global Subordinated Note”) registered in the name of The Depository Trust Company or another organization registered as a clearing agency under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), and designated as Depositary by the Company or any successor thereto (the “Depositary”) or a nominee thereof and delivered to such Depositary or a nominee thereof.

 

(b)                                 Notwithstanding any other provision herein, no Global Subordinated Note may be exchanged in whole or in part for Subordinated Notes registered, and no transfer of a Global Subordinated Note in whole or in part may be registered, in the name of any person other than the Depositary for such Global Subordinated Note or a nominee thereof unless (i) such Depositary advises the Company in writing that such Depositary is no longer willing or able to properly discharge its responsibilities as Depositary with respect to such Global Subordinated Note, and no qualified successor is appointed by the Company within 90 days of receipt by the Company of such notice, (ii) such Depositary ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act and no successor is appointed by the Company within 90 days after obtaining knowledge of such event, (iii) the Company elects to terminate the book-entry system through the Depositary or (iv) an Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing.  Upon the occurrence of any event specified in clause (i), (ii), (iii) or (iv) of this Section 9(b) above, the Company or its agent shall notify the Depositary and instruct the Depositary to notify all owners of beneficial interests in such Global Subordinated Note of the occurrence of such event and of the availability of Subordinated Notes to such owners of beneficial interests requesting the same.

 

(c)                                  If any Global Subordinated Note is to be exchanged for other Subordinated Notes or canceled in part, or if another Subordinated Note is to be exchanged in whole or in part for a beneficial interest in any Global Subordinated Note, then either (i) such Global Subordinated Note shall be so surrendered for exchange or cancellation as provided in this Section 9 or (ii) the principal amount thereof shall be reduced or increased by an amount equal to the portion thereof to be so exchanged or canceled, or equal to the principal amount of such other Subordinated Note to be so exchanged for a beneficial interest therein, as the case may be, by means of an appropriate adjustment made on the records of the Company or, if applicable, the Company’s registrar and transfer agent (“Registrar”), whereupon the Company or, if applicable, the Registrar, in accordance with the applicable rules and procedures of the Depositary (“Applicable Depositary Procedures”), shall instruct the Depositary or its authorized representative to make a corresponding adjustment to its records.  Upon any such surrender or adjustment of a Global Subordinated Note by the Depositary, accompanied by registration instructions, the Company shall execute and deliver any Subordinated Notes issuable in exchange for such Global Subordinated Note (or any portion thereof) in accordance with the instructions of the Depositary.

 

(d)                                 Every Subordinated Note executed and delivered upon registration of transfer of, or in exchange for or in lieu of, a Global Subordinated Note or any portion thereof shall be executed and delivered in the form of, and shall be, a Global Subordinated Note, unless such Subordinated Note is registered in the name of a person other than the Depositary for such Global Subordinated Note or a nominee thereof.

 

(e)                                  The Depositary or its nominee, as the registered owner of a Global Subordinated Note, shall be the holder of such Global Subordinated Note for all purposes under this Subordinated Note, and owners of beneficial interests in a Global Subordinated Note shall hold

 

A-11



 

such interests pursuant to Applicable Depositary Procedures.  Accordingly, any such owner’s beneficial interest in a Global Subordinated Note shall be shown only on, and the transfer of such interest shall be effected only through, records maintained by the Depositary or its nominee or its Depositary participants.  If applicable, the Registrar shall be entitled to deal with the Depositary for all purposes relating to a Global Subordinated Note (including the payment of principal and interest thereon and the giving of instructions or directions by owners of beneficial interests therein and the giving of notices) as the sole holder of the Subordinated Note and shall have no obligations to the owners of beneficial interests therein.  The Registrar shall have no liability in respect of any transfers affected by the Depositary.

 

(f)                                   The rights of owners of beneficial interests in a Global Subordinated Note shall be exercised only through the Depositary and shall be limited to those established by law and agreements between such owners and the Depositary and/or its participants.

 

(g)                                  No holder of any beneficial interest in any Global Subordinated Note held on its behalf by a Depositary shall have any rights with respect to such Global Subordinated Note, and such Depositary may be treated by the Company and any agent of the Company as the owner of such Global Subordinated Note for all purposes whatsoever.  Neither the Company nor any agent of the Company will have any responsibility or liability for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on account of beneficial ownership interests of a Global Subordinated Note or maintaining, supervising or reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing herein shall prevent the Company or any agent of the Company from giving effect to any written certification, proxy or other authorization furnished by a Depositary or impair, as between a Depositary and such holders of beneficial interests, the operation of customary practices governing the exercise of the rights of the Depositary (or its nominee) as holder of any Subordinated Note.

 

(h)                                 Company, within 30 calendar days after the receipt of written notice from the Noteholder or any other holder of the Subordinated Notes of the occurrence of an Event of Default with respect to this Note, shall mail to all the Noteholders, at their addresses shown on the Security Register (as defined in Section 14 below), such written notice of Event of Default, unless such Event of Default shall have been cured or waived before the giving of such notice as certified by Company in writing.

 

10.                               Denominations.  The Subordinated Notes are issuable only in registered form without interest coupons in minimum denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

 

11.                               Charges and Transfer Taxes.  No service charge will be made for any registration of transfer or exchange of this Subordinated Note, or any redemption or repayment of this Subordinated Note, or any conversion or exchange of this Subordinated Note for other types of securities or property, but the Company may require payment of a sum sufficient to pay all taxes, assessments or other governmental charges that may be imposed in connection with the transfer or exchange of this Subordinated Note from the Noteholder requesting such transfer or exchange.

 

12.                               Payment Procedures.  Payment of the principal and interest payable on the Stated Maturity will be made by check, or by wire transfer in immediately available funds to a bank

 

A-12



 

account in the United States designated by the Noteholder if such Noteholder shall have previously provided wire instructions to the Company, upon presentation and surrender of this Subordinated Note at the Payment Office (as defined in Section 21 below) or at such other place or places as the Company shall designate by notice to the Noteholders as the Payment Office, provided that this Subordinated Note is presented to the Company in time for the Company to make such payments in such funds in accordance with its normal procedures.  Payments of interest (other than interest payable on the Stated Maturity) shall be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds or check mailed to the registered Noteholder, as such person’s address appears on the Security Register (as defined below).  Interest payable on any Interest Payment Date shall be payable to the Noteholder in whose name this Subordinated Note is registered at the close of business on the fifteenth calendar day prior to the applicable Interest Payment Date, without regard to whether such date is a Business Day (such date being referred to herein as the “Regular Record Date”), except that interest not paid on the Interest Payment Date, if any, will be paid to the Noteholder in whose name this Subordinated Note is registered at the close of business on a special record date fixed by the Company (a “Special Record Date”), notice of which shall be given to the Noteholder not less than 10 calendar days prior to such Special Record Date.  (The Regular Record Date and Special Record Date are referred to herein collectively as the “Record Dates”).  To the extent permitted by applicable law, interest shall accrue, at the rate at which interest accrues on the principal of this Subordinated Note, on any amount of principal or interest on this Subordinated Note not paid when due.  All payments on this Subordinated Note shall be applied first against interest due hereunder; and then against principal due hereunder.  The Noteholder acknowledges and agrees that the payment of all or any portion of the outstanding principal amount of this Subordinated Note and all interest hereon shall be pari passu in right of payment and in all other respects to the other Subordinated Notes.  In the event that the Noteholder receives payments in excess of its pro rata share of the Company’s payments to the Noteholders of all of the Subordinated Notes, then the Noteholder shall hold in trust all such excess payments for the benefit of the Noteholders of the other Subordinated Notes and shall pay such amounts held in trust to such other Noteholders upon demand by such Noteholders.

 

13.                               Form of Payment.  Payments of principal and interest on this Subordinated Note shall be made in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment shall be legal tender for the payment of public and private debts.

 

14.                               Registration of Transfer, Security Register.  Except as otherwise provided herein, this Subordinated Note is transferable in whole or in part, and may be exchanged for a like aggregate principal amount of Subordinated Notes of other authorized denominations, by the Noteholder in person, or by his attorney duly authorized in writing, at the Payment Office.  The Company shall maintain a register providing for the registration of the Subordinated Notes and any exchange or transfer thereof (the “Security Register”).  Upon surrender or presentation of this Subordinated Note for exchange or registration of transfer, the Company shall execute and deliver in exchange therefor a Subordinated Note or Subordinated Notes of like aggregate principal amount, each in a minimum denomination of $1,000 or any amount in excess thereof which is an integral multiple of $1,000 (and, in the absence of an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the Company to the contrary, bearing the restrictive legend(s) set forth hereinabove) and that is or are registered in such name or names requested by the Noteholder.  Any Subordinated Note presented or surrendered for registration of transfer or for exchange shall be duly endorsed and accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in such form as is attached hereto and incorporated herein, duly

 

A-13



 

executed by the Noteholder or his attorney duly authorized in writing, with such tax identification number or other information for each person in whose name a Subordinated Note is to be issued, and accompanied by evidence of compliance with any restrictive legend(s) appearing on such Subordinated Note or Subordinated Notes as the Company may reasonably request to comply with applicable law.  No exchange or registration of transfer of this Subordinated Note shall be made on or after (i) the fifteenth day immediately preceding the Stated Maturity or (ii) the due delivery of notice of redemption.

 

15.                               Priority.  The Subordinated Notes rank pari passu among themselves and pari passu, in the event of any insolvency proceeding, dissolution, assignment for the benefit of creditors, reorganization, restructuring of debt, marshaling of assets and liabilities or similar proceeding or any liquidation or winding up of the Company, with all other present or future unsecured subordinated debt obligations of the Company, except any unsecured subordinated debt that, pursuant to its express terms, is senior or subordinate in right of payment to the Subordinated Notes.

 

16.                               Ownership.  Prior to due presentment of this Subordinated Note for registration of transfer, the Company may treat the Noteholder in whose name this Subordinated Note is registered in the Security Register as the absolute owner of this Subordinated Note for receiving payments of principal and interest on this Subordinated Note and for all other purposes whatsoever, whether or not this Subordinated Note be overdue, and the Company shall not be affected by any notice to the contrary.

 

17.                               Waiver and Consent.

 

(a)                                 Any consent or waiver given by the Noteholder shall be conclusive and binding upon such Noteholder and upon all future Noteholders of this Subordinated Note and of any Subordinated Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange therefor or in lieu hereof, whether or not notation of such consent or waiver is made upon this Subordinated Note.  No delay or omission of the Noteholder to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Event of Default shall impair such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Any insured depository institution which shall be a Noteholder or which otherwise shall have any beneficial ownership interest in this Subordinated Note shall, by its acceptance of such Subordinated Note (or beneficial interest therein), be deemed to have waived any right of offset with respect to the indebtedness evidenced thereby.

 

(b)                                 No waiver or amendment of any term, provision, condition, covenant or agreement in the Subordinated Notes shall be effective except with the consent of the holders of not less than more than fifty percent (50%) in aggregate principal amount (excluding any Subordinated Notes held by Company or any of its Affiliates) of the Subordinated Notes at the time outstanding; provided, however, that without the consent of each Noteholder of an affected Subordinated Note, no such amendment or waiver may:  (i) reduce the principal amount of any Subordinated Note; (ii) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any Subordinated Note; (iii) extend the maturity of any Subordinated Note, (iv) change the currency in which payment of the obligations of Company under the Subordinated Notes are to be made; (v) lower the percentage of aggregate principal amount of outstanding Subordinated Notes required to approve any amendment of the Subordinated Notes; (vi) make any changes to Section 6 (Failure to Make

 

A-14



 

Payments) of the Subordinated Notes that adversely affects the rights of any Noteholder; or (vii) disproportionately affect any of the Noteholders of the then outstanding Subordinated Notes.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, Company may amend or supplement the Subordinated Notes without the consent of the Noteholders to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency or to provide for uncertificated Subordinated Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Subordinated Notes, or to make any change that does not adversely affect the rights of any Noteholder of any of the Subordinated Notes.  No failure to exercise or delay in exercising, by any Noteholder of the Subordinated Notes, of any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege preclude any other or further exercise thereof, or the exercise of any other right or remedy provided by law.  The rights and remedies provided in this Subordinated Note are cumulative and not exclusive of any right or remedy provided by law or equity.  No notice or demand on Company in any case shall, in itself, entitle Company to any other or further notice or demand in similar or other circumstances or constitute a waiver of the rights of Noteholders to any other or further action in any circumstances without notice or demand.  No consent or waiver, expressed or implied, by Noteholders to or of any breach or default by Company in the performance of its obligations hereunder shall be deemed or construed to be a consent or waiver to or of any other breach or default in the performance of the same or any other obligations of Company hereunder.  Failure on the part of the Noteholders to complain of any acts or failure to act or to declare an Event of Default, irrespective of how long such failure continues, shall not constitute a waiver by the Noteholders of their rights hereunder or impair any rights, powers or remedies on account of any breach or default by Company.

 

18.                               Absolute and Unconditional Obligation of the Company.  No provisions of this Subordinated Note shall alter or impair the obligation of the Company, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal and interest on this Subordinated Note at the times, places and rate, and in the coin or currency, herein prescribed.

 

19.                               No Sinking Fund; Convertibility.  This Subordinated Note is not entitled to the benefit of any sinking fund.  This Subordinated Note is not convertible into or exchangeable for any of the equity securities, other securities or assets of the Company or any subsidiary.

 

20.                               No Recourse Against Others.  No recourse under or upon any obligation, covenant or agreement contained in this Subordinated Note, or for any claim based thereon or otherwise in respect thereof, will be had against any past, present or future shareholder, employee, officer, or director, as such, of the Company or of any predecessor or successor, either directly or through the Company or any predecessor or successor, under any rate of law, statute or constitutional provision or by the enforcement of any assessment or by any legal or equitable proceeding or otherwise, all such liability being expressly waived and released by the acceptance of this Subordinated Note by the Noteholder and as part of the consideration for the issuance of this Subordinated Note.

 

21.                               Notices.  All notices to the Company under this Subordinated Note shall be in writing and addressed to the Company at One Towne Square, Suite 1900, Southfield, MI 48076, Attention: Colleen Kimmel, or to such other address as the Company may notify to the Holder (the “Payment Office”).  All notices to the Noteholders shall be in writing and sent by first-class mail to each Noteholder at his or its address as set forth in the Security Register.

 

A-15



 

22.                               Further Issues.  The Company may, without the consent of the Noteholders, create and issue additional notes having the same terms and conditions of the Subordinated Notes (except for the Issue Date) so that such further notes shall be consolidated and form a single series with the Subordinated Notes.

 

23.                               Governing Law; Interpretation.  THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE WILL BE DEEMED TO BE A CONTRACT MADE UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK AND WILL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK WITHOUT REGARD TO CONFLICT OF LAW PRINCIPLES THEREOF.  THIS SUBORDINATED NOTE IS INTENDED TO MEET THE CRITERIA FOR QUALIFICATION OF THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AS TIER 2 CAPITAL UNDER THE REGULATORY GUIDELINES OF THE FEDERAL RESERVE, AND THE TERMS HEREOF SHALL BE INTERPRETED IN A MANNER TO SATISFY SUCH INTENT.

 

[Signature Page Follows]

 

A-16



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has caused this Subordinated Note to be duly executed and attested.

 

 

STERLING BANCORP, INC.

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

Gary Judd

 

 

Title:

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

ATTEST:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name: Tom Lopp

 

Title: President

 

 

[Signature Page to Subordinated Note]

 



 

ASSIGNMENT FORM

 

To assign this Subordinated Note, fill in the form below: (I) or (we) assign and transfer this Subordinated Note to:

 

 

(Print or type assignee’s name, address and zip code)

 

 

(Insert assignee’s social security or tax I.D. No.)

 

and irrevocably appoint                                       agent to transfer this Subordinated Note on the books of the Company. The agent may substitute another to act for him.

 

Date:

 

 

Your signature:

 

 

(Sign exactly as your name appears on the face of this Subordinated Note)

 

 

 

Tax Identification No:

 

 

Signature Guarantee:

 

(Signatures must be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution (banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions with membership in an approved signature guarantee medallion program), pursuant to Rule 17Ad-15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)).

 

The undersigned certifies that it [is / is not] an Affiliate of the Company and that, to its knowledge, the proposed transferee [is / is not] an Affiliate of the Company.

 

In connection with any transfer or exchange of this Subordinated Note occurring prior to the date that is one year after the later of the date of original issuance of this Subordinated Note and the last date, if any, on which this Subordinated Note was owned by the Company or any Affiliate of the Company, the undersigned confirms that this Subordinated Note is being:

 

CHECK ONE BOX BELOW:

 

¨                              (1)                                       acquired for the undersigned’s own account, without transfer;

 

¨                              (2)                                       transferred to the Company;

 

¨                              (3)                                       transferred in accordance and in compliance with Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”);

 

¨                              (4)                                       transferred under an effective registration statement under the Securities Act;

 

¨                              (5)                                       transferred in accordance with and in compliance with Regulation S under the Securities Act;

 



 

¨                              (6)                                       transferred to an institutional “accredited investor” (as defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2), (3) or (7) under the Securities Act) or an “accredited investor” (as defined in Rule 501(a)(4) under the Securities Act), that has furnished a signed letter containing certain representations and agreements; or

 

¨                              (7)                                       transferred in accordance with another available exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 

Unless one of the boxes is checked, the Company will refuse to register this Subordinated Note in the name of any person other than the registered holder thereof; provided, however, that if box (5), (6) or (7) is checked, the Company may require, prior to registering any such transfer of this Subordinated Note, in its sole discretion, such legal opinions, certifications and other information as the Company may reasonably request to confirm that such transfer is being made pursuant to an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the registration requirements of the Securities Act such as the exemption provided by Rule 144 under such Act.

 

 

Signature:

 

 

Signature Guarantee:

 

(Signatures must be guaranteed by an eligible guarantor institution (banks, stockbrokers, savings and loan associations and credit unions with membership in an approved signature guarantee medallion program), pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 17Ad-l5).

 

TO BE COMPLETED BY PURCHASER IF BOX (1) OR (3) ABOVE IS CHECKED.

 

The undersigned represents and warrants that it is purchasing this Subordinated Note for its own account or an account with respect to which it exercises sole investment discretion and that it and any such account is a “qualified institutional buyer” within the meaning of Rule 144A under the Securities Act and is aware that the sale to it is being made in reliance on Rule 144A and acknowledges that it has received such information regarding the Company as the undersigned has requested pursuant to Rule 144A or has determined not to request such information and that it is aware that the transferor is relying upon the undersigned’s foregoing representations in order to claim the exemption from registration provided by Rule 144A.

 

Date:

 

 

Signature:

 

 



 

EXHIBIT B

 

OPINION OF COUNSEL

 

1.             Company is validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization.(1)

 

2.             Bank is validly existing and in good standing under federal law.(2)

 

3.             Each of Company and Bank has all requisite power and authority to carry on its business and to own, lease and operate its properties and assets as described in Company’s Reports.

 

4.             Company has all necessary power and authority to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Transaction Documents to which it is a party and to consummate the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Documents.

 

5.             The Agreement has been duly and validly authorized, executed and delivered by Company.

 

6.             The Subordinated Notes have been duly and validly authorized by Company and when issued and delivered to and paid for by Purchasers in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, will have been duly executed, issued and delivered and will constitute legal, valid and binding obligations of Company, enforceable against Company in accordance with their terms, except that the enforcement thereof may be subject to (i) bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, receivership, moratorium, fraudulent conveyance, fraudulent transfer or other similar laws now or hereafter in effect relating to creditors’ rights generally and (ii) general principles of equity (whether applied by a court of law or equity) and the discretion of the court before which any proceeding therefor may be brought.

 

7.             Assuming the accuracy of the representations and warranties of each of the Purchasers set forth in the Agreement and in the Prior Purchase Agreements, the Subordinated Notes to be issued and sold by Company to Purchasers pursuant to the Agreement will be issued in a transaction exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 


(1)  Opinion to be based solely on good standing certificates issued by relevant governmental agencies.

(2)  Opinion to be based solely on good standing certificates issued by relevant governmental agencies in connection with the August issuance.

 




Exhibit 21

 

Subsidiaries of Sterling Bancorp, Inc.

 

Subsidiary

 

State of Formation

Sterling Bank & Trust, F.S.B.

 

Michigan

Quantum Capital Management

 

Michigan

Sterling Wealth Management

 

Michigan

 




Exhibit 23.1

 

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

We consent to the use in this Registration Statement of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. on Form S-1 of our report dated September 15, 2017 on the consolidated financial statements of Sterling Bancorp, Inc. and to the reference to us under the heading “Experts” in the prospectus.

 

 

/s/ Crowe Horwath LLP

 

 

 

Crowe Horwath LLP

 

 

Grand Rapids, Michigan

 

October 19, 2017